Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 340

Inglés 6F9012720BQ (11.

21)

6F9012720BQ

SEAT Arona Inglés (11.21)


Owner’s manual
Arona
Vehicle identification data Confirmation of receipt of documentation
and vehicle keys
Model:
The following items were delivered
YES NO
with the vehicle:
Vehicle Registration:
On-board documentation
Vehicle identification
number: First key

Date of vehicle registration Second key


or vehicle delivery:
Correct working order of all keys was
checked
SEAT Official Service:
Location:

SEAT S.A. is permanently concerned about continuous development of its types and models. For this reason we ask you to understand,
that at any given time, changes regarding shape, equipment and technique may take place on the car delivered. For this reason no
Date: right at all may derive based on the data, drawings and descriptions in this current handbook.
All texts, illustrations and standards in this handbook are based on the status of information at the time of printing. Except for error or
omission, the information included in the current handbook is valid as of the date of closing print.
Signature of owner: Re-printing, copying or translating, whether total or partial is not allowed unless SEAT allows it in written form.
SEAT reserves all rights in accordance with the “Copyright” Act.
Service advisor:
All rights on changes are reserved.

Telephone:
❀ This paper has been manufactured using bleached non-chlorine cellulose.
© SEAT S.A. - Reprint: 15.11.21
Introduction
Thank you for your trust choosing a SEAT ve- WARNING
hicle. Read and always observe safety infor-
With your new SEAT, you will be able to enjoy mation concerning the passenger's
a vehicle with state-of-the-art technology front airbag ››› page 30, Fitting and us-
and top quality features. ing child seats.
We recommend reading this Instruction Man-
ual carefully to learn more about your vehicle
so you can enjoy all its benefits in your daily
driving.
Information about handling is complemented
with instructions regarding the operation and
maintenance of the vehicle in order to ensure
its safety and maintain its value. Moreover, we
want to give you valuable advice and tips to
drive your vehicle efficiently and respecting
the environment.
We wish you safe and enjoyable motoring.

SEAT, S.A.
About this manual direction of the vehicle unless otherwise sta-
ted.
WARNING
Texts after this symbol contain informa-
This instruction manual is valid for all variants This instruction manual has been written for tion about safety and warn you about
and versions of your SEAT model. It describes left-hand drive vehicles. In right-hand drive possible accident or injury risks.
all equipment and models without specifying vehicles, the arrangement of the controls dif-
whether they are optional equipment or fers partly from that shown in the illustrations
or described in the texts. CAUTION
model variants. As a result, equipment not fit-
ted to your vehicle or only available in certain Texts after this symbol indicate possible
Technical modifications to the vehicle or
countries may be described. Find out about damage to the vehicle.
safety-critical issues that have arisen since
your vehicle's equipment in the documenta-
the time of going to press will be included in a
tion supplied with it and please contact your
supplement to the on-board documentation. For the sake of the environment
SEAT Official SEAT Service if you require
more detailed information. Texts after this symbol contain informa-
® Trademarks are marked with ®. The ab-
tion about the protection of the environ-
All information provided in instruction manual sence of this symbol does not guarantee
that the term is not a trademark. ment.
corresponds to the information available at
the time of going to press. As the vehicle is  It indicates that the section continues on
under continuous development, it may have the next page. Note
differences to the data included in this man- Texts after this symbol contain addition-
ual. For this reason, no claims can be made in You can access the information in this manual
al information.
the event of mismatching data, illustrations using:
and descriptions. ● Thematic table of contents that follows the
Ensure that the on-board documentation is manual’s general chapter structure.
kept in the vehicle at all times if you sell it or ● Visual table of contents that uses graphics
lend it to third parties. In addition, SEAT rec- to indicate the pages containing “essential”
ommends resetting the infotainment system information, which is detailed in the corre-
to factory settings to delete all personal data. sponding chapters.
Some details on the drawings may vary from ● Alphabetical index with many terms and
its vehicle and must be interpreted as a synonyms to help you find information.
standard representation.
The direction indicators (left, right, forwards,
backwards) in this manual refer to the travel
Digital instruction manual Related videos
The digital version of the manual can be The operation of some of the vehicle's fea-
found on SEAT's official website: tures can be shown as an instruction video:

Fig. 1 SEAT website Fig. 2 SEAT website

● scan the QR code ››› Fig. 1 ● scan the QR code ››› Fig. 2
● OR enter the following address in the navi- ● OR enter the following address in the navi-
gator website: gator website:

http://www.seat.com/owners/your- http://www.seat.com/owners/your-
seat/manuals-offline.html seat/manuals-offline.html

and select your vehicle. choose your vehicle and then “Multimedia”.

Note
Video instructions are only available in
certain languages.
Table of Contents

Table of Contents Jump start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .


Tow start and towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
49
51
Transport and practical equipment . . . . . .
Storing objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
128
128
Fuses and bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
General views of the vehicle . . . . . . . . 7
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Roof carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Changing bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Storage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Drink holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Overview (left hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Power sockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Overview (right hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Controls and displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Interior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Interior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Heating, ventilation and cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Instruments and warning/control
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 Infotainment system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Advice about driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Using the instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 First steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Correct sitting position of vehicle occu-
Control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Overview and controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
pants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Infotainment system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 General instructions for use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Pedal area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Multifunction steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Data transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 SEAT CONNECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
The whys and wherefores of seat belts . . . . . 16
Set of vehicle keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Full Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
How to properly adjust your seat belt . . . . . . 19
Central locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 WLAN access point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Anti-theft alarm system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Infotainment operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 voice control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Brief introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Radio mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Operation of the airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Window controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Media Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Transporting children safely . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Vehicle lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Telephone interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Self-help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Windscreen wiper and rear window wiper
Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Information, assistance and emergency
systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Start and driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
call service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Starting and stopping the engine . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Emergency equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Sun protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Start-Stop system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Tyre repairs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Seats and headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Adjusting seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Automatic gearbox/DSG automatic gear-
Changing the windscreen wiper blades . . . . 47
Headrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Seat functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Gear-change recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
5
Table of Contents

SEAT Drive Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Engine management and emissions control


Driving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Driver assistance systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
General notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Drive assist sensors and cameras . . . . . . . . . . 210 Cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Cruise control system (CCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 Windscreen washer reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Emergency brake assistance system (Front 12-volt battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Assist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
ACC - Adaptive Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Wheels and tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Tyre pressure monitor system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Driving Assist (Travel Assist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
Side Assist with Rear Cross Traffic Alert
(RCTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
SEAT Maintenance Programme . . . . . . . . . . 298
Braking and parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
Braking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Additional service offers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
Stabilisation and brake assistance sys-
tems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 Vehicle maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
Help with parking and manoeuvring . . . . . 240 Maintenance and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
Assisted parking system (Park Assist) . . . . . . . 240 Accessories and modifications to the ve-
hicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
Parking aid parking and manoeuvring
(ParkPilot) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Accessories, spare parts and repair work . . . 306
Parking System Plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Information for the user . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
Rear parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 Information for the user . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
Reverse Assist (Rear View Camera) . . . . . . . . . 254 Information stored by the control units . . . . . . 309
Towing bracket device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 Other important information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
Trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 Radioelectrical equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
Towing bracket device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
Retrofitting a towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 Technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
Indications about the technical data . . . . 316
Practical tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Important information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
Checking and refilling levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Fuel types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272

6
General views of the vehicle

Exterior view

Driving assistance sensors ››› page 209 A Levels control – Tow-start ››› page 51
1 Front radar – Oil ››› page 279
2 Parking aid sensors – Brake fluid ››› page 284
3 Park assist sensor – Battery ››› page 285
4 Front multifunction camera B Bonnet
– Unlocking lever ››› page 277
– Open/close ››› page 277

C Towing the vehicle


– Towline anchorage ››› page 53

7
General views of the vehicle

Exterior view

Driving assistance sensors ››› page 209 A Rear lid D Fuel tank
1 Rear view camera – Opening from outside ››› page 108 – Fuel capacity ››› page 316
2 Parking aid sensors – Emergency opening ››› page 108 – Open/Close cap ››› page 270
3 Rear radars B Towing the vehicle E Action in the event of a puncture
4 Park assist sensor – Towline anchorage ››› page 53 – Anti-puncture kit ››› page 40
– Tow-start ››› page 51 – Wheel change ››› page 43
C Opening and closing
– Doors ››› page 105
– Central locking ››› page 96
– Emergency lock ››› page 106
8
General views of the vehicle

Overview (left hand drive)

1 Electric windows ››› page 109 Driver information system ››› page 84 16 Front passenger airbag disconnection
2 Exterior mirror adjustment ››› page 122 8 Hazard warning lights ››› page 117 display ››› page 25

3 Open bonnet lever ››› page 277 9 Infotainment system ››› page 88,
4 Headlight switch ››› page 111 ››› page 143
5 Turn signal and main beam lever 10 Fuses ››› page 55
››› page 113 11 Steering wheel adjustment ››› page 15
Cruise control ››› page 212 12 Ignition lock ››› page 189
6 Warning lamps ››› page 86 13 Air conditioning ››› page 137
7 Wipers and rear window wiper 14 Starter button ››› page 189
››› page 120 15 Central locking ››› page 96
9
General views of the vehicle

Overview (right hand drive)

1 Open bonnet lever ››› page 277 7 Headlight switch ››› page 111 16 Fuses ››› page 55
2 Hazard warning lights ››› page 117 8 Exterior mirror adjustment ››› page 122
3 Infotainment system ››› page 88 9 Electric windows ››› page 109
4 Turn signal and main beam lever 10 Air conditioning ››› page 137
››› page 113 11 Central locking ››› page 96
Cruise control ››› page 212 12 Start button ››› page 189
5 Warning lamps ››› page 86 13 Front passenger airbag disconnection
6 Wipers and rear window wiper display ››› page 25
››› page 120 14 Steering wheel adjustment ››› page 15
Driver information system ››› page 84 15 Ignition lock ››› page 189
10
General views of the vehicle

Interior view

1 Isofix anchors ››› page 31


2 Headrest adjustment ››› page 125
3 Seat belts ››› page 16
4 Interior mirror ››› page 122
5 Disconnecting the front passenger front
airbag ››› page 25
6 Handbrake ››› page 236
7 Seat adjustment ››› page 124

11
Safety

Safety – Ensure that all windows provide a clear and


good view of the surroundings.
– Always pay attention to traffic and do not
get distracted by passengers or telephone
calls.
– Make sure all luggage is secured
Safe driving ››› page 128. – Never drive when your driving ability is im-
paired (e.g. by medication, alcohol, drugs).
– Make sure that no objects can interfere with
Advice about driving the pedals. – Observe traffic laws and speed limits.

– Adjust front seat, headrest and mirrors – Always reduce your speed as appropriate
Safety first! properly according to your size. for road, traffic and weather conditions.
– Ensure that the passengers in the rear seats – When travelling long distances, take breaks
WARNING
always have the headrests in the in-use po- regularly - at least every two hours.
● This manual contains important informa- sition ››› page 125.
tion about the operation of the vehicle, – If possible, avoid driving when you are tired
both for the driver and the passengers. The – Instruct passengers to adjust the headrests or stressed.
other sections of the on-board documenta- according to their height.
tion also contain further information that WARNING
– Protect children with appropriate child
you should be aware of for your own safety Driving under the influence of alcohol,
seats and properly applied seat belts
and for the safety of your passengers. drugs, medication or narcotics may result
››› page 28.
● Ensure that the on-board documentation in severe accidents and even loss of life.
is kept in the vehicle at all times. This is es- – Assume the correct sitting position. Instruct
● Alcohol, drugs, medication and narcotics
pecially important when lending or selling your passengers also to assume a proper
may significantly alter perception, affect
the vehicle to another person. sitting position ››› page 13.
reaction times and safety while driving,
– Fasten your seat belt securely. Instruct your which could result in the loss of control of
passengers also to fasten their seat belts the vehicle.
Before driving properly ››› page 16.

For your own safety and the safety of your Safety equipment
passengers, always note the following points Factors influencing safety
before every trip: Never put your safety or the safety of your
– Make sure that the vehicle's lights and turn As a driver, you are responsible for yourself passengers in danger. In the event of an acci-
signals are working properly. and your passengers. dent, the safety equipment may reduce the

– Check tyre pressure.

12
Safe driving

risk of injury. The following points cover part


Correct sitting position of The correct sitting positions for the driver and
of the safety equipment in your SEAT1): passengers are shown below.
vehicle occupants If your physical constitution prevents you
● three-point seat belts,
from maintaining the correct sitting position,
● belt tension limiters for the front and rear Correct position on the seat contact a specialised workshop for help with
side seats,
any special devices. The seat belt and airbag
● belt tensioners for the front and rear side can only provide optimum protection if a cor-
seats, rect sitting position is adopted. SEAT recom-
● front airbags, mends taking your car in for technical serv-
● side airbags in the front seat backrests,
ice.

● head-protection airbags, For your own safety and to reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accident or sudden
● “ISOFIX” anchor points for child seats on
braking or manoeuvre, SEAT recommend the
the rear side seats with the “ISOFIX” system,
following positions:
● height-adjustable front headrests,
● rear headrests with in-use position and Valid for all vehicle occupants:
Fig. 3 The correct distance between the driver
non-use position, and the steering wheel must be at least 25 cm ● Adjust the headrest so that its upper edge is
● adjustable steering column. (10 inches). at the same level as the top of your head, or
as close as possible to the same level as the
The safety equipment mentioned above top of your head and under no circumstances
works together to provide you and your pas- below eye level. Keep the back of your neck
sengers with the best possible protection in as close as possible to the headrest ››› Fig. 4.
the event of an accident. However, these
● Short people must lower the headrest com-
safety systems can only be effective if you
pletely, even if your head is below its upper
and your passengers are sitting in a correct
edge.
position and use this equipment properly.
● Tall people must raise the headrest com-
Safety is everyone's business!
pletely.
● Always keep your feet in the footwell while
Fig. 4 Correct belt web and headrest positions the vehicle is in motion. »

1) Depending on the version/market.


13
Safety

● Adjust and fasten your seat belt correctly board check translation). If you are sitting and also increase the risk of injury in the
››› page 19. closer than 25 cm, the airbag system cannot event of an accident.
protect you properly.
The following also applies to the driver:
● Move the seat backrest to an almost up- Risks of sitting in an incorrect posi-
right position so that your back rests com- Number of seats
tion
pletely against it.
The vehicle has 5 seats, 2 in the front and 3 in
● Move the steering wheel so it is at least If seat belts are worn incorrectly or not at all,
the rear. All seats are equipped with a safety
25 cm (10 inches) away from the sternum the risk of severe or lethal injuries increases.
belt.
››› Fig. 3 and you can hold it with both hands Seat belts can provide optimal protection on-
on both sides, on the outer part, with your ly if the belt web is properly worn. Incorrect
WARNING
arms slightly bent. sitting positions substantially reduce the pro-
Sitting in an incorrect position may in- tective function of seat belts and, therefore,
● The steering wheel must always point to-
crease the risk of severe or lethal injuries in increase the risk of severe or even lethal inju-
wards the chest and never towards the face.
the event of sudden braking or manoeu-
ries. The risk of severe or fatal injuries is espe-
● Move the seat in such a way that you can vring, in case of collision or accident and if
cially heightened when a deploying airbag
step on the pedals with your knees slightly the airbags deploy.
strikes a vehicle occupant who has assumed
bent and with a distance between the knees ● Before starting the car, all passengers an incorrect sitting position. The driver is re-
and the dashboard of at least 10 cm (4 in- must be sitting in a correct position and sponsible for all people, particularly children,
ches) ››› Fig. 3. stay like that for the entire journey. This al- inside the vehicle.
● Adjust the height of the seat so that you so applies to a correct use of the seat belt.
can reach the top of the steering wheel. ● The maximum amount of people in the The following list contains examples of incor-
vehicle is the same as the amount of seats rect sitting positions that could be dangerous
● Always keep both feet in the footwell so
with seat belts. for all vehicle occupants.
that you have the vehicle under control at all
times. ● For children, always use a certified pro-
tection system, certified and suited for their
When the vehicle is in motion:

For the passenger, the following applies: weight and height ››› page 28. ● Never stand in the vehicle.
● While driving, always keep your feet in ● Never stand on the seats.
● Move the seat backrest to an almost up-
the footwell. Never place them over the
right position so that your back rests com- ● Never kneel on the seats.
seat or the dashboard, for example, or out-
pletely against it. ● Never tilt your seat backrest too far to the
side the window. Otherwise the airbag and
● Move the seat as far back as possible (mini- seat belt may offer insufficient protection rear.
mum 25 cm between the chest and the dash- ● Never lean against the dash panel.

14
Safe driving

● Never lie on the rear seats. Steering wheel position adjust- ● Never adjust the steering wheel while the
● Never sit on the front edge of a seat. ment vehicle is in motion. If you need to adjust
● Never sit sideways.
the steering wheel while the vehicle is in
motion, stop safely and make the proper
● Never lean out of a window. adjustment.
● Never put your feet out of a window. ● The adjusted steering wheel should be
● Never put your feet on the dash panel. facing your chest and not your face so as
not to hinder the driver's front airbag pro-
● Never place your feet on the bench or on
tection in the event of an accident.
the backrest of the seat.
● When driving, always hold the steering
● Never travel in a footwell. wheel with both hands on the outside of the
● Never sit on the armrests. ring at the 9 o'clock and 3 o'clock positions
to reduce injuries when the driver's front
● Never travel without wearing the seat belt.
airbag deploys.
● Never travel in the luggage compartment. Fig. 5 Lever in the lower left side of the steering
column. ● Never hold the steering wheel at the 12
o'clock position or in any other manner
WARNING (e.g. in the centre of the steering wheel). In
Adjust the steering wheel before your trip and
Sitting in an incorrect position increases only when the vehicle is stationary. such cases, if the driver's airbag deploys,
the risk of severe or fatal injuries in the you may sustain injuries to your arms,
event of accidents and sudden braking or ● Pull the ››› Fig. 5 1 lever down, move the hands and head.
manoeuvres. steering wheel to the desired position and lift
● All occupants must sit correctly during the lever back up until it locks.
the journey and wear the seat belt correct-
ly. WARNING Pedal area
● Occupants of the vehicle that are not sit- Incorrect use of the steering wheel adjust-
ting correctly, not wearing the seat belt or ment function and an incorrect adjustment Pedals
are not at a proper distance of the airbag of the steering wheel can result in severe or
risk suffering very serious or lethal injuries, fatal injury. – Ensure that you can always press the ac-
especially if the airbags deploy and strike ● After adjusting the steering column, push
celerator, brake and clutch pedals unim-
them. the lever ››› Fig. 5 1 firmly upwards to en- paired to the floor.
sure the steering wheel does not acciden- – Ensure that the pedals can return unim-
tally change position while driving. paired to their initial positions. »

15
Safety

– Ensure that the floor mats are securely fas-


tened during the trip and do not obstruct
Seat belts Rear seat belts fastened display
the pedals ››› .
The whys and wherefores of
Only use floor mats which leave the pedals
clear and which are secured to prevent them seat belts
from slipping. You can obtain suitable floor
mats from a specialised dealership. Fasteners Control lamps
for floor mats are fitted in the footwells.
If a brake circuit fails, the brake pedal must be  It lights up red
pressed down thoroughly in order to stop the
Driver or passenger has not fastened seat belt.
vehicle.
The control lamp  lights up to remind the Fig. 6 Instrument panel: left rear seat occu-
Wear suitable footwear driver to fasten their seat belt. pied and corresponding seat belt fastened dis-
play.
Always wear shoes which support your feet
Before starting the vehicle:
properly and give you a good feeling for the
Depending on the model version, when the
pedals. ● Fasten your seat belt securely.
ignition is switched on, the seat belt status
● Instruct your passengers to fasten their display ››› Fig. 6 on the instrument panel in-
WARNING
seat belts properly before driving off. forms the driver whether the passengers in
● Restricting pedal operation can lead to the rear seats have fastened their seat belts.
● Protect children by using a child seat ac-
critical situations while driving.
cording to the child's height and weight
It indicates that the corresponding seat
● Never lay or fit floor mats or other floor ››› page 28.  is empty.
coverings over the original floor mats. This
would reduce the pedal area and could ob- When starting to drive, if the vehicle's speed Indicates that the seat is occupied and
struct the pedals. Risk of accident. exceeds approx. 25 km/h (15 mph) and the
 the occupant is wearing the seat belt.
● Never place objects in the driver footwell. seat belts are not fastened or are unfastened
An object could move into the pedal area while driving, a warning sound will be heard The seat belt status flashes for a maximum of
and impair pedal operation. for a few seconds. The warning light will also 60 seconds when a seat belt in the rear seats
flash . is unfastened while the vehicle is in motion. An
audible warning will also be heard if the vehi-
The lamp  goes out when the driver and cle is travelling at over 25 km/h (15 mph).
passenger seat belts are fastened with the
ignition switched on. If a seat belt is fastened or unfastened while
driving in some of the rear seats, the seat belt
16
Seat belts

status is displayed for approximately 30 sec- gy released in a collision. Taken together, all – Ensure that the seat belts can be fastened
onds. these features reduce the releasing kinetic at all times and are not damaged.
energy and consequently, the risk of injury.
This is why it is so important to fasten seat WARNING
The protective function of seat belts before every trip, even when "just driving ● If seat belts are worn incorrectly or not at
around the corner".
belts all, the risk of severe injuries increases. The
Ensure that your passengers wear their seat optimal protection from seat belts can be
belts as well. Accident statistics have shown achieved only if you use them properly.
that wearing seat belts is an effective means ● Never allow two passengers (even chil-
of substantially reducing the risk of injury and dren) to share the same seat belt.
improving the chances of survival when in- ● Never unbuckle a seat belt while the ve-
volved in a serious accident. Furthermore, hicle is in motion. Risk of fatal injury.
properly worn seat belts improve the protec- ● The seat belt should never lie on hard or
tion provided by airbags in the event of an fragile objects (such as glasses or pens,
accident. For this reason, wearing a seat belt etc.) because this can cause injuries.
is required by law in most countries. ● Do not allow the seat belt to be damaged
Although your vehicle is equipped with air- or jammed, or to rub on any sharp edges.
Fig. 7 Drivers with properly worn seat belts will bags, the seat belts must be fastened and ● Never wear the seat belt under the arm or
not be thrown forward in the event of sudden worn. The front airbags, for example, are only in any other incorrect position.
braking.
triggered in some cases of head-on collision. ● Bulky and unfastened clothing (such as
The front airbags will not be triggered during an overcoat over a sweater) impairs the
Properly worn seat belts hold the occupants
minor frontal or side collisions, rear-end colli- proper fit and function of the seat belts, re-
in the proper position. They also help prevent
sions, overturns or accidents in which the air- ducing their capacity to protect.
uncontrolled movements that may result in
bag trigger threshold value in the control unit ● The slot in the seat belt buckle must not
serious injury and reduce the risk of being
is not exceeded. be blocked with paper or other objects, as
thrown out of the vehicle in case of an acci-
dent. this can prevent the latch plate from en-
gaging securely.
Vehicle occupants wearing their seat belts Important safety instructions for ● Never use seat belt clips, fastening rings
correctly benefit greatly from the ability of
the belts to absorb kinetic energy. In addition,
the use of seat belts or similar items to alter the position of the
belt webbing.
the front part of your vehicle and other pas-
– Always wear the seat belt as described in ● Frayed or torn seat belts or damage to
sive safety features (such as the airbag sys-
tem) are designed to absorb the kinetic ener-
this section. the connections, belt retractors or parts of »
17
Safety

the buckle could cause severe injuries in amount of the passengers' kinetic energy will
the event of an accident. Therefore, you be only absorbed by the mentioned impact.
must check the condition of all seat belts Even at speeds of 30 km/h (19 mph) to
at regular intervals. 50 km/h (30 mph), the forces acting on bod-
● Seat belts which have been worn in an ies in a collision can easily exceed one tonne
accident and have been stretched must be (1000 kg). At greater speed these forces are
replaced by a specialised workshop. Re- even higher.
newal may be necessary even if there is no
apparent damage. The belt anchorage Vehicle occupants not wearing seat belts are
should also be checked. not “attached” to the vehicle. In a head-on
collision, they will move forward at the same
● Do not attempt to repair a damaged seat Fig. 9 The unbelted passenger in the rear seat
belt yourself. The seat belts must not be re- is thrown forward violently, hitting the driver speed their vehicle was travelling just before
moved or modified in any way. who is wearing a seat belt. the impact. This example applies not only to
head-on collisions, but to all accidents and
● The belts must be kept clean, otherwise
The effects of the laws of physics in the case collisions.
the retractors may not work properly.
of a head-on collision are easy to explain: the
Even at low speeds the forces acting on the
moment a vehicle starts moving, a type of en-
body in a collision are so great that it is not
ergy called “kinetic energy” starts acting on
possible to brace oneself with one's hands. In
Head-on collisions and the laws of both the vehicle and its passengers.
a frontal collision, unbelted passengers are
physics The amount of “kinetic energy” depends on thrown forward and will make violent contact
the speed of the vehicle and on the weight of with the steering wheel, dash panel, wind-
the vehicle and of its passengers. The higher screen or whatever else is in the way
they are, the more energy there is to be “ab- ››› Fig. 8.
sorbed” in the event of an accident.
It is also important for rear passengers to
The most significant factor, however, is the wear seat belts properly, as they could other-
speed of the vehicle. If the speed doubles wise be thrown forward violently through the
from 25 km/h (15 mph) to 50 km/h (30 mph), vehicle interior in an accident. Passengers in
for example, the corresponding kinetic ener- the rear seats who do not use seat belts en-
gy is multiplied by four. danger not only themselves but also the front
occupants ››› Fig. 9.
Given that the passengers of the vehicle in
Fig. 8 A driver not wearing a seat belt is thrown our example do not have their seat belts fas-
forward violently. tened, in the event of a collision the entire

18
Seat belts

How to properly adjust your Properly worn seat belts hold the vehicle oc- WARNING
cupants in the position that most protects
seat belt them in the event of an accident or sudden
● The seat belt cannot offer its full protec-
tion unless the seat backrest is in an up-
braking ››› .
right position and the seat belt is worn cor-
Fastening and unfastening the seat rectly, according to your size.
belt Fastening the seat belt
● Unbuckling your seat belt while the vehi-
Fasten your seat belt before each trip. cle is in motion can cause severe or fatal
injuries in the event of an accident or sud-
● Adjust the front seat and headrest correctly
den braking.
››› page 13.
● The seat belt itself, or a loose seat belt,
● Engage the seat backrest of the rear seat in
can cause severe injuries if the belt moves
an upright position ››› . from hard areas of the body to soft areas
● Pull the latch plate and place the belt web- (e.g. the stomach).
bing evenly across your chest and lap. Do
not twist the seat belt when doing so ››› .
● Engage the latch plate in the buckle of the
corresponding seat ››› Fig. 10.
Fig. 10 Insert the latch plate of the seat belt
into the buckle. ● Pull the belt to ensure that the latch plate is
securely engaged in the buckle.

Releasing the seat belt


Only unfasten the seat belt when the vehicle
has come to a standstill ››› .

● Press the red button on the buckle


››› Fig. 11. The latch plate is released from the
buckle.
● Guide the belt back by hand so that it rolls
up easily and the trim will not be damaged.
Fig. 11 Release the seat belt's buckle.

19
Safety

Correct seat belt position belt will hold the vehicle occupants in the op- WARNING
timum position to ensure the airbag provides
An incorrectly worn seat belt web can
the maximum protection. The seat belt must
cause severe or fatal injuries in the event of
therefore always be worn and the webbing
an accident.
correctly positioned.
● The shoulder part of the seat belt must lie
Incorrectly worn seat belts can cause severe on the centre of the shoulder, never across
or even fatal injuries ››› page 13, Correct sit- the neck or the arm.
ting position of vehicle occupants. ● The seat belt must lie flat and fit comfort-

● The shoulder part of the seat belt must lie ably on the torso
on the centre of the shoulder, never across ● The lap part of the seat belt must lie
the neck or the arm, under the arm or behind across the pelvis, never across the stom-
the shoulder. ach. The seat belt must lie flat and fit com-
Fig. 12 Correct seat belt and headrest posi-
fortably on the pelvis Pull the belt tight if
tions, viewed from front and the side. ● The lap part of the seat belt must lie across
necessary to take up any slack.
the pelvis, never across the stomach.
● For pregnant women, the lap part of the
● The seat belt must lie flat and fit comforta- seat belt must lie as low as possible over
bly. Pull the belt tight if necessary to take up the pelvis and always lie flat, “surrounding”
any slack. the stomach››› Fig. 13.
● Do not twist the seat belt while it is fas-
In the case of pregnant women, the seat belt
tened.
must lie evenly across the chest and as low
as possible over the pelvis, never across the ● Once the seat belt is positioned correct-
stomach and must be worn properly at all ly, don't pull it away from your body with
times during the pregnancy ››› Fig. 13. your hand.
● Do not lie the seat belt across rigid or
Adapting the position of the belt webbing fragile objects, e.g. glasses, pens or keys.
to your size ● Never use seat belt clips, retaining rings
Fig. 13 Position of seat belt during pregnancy.
The position of the seat belt can be adapted or similar instruments to alter the position
by adjusting the height of the front seats. of the belt webbing.
Seat belts offer their maximum protection in
the event of an accident and reduce the risk
of sustaining severe or fatal injuries only when Note
they are properly positioned. Furthermore, if If your physical constitution prevents you
the webbing is correctly positioned, the seat from maintaining the correct position of the
20
Seat belts

belt webbing, contact a specialised work- of the system are scrapped. Specialised ● The seat belt tensioner, seat belt and au-
shop for help with any special devices to workshops are familiar with these regula- tomatic retractor cannot be repaired.
ensure the optimum protection of the seat tions, which are also available to you. ● Any work on the belt tensioners and seat
belt and airbag. SEAT recommends taking belts, including the removal and refitting of
your car in for technical service. system parts in conjunction with other re-
Maintenance and disposal of seat pair work, must be performed by a special-
ised workshop only.
belt tensioners
Seat belt tensioners ● The belt tensioners will only provide pro-
tection for one accident and must be
The belt tensioners are components of the
changed if they have been activated.
seat belts that are installed in the seats of
How the seat belt tensioner works
your vehicle. If you work on the belt tension-
The seat belts for the front seats and the side ers or remove and install parts of the system For the sake of the environment
rear seats1) are equipped with belt tensioners. when performing other repair work, the seat Airbag modules and belt tensioners may
belt may be damaged. The consequence contain perchlorate. Observe the legal re-
The belt tensioners are activated by sensors, may be that, in the event of an accident, the quirements for their disposal.
although only in severe head-on, lateral and belt tensioners function incorrectly or may
rear-end collisions. This retracts and tightens not function at all.
the seat belts, reducing the forward motion of
the occupants. So that the effectiveness of the seat belt ten-
sioner is not reduced and that removed parts
The belt pre-tensioners work in combination do not cause any injuries or environmental
with the airbag system. In case of overturn, pollution, regulations, which are known to the
the pre-tensioners do not activate unless the specialised workshops, must be observed.
head airbags are deployed.
WARNING
Note
● Improper use or repairs not carried out by
● If the seat belt tensioners are triggered, a qualified mechanics increase the risk of se-
fine dust is produced. This is normal and it vere or fatal injuries. The belt tensioners
is not an indication of fire in the vehicle. may fail to trigger or may trigger in the
● The relevant safety requirements must be wrong circumstances.
observed when the vehicle or components

1) Depending on version/market.
21
Safety

Airbag system thrown forward into the area of the deploying


airbag. In this case, the inflating airbag may
gered. Children up to 12 years old should
always travel on the rear seat. Never trans-
inflict critical or fatal injuries on the occupant. port children in the vehicle if they are not
Brief introduction This also applies to children. restrained or the restraint system is not ap-
propriate for their age, size or weight.
Always maintain the greatest possible dis-
Why is it so important to wear a tance between yourself and the front airbag. ● To reduce the risk of injury from an inflat-

seat belt and to sit correctly? This way, the front airbags can completely ing airbag, always wear the seat belt prop-
deploy when triggered, providing their maxi- erly ››› page 16.
For the inflating airbags to achieve the best mum protection.
protection, the seat belt must always be worn
The most important factors for triggering the
properly and the correct sitting position must Description of the airbag system
airbag are the type of accident, the angle of
be assumed.
impact and the vehicle speed.
The airbag system is not a substitute for seat The airbag system offers additional protec-
Whether or not the airbags are triggered de- tion for the occupants in combination with the
belts, but it is an integral part of the vehicle's
pends primarily on the vehicle deceleration seat belts.
overall passive safety system. Please bear in
rate resulting from the collision and detected
mind that the airbag system can only work
by the control unit. If the vehicle deceleration The airbag system comprises the follow-
effectively when the vehicle occupants are
occurring during the collision and measured ing modules (as per vehicle equipment):
wearing their seat belts correctly and have
by the control unit remains below the speci-
adjusted the headrests properly. Therefore, it ● Electronic control unit
fied reference values, the front, side and/or
is most important to properly wear the seat ● Front airbags for driver and passenger
head-protection airbags will not be triggered.
belts at all times, not only because this is re-
Take into account that the visible damage in ● Side airbags
quired by law in most countries, but also for
a vehicle involved in an accident, no matter
your safety ››› page 16, The whys and ● Head airbag
how serious, is not a determining factor for
wherefores of seat belts. ● Airbag control lamp  on the instrument
the airbags to have been triggered.
The airbag inflates in a matter of seconds, so panel ››› page 24
if you are not properly seated when the air- WARNING ● Key-operated switch for front passenger
bag is triggered, you may sustain fatal inju- ● Wearing the seat belt incorrectly or as- airbag
ries. Therefore, it is essential that all vehicle suming an incorrect sitting position can ● Control lamp for disabled/enabled status
occupants assume a correct sitting position lead to critical or fatal injuries. of the front passenger airbag.
while travelling.
● All vehicle occupants, including children,
Sharp braking before an accident may cause who are not properly belted can sustain
a passenger not wearing a seat belt to be critical or fatal injuries if the airbag is trig-

22
Airbag system

The airbag system operation is monitored system may fail to trigger, or not trigger The control unit analyses the collision trajec-
electronically. The airbag control lamp will il- correctly. tory and activates the respective restraint
luminate for a few seconds every time the system.
ignition is switched on (self-diagnosis).
If the deceleration rate is below the prede-
Airbag activation fined reference value in the control unit the
There is a fault in the system if the control
airbags will not be triggered, even though the
lamp :
The airbags deploy extremely rapidly, within accident may cause extensive damage to the
● does not light up when the ignition is thousands of a second, to provide additional car.
switched on ››› page 24, protection in the event of an accident. A fine
● turns off after 4 seconds after the ignition is dust may develop when the airbag deploys. The following airbags are triggered in seri-
switched on, This is normal and it is not an indication of fire ous head-on collisions:
● turns off and then lights up again after the
in the vehicle. ● Driver airbag.
ignition is switched on, The airbag system is only ready to function ● Front passenger front airbag
● illuminates or flashes while the vehicle is when the ignition is on.
moving. In special accidents instances, several air- The following airbags are triggered in seri-
bags may activate at the same time. ous side-on collisions:
The airbag system is not triggered if: ● Front side airbag on the side of the acci-
In the event of minor head-on and side colli-
● the ignition is switched off sions, rear-end collisions, overturning or roll- dent.
● there is a minor frontal collision over of the vehicle, airbags do not activate. ● Curtain (head) airbag on the side of the ac-

● there is a minor side collision cident.


Activation factors
● there is a rear-end collision
In an accident with airbag activation:
The conditions that lead to the airbag system
● the vehicle turns over.
activating in each situation cannot be gener- ● the interior lights switch on (if the interior
alised. Some factors play an important role, light switch is in the courtesy light position);
WARNING
such as the properties of the object the vehi- ● the hazard warning lights switch on;
● The seat belts and airbags can only pro- cle hits (hard/soft), angle of impact, vehicle
● all doors are unlocked;
vide maximum protection if the occupants speed, etc.
are seated correctly ››› page 13. ● the fuel supply to the engine is cut.
Deceleration trajectory is key for airbag acti-
● If a fault has occurred in the airbag sys- ● an emergency call is started ››› page 38.
vation.
tem, have the system checked immediately
by a specialised workshop. Otherwise
there is a danger that during a collision, the
23
Safety

Operation of the airbags checked immediately by a specialised work- tions and instructions to avoid damage to
shop. the vehicle or harm to the occupants.

Airbag system control lamps If the front passenger airbag is deactivated,


the warning lamp      re-
mains lit on the dash panel to remind you that Front airbags
It lights up on the combi-instru-
 ment
the airbag is deactivated. If, with the front
passenger airbag deactivated, this lamp
Fault in the airbag system and seat belt tensioners . does not remain lit or if it is lit along with the
Have the system checked immediately by a special- control lamp  on the instrument panel,
ised workshop. there is a fault in the airbag system ››› . If
the control lamp is flashing, there is a fault in
  It lights up on the dash panel the disabling of the airbag system ››› . Have
the system checked immediately by a speci-
Fault in the airbag system.
alised workshop.
Have the system checked immediately by a special-
ised workshop.
WARNING
Front passenger front airbag deactivated.
Check if the airbag should be kept deactivated In the event of a fault in the airbag and seat Fig. 14 Driver airbag located in steering
belt tensioner system, the airbags and seat wheel.
belts may not trigger correctly, may fail to
  It lights up on the dash panel trigger or may even trigger unexpectedly.
Front passenger front airbag activated. ● The vehicle occupants run the risk of sus-
The control lamp turns off automatically 60 seconds taining severe or fatal injuries. Have the
after the ignition is switched on system checked immediately by a special-
ised workshop.
Several warning and control lamps light up ● Do not mount a child seat in the front
for a few seconds when the ignition is switch- passenger seat or remove the mounted
ed on, signalling that the function is being child seat! The front passenger front airbag
verified. They will switch off after a few sec- may deploy during an accident in spite of
onds. the fault.
If the airbag and seat belt tensioner system Fig. 15 Front passenger airbag located in dash
control lamp  remains on or flashes, it indi- CAUTION panel.
cates a malfunction in the airbag and seat Always pay attention to any lit control
belt tensioner system ››› . Have the system lamps and to the corresponding descrip-
24
Airbag system

The driver's front airbag is housed in the Activate and deactivate front pas- SEAT recommends fitting the child seat in the
steering wheel and that of the front passen- rear seat to avoid having to deactivate the
senger front airbag
ger, on the instrument panel . Airbags are front passenger airbag.
identified by the word “AIRBAG”.
When the front passenger airbag is deacti-
The airbag covers fold open and remain at- vated, this means that only the front passen-
tached to the steering wheel ››› Fig. 14 and ger front airbag is deactivated. All the other
the dash panel ››› Fig. 15when the driver and airbags in the vehicle remain activated.
front passenger airbags, respectively, are
triggered. Deactivate and activate the front passen-
ger front airbag
In conjunction with the seat belts, the front
airbag system gives the front occupants ad- ● Switch the ignition off.
ditional protection for the head and chest in ● Open the door on the front passenger side.
the event of a severe frontal collision ››› .
Fig. 16 Switch for activating and deactivating ● Insert the key into the slot of the switch for
Their special design allows the controlled es- the front passenger airbag. deactivating the front passenger airbag
cape of the propellant gas when an occu- ››› Fig. 16. About 3/4 of the key should enter;
pant puts pressure on the bag. Thus, the this is as far as it will go.
head and chest are protected by the airbag. ● Turn the key gently to change its position to
After the collision, the airbag deflates suffi-  (deactivate) or to  (activate). If you have
ciently to allow visibility. difficulty, ensure that you have inserted the
key as far as it will go.
WARNING
● Close the front passenger door.
● The deployment space between the front
● When deactivating the airbag, switch the
passengers and the airbags must not in
any case be occupied by other passenger, ignition on and check that the control lamp
pets and objects.   with the lettering    re-
mains lit in the middle of the dash panel
● The airbags provide protection for just Fig. 17 Central part of the dashboard: control
one accident; replace them once they have lamp for the deactivation of the front passen- ››› Fig. 17.
deployed. ger front airbag. ● When reactivating the airbag, check that
● It is also important not to attach any ob- when the ignition is switched on, the  
Deactivate the front passenger front airbag control lamp does not light up and the  
jects such as cup holders or telephone
only if you have to use a rear-facing child lamp lights up or 60 seconds and then turns
mountings to the surfaces covering the air-
bag units.
seat in the front passenger seat. off. »
25
Safety

WARNING WARNING
● The driver of the vehicle is responsible for ● If you do not wear a seat belt, if you lean
disabling or switching on the airbag. forward, or are not seated correctly while
● Always switch off the ignition before dis- the vehicle is in motion, you are at a greater
abling the front passenger airbag! Failure risk of injury if the side airbag system is
to do so could result in a fault in the airbag triggered in an accident.
deactivation system. ● In order for the side airbags to provide
● Never leave the key in the airbag disa- their maximum protection, the prescribed
bling switch as it could get damaged or en- sitting position must always be maintained
able or disable the airbag during driving. with seat belts fastened while travelling.
Fig. 19 Illustration of completely inflated side ● In a side-on collision the side airbags will
● If for any reason an airbag is deactivated, airbag on left side of vehicle.
reactivate it as soon as possible so that it not work if the sensors do not correctly
can fulfil its protective function. measure the pressure increase on the inte-
The side airbags are located in the driver's
rior of the doors, due to air escaping
seat and front passenger seat backrests
through the areas with holes or openings in
››› Fig. 18. the door panel.
Side airbags The locations are identified by the text “AIR- ● Never drive if the interior door panels
BAG” in the upper region of the backrests. have been removed or if the panels have
not been correctly fitted.
In conjunction with the seat belts, the side air-
bag system provides additional protection for ● Never drive the vehicle if the loudspeak-

the upper body in the event of a severe side ers in the door panels have been removed,
collision ››› . unless the holes left by the loudspeakers
have been closed properly.
In a side collision, the side airbags reduce the ● Always check that the openings are
risk of injury to passengers to the areas of the closed or covered if loudspeakers or other
body facing the impact. In addition to their equipment are fitted inside the door pan-
normal protection, the seat belts also hold els.
the passengers in the event of a side collision; ● Occupants of the outer seats must never
Fig. 18 Side airbag in driver's seat. this is how these airbags provide maximum carry any objects or pets in the deploy-
protection. ment space between them and the airbags,
or allow children or other passengers to
travel in this position. It is also important
not to attach any accessories (such as cup

26
Airbag system

holders) to the doors. This would impair the head-protection airbags The head-protection airbags reduce the risk
protection offered by the side airbags. of injury to passengers in the front and rear
side seats facing the impact.
● The built-in coat hooks should be used
only for lightweight clothing. Do not leave
any heavy or sharp-edged objects in the
WARNING
pockets. ● In order for the head-protection airbags
● Great forces, such as hard blows or kicks, to provide their maximum protection, the
must not be exerted upon the backrest bol- prescribed sitting position must always be
ster because the system may be damaged. maintained with seat belts fastened while
In this case, the side airbags would not be travelling.
triggered. ● For safety reasons, the head-protection
● Under no circumstances should protec- airbag must be disabled in those vehicles
tive covers be fitted over seats with side Fig. 20 Location and deployment area of the fitted with a screen dividing the interior of
airbags unless the covers have been ap- head-protection airbag. the vehicle. See your technical service to
proved for use in your vehicle. Because the make this adjustment.
airbag deploys from the side of the back- The head-protection airbags are located on ● There must be no other persons, animals
rest, the use of conventional seat covers both sides in the interior above the doors or objects between the occupants of the
would obstruct the side airbag, seriously ››› Fig. 20 and are identified with the text outer seats and the deployment space of
reducing the airbag's effectiveness. “AIRBAG”. the head-protection airbags so that the
● Any damage to the original seat uphols- In conjunction with the seat belts, the head- head-protection airbag can deploy com-
tery or around the seams of the side airbag pletely without restriction and provide the
protection airbag system gives the vehicle
units must be repaired immediately by a greatest possible protection. Therefore,
occupants additional protection for the head
specialised workshop. sun blinds which have not been expressly
and upper body in the event of a severe side
approved for use in your vehicle may not be
● The airbags provide protection for just collision ››› .
attached to the side windows.
one accident; replace them once they have
The area framed in red is covered by the ● The built-in coat hooks should be used
deployed.
head-protection airbag when it is deployed only for lightweight clothing. Do not leave
● Any work on the side airbag system or re-
››› Fig. 20 (deployment area). Therefore, ob- any heavy or sharp-edged objects in the
moval and installation of the airbag com-
jects should never be placed or mounted in pockets. Please, do not hang the clothes on
ponents for other repairs (such as removal
this area ››› . coat hangers.
of the front seat) should only be performed
● The airbags provide protection for just
by a specialised workshop. Otherwise, In the event of a side collision the head-pro-
faults may occur during the airbag system tection airbag is triggered on the impact side one accident; replace them once they have
operation. of the vehicle.
deployed. »

27
Safety

● Any work on the head-protection airbag Transporting children These systems have been especially de-
signed and approved, complying with the
system or removal and installation of the
airbag components for other repairs (such safely ECE-R44. regulation.
as removal of the roof lining) should only SEAT recommends securing the child seats
be performed by a specialised workshop.
Otherwise, faults may occur during the air- Child safety shown on the website as described below:
bag system operation. ● Child seats in the opposite direction of trav-
● The side and head airbags are managed Introduction el (group 0+): ISOFIX and support bracket
through sensors located in the interior of (Peke G0 Plus + ISOFIX Base (RWF)).
the front doors. To ensure the correct oper- For safety reasons, as we have learned from
● Child seats in the direction of travel (group
ation of the side and head-protection air- accident statistics, we recommend that chil-
1): ISOFIX and Top Tether (Peke G1 ISOFIX
bags neither the doors nor the door panels dren under 12 years of age travel in the rear
DUO Plus).
should be modified in any way (e.g. fitting seats. Depending on their age, height and
loudspeakers). If the front door is dam- weight, children travelling in rear seats must ● Child seats directed towards the front of
aged, the airbag system may not work cor- use a child seat or a seat belt. For safety rea- the vehicle for group 2: safety belt and ISOFIX
rectly. All work carried out on the front door sons, the child seat should be installed in the (RÖMER KIDFIX XP©).
must be done in a specialised workshop. rear seat, behind the front passenger seat or ● Child seats directed towards the front of
in the centre back seat. the vehicle for group 3: safety belt and ISOFIX
The physical laws involved and the forces (TATAKI MAXI PLUS©).
acting in a collision apply also to children
Follow the manufacturer's instructions and
››› page 18. But unlike adults, children do not observe any statutory requirements when in-
have fully developed muscle and bone struc-
stalling and using child seats. Always read
tures. This means that children are subject to
and note ››› page 30.
a greater risk of injury.
We recommend you always carry the manu-
To reduce the risk of injuries, children must al-
facturer's Child Seat Instruction Manual to-
ways use special child restraint systems
gether with the on-board documentation.
when travelling in the vehicle.
We recommend the use of child safety prod-
ucts from the SEAT Original Accessories Pro-
gramme, which includes systems for all ages
made by “Peke” (not for all countries) (see
www.seat.com).

28
Transporting children safely

Child seats group classification Child seats that have been tested and ap- universal approval, requires safety devices to
proved under the ECE R44 or ECE-R129 lock the child seat, which require additional
standards bear the ECE-R44 or ECE-R129 testing. Child seats with semi-universal ap-
test marks on the seat (the letter E in a circle proval include a list of vehicle models for
with the test number below it). which they can be installed.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions and ● Vehicle-specific: vehicle-specific approval
observe any statutory requirements when in- requires a dynamic test of the child seat for
stalling and using child seats. each vehicle model separately. Child seats
with vehicle-specific approval also include a
We recommend you to always include the list of vehicle models for which they can be
manufacturer's Child Seat Instruction Manual installed.
together with the on-board documentation.
● i-Size: child seats with i-Size approval must
Fig. 21 Examples of child seats. SEAT recommends you use child seats from meet the requirements set out in the ECE-
the Original Accessories Catalogue. These R129 standard in relation to installation and
Use only child seats that are officially ap- child seats have been designed and tested safety. Child seat manufacturers can tell you
proved and suitable for the child. for use in SEAT vehicles. You can find the right which seats have i-Size approval for this vehi-
These seats are subject to the ECE-R44 or child seat for your model and age group at cle.
ECE-R129 standards. ECE-R stands for: Eco- SEAT dealers.
nomic Commission for Europe Regulation.
Child seats by approval category
Child seats by weight group Child seats may have the approval category
The child seats are grouped into 5 catego- of universal, semi-universal, vehicle specific
ries: (all according to the ECE-R44 standard) or i-
Size (according to the ECE-R129 standard).
Age group Weight of the child ● Universal: child seats with universal appro-
Group 0 Up to 10 kg val can be installed in all vehicles. There is no
need to consult any list of models. In the case
Group 0+ Up to 13 kg of universal approval for ISOFIX, the child
Group 1 From 9 to 18 kg
seat is additionally provided with a Top Tether
belt.
Group 2 From 15 to 25 kg ● Semi-universal: semi-universal approval,
Group 3 From 22 to 36 kg in addition to the standard requirements of

29
Safety

Fitting and using child seats Warnings about fitting a child seat bracket, it should never be installed in the
Take the following general warnings into ac- central rear seat as the ground clearance is
count if you are going to fit a child seat. They lower than in other places and the support
are valid for all child seats regardless of their bracket will not allow the seat to remain suffi-
attachment system. ciently stable.
● When fitting a child seat on the front pas-
● Please read and follow the child seat man- senger seat, the seat must be moved back-
ufacturer's operating instructions. wards as far as possible and placed in the
● The child seat should preferably be fitted to highest position. The backrest must also be
the rear seat behind the front passenger seat put in a vertical position1).
Fig. 22 Airbag sticker: on the passenger’s sun
so that the child can exit the vehicle on the
visor pavement side. Important information about the front pas-
● Set the height of the seat belt such that it senger front airbag
adapts to the child seat naturally, without A sticker with important information about the
twisting. The lowest position of the seat belt passenger airbag is located on the passeng-
height regulator must be used with rear-fac- er's sun visor and/or on the passenger side
ing child seats. door frame ››› Fig. 22.
● To correctly use a child seat in the back, Read and always observe the safety informa-
the front backrest must be adjusted so that tion included in the following chapters:
there is no contact with the child seat in the
back in the case that it goes opposite to the ● Safety distance with respect to the passen-
direction of the car. In the case of front facing ger airbag ››› page 22.
restraint systems, the front backrest must be ● Objects between the passenger and the
adjusted so that there is no contact with the passenger side airbag ››› in Front airbags
child's feet. on page 25.
Fig. 23 Airbag sticker: on the rear frame of the
passenger side door ● If a semi-universal type chair is to be instal-
led, in which the method of attachment to the The passenger side front airbag, when ena-
car is through the seat belt and support bled, is a serious risk for a child that is facing
backward since the airbag can strike the seat

1) Compliance with current national legislation

and the manufacturer's instructions is required


when using or installing child seats.
30
Transporting children safely

with such force that it can cause serious or ● For those vehicles that do not include a Attachment systems overview
fatal injuries. Children up to 12 years old key lock switch to deactivate the airbag, ● ISOFIX: ISOFIX is a standardised attach-
should always travel on the rear seat. the vehicle must be taken to a technical ment system allowing quick and safe attach-
Therefore we strongly recommend you to service. Do not forget to reconnect the air- ment of child seats in the vehicle. ISOFIX at-
bag when an adult wants to sit in the front tachment establishes a rigid connection be-
transport children on the rear seats. This is
passenger seat. tween the child seat and the car body.
the safest location in the vehicle. Alternative-
ly, the front passenger airbag can be disa- ● Never allow a child to be transported in a
vehicle without being properly secured, or The child seat has two rigid attachment clips,
bled with a key-operated switch ››› page 25.
to stand up or kneel on a seat while travel- called connectors. These connectors are fit-
When transporting children, use a child seat
ling. In an accident, the child could be flung ted into the ISOFIX attachment rings found
suitable for the age and size of each child
through the vehicle, causing possibly fatal between the seat cushion and the backrest
››› page 29. injuries to themselves and to the other vehi- of the vehicle's back seat (on the sides). ISO-
cle occupants. FIX attachment systems are used mainly in
WARNING
● Never leave a child alone in the child seat Europe ››› page 32. If necessary, ISOFIX at-
● If a child seat is secured to the front pas- tachment may have to be supplemented with
or in the vehicle.
senger seat, the risk to the child of sustain- a Top Tether belt or a support bracket.
● Children who are less than 1.5 metres tall
ing critical or fatal injuries in the event of an
must not wear a normal seat belt without a
accident increases. ● Automatic three-point seat belt. When-
child seat, as this could cause injuries to
● An inflating front passenger airbag can ever possible, it is preferable to attach the
the abdominal and neck areas during a
strike the rear-facing child seat and project sudden braking manoeuvre or in an acci- child seats with the ISOFIX system rather than
it with great force against the door, the roof dent. attaching them with an automatic three-point
or the backrest. seat belt ››› page 35.
● When a child seat is mounted in the rear
● Never install a child seat facing back-
seats, the door child-proof lock should be Additional attachment:
wards on the front passenger seat unless activated ››› page 107.
the front passenger front airbag has been ● Top Tether: the Top Tether belt is guided
disabled. Risk of potentially fatal injuries to
over the back of the rear seat and attached
the child! However, if necessary, the front
to an anchor point with a hook. Anchor points
passenger front airbag must be deactiva- Attachment systems
are located at the back of the rear seat back-
ted ››› page 25. If the passenger seat has a
height adjustment option, move it to the Depending on the country, different attach- rest on the boot side ››› page 34. The rings
highest, most upright position. If you have a ment systems are used for safely installing for retaining the Top Tether belt are marked
fixed seat, do not install any child restraint child seats. with an anchor symbol.
system in this location. ● Support bracket: some child seats rest on
the floor of the vehicle with a support bracket.
The support bracket prevents the child seat »
31
Safety

from tipping forward in the event of impact. Recommended systems for attaching ● Child seats in the direction of travel: ISO-
Child seats fitted with a support bracket child seats FIX and Top Tether.
should only be used in the passenger seat SEAT recommends attaching child seats as
and side rear seats ››› . For the assembly of follows: WARNING
this type of seat you should also consult the Incorrect use of the support bracket can
list of approved vehicles for this assembly, ● Baby carriers or child seats in the oppo- cause serious or fatal injury.
available in the instructions for child restraint site direction of travel: ISOFIX and support
● Make sure the support bracket is correct-
systems. bracket or i-Size.
ly and safely installed.

Fit a child seat with the ISOFIX / i-Size and Top Tether system

Fig. 25 Rear seats: fitting a child seat with the


ISOFIX system.

Fig. 24 Rear seat: slots die cut to access the


ISOFIX / iSize securing rings.

Child seats can be secured quickly, easily Two “ISOFIX” retaining rings are fitted on each backrest and the seat cushioning ››› Fig. 24.
and safely on the rear side seats with the rear side seat. In some vehicles, the rings are The Top Tether rings are located on the rear
“ISOFIX” and Top Tether system. secured to the seat frame and, in others, they part of the rear seat backrests (behind the
are secured to the rear floor. The “ISOFIX” backrest or in the luggage compartment)
rings are located between the rear seat ››› page 34.
32
Transporting children safely

To understand the compatibility of the “ISO-


FIX” systems in the vehicle, check the table
below.

Age group Height classification Front passenger seat Side rear seats Middle rear bench seat
Group 0: up to 10 kg E X IL-SU X

E X X

Group 0+: up to 13 kg D X IL-SU X

C X X

D X X

C X X

Group 1: from 9 to 18 kg B X IL-SU, IUF X

B1 X X

A X X

Group 2: from 15 to 25 kg – X IL-SU X

Group 3: from 22 to 36 kg – X IL-SU X

i-Size child restraint system – X i-U X

Height classification: The height classification indication is equivalent to the authorised bodyweight for the child seat. In the case of child seats with universal or semi-
universal approval, the height classification is shown on the ECE approval label. The height classification is specified on each child seat.
X: Vehicle seat unsuitable for fitting this group of child seat.
IL-SU: Vehicle seat suitable for fitting an ISOFIX child seat with semi-universal approval. The vehicle list provided by the child seat manufacturer must be consulted.
IUF: Vehicle seat suitable for fitting an ISOFIX child seat with universal approval.
i-U: Vehicle seat suitable for fitting a forward- or rear-facing i-Size child seat with universal approval.
Vehicle seat suitable for fitting a forward- or rear-facing i-Size child seat with universal approval. Vehicle seat suitable for fitting a forward-facing i-Size child seat with
universal approval. »

33
Safety

Securing the child seat with the “ISOFIX/i- ● Ensure that the child seat is correctly se-
Size” system cured to the “ISOFIX” and Top Tether secur-
You are obliged to follow the seat manufac- ing rings.
turer's instructions.

● Open the cut-out section behind the


marked grooves to access the retaining rings
Top Tether securing belts
››› Fig. 24.
● Press the child seat onto the “ISOFIX/iSize”
retaining rings until the child seat is heard to
engage securely ››› Fig. 25. If the child seat is Fig. 27 Back of the rear seats: Top Tether se-
equipped with Top Tether anchor points, se- curing rings.
cure it to the correspondent ring
››› page 34. Observe the manufacturer's in- Child seats with the Top Tether system come
structions. with a strap for securing the seat to the vehi-
cle anchor point, located at the back of the
● Pull on both sides of the child seat to ensure
rear seat backrest and provide greater re-
that it is properly anchored.
straint.
Child seats with the “ISOFIX” and Top Tether The objective of this strap is to reduce for-
attachment system are available from Tech- ward movements of the child seat in a crash,
nical Services. to reduce the risk of injuries to the head from
hitting the inside of the vehicle.
WARNING
The securing rings are designed only for Using the Top Tether in rear-facing moun-
use with “ISOFIX” and Top Tether system ted seats
child seats.
Currently, there are very few rear-facing child
● Never secure other child seats that do safety seats that have Top Tether. Please
not have the “ISOFIX” or Top Tether system, Fig. 26 Rear seats: adjustment and assembly carefully read and follow the seat manufac-
or safety belts or any other objects to the according to the Top Tether belt. turer instructions to learn the proper way to
securing rings – as this can result in poten-
install the Top Tether strap.
tially fatal injuries to the child.

34
Transporting children safely

Securing the retainer strap ● Firmly tighten the strap following the manu- WARNING
● Follow the manufacturer's instructions to facturer's instructions.
An undue installation of the safety seat will
deploy the child seat Top Tether retaining increase the risk of injury in the event of a
strap. Releasing the retaining strap
crash.
● Place the belt under the headrest of the ● Loosen the strap following the manufactur-
● Never tie the retainer strap to a hook in
back seat ››› Fig. 26 (depending on the in- er's instructions. the luggage compartment.
structions of the chair itself, lift or remove the ● Push the lock and release it from the an- ● Never secure or tie luggage or other
headrest if necessary). choring support. items to the lower anchorages (ISOFIX) or
● Slide the strap and secure it properly with the upper ones (Top Tether).
the anchorage of the backrest ››› Fig. 27.

Fitting a child seat using the seat belt

If you want to fit a universal approval catego- cle. You will find any necessary information bel. The following table shows the different
ry (U) child seat in your vehicle, you must on the child seat’s orange ECE approval la- fitting options. »
check that the seat is approved for your vehi-

35
Safety

Front passenger seat


Age group Weight of the child Front passenger air- Front passenger air- Rear seats
bag activated bag deactivated
Group 0 Up to 10 kg X U U

Group 0+ Up to 13 kg X U U

Rear-facing From 9 to 18 kg X U U
Group 1
Forward-facing From 9 to 18 kg U X U

Group 2 From 15 to 25 kg U X U

Group 3 From 22 to 36 kg U X U

U: universal.
X: vehicle seat unsuitable for fitting this group of child seat.

Fitting a child seat using the seat belt WARNING Fitting a child seat to the middle
● Set the height of the seat belt such that it
When travelling, children must be secured seat of the rear bench using the
adapts to the child seat naturally, without in the vehicle with a restraint system suita- seat belt
twisting. The lowest position of the seat belt ble for age, weight and size.
height regulator must be used with rear-fac- ● Read and always observe information
ing child seats. and warnings concerning the use of child
● Put the seat belt in place and pass it seats ››› page 30.
through the child seat according to the in-
structions of the child seat manufacturer.
● Make sure that the seat belt is not twisted.
● Insert the latch plate into the seat's buckle
until you hear the engagement click.

Fig. 28 Position of the belt buckle on the rear


seat

36
Transporting children safely

1 Belt buckle for the middle seat


2 Belt buckle for the side seat

Child seats must always be fitted in the mid-


dle of a vehicle seat. Take into account these
instructions to ensure that this is possible on
the middle seat of the rear bench:

● Place the middle seat's belt buckle


››› Fig. 28 1 behind the side seat's belt buck-
le ››› Fig. 28 2 .
● Plug the middle seat's seat belt into the
middle seat's belt buckle ››› Fig. 28 1 and
make sure it clicks in place.
● For seat belts to be correctly fitted, the
buckles must not be twisted ››› Fig. 28.

37
Emergencies

Emergencies A built-in control unit establishes the connec-  Assistance call1)


tion. With the assistance call you can directly re-
When a voice service is activated, a connec- quest specialised help in the event of a
Self-help tion is established with a phone line. breakdown.
Parallel to the voice call, some vehicle data is
Information, assistance and Control lamp transmitted, e.g. your current location.
The control has a warning lamp ››› Fig. 29
emergency call service (arrow). It shows the following statuses:  Emergency call service1)
If an emergency call is conducted manually
How it works ● Off: the eCall service is not available.
or activated automatically in the event of an
● Flashes red, approx. 20 seconds after
accident with an airbag triggering, informa-
switching on the ignition: the eCall service tion relevant to the emergency is broadcast,
is off. e.g. the current location of the vehicle
● Lights up red: system failure. The eCall ››› page 309.
service is available with certain restrictions.
If the call is public, the person on the other
SEAT suggests going to a specialised work-
end of the line uses the language of the
shop.
country in which you are located.
Fig. 29 On the roof console: voice service con- ● Lights up green: the eCall service is avail-
trols able. The system works correctly. If the call is private, the person on the other
end of the line will assist you in the language
● Flashes green: There is an ongoing voice
Depending on the equipment, there is a con- you have configured in the Infotainment sys-
connection.
trol on the roof console. tem. If the configured language is not availa-
ble, English will be used.
By pressing the buttons ,  and   Information call1)
››› Fig. 29, you can run the following voice With the information call, a call is made to Diversion to 112 emergency number
services: SEAT, S.A. customer service.
In some situations where the emergency call
● information call service is limited or cannot be carried out, an
● assistance call emergency call is made to 112.
● emergency call service.

1) Only available in certain countries.


38
Self-help

The following conditions may cause the


Emergency equipment WARNING
emergency call service to function in a limi-
Loose objects in the vehicle interior can be
ted manner or the call to be diverted to the
112 emergency number: First aid kit, warning triangle and violently thrown in case of a sudden ma-
noeuvre or braking and especially in acci-
fire extinguishers
● The emergency call is made from an area dents causing serious injury.
with weak or no mobile and GPS signal, as Warning triangle ● Secure or store fire extinguishers, first aid
well as e.g. tunnels, between very tall build- kit, reflective vests and warning triangle
The use of reflective warning triangles is
ings, garages, underground walkways, moun- securely in the vehicle.
obligatory in emergencies in some countries.
tains and valleys.
As are the first aid kit and a set of spare light
● In areas with sufficient mobile telephone bulbs. Note
and GPS coverage, the mobile telephone ● The first aid kit, warning triangle, reflec-
The warning triangle is under the storage
network of the telecommunications operator tive vests and fire extinguishers are not part
compartment which is located under the lug-
in question may not be available. of the vehicle's standard equipment.
gage compartment floor.
● In some countries, the emergency call serv- ● The warning triangle should meet legal
ice may not be available due to legal rea- First aid kit requirements.
sons. There is no valid license for the use of ● Before acquiring accessories and emer-
the emergency call service. The first-aid kit can go in the storage com-
gency equipment see the instructions in
partment which is located under the luggage
● The components of the vehicle required for “Accessories and spares” ››› page 306.
compartment floor.
the emergency phone call are damaged or
do not get enough power. The first aid kit must comply with legal re-
● In some countries, the emergency call serv- quirements. Check the expiry date of the
contents of the first aid kit.
ice may not be available and depending on
the location of the vehicle, the control lamp
LEDs, and even the operation of the different Fire extinguisher
types of calls, could have a specific behav- The fire extinguisher is attached to the lug-
iour. gage compartment carpet with Velcro.
The fire extinguisher must conform to legal
Note
requirements, be ready for use and be
Breakdown service and information calls checked regularly. Check the certification
can incur an additional cost on your tele- seal on the extinguisher.
phone bill.

39
Emergencies

Vehicle tool kit WARNING Do not remove foreign objects, e.g. screws
or nails, from the tyre.
When the vehicle tool kit, tyre mobility set
and spare wheel are loose in the interior After inserting the sealant residue in the tyre,
they can be violently thrown in case of a you must again check the tyre pressure
sudden manoeuvre or braking and espe- about 10 minutes after starting the engine.
cially in accidents, causing serious injury.
You should only use the tyre mobility set if the
● Ensure that the vehicle tool kit, the tyre
vehicle is parked in a safe place, you are fa-
mobility set and the spare wheel or tempo- miliar with the procedure and you have the
rary spare wheel are safely secured in the
necessary tyre mobility set! Otherwise, you
luggage compartment.
should seek professional assistance.

WARNING Do not use the tyre sealant in the following


Fig. 30 Underneath the floor panel of the lug-
gage compartment: vehicle tool kit. Unsuitable or damaged vehicle tools can cases:
cause injury or accidents. ● If the wheel rim has been damaged.
The vehicle tool kit is located under the floor ● Never work with inappropriate or dam- ● In outside temperatures below -20°C
panel in the luggage compartment. To ac- aged tools. (-4°F).
cess the vehicle tools ››› page 129.
● In the event of cuts or perforations in the
The tool kit includes: Note tyre greater than 4 mm.
1 Adapter for the anti-theft bolt The jack does not generally require any ● If you have been driving with very low pres-
maintenance. If required, it should be sure or a completely flat tyre.
2 Towing eye, removable greased using universal type grease.
● If the sealant bottle has passed its use by
3 Wheel spanner
date.
4 Crank handle for jack
5 Jack Tyre repairs WARNING
6 Hook for extracting the central wheel Using the tyre mobility system can be dan-
trims TMS (Tyre Mobility System) gerous, especially when filling the tyre at
7 Clip for removing the wheel bolt caps the roadside. Please observe the following
The Tyre Mobility System will reliably seal rules to minimise the risk of injury:
Some of the items listed are only provided in punctures caused by the penetration of a for- ● Stop the vehicle safely as soon as possi-
certain model versions, or are optional extras. eign body of up to about 4 mm in diameter. ble. Park it at a safe distance from sur-
rounding traffic to fill the tyre.

40
Self-help

● Ensure the ground on which you park is ● Avoid heavy acceleration, hard braking Anti-puncture kit contents
flat and solid. and fast cornering.
● All passengers and particularly children ● Drive for only 10 minutes at a maximum
must keep a safe distance from the work speed of 80 km/h (50 mph) and then check
area. the tyre.
● Turn on the hazard warning lights to warn
other road users. For the sake of the environment
● Use the tyre mobility system only if you
Dispose of used or expired sealant observ-
are familiar with the necessary procedures. ing any legal requirements.
Otherwise, you should seek professional
assistance.
● The tyre mobility set is intended for tem-
Note
porary emergency use only until you can A new bottle of sealant can be purchased
reach the nearest specialised workshop. at SEAT dealerships.
● Replace the repaired tyre with the tyre Fig. 31 Standard representation: anti-punc-
mobility set as soon as possible. Note ture kit contents.
● The sealant is a health hazard and must Take into account the separate instruction The anti-puncture kit is located underneath
be cleaned immediately if it comes into manual of the tyre mobility system’s manu- the floor covering in the luggage compart-
contact with the skin. facturer. ment. It includes the following components
● Always keep the tyre mobility set out of
››› Fig. 31:
the reach of small children.
● Always stop the engine, apply the hand 1 Valve insert remover
brake and put it in gear when using a man- 2 A sticker to be adhered to the instrument
ual gearbox, in order to reduce the risk of cluster, within the driver's visual field, to
involuntary movement of the vehicle. remind that the maximum advisable
speed “max. 80 km/h” or “max. 50 mph”
WARNING 3 Filler tube with cap
A tyre filled with sealant does not have the 4 Air compressor
same performance properties as a conven-
5 ON/OFF switch
tional tyre.
● Never drive faster than 80 km/h
6 Air bleed screw (it can also be integrated
(50 mph). in the inflator tube). »
41
Emergencies

7 Warning provided by tyre pressure moni- ● Remove the bottle from the valve. ● Disconnect the air compressor. Unscrew
toring system (it can also be integrated in ● Place the insert back into the tyre valve us- the tyre inflator tube from the tyre valve.
the inflator tube). ing the tool ››› Fig. 31 1 . ● When the tyre pressure is between 2.5 and
8 Tube for inflating tyres 2.0 bars, continue driving without exceeding
9 12 volt connector Inflating the tyre 80 km/h (50 mph).
● Screw the compressor tyre inflator tube ● Attach the sticker ››› Fig. 31 2 to the instru-
10 Bottle of sealant
››› Fig. 31 8 into the tyre valve. ment cluster, within the driver's visual field.
11 Spare tyre valve
● Check that the air bleed screw is closed ● Check the pressure again after 10 minutes
The valve insert remover 1 has a gap at ››› Fig. 31 6 . ››› page 43.
the lower end for a valve insert. The valve in- ● Start the engine and leave it running.
sert can only be screwed or unscrewed in this WARNING
● Insert the connector ››› Fig. 31 9 into the
way. This also applies to its replacement part When inflating the wheel, the air compres-
11 . vehicle's 12-volt socket ››› page 136.
sor and the inflator tube may become hot.
● Turn the air compressor on with the
● Protect hands and skin from hot parts.
ON/OFF switch ››› Fig. 31 5 .
● Do not place the hot flexible inflator tube
Sealing and inflating a tyre ● Keep the air compressor running until it rea-
or hot air compressor on flammable mate-
ches 2.0 to 2.5 bar (29-36 psi/200-250 kPa). rial.
Sealing the tyre A maximum of 8 minutes.
● Allow them to cool before storing the de-
● Unscrew the tyre valve cap and insert. Use ● Disconnect the air compressor. vice.
the ››› Fig. 31 1 tool to remove the insert. ● If it does not reach the pressure indicated, ● If it is not possible to inflate the tyre to at
Place it on a clean surface. unscrew the tyre inflator tube from the valve. least 2.0 bars (29 psi / 200 kPa), the tyre is
● Shake the tyre sealant bottle vigorously ● Move the vehicle 10m so that the sealant is too badly damaged. The sealant is not in a
››› Fig. 31 10 .
distributed throughout the tyre. good condition to seal the tyre. Do not con-
● Screw the inflator tube ››› Fig. 31 3 into the tinue driving. Seek specialist assistance.
● Screw the compressor tyre inflator into the
sealant bottle. The bottle's seal will break au- valve.
tomatically. CAUTION
● Repeat the inflation process.
● Remove the lid from the filling tube Switch off the air compressor after a maxi-
● If the indicated pressure still cannot be
››› Fig. 313 and screw the open end of the mum of 8 operational minutes to avoid
tube into the tyre valve. reached, the tyre is too badly damaged. Stop
overheating! Before switching on the air
and request assistance from an authorised compressor again, let it cool for several mi-
● With the bottle upside down, empty all of
technician. nutes.
the contents into the tyre.

42
Self-help

Check after 10 minutes of driving Changing a wheel Wheel central trim

Screw the inflator tube ››› Fig. 31 5 again


and check the pressure on the gauge 6 .
What to do first
● Park the vehicle on a horizontal surface and
1.3 bar (19 psi / 130 kPa) and lower:
in a safe place as far away from traffic as
● Stop the vehicle! The tyre cannot be possible.
sealed sufficiently with the tyre mobility set. ● Apply the handbrake.
● You should obtain professional assistance
● Switch on the hazard warning lights.
››› .
● Manual transmission: select the 1st gear.

1.4 bar (20 psi / 140 kPa) and higher: ● Automatic transmission: Move the selector
lever to position P. Fig. 32 Correct positioning of the central
● Set the tyre pressure to the correct value wheel trim for steel rims.
again. ● If you are towing a trailer, unhitch it from
your vehicle. The central trims must be removed for access
● Carefully resume your journey until you
reach the nearest specialised workshop with- ● Make sure that the vehicle tool kit to the wheel nuts.
out exceeding 80 km/h (50 mph). ››› page 40 and the spare wheel
● Have the damaged tyre replaced.
››› page 296 are ready. Removing
● Observe the applicable legislation for each ● Attach the wire hook (vehicle tools
WARNING country (reflective vest, warning triangles, ››› page 40) to one of the recesses of the
etc.). central wheel trim and remove it.
Driving with an unsealed tyre is dangerous
and can cause accidents and serious in- ● All occupants should leave the vehicle and
jury. wait in a safe place (for instance behind the Fitting

● Do not continue driving if the tyre pres- roadside crash barrier). ● Fit the central wheel trim onto the rim. The
sure is 1.3 bar (19 psi / 130 kPa) and lower. bottom of the “S” of the SEAT badge should
WARNING align with the inflation valve ››› Fig. 32 1 .
● Seek specialist assistance.
● Always observe the above steps and pro- ● Press the central trim firmly until it locks in
tect yourself and other road users. with an audible click. »
● If you change the wheel on a slope, block
the wheel on the opposite side of the car
with a stone or similar to prevent the vehi-
cle from moving.
43
Emergencies

Note Anti-theft wheel nuts Loosening wheel nuts


There is also a valve mark on the back of
the central wheel trim that indicates the
correct alignment.

Wheel bolt caps

Fig. 34 Anti-theft wheel bolt with cap and Fig. 35 Wheel change: loosen the wheel nuts.
adapter.

Loosening the anti-theft wheel bolt


● Remove the wheel cover or the cap.
● Insert the special adapter ››› Fig. 34 1 (ve-

Fig. 33 Wheel: wheel nuts with caps.


hicle tools ››› page 40) onto the anti-theft
wheel bolt and push it on as far as it will go.
Removal ● Insert the wheel brace (vehicle tools) onto
● Fit the plastic clip (vehicle tools ››› Fig. 30) the adapter as far as it will go.
over the cap until it clicks into place ● Remove the wheel bolt ››› page 44.
››› Fig. 33. Fig. 36 Wheel change: tyre valve 1 and the
● Remove the cap with the plastic clip. Note correct position for the anti-theft wheel locking
Make a note of the code number of the an-
bolt 2 or 3 .
The caps protect the wheel nuts and should ti-theft wheel bolt and keep it in a safe
be remounted after changing the tyre. place, but not in your vehicle. If you need a
Use only the wheel wrench belonging to the
new adapter, you can obtain it from the car to loosen the wheel nuts.
The anti-theft wheel locking bolt has a
SEAT Official Service, indicating the code Loosen the wheel nuts only about one turn
special cap. This only fits on anti-theft locking
number. before raising the vehicle with the jack.
bolts and is not for use with standard wheel
nuts.
44
Self-help

If the wheel bolt is very tight, carefully push and cause an accident, serious injury and Raise the vehicle
on the end of the wheel wrench with your loss of vehicle control.
foot. Hold on to the vehicle for support and
● Use only wheel nuts which correspond to
take care not to slip during this operation.
the rim in question.
● Never use different wheel nuts.
Loosening wheel nuts
● Wheel nuts and threads should be clean,
● Fit the wheel wrench on as far as it will go
free of oil and grease, and it should be pos-
››› Fig. 35. sible to screw them easily.
● Hold the wrench at the end and rotate the ● To loosen and tighten wheel nuts, only
bolt approximately one turn anticlock- use the wheel wrench that came with the
wise ››› . car from the factory.
● The wheel nuts should only be loosened
Important information about wheel nuts Fig. 37 Jack position points.
slightly (about one turn) before raising the
Factory-fitted rims and wheel nuts are spe- vehicle with the jack. Risk of accident!
cially matched during construction. There- ● Never apply grease or oil to wheel nuts or
fore, if different rims are fitted, the correct to the wheel hub threads. Even if the bolts
wheel nuts with the right length and heads have been tightened to the prescribed tor-
must be used. This ensures that wheels are que, they could come loose while driving.
fitted securely and that the brake system ● Never loosen the screwed joints of wheel
functions correctly. rims with bolted ring trims.
In certain circumstances, you should not even ● If wheel nuts are tightened below the
use wheel nuts from vehicles of the same prescribed torque, the bolts and rims could
model. come loose while driving. If tightening tor-
que is too high, the wheel nuts or threads Fig. 38 Cross member: positioning the jack on
In wheels with full hubcaps, the anti-theft can be damaged. the vehicle.
locking bolt must be threaded onto positions
››› Fig. 36 2 or 3 , taking the tyre valve’s po- ● Rest the jack (vehicles tools) on firm
sition as reference 1 . Otherwise it will not be ground. If necessary use a large, strong
possible to mount the hubcap. board or similar support. If the surface is slip-
pery (for example tiles) place the jack on a
WARNING rubber mat or similar to prevent it from slip-
If the wheel nuts are not properly tight- ping ››› . »
ened, they could come loose while driving
45
Emergencies

● Find the support point on the strut (sunken Taking off the wheel
not have sufficient grip on the vehicle: risk
area) closest to the wheel to be changed of injury! ● Unscrew the wheel nuts using the box
››› Fig. 37. ● You should never place a body limb such spanner and place them on a clean surface.
● Turn the jack crank handle, located below as an arm or leg under a raised vehicle that ● Take off the wheel.
the strut support point, to raise it until the is solely supported by the jack.
tab 1 ››› Fig. 38 is below the housing provi- ● If you have to work underneath the vehi- Putting on the spare wheel
ded. cle, you must use suitable stands addition-
Check the direction of rotation of the tyre
● Align the jack so that tab 1 “grips” onto ally to support the vehicle, there is a risk of
accident!. ››› page 47.
the housing provided on the strut and the mo-
bile base 2 is resting on the ground. The ● Never raise the vehicle if it is tilting to one ● Place the spare wheel or temporary spare
base plate 2 should fall vertically with re- side or the engine is running. wheel into position.
spect to the support point 1 . ● Never start the engine when the vehicle is ● Screw on the wheel nuts in position and
● Continue turning the jack until the wheel is raised. The vehicle may come loose from tighten them loosely with a box spanner.
slightly lifted off the ground. the jack due to the engine vibrations.
● To tighten the anti-theft locking wheel nuts
use the corresponding adaptor.
WARNING CAUTION
● Carefully lower the vehicle using the jack.
The factory-supplied jack is only designed The vehicle must not be raised on the
for changing wheels on this model. On no ● Use the wheel spanner to tighten all of the
crossbar. Place the jack only at the support
account attempt to use it for lifting heavier wheel nuts clockwise. Tighten the bolts in di-
points provided on the strut and align it.
vehicles or other loads. Risk of injury. Otherwise, the vehicle may be damaged. agonal pairs (not in a circle).
● Make sure the jack remains stable. If the ● Put the caps, trim or full hubcap back on.
surface is slippery or soft, the jack could
slip or sink, respectively, with the conse- The wheel nuts should be clean and turn
quent risk of causing injuries.
Removing and installing a wheel easily. Before fitting the spare wheel, inspect
● Lift the vehicle using only the jack sup-
the wheel condition and hub mounting surfa-
Change the wheel after loosening the wheel ces. These surfaces must be clean before fit-
plied from the factory. Other jacks, even nuts and raising the vehicle with the jack.
those approved for other SEAT models ting the wheel.
could slip, with the consequent risk of in- When removing/fitting the wheel, the rim may
jury. hit and damage the brake disc. For this rea- Tightening torque of the wheel nuts
● Place the jack only at the support points son, please take care and get a second per- The recommended tightening torque for
provided on the strut and align it. Other- son to assist you. wheel nuts for steel and alloy wheels is
wise, the jack could slip because it does 120 Nm. After changing a wheel, have the

46
Self-help

tightening torque checked immediately with a Works after changing a wheel Changing the windscreen
torque wrench that is working perfectly.
Before checking tightening torque, have any
● Alloy wheels: replace the wheel bolt caps. wiper blades
rusty wheel nuts that are difficult to screw re- ● Plate wheels: replace the wheel hubcap .
placed and clean the wheel hub threads. ● Return all tools to their proper storing loca-
Wiper service position
Never apply grease or oil to wheel nuts or to tion.
the wheel hub threads. Even if the bolts have ● If the replaced wheel does not fit in the
been tightened to the prescribed torque, they spare wheel housing, store it safely in the lug-
could come loose while driving. gage compartment ››› page 128.
● Check the tyre pressure of the newly moun-
ted tyre as soon as possible.
Tyres with directional tread pattern ● In vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure indica-
tor, adjust the pressure and store it in memory
Tyres with directional tread pattern have
››› page 295.
been designed to operate best when rotating
● Have the tightening torque of the wheel
in only one direction. An arrow on the tyre Fig. 39 Wipers in service position.
sidewall indicates the direction of rotation on nuts checked as soon as possible with a tor-
tyres with directional tread. Always observe que wrench ››› page 46. Meanwhile, drive
Ensure that the wiper blades are not frozen.
the indicated direction of rotation in order to carefully.
guarantee optimum grip and help avoid ● Have the flat tyre replaced as quickly as The wiper arms can be raised when the wip-
aquaplaning, excessive noise and wear. possible. ers are in service position ››› Fig. 39.

If the tyre is mounted in the opposite direction ● Close the bonnet ››› page 276.
of rotation, drive with extreme caution, as the ● Switch the ignition on and off.
tyre is no longer being used correctly. This is
● Press the windscreen wiper lever down-
of particular importance when the road sur-
wards briefly ››› page 120 4 .
face is wet. Change the tyre as soon as pos-
sible or remount it with the correct direction Before driving, always lower the wiper arms.
of rotation. Using the windscreen wiper lever, the wind-
screen wiper arms return to their initial posi-
tion. »

47
Emergencies

Note Raising and lowering windscreen wiper


arms
● The windscreen wiper arms can be
moved to the service position only when ● Place the windscreen wipers in the service
the bonnet is properly closed. position ››› page 47.
● You can also use the service position, for ● Grip the wiper arms only by the blade's
example, if you want to fix a cover over the fastening point.
windscreen in the winter to keep it clear of
ice. Cleaning windscreen wiper blades
● Raise the wiper arms.
Fig. 41 Changing the rear wiper blade ● Use a soft cloth to remove dust and dirt
Changing the wiper rear wiper from the windscreen wiper blades.
blades The windscreen wiper blades are supplied as ● If the blades are very dirty, a sponge or
standard with a layer of graphite. This layer is
damp cloth may be used ››› .
responsible for ensuring that the wipe is silent.
If the graphite layer is damaged, the noise of
Changing the windscreen wiper blades
the water as it is wiped across the windscreen
will be louder. ● Lift and unfold the wiper arms.
● Press and hold release button ››› Fig. 40 1
Check the condition of the wiper blades reg-
ularly. If the wipers scrape across the and pull gently on the wiper blade in the di-
glass, they should be changed if they are rection of the arrow.
damaged, or cleaned if they are dirty ››› . ● Fit a new wiper blade of the same length
and design on to the wiper arm and hook it
If this does not produce the desired results,
into place.
Fig. 40 Changing the windscreen wiper the setting angle of the windscreen wiper
arms might be incorrect. They should be ● Rest the wiper arms back onto the wind-
blades
checked by a specialised workshop and cor- screen.
rected if necessary.
Changing the rear wiper blade
Damaged windscreen wiper blades should
● Lift and fold the wiper arm.
be replaced immediately. These are availa-
ble from qualified workshops. ● Turn the blade slightly ››› Fig. 41 (arrow A ).

48
Self-help

● Hold down the release button 1 while gen- CAUTION Jump start: description
tly pulling the blade in the direction of arrow
● To prevent damage to the bonnet and the
B .
wiper arms, only leave them in the service
● Insert a new blade of the same length and position.
type in the rear wiper arm in the opposite di-
● Before driving, always lower the wiper
rection to the arrow B and hook into place
arms.
button 1 .
● Replace the wiper arm on the rear window.

WARNING Jump start


Worn or dirty windscreen wiper blades re-
duce visibility and increase the risk of acci- Jump leads
Fig. 42 Diagram of connections for vehicles
dent and serious injury.
without Start Stop system
● Always replace damaged or worn wind- The jump lead must have a sufficient wire
screen wiper blades or blades that no lon- cross section.
ger clean the windscreen properly. If the engine fails to start because of a dis-
charged battery, the battery can be connec-
CAUTION ted to the battery of another vehicle to start
● Damaged or dirty windscreen wipers
the engine.
could scratch the glass. Jump leads must comply with standard DIN
● If products containing solvents, rough 72553 (see cable manufacturer's instruc-
sponges or sharp objects are used to clean tions). The wire cross section must be at least
the blades, the graphite layer will be dam- 25 mm2 for petrol engines and at least
aged. 35 mm2 for diesel engines.
● Never use fuel, nail varnish remover, paint Fig. 43 Diagram of connections for vehicles
Note with Start Stop system
thinner or similar products to clean the win-
dows. ● The vehicles must not touch each other,
Jump lead terminal connections
● In icy conditions, always check that the otherwise electricity could flow as soon as
wiper blades are not frozen to the glass be- the positive terminals are connected. 1. Switch off the ignition of both vehicles
fore using the wipers. In cold weather, it ● The discharged battery must be properly
››› . »
may help to leave the vehicle parked with connected to the on-board network.
the wipers in service position ››› page 47.

49
Emergencies

2. Connect one end of the red jump lead to 8. Start the engine of the vehicle with the ty (see imprint on battery). Failure to com-
the positive + terminal of the vehicle flat battery and wait for 2 or 3 minutes ply could result in an explosion.
with the flat battery A ››› Fig. 42. until the engine is running.
● Never use jump leads when one of the
3. Connect the other end of the red jump batteries is frozen. Danger of explosion!
lead to the positive terminal + in the ve- Removing the jump leads Even after the battery has thawed, battery
hicle providing assistance B . 9. Before you remove the jump leads, acid could leak and cause chemical burns.
4a. In vehicles without a Start-Stop system: switch off the dipped beam headlights if If a battery freezes, it should be replaced.
connect one end of the black jump lead they are switched on. ● Keep sparks, flames and lighted ciga-
to the negative terminal – of the vehicle 10. Turn on the heater blower and heated rettes away from batteries, danger of ex-
providing the current B ››› Fig. 42. rear window in the vehicle with the flat plosion. Failure to comply could result in an
explosion.
4b. In vehicles with a Start-stop system: battery. This helps minimise voltage
peaks which are generated when the ● Observe the instructions provided by the
connect one end of the black jump lead
X to a suitable ground terminal, to a sol- leads are disconnected. manufacturer of the jump leads.
id piece of metal in the engine block, or ● Do not connect the negative cable from
11. When the engine is running, disconnect
to the engine block itself ››› Fig. 43. the leads in reverse order to the details the other vehicle directly to the negative
terminal of the flat battery. The gas emit-
5. Connect the other end of the black jump given above.
ted from the battery could be ignited by
lead X to a solid metal component bol- sparks. Danger of explosion.
Make sure the battery clamps have sufficient
ted to the engine block or to the engine
metal-to-metal contact with the battery ter- ● Never attach the negative cable to fuel
block itself of the vehicle with the flat
minals. system components or the brake lines in
battery. Do not connect it to a point near
the other vehicle.
the battery A . If the engine fails to start after about 10 sec-
● The non-insulated parts of the battery
6. Position the leads in such a way that onds, switch off the starter and try again after
clamps must not be allowed to touch. The
they cannot come into contact with any about 1 minute.
jump lead attached to the positive battery
moving parts in the engine compart- terminal must not touch metal parts of the
ment. WARNING
vehicle, this can cause a short circuit.
● Please note the safety warnings referring
● Position the leads in such a way that they
Starting to working in the engine compartment
cannot come into contact with any moving
7. Start the engine of the vehicle with the
››› page 276. parts in the engine compartment.
boosting battery and let it run at idling ● The battery providing assistance must
● Do not lean on the batteries. This could
speed. have the same voltage as the flat battery
result in chemical burns.
(12V) and approximately the same capaci-

50
Self-help

Note Keyless Access system, the steering wheel not operate when the engine is switch-
could lock ››› . ed off.
The vehicles must not touch each other,
otherwise electricity could flow as soon as ● As the driver of the towing vehicle:
WARNING
the positive terminals are connected. – Accelerate with particular care and
A vehicle with no power should never be caution.
towed.
– Avoid sudden braking and manoeuvres.
● When towing, never remove the ignition
Tow start and towing key or disconnect the ignition with the start
– Brake earlier than usual and more

button. Otherwise, the electronic lock of smoothly.

Introduction the steering column could suddenly be-


come blocked and it would be impossible CAUTION
Tow-starting means starting the engine of to steer the vehicle. This could cause an
● To avoid damaging the vehicle, for exam-
accident, serious injury and loss of control
the vehicle while another pulls it. ple the paint, remove and replace the lid
of the vehicle.
Towing means one vehicle pulling another and towing eye carefully.
● If during towing the vehicle runs out of
that is not roadworthy. ● Unburnt fuel could enter the catalytic
power, stop towing immediately and re-
converter and damage it during towing.
Always consider the legal provisions relating quest the assistance of specialist person-
to tow-starting and towing. nel.

For technical reasons, towing a vehicle Instructions for tow-starting


with a discharged battery is not allowed.
WARNING
The jump start should be used instead Vehicle handling and braking capacity Vehicle's should not generally be tow-
››› page 49. change considerably during towing. Please started. The jump start should be used in-
observe the following instructions to mini-
If the vehicle comes with the Keyless Access stead ››› page 49.
mise the risk of serious accidents and in-
system, towing is only allowed with the igni- jury: For technical reasons, towing the following
tion on! vehicles is not allowed:
● As the driver of the vehicle being towed:
The vehicle battery drains if the vehicle is – You should depress the brake much ● Vehicles with an automatic gearbox.
towed with the engine switched off and the harder as the brake servo does not op-
ignition connected. Depending on the battery ● If the vehicle battery is discharged, be-
erate. Pay the utmost attention to avoid
charge status, the drop in voltage may be so crashing into the towing vehicle. cause in vehicles with the Keyless Access
large, even after just a few minutes, that no locking and ignition system the steering re-
– More strength is required at the steer-
electrical device in the vehicle may work e.g. mains locked and the electronic parking
the hazard warning lights. In vehicles with the
ing wheel as the power steering does
brake cannot be deactivated nor can the »
51
Emergencies

electronic lock of the steering column be re- Towing instructions ● You should depress the brake much harder
leased if they are activated. as the brake servo does not operate. Avoid
● If the battery is flat, it is possible that the Towing requires some expertise and experi- hitting the towing vehicle.
engine control units may not operate correct- ence, especially when using a tow rope. Both ● Bear in mind the information and instruc-
ly. drivers should be familiar with the difficulties tions in the manual of the vehicle to be towed.
involved in towing. For this reason, inexper-
However, if the vehicle must absolutely be ienced drivers should abstain from towing. Notes for the driver of the towing vehicle
tow-started (in the case of manual gear- During towing, it should be ensured that no ● Accelerate with particular care and cau-
boxes): impermissible tractive forces or shocks are tion. Avoid sharp manoeuvres.
● Engage the 2nd or 3rd gear. generated. When towing on an unpaved
● Brake earlier than usual and smoothly.
road, there is always a risk of overloading and
● Keep the clutch pressed down. ● Bear in mind the information and instruc-
damaging the anchorage points.
● Switch on the ignition and the hazard warn- tions in the manual of the towed vehicle.
ing lights of both vehicles. During towing, the towing vehicle can signal
the change of direction even with the hazard Tow rope or tow bar
● Once both vehicles are moving, release the
warning lights turned on. To do so, at the
clutch. It is safer for the vehicle to be towed using a
same time, the turn signal lever must be oper-
● Once the engine starts, press the clutch ated with ignition switched on. Meanwhile, the tow bar, avoiding damage to the vehicle. A
and disengage the gear to avoid colliding hazard warning lights will go off. When the tow rope should only be used if a tow bar is
with the towing vehicle. turn signal lever is returned to the rest posi- not available.
tion, the hazard warning lights will be auto- A tow rope should be slightly elastic to avoid
CAUTION matically reactivated. damage to both vehicles. It is advisable to
● When tow-starting, unburnt fuel could use a tow rope made of synthetic fibre or sim-
enter the catalytic converter and damage Notes for the driver of the towed vehicle ilarly elastic material.
it. ● Leave the ignition on, so that the steering is Only attach the tow rope or the tow bar to
● Do not tow a vehicle for more than 50 m not blocked, and the electronic parking brake the towing eyes provided or a towing bracket.
in attempt to start it. There is risk of dam- may be deactivated and the turn signals and
age to the catalytic converter. wash/wipe operated. If the vehicle has a factory-fitted towing de-
vice, towing with a tow bar is only permitted
● More strength is required at the steering
if it has been specially designed to be instal-
wheel as the power steering does not oper-
led on a tow hitch ››› page 256.
ate when the engine is switched off.

52
Self-help

When the vehicle has to be towed: ● When, for example, after an accident, the Front towline anchorage
Check whether the vehicle may be towed smooth rotation of the wheels or the steering
operation cannot be guaranteed.
››› page 53, Cases where towing the vehi-
cle is not permitted.
When the vehicle is to tow another vehicle:
The vehicle can be towed using a tow bar or
● Observe legal requirements.
tow rope in the normal way, with all four
wheels on the road; it can also be towed with ● Keep in mind the instructions in the manual
either the front or rear wheels lifted off the on towing vehicles.
road.
CAUTION
● Switch the ignition on.
If there is no oil in the gearbox or no lubri-
● Put the gearbox lever in neutral or the se- cant in the automatic transmission the car
Fig. 44 Right side of the front bumper: remove
lector lever in the N ››› page 196 position. may only be towed with the driven wheels
the cover.
● Do not allow the vehicle to be towed at lifted clear of the road, or transported on a
speeds of over 50 km/h (30 mph). special car transporter or trailer.

● The vehicle must not be towed further than


50 km (30 miles). Note
● If a breakdown lorry is used, vehicles with The vehicle can only be towed if the steer-
automatic transmission are only allowed to ing lock electronic gearbox lock is deacti-
be towed with the front wheels suspended. vated. If the vehicle has no power supply or
there is an electric system fault, the engine
must be started using jump leads to deacti-
Cases where towing the vehicle is not per-
vate the steering column electronic gear-
mitted
box lock.
● If, due to a fault, the gearbox is out of lubri-
Fig. 45 Right side of the front bumper: towline
cant. anchorage in position.
● If the battery is flat and the steering cannot
be unlocked as a result, the electronic steer- The housing of the removable towline an-
ing lock and electronic parking brake cannot chorage is on the right side of the front bump-
be disengaged. er underneath a cover ››› Fig. 44.
● If a distance above 50 km needs to be trav- The towing eye should always be kept in the
elled. vehicle. »
53
Emergencies

Bear in mind the instructions for towing Rear towline anchorage Fitting the rear towline anchorage
››› page 52. ● Remove the towing eye from the vehicle
tool kit in the luggage compartment
Fitting the towline anchorage ››› page 40.
● Remove the towing eye from the vehicle ● Press the right hand side of the cover
tool kit in the luggage compartment ››› Fig. 46 to unclip it.
››› page 40. ● Remove the lid and let it hang from the ve-
● Remove the cover by pressing down on its hicle.
right-hand side and leave it hanging from the
● Screw the towline anchorage into the hous-
vehicle ››› Fig. 44.
ing by turning it as far as it will go anticlock-
● Screw the towing eye in the housing by wise ››› Fig. 47››› . Use a suitable object
turning it as far as it will go anticlock- that can completely and securely tighten the
Fig. 46 On the right side of the rear bumper:
wise ››› Fig. 45 ››› . Use a suitable object remove the cover. towing eye in its housing.
that can completely and securely tighten the
● After towing, unscrew the towing eye
towing eye in its housing.
clockwise with a suitable object.
● After towing, unscrew the towing eye
● Clean the towing eye if necessary and then
clockwise with a suitable object.
store it in the luggage compartment along
● Replace the cover and press on its left side with the other vehicle tools.
until the tab snaps into the bumper.
● Clean the towing eye if necessary and then CAUTION
store it in the luggage compartment along The towing eye must always be completely
with the other vehicle tools. and firmly tightened. Otherwise, it could be
released while towing and tow-starting.
CAUTION
Fig. 47 On the right side of the rear bumper:
The towing eye must always be completely towline anchorage in position.
and firmly tightened. Otherwise, it could be
released while towing and tow-starting. The housing of the screw towing eye is on the
Make sure that there are no objects that right side of the rear bumper behind a lid
prevent the eyebolt being screwed.
››› Fig. 46.
Bear in mind the instructions for towing
››› page 52.
54
Fuses and bulbs

Fuses and bulbs perage (same colour and markings) and Fuses inside the vehicle
size.
● Never replace a fuse by a metal strip, sta-
Fuses ple or similar.

Introduction
CAUTION
In general, a fuse can be assigned to various ● To prevent damage to the vehicle's elec-
electrical components. Likewise, an electrical tric system, before replacing a fuse always
component can be protected by several turn off the ignition, the lights and all elec-
fuses. trical elements and remove the key from
the ignition.
Only replace fuses when the cause of the
● Protect the fuse boxes when open to pre-
problem has been solved. If a newly inserted Fig. 48 On the driver's side dashboard: fuse
vent the entry of dust or humidity as they box cover.
fuse blows after a short time, you must have can damage the electrical system.
the electrical system checked by a special-
Opening and closing the fuse box situated
ised workshop as soon as possible.
Note below the dash panel
WARNING ● One component may have more than one ● Open: remove the fuse box cover in the di-
fuse. rection indicated ››› Fig. 48.
The high voltages in the electrical system
can give serious electrical shocks, causing ● Several components may run on a single ● Close: click the cover back into place.
burns and even death! fuse.
● Never touch the electrical wiring of the ● In the vehicle, there are more fuses than Identifying fuses below the dashboard by
ignition system. those indicated in this chapter. colours
● Take care not to cause short circuits in
Colour Amp rating
the electrical system.
Black 1
WARNING Purple 3
Using unsuitable fuses, repairing fuses or Light brown 5
bridging a current circuit without fuses can
cause a fire and serious injury. Brown 7.5
● Never use a fuse with a higher value. Only Red 10 »
replace fuses with a fuse of the same am-
55
Emergencies

Colour Amp rating Fuses in the engine compartment Replace a blown fuse
Blue 15

Yellow 20

White or transparent 25

Green 30

Orange 40

CAUTION
● Always carefully remove the fuse box
covers and refit them correctly to avoid Fig. 49 In the engine compartment: fuse box Fig. 50 Image of a blown fuse.
problems with your vehicle. cover.
● Protect the fuse boxes when open to
Preparations
To open the engine compartment fuse box
avoid the entry of dust or humidity. Dirt and ● Switch off the ignition, lights and all electri-
humidity inside fuse boxes can cause dam- ● Open the bonnet  ››› page 276. cal equipment.
age to the electrical system. ● Press the locking tabs to release the fuse ● Open the corresponding fuse box
box cover ››› Fig. 49. ››› page 55, ››› page 56.
● Then lift the cover out.
● To fit the cover, place it on the fuse box. Recognise a blown fuse
Push the locking tabs down until they click A fuse is blown if its metal strip is ruptured
audibly into place. ››› Fig. 50.
● Point a lamp at the fuse to see if it has
blown.

To replace a fuse
● Remove the fuse.
● Replace the blown fuse by one with an
identical amperage rating (same colour and
markings) and identical size.

56
Fuses and bulbs

● Replace the cover again or close the fuse


No. Consumer/Amps No. Consumer/Amps
box lid.
19 Radio, Multimedia System 25 Light switch, diagnosis input, head-
lamp range regulator, LSS steering
20 Heated rear window 30 40 column: lamps, halogen lamps, 7.5
Fuse placement switch, reverse gear, electrochromic
21 SCR Control Unit 30 mirror, RKA without radio.
Only replace fuses with a fuse of the same 23 Rear View Camera 7.5
amperage (same colour and markings) and Regulation of unfolded exterior mir-
41 7.5
rors,
size. Connectivity Box, connection for ex-
24 ternal audio sources (Double USB), 5 Clutch pedal, ignition relays, CNG
Fuses in the vehicle interior MIB display 42 7.5
relay coil, AC pressure sensor
No. Consumer/Amps 25 Steering column electronics (MFL) 7.5 43 DWP relay coil, rear window wiper
15
motor
1 Tow hook 20 26 Gateway 7.5
44 Airbag 7.5
3 Sound amplifier 30 27 Active suspension control unit 7.5
45 Left full LED headlight 7.5
4 Cigarette lighter/12V power point 20 28 DWA Sensor 7.5
46 Right full LED headlight 7.5
6 Central locking 40 29 DWA Horn 7.5
Steering column lock, Kessy Control
8 Heating fan/Climatronic 30 9AA/9AB climate control unit 7.5 48 7.5
31 Unit
10 Tow hook 25 9AK Climatronic control unit 15
49 SCR relay 7.5
11 CNG Gauge 7.5 32 Steering Column LSS, without Kessy 7.5
53 Automatic gearbox lever, ZSS 7.5
Lights switch, steering column LSS 33 Left Door Window Control 30
58 Windscreen washer pump 7.5
13 and SMLS, diagnostic port, 7.5
rain/light sensor 35 Left lights power supply 40
59 Heated rear view mirrors 10
14 Steering Column LSS: wiper control 10 36 Signal Horn 20
60 Tow hook 30
15 Kombi, Emergency call (+ NZ4) 7.5 37 Heated seats control unit 30
61 Tow hook 30 »
16 Right lights power supply 40 38 BCM Power C63 30

17 Right Door Window Control 30 39 BSD, PDC, MRR, PLA 10

18 Windscreen wipers 30
57
Emergencies

Fuse arrangement in engine compartment


No. Consumer/Amps should only be changed by a specialised
No. Consumer/Amps workshop.
ESC, Relay 87 coil and engine con-
● Positions not containing a fuse do not ap-
MPI Engine Injection Module 10 14 troller of engines (+ TJ1 / TJ4 / TH4 / 7.5
T5I / T6P / TJ7 / TC5 / T5Y). pear in the following tables.
1
TSI Engine Injection Module 15 ● Some of the equipment listed in the ta-
Automatic gearbox DQ200 and
15 30 bles below pertain only to certain versions
Fuel metering valve (TJ4/T6P/TJ7), AQ160
of the model or are optional extras.
Low temperature coolant pump
(TJ4/T6P/TJ7); Oil pressure regulat- 17 50 Diag 7.5 ● Please note that the above lists, while
2 ing valve (TJ1), AGR coolant valve 7.5 correct at the time of printing, are subject
18 BDM starter motor 30
(TJ1), High and low pressure water to change.
pumps (TJ1), SCR relay coil, cylin- ESC (Pump) 60
der head water valve 20
ABS (Pump) 40
3 Lambda probes 15
21 ESC/ABS (Valves) 25 Changing bulbs
Engine petrol pump relay (MPI),
4 15
Gauge control unit (TSI) TH4 Electric fan without A/C for
24
moderate climate countries
30 Introduction
Electric fan (EC), LDR valve, canni-
ster and variable distribution valve, TH4 fan with A/C or T5I for moder- Changing bulbs requires a certain degree of
20
5 oil pressure regulating valve, cylin- 10 ate climate countries practical skill. If you are unsure, SEAT recom-
25
der disconnection valves, WIV sen-
PTC1 40 mends that you consult a technical service or
sor and CNG pressure regulator
request assistance from a specialist. In gen-
6 Spark plugs (MPI and TSI) 20 TJ1/TJ4/TJ7/T6P or TH4/T5I Electric eral a specialist is needed if, in addition to the
26 50
fan for warm climate countries bulbs, other vehicle components require re-
7 Vacuum pump (TSI, CNG) 15
TH4 fan with A/C or T5I for moder- moval.
30
8 Injectors and EKP relay coil (MPI) 10 ate climate countries
27 Always use identical bulbs with the same
9 Servo sensor 7.5 PTC2 40 designation. The name can be found on the
base of the bulb holder.
Vref Battery: Gateway, BDM and 28 PTC3 40
10 7.5
BCM Depending on how equipped the vehicle is,
there are different sets of headlights and tail
12 Detachable compressor 10 Note
lights:
● In the vehicle, there are more fuses than
those indicated in this chapter. These ● ECOLED (full-LED) main headlights

58
Fuses and bulbs

● High (full-LED) main headlights Light source used for each function ● When changing the bulbs, take care not
● Rear bulb light to injure yourself on parts with sharp
Bulb lighta) Left Right
● LED rear light
edges.
Brake lights
2 x P21WLL 2 x P21WLL
Full-LED headlight system Side lights CAUTION
Full-LED headlights handle all light functions ● Remove the ignition key before working
Retro fog light P21 WLL –
(daylight, side light, turn signal, dipped beam on the electric system. Otherwise, a short
and route light) with light emitting diodes Reverse light – P21 WLL circuit could occur.
(LEDs) as a light source. ● Switch off the lights and the parking light
Turn signal PY 21W NA LL PY 21W NA LL
before changing a bulb.
Full-LED headlights are designed to last the a) The table corresponds to a right-hand traffic vehi-
● Take good care to avoid damaging any
lifetime of the car and light bulbs cannot be
cle. The position of lights may vary according to the components.
replaced. In case of headlight failure, go to an country.
authorised workshop to have it replaced.
Light with Left Right For the sake of the environment
Bulbs (12 V) LEDsa) Please ask your specialist retailer how to
Depending on the level of equipment fitted in dispose of used bulbs in the proper manner.
Brake lights LED LED
the vehicle, LEDs may be used for part or all
of the interior and/or exterior lighting. LEDs Side lights LED LED Note
have an estimated life that exceeds that of
Retro fog light LED – ● Depending on weather conditions (cold
the vehicle. If an LED light fails, go to an au-
or wet), the front lights, the fog lights, the
thorised workshop for its replacement. Reverse light – P21 WLL
tail lights and the turn signals may be tem-
Turn signal PY 21W NA LL PY 21W NA LL porarily misted. This has no influence on
the useful life of the lighting system. By
a)The table corresponds to a right-hand traffic vehi- switching on the lights, the area through
cle. The position of lights may vary according to the which the beam of light is projected will
country.
quickly be demisted. However, the edges
may continue to be misted.
WARNING
● Please check at regular intervals that all
● Bulbs are highly sensitive to pressure. The lighting (especially the exterior lighting) on
glass can break when you touch the bulb, your vehicle is functioning properly. This is
causing injury. not only in the interest of your own safety,
but also that of all other road users. »
59
Emergencies

● Before changing a bulb, make sure you CAUTION


have the correct new bulb.
Take care when removing the rear light unit
● Do not touch the glass part of the bulb to make sure there is no damage to the
with your bare hands, use a cloth or paper paintwork or any of its components.
towel instead, since the fingerprints left on
the glass will vaporise as a result of the
heat generated by the bulb, they will be
Note
deposited on the reflector and will impair ● Make sure you have a soft cloth ready to
its surface. place under the glass on the rear light unit,
● Depending on the level of equipment fit- to avoid any scratches.
ted in the vehicle, LEDs may be used for Fig. 52 Retaining tabs on reverse side of tail ● For LED lights, you can only change the
part or all of the interior and/or exterior light. turn signal and reverse light bulbs.
lighting. LEDs have an estimated life that
exceeds than that of the car. If an LED light Follow the steps indicated:
fails, go to an authorised workshop for its
– Check which of the bulbs is defective.
replacement.
– Open the rear lid.

– Remove the lid, levering the flat side of a


Tail light bulbs located in the body- screwdriver into the recess ››› Fig. 51 1 .
work – Remove the bulb connector 2 .

– Unscrew the light securing bolt 3 by hand


or using a screwdriver.
– Remove the light from the body, gently pull-
ing it toward you, and place on a clean,
smooth surface.
– Remove the bulb holder unlocking the re-
taining tabs ››› Fig. 52 A .
– Change the damaged bulb.

– To refit follow the steps in reverse order, tak-


Fig. 51 Luggage compartment: access to the
ing special care when fitting the bulb hold-
bolt securing the tail light unit.
er. The securing tabs must click into place.
60
Fuses and bulbs

Tail lights bulbs located in the rear – Remove the bulb connector ››› Fig. 54 1 . Side turn signals
lid – Remove the bulb holder unlocking the re-
taining tabs A .
– Change the damaged bulb.

– Use a cloth to remove any fingerprints from


the glass part of the bulb.
– Check that the new bulb works properly.

– Carry out the same actions in reverse order


for assembly and pay special attention to
placing the bulb holder, ensuring that the
tabs are properly secured. Fig. 55 Turn signal integrated in the rear view
Fig. 53 Rear lid open: remove the cover. mirror
Note
The side turn signals are LEDS and are inte-
For LED lights, you can only change the turn
grated in the rear view mirrors.
signal and reverse light bulbs.
In case of failure, go to an authorised work-
shop to have it replaced.
number plate light
Additional brake light
Note
Taking into account that it consists of LED
Number plate lights use LED technology.
bulbs, the change should be made at a tech-
LEDs have an estimated life that exceeds
Fig. 54 Remove the bulb holder. nical service centre.
than that of the car. If a light with LEDs fails,
go to an authorised workshop for replace-
Follow the steps indicated:
ment.
– Check which of the bulbs is defective.

– Open the rear lid.

– Remove the rear lid cover in the direction


indicated ››› Fig. 53.
61
Emergencies

Interior light and front reading front part until the two long tabs click on
the support.
lights
Note
In LED courtesy lights it is not possible to
replace the light sources. If the light does
not work, take the vehicle to an official
Service.

Luggage compartment lighting Fig. 58 Boot light.

– Extract the bulb by pressing on its inside


edge using the flat side of a screwdriver
Fig. 56 Front reading light.
››› Fig. 57.
To remove the glass – Disconnect the cable.
– Insert a fine screwdriver between the cas- – Press the bulb sideways and remove it from
ing and the glass ››› Fig. 56. its housing ››› Fig. 58.
– Carefully remove the glass, levering it to – Change the bulb.
avoid possible damage.
– Connect the cable again.
To replace the bulbs – Refit the bulb and press it in until it engages.
Fig. 57 Boot light.
– Pull the bulbs outwards.

– To remove the central bulb, hold and press


to one side.

Assembly
– Proceed in the reverse order, pressing gen-
tly on the outer edge of the side light.
– First fit the glass with the fastening tabs
over the frame of the switch. Next press the
62
Operation

Fig. 59 Instruments and controls.

64
Controls and displays

Operation – Wipe and wash system* . . . . . . . . . . .


– Multi-function display control . . . . .
120
72
– USB port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
– Connectivity Box/Wireless Charg-
188

9 Infotainment system: er . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187


Controls and displays 10 Hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 21 Driver's seat heating control . . . . . . . . 142
11 Glove compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 22 Ignition lock (vehicles without Key-
Interior view 12 Front passenger airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
less Access) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
23 Steering column adjustment lev-
13 Front passenger airbag disconnec-
Overview er . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
tion switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
24 Fuse housing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
1 Electric window controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 14 Switches for:
25 Lever for unlocking the bonnet . . . . . . 277
2 Interior door handle – Heating and ventilation . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
26 Light range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
3 Control for adjusting electric exteri- – Air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
or mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
27 Light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
– Climatronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
4 Air vents 15 Front passenger seat heating con- Note
5 Turn signal and main beam lever . . . . 113 trol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
● Some of the equipment listed in this sec-
6 Steering wheel with horn and 16 Gear lever tion is only fitted on certain models or are
– Driver airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 – Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 optional extras.
● The arrangement of controls on right-
– On-board computer controls . . . . . 84 – Automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
hand drive models may be slightly different
– Controls for radio, telephone, 17 Depending on the equipment, but- from the layout shown in ››› page 64. How-
navigation and speech dialogue tons for: ever, the symbols used to identify the con-
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 – Central locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 trols are the same.
– Paddle levers for tiptronic gear- – Start-Stop operation button . . . . . . . 193
shift (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . 199
– SEAT Drive Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
7 Instrument panel and warning
– Park assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
lamps:
18 Handbrake lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
– Instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
19 Start-up push button (Keyless Ac-
– Control and warning lamps . . . . . . . 86
cess closing and start-up sys-
8 Lever for: tem) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
– Windscreen wipers and washer . . . 120 20 Depending on the equipment:
65
Operation

Instruments and warn- After switching the engine on with a 12-volt


battery that is heavily discharged or newly
on the screen of the instrument panel and
to the instructions on the screen of the Info-
ing/control lamps changed some system settings (such as the tainment system when the vehicle is sta-
time, the date, the personalised comfort set- tionary.
tings and the programming) might be altered
Instrument panel or deleted. Check and correct these settings
once the battery is sufficiently charged.
Introduction
WARNING
The vehicle can be fitted with a instrument
Any distraction may lead to an accident,
panel digital lap timer or one Digital (SEAT
with the risk of injury.
Cockpit).
● Do not operate the instrument panel con-
trols when driving.
● To reduce the risk of accident and injury,
only make adjustments to the instructions

66
Instruments and warning/control lamps

Analogue instrument panel

Fig. 60 Instrument panel, on dash panel.

Details of the instruments ››› Fig. 60: 2 Engine coolant temperature display 4 Adjuster button and display.
››› page 82 or natural gas gauge in ve- 5 Speedometer.
1 Revolution counter (with the engine run- hicles with natural gas engine (CNG)
ning, in hundreds of revolutions per mi- 6 Fuel gauge ››› page 79.
››› page 81
nute) ››› page 79.
3 Displays on the screen ››› page 69.

67
Operation

Digital dashboard (SEAT Digital Cockpit)

Fig. 61 SEAT Digital Cockpit on the instrument


panel (classic view).

Details of the instruments: The Digital SEAT Cockpit is an instrument All views will display information on the
1 Engine coolant temperature display panel digital with monochrome screen in col- screen about audio, phone, travel data, vehi-
››› page 82 our high resolution. It has a 3 views accessi- cle status, navigation1) and driving aids1).
ble using the button  of the multifunction
2 Revolution counter. Revolutions per mi- In all views the information displayed in Infor-
steering wheel. By selecting different infor-
nute the engine is running ››› page 79. mation profiles can be customised
mation profiles, indications other than the
Gear engaged or position of the selec- ››› Fig. 61 8 .
3 classic circular instruments can be displayed,
tor lever currently selected such as navigation data, multimedia informa-
Information profiles
4 Screen display ››› page 69 tion or travel data.
Using the INSTRUMENT CLUSTER option, you
5 Speedometer The 3 views are: can choose between the different options for
6 Digital speed display ● Classic displaying the information to be displayed in
7 Fuel gauge ››› page 79. ● Dynamic the SEAT Digital Cockpit (select  > View >
Instrument cluster OR:  > Interior
8 Information Profile ››› page 68. ● Navigation

1) Depending on the version.


68
Instruments and warning/control lamps

settings > Infotainment > Instrument ● Information about the final destination. this, select the Navigation option in the
cluster). Digital display of the remaining travelling menu on the instrument panel ››› page 71.
time, distance to the destination and the esti-
Depending on the features or the navigation
Classic View mated time of arrival.
map, it can be shown in the Digital SEAT
The revolutions per minute and speedometer ● Operating range. Digital display of the re- Cockpit or on the Infotainment system or on
needles appear along the entire length maining range. both at the same time. If it is displayed only in
››› Fig. 61. ● Travel time. the Infotainment system, the SEAT Digital
● Route guidance. Cockpit will only display the arrows for ma-
View 1, 2, 3 or AUTOMATIC1) noeuvres.
● Journey. Digital display of the distance
Personalisation of the information that ap- travelled. Transfer of navigation map
pears in the Digital SEAT Cockpit. Only 2 of
● Assist systems. Graphic representation of
these items of information can be displayed The map is transferred from the Infotainment
different assistance systems.
at the same time, but the user chooses which system to the Digital SEAT Cockpit and vice
to display, and in what order, by moving the ● Traffic signs. Display of traffic signs detec- versa using the map transfer key.
finger vertically over the dials. ted.
Using the right thumbwheel of the multifunc-
● Navigation. Graphical representation of
Depending on the version, the Views can be tion steering wheel, in the Navigation menu,
memorised by exiting the menu or keeping the navigation with arrows. you can transfer the map back to the Info-
the View button pressed. tainment System.
It may vary based on the features, the num-
● Consumption. Graphic representation of ber and the contents of the selectable infor-
the current consumption and digital display mation profiles.
Status display
of the average consumption.
● Audio. Digital display of the current audio Possible indications on the instrument
playback. Navigation map in the SEAT Digital
panel display
● Altitude. Digital display of the current alti-
Cockpit
Different pieces of information can be dis-
tude above sea level. played on the screen of the instrument panel,
Depending on the features, the SEAT Digital
● Compass. Digital display of the compass. Cockpit can display a detailed map. To do depending on the features of the vehicle.
● Doors, bonnet and rear lid open »

1) Pre-set information depending on the selected

“Driving mode”.
69
Operation

● Warning and information messages Doors, bonnet and rear lid open The margin of measurement ranges from
● Odometer When the vehicle is unlocked and while driv- -45 °C (-49 °F) to +76 °C (+169 °F).
● Time ››› page 79 ing, the instrument panel display shows if any
of the doors, the bonnet or rear lid are Gear-change recommendation
● Radio, media and navigation system indi-
opened and, in some cases, it is also indica- While driving, the instrument panel of certain
cations
ted by an audible warning. The display may vehicles may indicate a gear recommenda-
● Indications of the phone vary according to the type of instrument pan- tion for saving fuel ››› page 203.
● Outside temperature el fitted.
● Indications of the compass Odometer
Selector lever positions (DSG® dual clutch
● Selector lever positions The odometer registers the total distance
gearbox)
travelled by the car.
● Gear-change recommendation
The current position of the selector lever is
››› page 203 shown on the side of the lever and on the in-
The partial odometer (trip) shows the dis-
● Display of travel data (multifunction dis- tance travelled since the last time it was reset
strument panel display. When the lever is in
play) and menus for different settings to zero.
the D/S position or in the Tiptronic position, in
››› page 71 some cases, the gear engaged in each case Vehicles with analogue instrument panel:
● Service interval display ››› page 82 is shown on the instrument panel display .
● Briefly press the button  ››› Fig. 60 4
● Speed warning ››› page 72 to reset the trip recorder to 0.
Outside temperature indicator
● Speed warning for winter tyres ● Keep the button  4 pressed for
If the outside temperature is lower than ap-
● Start-Stop system status display about 3 seconds and the previous value will
proximately +4 °C (+39 °F), the “ice crystal
››› page 193 be displayed.
symbol”  on the outside temperature dis-
● Signs detected by the traffic signal detec- play also lights up. This symbol remains lit un- Vehicles with digital instrument panel:
tion system ››› page 75 til the outside temperature exceeds +6 °C ● Set the odometer to zero via the Infotain-
● Active cylinder management (ACT®) status (+43 °F) ››› .
ment system or the multifunction steering
indication ››› page 206 When the vehicle is stationary, when the aux- wheel ››› page 72.
● Low consumption driving  iliary heater is switched on or when driving at
● Identifying letters on engine (LDM) very low speeds, the outside temperature in- Speed warning for winter tyres
dicated may be higher than the actual tem- If the maximum speed set is exceeded, this is
● Driver assistance system display
perature due to the heat produced by the en- displayed on the instrument panel
››› page 209 gine.
››› page 71.
● Copyright

70
Instruments and warning/control lamps

The speed warning can be set in the infotain- Copyright ter the other for a few seconds. The sym-
ment system using the infotainment button  Legal text about the property rights and bols will stay on until you remove the
> Settings > Tyres; OR  > Exterior copyrights of the instrument cluster. cause.
settings > tyres ››› page 92. ● If when switching on the ignition warnings
WARNING are shown about existing faults, it might not
Indications of the compass be possible to change the settings or show
Even when the outside temperature is high-
Depending on the equipment, when the igni- the information as described. In this case,
er than freezing temperature, some roads
tion is on, the instrument panel display indi- go to a specialised workshop and request a
and bridges could be frozen.
cates the direction in which you are driving repair.
● The “ice crystal symbol” indicates that
with a symbol, e.g. NW for Northwest. there may be a risk of freezing.
When the Infotainment system is on and there ● At outside temperatures above +4 °C
is no route guidance active, the graphic rep- (+39 °F), there may be ice even when the
Instrument panel menus
resentation of a compass is also shown. “ice crystal symbol” is not on.
The number of menus and information items
● The outside temperature sensor takes a
available will depend on the vehicle’s elec-
Low consumption driving  guideline measurement.
tronics and features.
Depending on the equipment, when the vehi-
cle is moving  is displayed on the instru- A specialised workshop can programme or
Note
ment cluster display when the vehicle is in an modify additional functions, according to the
● There are different instrument panels and vehicle equipment. SEAT recommends visiting
economical consumption status due to active
therefore the versions and instructions on a SEAT dealership for this.
cylinder management (ACT®) ››› page 206.
the display may vary. In the case of dis-
plays without warning or information texts, Some menu options can only be read when
Identifying letters on engine (LDM) faults are indicated exclusively by the con- the vehicle is stationary.
Vehicles with analogue instrument panel: trol warning lamps. ■ Driving data ››› page 72
● Some indications on the instrument panel
● Switch the ignition on, but do not start the ■ Assistance systems
screen may be concealed by a sudden
engine. ■ Front Assist On/Off ››› page 216
event, e.g. an incoming call.
● Hold the button  ››› Fig. 60 4down
● Depending on the equipment, some set-
■ ACC (only display) ››› page 219
for more than 15 seconds to display the iden- ■ Lane Assist On/Off ››› page 224
tings and instructions can be carried out or
tifying letters of the vehicle engine (MKB).
displayed on the infotainment system as ■ Side Assist On/Off ››› page 229
well. ■ Navigation
● If there are several warnings at the same ■ Audio
time, the symbols will be displayed one af- ■ Telephone »
71
Operation

■ Vehicle status ››› page 73 Restart the oil service Change from one display to another
Select the Restore Oil service menu and ● Turn the right thumbwheel of the multifunc-
follow the instructions on the instrument pan- tion steering wheel ››› page 84.
Service Menu el display.
3 Applies to vehicles with Active Info Display Changing memory
(Digital SEAT Cockpit) Restart journey data Vehicles with analogue instrument panel:
Select the Reset trip menu and follow the ● Press the  button on the windscreen
In the Service menu various settings can be
instructions on the instrument panel display wiper lever or the  button of the multifunc-
adjusted depending on the features.
to reset the value. tion steering wheel.
Open the Service menu
Identifying letters on engine (LDM) Vehicles with digital instrument panel:
To open up the Service menu, select the ● While in Travel data > General infor-
Select the menu Engine code. The identify-
Range information profile while in the Driv-
ing letters of the engine will be shown on the mation press  on the multi-function steer-
ing data menu, and keep the  key press-
instrument cluster display at the bottom left. ing wheel to switch between the 3 memo-
ed on the multifunction steering wheel for ap-
ries1):
proximately 4 seconds. When it is released,
Setting the clock
the Service menu will be displayed. Now – Since start: The memory is deleted if
you can browse through the menu using the Select the Time menu and set the correct the journey is interrupted for more than 2
keys on the multifunction steering wheel as time by turning the right thumbwheel of the hours.
usual. multifunction steering wheel.
– Since refuelling: Display and stor-
age of the journey data and the con-
Restart the service interval display sumption values collected. When refuel-
Select the Service menu and follow the in- Driving data indicator (multifunc- ling, the memory is deleted.
structions on the screen of the instrument tion display) – Long-term: This memory contains trav-
panel. el data up to a maximum of 19 hours and
The display of the travel data (multifunction
59 minutes or 99 hours and 59 minutes,
display) shows different values about the
or up to a maximum of 1999.9 km or
journey and the consumption.
9999.9 km. When one of these values is

1) This will show all data on the display at the

same time: distance travelled, average con-


sumption, average speed and autonomy.
72
Instruments and warning/control lamps

exceeded (varies depending on the ver- – Average speed: The average speed Display Oil temperature
sion of the instrument panel), the memo- will be shown after driving for approxi- The engine reaches its operating tempera-
ry is deleted. mately 100 metres. ture when, under normal driving conditions,
– Digital speed display: Current the oil temperature is between 80°C (176°F)
Delete journey data presets speed displayed in digital format. and 120°C (248°F). If a great effort is required
● Select the memory that you wish to erase. – Eco tips: Recommendations messag- from the engine and the outside temperature
● Hold the  button of the multifunction es are shown to reduce consumption is high, the engine oil temperature may in-
steering wheel or the  button of the multi- through good driving practices, e.g. Air crease. This does not present any problem as
function wheel pressed down for about 2 conditioning on: close the win- long as the warning lamps  or 
seconds. dow. ››› page 280 do not appear on the display.

Select the instructions Setting a speed warning


● Select the display Warning at --- km/h Warning and information messages
In the Infotainment system, in the menu Vehi-
cle settings, you can display different travel or Speed warning at --- mph. (Vehicle status)
data ››› page 88. ● Press the button  on the windscreen
The system runs a check on certain compo-
wiper lever or the button  on the multifunc-
– Current consumption: The current nents and functions when the ignition is
tion steering wheel to store the current speed
fuel consumption display operates switched on and while the vehicle is moving.
and activate the warning.
throughout the journey, in litres/100 km; Faults displayed on the instrument panel as
and with the engine running and the ve- ● Activate: adjust to the desired speed within red and yellow warning symbols accompa-
hicle stopped, in litres/hour. 5 seconds using the rocker switch  on the nied with messages and, depending on the
windscreen wiper lever or by turning the case, even an audible warning ››› page 86.
– Average consumption: The average
thumbwheel on the multifunction steering The representation of the messages and
fuel consumption is displayed after driv-
wheel. Next, press the button  or  symbols may vary depending on the version
ing for approximately 300 metres.
again or wait several seconds. The speed is of the instrument panel.
– Travelling time: This indicates the stored and the warning activated.
hours (h) and minutes (min) since the ig- Existing faults can also be checked manually.
● Deactivate: press button  or button
nition was switched on. To do so, open the menu Vehicle status or
 . The stored speed is deleted. Vehicle ››› page 71.
– Range: Approximate distance in km that
can still be travelled if the same driving The warning can be adjusted for speeds be-
tween 30 km/h (18 mph) and 250 km/h Priority 1 warning (red)
style is maintained.
(155 mph). The symbol lights up or flashes (in part ac-
– Distance: Distance covered in km (m)
after switching on the ignition. companied by audible warnings).  Stop »
73
Operation

driving! Danger! Check the fault and elimi- The Fatigue detection informs the driver when Switching on and off
nate the cause. If necessary, seek professio- their driving behaviour shows signs of fatigue. Fatigue detection can be activated or deacti-
nal assistance. vated in the infotainment system using the
Function and operation function button  > Driver assistance > Fa-
Priority 2 warning (yellow) Fatigue detection determines the driving be- tigue detector ››› page 92. A mark indi-
The symbol lights up or flashes (in part ac- haviour of the driver when starting a journey, cates that the adjustment has been activa-
companied by audible warnings). Operating making a calculation of tiredness. This is con- ted.
faults or the lack of operating fluids can stantly compared with the current driving be-
cause damage to the vehicle or a fault. haviour. If the system detects that the driver is System limitations
Check the faulty function as soon as possible. tired, an audible warning is given with a The Fatigue detection has certain limitations
If necessary, seek professional assistance. sound and an optic warning is shown with a inherent to the system. The following condi-
symbol and complementary message on the tions can limit the Fatigue detection or pre-
Information message instrument panel display ››› Fig. 62. The mes- vent it from functioning.
sage on the instrument panel display is
It provides information about processes in the
shown for approximately 5 seconds, and de- ● At speeds below 65 km/h (40 mph)
vehicle.
pending on the case, is repeated. The system ● At speeds above 200 km/h (125 mph)
stores the last message displayed.
● When cornering
Driver alert system (break recom- The message on the instrument panel display
● On roads in poor condition
can be switched off by pressing the 
mendation) ● In unfavourable weather conditions
button on the windscreen wiper lever or the
button  on the multi function steering wheel ● When a sporty driving style is employed
››› page 84. ● In the event of a serious distraction to the
The message can be recalled to the instru- driver
ment panel display using the multifunction
Fatigue detection will be restored when the
display ››› page 72.
vehicle is stopped for more than 15 minutes,
when the ignition is switched off or when the
Conditions of operation
driver has unbuckled their seat belt and
Driving behaviour is only calculated on opened the door.
speeds above about 65 km/h (40 mph) up to
around 200 km/h (125 mph). In the event of slow driving during a long peri-
Fig. 62 On the instrument panel display: driver od of time (below 65 km/h, 40 mph) the sys-
alert system symbol. tem automatically re-establishes the tired-
ness calculation. When driving at a faster
74
Instruments and warning/control lamps

speed the driving behaviour will be recalcula- ● If there is a fault in the system, have it The traffic sign detection system records the
ted. checked by a specialised workshop. standard traffic signs in front of the vehicle
with a camera located on the base of the in-
WARNING terior mirror and provides information about
Do not let the comfort afforded by the Fati- speed limits and overtaking prohibitions.
Road signs detection system1)
gue detection system tempt you into taking Within its limitations, the system also displays
any risks when driving. Take regular breaks, additional signals, such as time-specific pro-
sufficient in length when making long jour- hibitions, signs for vehicles towing trailers
neys.
››› page 256 or limitations that only apply in
● The driver always assumes the responsi- the event of rain. Even on journeys without
bility of driving to their full capacity. signs, the system may display any applicable
● Never drive if you are tired. speed limits.
● The system does not detect the tiredness The traffic sign detection system does not
of the driver in all circumstances. Consult work in all countries. Keep this in mind when
the information in the section ››› page 74, travelling abroad.
System limitations.
● In some situations, the system may incor- Shown on the display
rectly interpret an intended driving ma-
In Germany, on motorways and vehicle
noeuvre as driver tiredness.
roads, besides speed limits and overtaking
● No warning is given in the event of the ef-
provisions the system also displays the end of
fect called microsleep!
prohibition signs. The valid speed limit at the
● Please observe the indications on the in- time in other countries is always shown.
strument panel and act as is necessary.
The traffic signs detected by the system are
displayed on the dash panel display
Note ››› Fig. 63 and, depending on the navigation
● Fatigue detection has been developed Fig. 63 On the instrument panel display: ex- system fitted in the vehicle, on the infotain-
for driving on motorways and well paved amples of speed limits or overtaking prohibi- ment system as well ››› page 88. »
roads only. tions with their respective additional signs.

1) System available depending on the country.


75
Operation

Road sign detection system messages: Activate and deactivate the road sign dis- hibited, the latter sign will be displayed
There are no traffic signs available play on the instrument panel in second place ››› Fig. 63 C.

● The system is in its start-up phase. The permanent traffic sign view on the instru-
ment cluster can be switched on or off in the Speed warning
● OR: the camera has not recognized any
infotainment system using the function button If the system detects that the permitted
mandatory or prohibitive sign.  > Driver assistance. speed is exceeded, it may warn the driver
with a “gong” and visually with a message on
Error: Dynamic Road Sign Display
Display of traffic signs the dash panel display.
● There is a fault in the system. Have the sys-
tem checked by a specialised workshop. When the traffic sign detection system is con- The speed warning can be set or completely
nected, a camera located on the base of the switched off in the infotainment system using
Speed warning currently unavailable interior rear-view mirror records the traffic the function button  > Driver assis-
● The speed warning function of the road signs in front of the vehicle. After checking tance ››› page 88. The warning can be set
sign detection system is faulty. Have the sys- and evaluating the information from the cam- to 0 km/h (0 mph), 5 km/h (3 mph) or 10 km/h
tem checked by a specialised workshop. era, the navigation system and the current (5 mph) above the maximum permitted
vehicle data, up to three valid road signs are speed.
Dynamic Road Sign Display: please displayed, ››› Fig. 63  with their additional
clean the windscreen. signs. Trailer mode
● The windscreen is dirty in the camera area.
First: The sign that is currently valid for the In vehicles equipped with a towing bracket
Clean the windscreen. device from the factory and a trailer that is
driver is shown in the left side of the
screen For example, a maximum speed electrically connected to the vehicle, it is
Dynamic Road Sign Display currently
limit of 130 km/h (100 mph) ››› Fig. 63 A. possible to activate or deactivate the display
restricted.
of specific traffic signs for vehicles with trailer,
● The navigation system is not transmitting Second: A sign valid only in certain circum-
such as speed limits or overtaking prohibi-
data. Check if the navigation system has up- stances, e.g. 100 km/h (60 mph) is shown
tions. It can be activated or deactivated in the
dated maps. second, together with the additional rain
infotainment system using the function button
sign.
● OR: the vehicle is in a region not included  > Driver assistance > Trailer as-
on the navigation system's map. Additional sign: The supplementary panel sist ››› page 88.
will display the circumstances (rain,
No data available times of day, fog, etc.) under which the For trailer mode, the display of speed limits
displayed speed limit is in force. applicable to the type of trailer or to the legal
● The traffic sign detection system does not
provisions can be adjusted. The speed is ad-
work in the current country. Third: Thirdly, a sign prohibiting overtaking is
justed in steps of 10 km/h (5 mph) within a
partially displayed. If there is no condi-
range of between 60 km/h (40 mph) and
tional speed limit and overtaking is pro-
76
Instruments and warning/control lamps

130 km/h (80 mph). If it is adjusted to a speed ● In the case of variable messages on over-
tion system may differ from the actual cur-
greater than that which is permitted in the head or gantry signs (LED-based variable rent traffic situation.
country in question for driving with a trailer, traffic signs or other lighting units).
● The system may not detect or correctly
the system automatically displays the usual ● If the maps on the navigation system are show all the traffic signs.
speed limits, e.g. in Germany 80 km/h not up-to-date. ● Traffic signs and traffic regulations have
(50 mph).
● In the case of adhesives affixed to vehicles priority over the recommendations and dis-
If the speed warning for the trailer is deacti- that depict traffic signs, e.g. speed limits on plays provided by the system.
vated, the system displays the speed limits as lorries.
if there were no trailer hitched.
WARNING
WARNING
Limited operation If messages are ignored, the vehicle may
The technology in the traffic sign detection stall in traffic and cause accidents and se-
The traffic sign detection system has certain system cannot change the limits imposed vere injuries.
limitations. The following cases may lead the by the laws of physics and only works with-
● Never ignore the messages displayed.
system to operate with limitations or not at in the system's limits. Do not let the extra
convenience afforded by the traffic sign ● Stop the vehicle at the next opportunity
all:
detection system tempt you into taking any and in a safe place.
● In the case of poor visibility, e.g. in snow, risks when driving. The system is not a re-
rain, fog or intense mist. placement for driver awareness.
Note
● In cases of dazzling, e.g. caused by head- ● Adapt your speed and driving style to suit
To avoid affecting the correct operation of
on traffic or by the sun. visibility, weather, road and traffic condi-
the system, take the following points into
tions.
● When driving at high speeds. consideration:
● Poor visibility, darkness, snow, rain and
● If the camera is covered or dirty. ● Regularly clean the area of vision of the
fog may lead to the system failing to dis-
● If the traffic signs are out of the camera's camera and keep it in a clean state, without
play traffic signs or not displaying them
snow or ice.
field of vision. correctly.
● Do not cover the field of vision of the
● If the traffic signs are partially or totally ● If the camera's field of vision is dirty, cov-
camera.
covered, e.g. by trees, snow, dirt or other vehi- ered or damaged, system operation may
be impaired. ● Always replace damaged or worn blades
cles.
when required to avoid lines on the cam-
● In the case of traffic signs that do not fulfil era's field of vision.
the regulations. WARNING
● Check that the windscreen is not dam-
● In the case of damaged or bent traffic The driving recommendations and traffic aged in the area of the camera's field of vi-
signs. indications shown on the traffic sign detec- sion. »
77
Operation

● The use of outdated maps on the naviga- When you approach places such as a junc- Eco-efficient driving assistance is available
tion system may cause the system to show tion, a roundabout or a section of road with a depending on the equipment, although not in
traffic signs incorrectly. speed limit, the symbol  is displayed along all countries.
● In the waypoints mode of the navigation
with an event in the digital cockpit ››› Fig. 64.
system, the traffic sign detection system is
WARNING
As soon as you follow the indication and take
only partly available. your foot off the accelerator, the vehicle The system is not a replacement for driver
● Failure to heed the control lamps and adapts, based on the selected driving profile awareness.
corresponding text messages when they and distance to the incident, brake energy re- ● Adapt your speed and driving style at all
light up may result in damage to the vehi- cuperation and speed. times to suit visibility, weather, road and
cle. traffic conditions.
Eco-efficient driving assistance uses the trip
● Traffic signs on the road and traffic regu-
data from the infotainment system and the
sensors of some assist systems. If no destina- lations have priority over eco-driving notes.
Eco-efficient driving assistance tion guidance is active, the most likely route is
used. Note
Pressing the accelerator can cancel the in- ● The appearance of the symbols may vary
tervention of the assistance at any time. slightly depending on the equipment and
model. System updates may modify or ex-
Eco-efficient driving assistance can be pand the symbols.
switched on and off in the infotainment sys-
● When the system is switched on, eco-ef-
tem, in the assist system settings
ficient driving assistance can also increase
››› page 92. recuperation without any indication being
Eco-efficient driving assistance is temporarily displayed. This can occur in situations such
switched off if: as when the accelerator pedal is released
when a vehicle is driving in front. In this
Fig. 64 Eco-efficient driving assistance indi- ● The gear selector is in the S position. case, energy recuperation is adapted
cation (schematic representation). ● The sport driving program is used. match the speed of the vehicle in front
without any indication being displayed.
Eco-efficient driving assistance helps you ● Driving with adaptive cruise control (ACC)
drive with care and with low energy con- or cruise control (GRA).
sumption by following instructions superim-
When these conditions no longer exist, the
posed in the digital cockpit, depending on the
assistance is reactivated if it is switched on in
situation.
the assist system settings.

78
Instruments and warning/control lamps

Time Revolution counter For the sake of the environment


Changing up a gear early will help you to
Setting the time on the infotainment sys- The rev counter indicates the number of en-
save fuel and minimise emissions and en-
tem gine revolutions per minute.
gine noise.
● Press  >  Settings. Together with the gear-change indicator, the
● Select the menu option Time and date to rev counter offers you the possibility of using
set the time ››› page 88. the engine of your vehicle at a suitable
Fuel gauge
speed.
Setting the time on analogue the instru-
The beginning of the red zone of the rev
ment panel
counter indicates the maximum speed in any
● To set the time (for all vehicle clocks), press
gear after running-in and with the engine hot.
and hold the button  on the instrument However, it is advisable to change up a gear
panel until the Time is displayed. or move the selector lever to D (or lift your
● Release the button  . The time is dis- foot off the accelerator) before the needle
played on the instrument panel display and reaches the red zone ››› .
the hours field is highlighted.
We recommend that you avoid high revs and
● Afterwards, press the button  until the that you follow the recommendations on the
desired time is displayed. To scroll quickly, gear-change indicator. Consult the addition-
hold the button  . al information in ››› page 203, Selecting the Fig. 65 Analogue instrument panel: fuel
gauge
● When they have finished setting the hour, optimal gear.
wait until the minute field is marked on the in-
strument panel display. CAUTION
● Afterwards, press the button  until the ● To prevent damage to the engine, the rev
desired time is displayed. To scroll quickly, counter needle should only remain in the
hold the button  . red zone for a short period of time.
● Release the button  in order to finish ● When the engine is cold, avoid high revs

setting the time. and heavy acceleration and do not make


the engine work hard.

Fig. 66 Digital instrument panel: fuel gauge. »


79
Operation

Control lamps WARNING CAUTION


It lights up, and in addition, the When driving with low fuel, the vehicle may Never run the fuel tank completely dry. An
 lower diode lights up in red stall in traffic and cause accidents and se- irregular fuel supply can cause misfiring
vere injuries. and unburnt fuel could enter the exhaust
Fuel tank almost empty. The fuel reserve level has system. The catalytic converter or the par-
● If the fuel tank level is too low, fuel could
been reached ››› . Refuel as soon as you have the ticulate filter may get damaged!
opportunity. reach the engine irregularly, particularly
When the fuel level is very low, the lower diode flash- when driving up or down slopes.
es red. ● The steering system and the driver assis- Note
tance systems and brakes do not work The small arrow on the fuel gauge next to
The display only works when the ignition is when the engine is running irregularly or the fuel pump symbol points out towards
switched on. switches off due to lack of fuel or an irregu- the side of the vehicle with the fuel tank
lar supply thereof. flap.
The fuel range is displayed on the instrument
panel. ● SEAT recommends always refuelling
when the tank is approximately one quarter
You can consult the tank capacity of your ve- full, to prevent the vehicle from stopping
hicle in the ››› page 316 section. due to a lack of fuel.

80
Instruments and warning/control lamps

Natural gas level (CNG)


3 Valid in vehicles equipped with natural gas engine (CNG)

Fig. 67 Analogue instrument panel: natural gas


gauge

A Natural gas gauge The display only works when the ignition is the refuelled amount with a slight delay
B Petrol gauge switched on. (depending on the refuelled amount).

Control lamp Things to note


If the vehicle is left parked for a long time im-
 It lights up green ››› Fig. 67 1
mediately after refuelling, the natural gas lev-
The vehicle is running on natural gas. el indicator may not accurately indicate the
The lamp goes off when the natural gas runs out. The same level shown after refuelling when the
engine changes to operate with petrol. vehicle is started up again. This is not due to a
leak in the system, but to a drop in pressure in
It lights up, and in addition, the the gas tank for technical reasons after a
 lower diode lights up in red cooling phase just after refuelling.

The fuel reserve level has been reached. Note


When the fuel level is very low, the lower diode flash-
es red. In vehicles with natural gas engines, the
petrol tank fuel level gauge may display

81
Operation

Engine coolant temperature indica- B Normal zone. At high outside tempera- CAUTION
tures and when making the engine work
tor. ● To ensure a long useful life for the engine,
hard, the diodes may continue lighting up
avoid high revs, driving at high speed and
and reach the upper zone. This is no
making the engine work hard for approxi-
cause for concern, provided the control
mately the first 15 minutes when the engine
lamp does not light up 
is cold. The phase until the engine is warm
C Warning area. When the engine is work- also depends on the outside temperature. If
ing hard, especially at high outside tem- necessary, use the engine oil temperature
peratures, the diodes may light up in the as a guide ››› page 72››› page 73.
warning area. ● Additional lights and other accessories in
front of the air inlet reduce the cooling ef-
The coolant temperature gauge only works fect of the coolant. At high outside temper-
when the ignition is switched on. atures and high engine loads, there is a risk
of the engine overheating.
Fig. 68 Analogue instrument panel: engine
Control and warning lamp
coolant temperature indicator. ● The front spoiler also ensures proper dis-
tribution of the cooling air when the vehicle
 It lights up red is moving. If the spoiler is damaged this can
reduce the cooling effect, which could
 Do not carry on driving!
Engine coolant level too low, coolant temperature too cause the engine to overheat. Seek spe-
high. cialist assistance.

 Flashes red
Service intervals
Fault in the engine coolant system.
The service interval indication appears on the
● Stop the vehicle, switch off the engine and
instrument panel display and the Infotain-
let it cool down.
Fig. 69 Digital instrument panel: engine cool- ment system.
ant temperature indicator. ● Check the engine coolant level
There are different versions of instrument
››› page 282.
panels and infotainment systems, so the ver-
A Cool zone. The engine has not reached ● If the warning lamp does not switch off even
sions and instructions on the screens may
operating temperature yet. Avoid high if the coolant level is correct, request assis- vary.
speeds and stressing the engine if it has tance from specialised personnel.
not reached operating temperature. SEAT distinguishes between services with en-
gine oil change (e.g. Oil change service) and
82
Instruments and warning/control lamps

services without engine oil change (e.g. In- Service due Check the date of the current service on the
spection). When the time for a service or an inspec- infotainment system
tion comes, an audible warning will be emit- ● Press the function button  > Settings >
In vehicles with Services established by
time or mileage, the service intervals are al- ted when the ignition is switched on and the Service; OR  > Vehicle status
ready pre-defined. fixed key symbol  may appear on the in- ››› page 88.
strument panel for a few seconds, along with ● Select the Service menu option to display
In vehicles with LongLife Service, the inter-
one of the following messages: information about the services.
vals are determined individually. Thanks to
technological progress, maintenance work ● Service now! Vehicles with analogue instrument panel
has been greatly reduced. Because of the ● Please have your vehicle inspec- ● Press and hold the button 
technology used by SEAT, with this service
you only need to change the oil when the ve-
ted. ››› Fig. 60 4 for more than 5 seconds to con-
● Oil change service due! sult the service message
hicle so requires. To calculate this variation
(max. 2 years), the vehicle's conditions of use ● Oil change service and inspection
Vehicles with digital instrument panel
and individual driving styles are considered. due!
● The date of the service can only be read
The advance warning first appears 20 days
through the Service menu ››› page 72.
before the date established for the corre- Inspection of compressed natural gas
sponding service. The kilometres (miles) re- tanks (CNG) reminder
Resetting service interval display
maining until the next service are always
When less than 90 days for the review of the
rounded up to the nearest 100 km (miles) and If the service was not carried out by a SEAT
compressed natural gas tanks (CNG), when
the time is given in complete days. The cur- dealership, the display can be reset as fol-
the ignition is switched on, the instrument
rent service message cannot be viewed until lows:
panel display will a reminder for review of
500 km after the last service. Prior to this, on-
the gas tanks and an audible warning will be Vehicles with analogue instrument panel
ly lines are visible on the display.
emitted.
● Switch off the ignition, press and hold but-
Inspection reminder As approaches the service date of inspection ton  ››› Fig. 60 4 .
of the gas tanks, the message and the audi- ● Switch ignition back on.
If a service or an inspection has to be carried
ble warning will stop modify accordingly.
out soon, a service reminder will be dis- ● Release the  button and press it
played when the ignition is switched on. again for the next 20 seconds.
Consult a service notification
The figure displayed are the kilometres that
With the ignition switched on, the engine off Vehicles with digital instrument panel
can still be travelled or the time until the next
and the vehicle at a standstill, the current ● The service interval display can only be re-
service.
service notification can be read: set through the Service menu ››› page 72. »
83
Operation

Do not restart the indicator between the


Using the instrument panel Operation using the multifunction
service intervals, otherwise the information
steering wheel
displayed will be incorrect.
Introduction
If the oil change service is reset manually, the
service interval display changes to a fixed With the ignition switched on, it is possible to
service interval, also in vehicles with Flexible read the different functions of the display by
oil change service. scrolling through the menus.
In vehicles with multifunction steering wheel,
Note
the multifunction display can only be operat-
● The service message disappears after a ed with the steering wheel buttons.
few seconds, when the engine is started or
when  button is pressed on the wiper Some menu options can only be read when
lever, or the  button on the multifunction the vehicle is at a standstill.
steering wheel. Fig. 70 Right side of the multifunction steering
● In vehicles with the LongLife system in WARNING wheel: buttons to the menus and information
which the battery has been disconnected displays on the instrument panel.
Distracting the driver in any way can lead
for a long period of time, it is not possible to to an accident and cause injuries.
calculate the date of the next service. As long as a priority 1 ››› page 73 warning is
● Never use the menus on the instrument
Therefore the service interval display may active, it will not be possible to access any
panel display while the vehicle is in motion. menu. Some warnings can be confirmed and
not be correct. In this case, bear in mind the
maximum service intervals permitted hidden with the button  of the multifunction
››› page 298. Note steering wheel ››› Fig. 70.
● If you reset the display manually, the next After loading or changing the 12-volt bat-
service interval will be indicated as in vehi- tery, check the system settings. If the pow- Select a menu or an informative display
cles with fixed service intervals. For this er supply is interrupted, the system settings ● Switch the ignition on.
reason we recommend that the service in- might be incorrect or deleted.
● If a message or vehicle symbol is displayed,
terval display be reset by a SEAT author-
ised Dealer.
press the button  ››› Fig. 70; if necessary,
several times.
● If the period of 48 months for an inspec-
tion at a specialised workshop of com- ● Use the  or  ››› Fig. 70 to switch be-
pressed natural gas tanks (CNG) is excee- tween menus.
ded, the vehicle may not working in this ● To open the menu or the information dis-
mode. played, press the button  ››› Fig. 70 or wait

84
Instruments and warning/control lamps

a few seconds until the menu or the informa-


tive display opens automatically.

Changing menu settings


● In the menu displayed, turn the right thumb-
wheel of the multifunction steering wheel
››› Fig. 70 until the desired option of the menu
is highlighted. The option appears framed.
● Press the button  ››› Fig. 70 to make the
required modifications. A mark indicates that
the system or function is activated.

Back to menu selection


Press the  or  ››› Fig. 70 button.

85
Operation

Control lamps  Driver or passenger has not fastened seat  Fault in the steering system ››› page 204.
belt ››› page 16.
Tyre pressure monitor system
Control and warning lamps  Engine cooling fluid ››› page 82.  ››› page 295.
The control and warning lamps are indicators  Engine oil pressure ››› page 280.  Fuel tank almost empty ››› page 79.
of warnings ››› , faults or certain functions.
 Alternator abnormality ››› page 287. Fault in airbag system and seat belt ten-
Some control and warning lamps come on  sioners ››› page 24.
when the ignition is switched on, and switch  Press the foot brake ››› page 219.
off when the engine starts running, or while Front passenger front airbag disabled
driving.
Yellow warning lamps
  ››› page 24.
Depending on the model, additional text Front passenger airbag switched on
Notification central lamp: additional infor-
messages may be viewed on the instrument  mation on the instrument panel display
  ››› page 24.
panel display. These may be purely informa-
tive or they may be advising of the need for Fault in ESC or disconnection caused by Defective active cruise control (ACC)
 ››› page 224
action ››› page 66, Instrument panel.  the system; OR ESC or ASR in operation
››› page 237.
Depending upon the equipment fitted in the  Lane Assist (lane keeping system)
vehicle, instead of a warning lamp, some- Fault in ASR or disconnection caused by ››› page 225.
times a symbol may be displayed on the in-  the system; OR ASR in operation 
strument panel. ››› page 237.
 Error in the lane assist warning system
When certain control and warning lamps are ASR manually deactivated; OR ESC in
 Sport mode ››› page 237. ››› page 225.
lit, an audible warning is also heard. 
 Fault in the ABS ››› page 237.
Red warning lamps  Travel Assist error ››› page 229.

 Rear fog light switched on ››› page 111. Fault in the lighting of the vehicle
Notification central lamp: additional infor- 
 mation on the instrument panel display Fault in the emission control system ››› page 111.
 ››› page 275.
 Parking brake on ››› page 234.  Low engine oil level ››› page 280.
Fault in the petrol engine management
 Fault in the brake system ››› page 234.   Fault in the gearbox ››› page 202.
››› page 275.
 Fault in the steering system ››› page 204.
 Particulate filter blocked ››› page 275.

86
Instruments and warning/control lamps

Green indicator lamps Risk of freezing ››› page 70.



Turn lights or emergency lights on Start-Stop system activated ››› page 193.
 ››› page 111. 
Start-Stop system unavailable
 Trailer turn signals ››› page 111.  ››› page 193.
 Press the foot brake ››› page 197. Low consumption driving status
 ››› page 71.
Cruise control (GRA) ››› page 213; OR
 speed limited ››› page 214; OR Adaptive
cruise control (ACC) ››› page 220. WARNING
Adaptive cruise control (ACC) If the warning lamps and messages are ig-
 ››› page 220. nored, faults may occur in the vehicle, it
may stall in traffic, or accidents and seri-
 Lane assist active (Lane Assist) warning ous injuries may occur.
››› page 225. ● Never ignore the warning lamps or text
 messages.
 Travel Assist active ››› page 228. ● Stop the vehicle safely as soon as possi-
ble.
 Natural gas operating mode ››› page 81.
● A faulty vehicle represents a risk of acci-
dent for the driver and for other road users.
Blue indicator lamps
If necessary, switch on the hazard warning
Main beam on or flasher on ››› page 111. lamps and put out the warning triangle to
 advise other drivers.
● Before opening the bonnet, switch off the
Other warning lamps
engine and allow it to cool.
Door(s), rear lid or bonnet open or not ● In any vehicle, the engine compartment is
 properly closed ››› page 70. a hazardous area and could cause severe
injuries ››› page 276.
 Service interval display ››› page 82.

Mobile phone connected through Blue-


 tooth® .

 Mobile phone charge level .

87
Operation

Infotainment system How to move through the different menus ple, long lists of settings. Press on the scroll
and select them bar and pull up or down.
● Switch the ignition on.
Introduction Tutorial
● If the Infotainment system is off, switch it on.
The infotainment system brings together im- The first time you connect the Infotainment
● The different menus are selected directly
portant vehicle functions and systems into a system, a system tutorial will open with a brief
on the touch screen using texts, icons or but-
single central control unit, e.g. air condition- description of the main functions and how to
tons.
ing, menu settings, radio equipment and the use it.
navigation system. If the box is checked , the function is activa-
ted. Help
The actual number of menus available and
the name of the various options will depend Pressing the menu button  will always take In the Help menu you will find more informa-
on the vehicle’s electronics and equipment. you to the last menu used. tion and tips for using the Infotainment sys-
tem.
Any changes made using the settings menus
General operating information
are automatically saved on closing those WARNING
General information on the operation of the menus.
infotainment system, as well as on the warn- Any distraction may lead to an accident,
ing and safety instructions that must be taken Scroll bar: Some menus and functions show with the risk of injury. Operating the Info-
into account, is found in ››› page 143. more content above or below those dis- tainment system while driving could dis-
played on the screen at that time, for exam- tract you from traffic.

88
Instruments and warning/control lamps

Explanation of the function buttons

Fig. 71 Schematic representation: Overview of the


possible function buttons on the screen

Top part of the screen D Telephone information. Information re- : main menu with the 6 main functions
A Current time garding your mobile device is displayed: divided into 2 screens (3 + 3, customisa-
available network signal strength, estab- ble by the user by pressing on the func-
B Driving profile and navigation informa- lished Bluetooth connection, unanswered tion).
tion. If the user has an active route, both calls, new messages, battery status, etc.
the time and the distance to the destina- : main menu in mosaic mode (all func-
tion are displayed. If there is no active
E System customisation based on user tions of the Infotainment system)
route, the driving profile is displayed. On and notifications. Some settings can be G Direct accesses to the functions of the In-
vehicles with no available driving profile, saved in the user accounts of the person- fotainment system (up to 10 functions, 5 +
the current address is displayed whenev- alization function and can therefore be 5, customisable by the user). By pressing
er there is no active route. changed automatically when switching on the icon, you can select/deselect the
user accounts. functions in question.
C Information about the air condition-
ing1). The current outside temperature is
Bottom part of the screen1)
displayed.
F Main menu display mode:

1) Valid for the Connect System.


89
Operation

Initial configuration wizard

Fig. 72 Schematic representation: Initial configu-


ration wizard

The initial configuration wizard will help you Function button: Function Function button: Function
to set up your Infotainment system the first
time you switch it on. A Press to set day and time. Press to select your home address
E using your current position or by
Every time you switch on the Infotainment Press to search and store to memory manually entering an address.
system, the initial setup screen will be dis- B the radio stations that have the best
played ››› Fig. 72 if any parameters have not reception at that moment. Disables the possibility of changing
the settings of the Infotainment sys-
been set (marked with “”) or if the Don't Press to go to the Online Media set-
C Don't show tem. If you want to run the initial con-
show again function button has not been tings. again figuration, it can be accessed
pressed. through  Settings > Initial con-
Press to link your mobile phone to figuration wizard.
D
the Infotainment system.
Function button: Function
Start Starts up the Configuration Wizard.
 Closes the Configuration Wizard. Once one or more settings have
End been applied, press to finalise the
setup in the main menu of the wizard.

90
Instruments and warning/control lamps

Vehicle information

Fig. 73 Schematic representation: Vehicle infor-


mation and status

Pressing on  > Selection and then on 


Vehicle info opens the Vehicle information
menu with the following submenus:

– Driving data. The average consump-


tion, average speed, distance travelled,
trip duration and autonomy are shown. It
has 3 memories: “Since start”, “Long-
term” and “Since refuel” ››› page 72.
– Vehicle status. The warnings regarding
faults, incidents, memorisation of the
tyre pressure or information of the next
inspection service are displayed.

91
Operation

Assist systems and vehicle settings

Fig. 74 Schematic representation: Assist systems


and vehicle settings

The number of assist systems and settings ■ Traffic sign recognition ››› page 75.
depend on the version and the country in ■ Lane assist ››› page 229.
question.
■ Driver assistance
■ Park assist ››› page 240.
■ Activate / deactivate ESC, stabilisation
systems and brake assist ››› page 237.
■ Activate / deactivate the Start-Stop sys-
tem ››› page 193.
■ Adaptive cruise control (ACC)
››› page 219.
■ Lane Assist (lane keeping system)
››› page 224.
■ Emergency brake assistance system
(Front Assist) ››› page 216.
■ Fatigue detection ››› page 74.
92
Instruments and warning/control lamps

Buttons available depending on the version


Multifunction steering wheel Symbol Function
Symbol Function
: Activate ACC / Cruise control sys-
Functions Turn: Turn volume up/down tem / Limiter
1
Press: Mute volume
  : Reset programmed ACC speed or
cruise control system
Turn: Search in the instrument panel
menu. In Navigation mode, turn to in- : Increase programmed speed
crease/decrease map size in SEAT
 : Decrease programmed speed
2
Digital Cockpit
Open the drive assist menu in the in-
Press: Select the highlighted option in  strument panel
the instrument panel
Modify the programmed ACC dis-
Radio: Search for the previous/next  tance
station.
 Media: Short press: previous/next Switching Travel Assist on and off
track; long press: fast forward/rewind  ››› page 226
Fig. 75 Controls on the steering wheel.
Activate phone menu (answer call,
 end call)

Switch between media and radio


 sources

Change the instrument panel menu


 (previous/next)

 Enable/disable voice control

Analogue Panel: No function


Digital Panel (SEAT Digital Cockpit):
 Change digital panel views
Fig. 76 Controls on the steering wheel.
››› page 68
Connect/disconnect the Cruise con-
The steering wheel includes multifunction trol system ››› page 212 / ACC
modules from where it is possible to control  ››› page 219 / Speed limiter
the audio, telephone, navigation, voice con- ››› page 214
trol and assist functions without the driver
needing to be distracted from the road.
93
Operation

Opening and closing 1 Unlock the vehicle Control lamp on the vehicle key
2 Lock the vehicle When a button on the vehicle key is pressed,
Unlock only the rear lid. Press the button the control lamp flashes ››› Fig. 77 (arrow)
Set of vehicle keys 3
until all the turn signals on the vehicle once briefly, but if the button is held down for
flash briefly. You have 2 minutes to open a longer period the control lamp flashes sev-
Vehicle key the rear lid. Once this time has passed, it eral times, such as in convenience opening.
will lock again. In addition, the lamp on If the vehicle key control lamp does not light
the key flashes. up when the button is pressed, replace the
4 Folding the key shaft in and out key's battery ››› page 95.
5 Alarm button. Only press in the event of
an emergency! When the alarm button is Spare key
pressed, the vehicle's sounds and the turn To obtain a spare key and other vehicle keys,
signals light up for a short time. Press the vehicle ID number is required.
again to disconnect.
Each new key contains a microchip which
With the vehicle key the vehicle may be must be coded with the data from the vehicle
locked or unlocked remotely ››› page 96. electronic immobiliser. A vehicle key will not
Fig. 77 Assignment of buttons on the remote work if it does not contain a microchip or the
control key. The vehicle key includes an emitter and bat- microchip has not been encoded. This is also
tery. The receiver is in the interior of the vehi- true for keys which are specially cut for the
cle. The range of the vehicle key with remote vehicle.
control and new battery is several metres
around the vehicle. The vehicle keys or new spare keys can be
obtained from a SEAT Official Service, a spe-
If it is not possible to open or close the vehicle cialised workshop or an approved key service
using the remote control key, this should be qualified to create this kind of key.
re-synchronised ››› page 96 or the battery
changed ››› page 95. New keys or spare keys must be synchronised
before use ››› page 96.
Different keys belonging to the vehicle may
be used. WARNING
Fig. 78 Vehicle key with alarm button. ● Never leave children or disabled persons
in the vehicle. In case of emergency, they
Key to the ››› Fig. 77, ››› Fig. 78

94
Opening and closing

may not be able to leave the vehicle or ● Key operation can be greatly influenced To change the battery
manage on their own. by overlapping radio signals close to the
● An uncontrolled use of the key could start vehicle working in the same range of fre-
the engine or activate any electric equip- quencies, for example, radio transmitters or
ment (e.g. electric windows), causing risk mobile telephones.
of accident. The doors can be locked using ● Obstacles between the remote control
the remote control key. This could become and the vehicle, bad weather conditions
an obstacle for assistance in an emergen- and discharged batteries can considerably
cy situation. reduce the range of the remote control.
● Never forget the keys inside the vehicle. ● If the buttons of the vehicle key are
An unauthorised use of your vehicle could pressed or one of the central locking but-
result in injury, damage or theft. Therefore tons ››› page 99 is pressed repeatedly in
always take the key with you when you short succession, the central locking brief- Fig. 79 Vehicle key: opening the battery com-
leave the vehicle. ly disconnects as protection against over- partment cover.
● Never remove the key from the ignition if loading. The vehicle is then unlocked. Lock
the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, the it if necessary.
steering could suddenly block and it would ● Spare remote control keys are available
be impossible to steer the vehicle. at your Technical Service, where they must
be matched to the locking system.
CAUTION ● Up to five remote control keys can be
used.
All of the vehicle keys contain electronic
components. Protect them from damage,
impacts and humidity.

Note Fig. 80 Vehicle key: removing the battery.


● Only use the key button when you require
the corresponding function. Pushing the SEAT recommends you ask a specialised
button unnecessarily could accidentally workshop to replace the battery.
unlock the vehicle or trigger the alarm. It is
The battery is located to the rear of the vehi-
also possible even when you are outside
the radius of action. cle key, under a cover. »

95
Operation

Changing the battery place the dead battery with another of the Central locking
● Unfold the vehicle key blade ››› page 94. same voltage, size and specifications.
● Remove the cover from the back of the ve- ● When fitting the battery, check that the Introduction
hicle key ››› Fig. 79 in the direction of the ar- polarity is correct.
row ››› . Central locking functions correctly when all
● Extract the battery from the compartment For the sake of the environment the doors and the rear lid are correctly shut. If
the driver door is open, the vehicle cannot be
using a suitable thin object ››› Fig. 80. Please dispose of your used batteries cor-
locked with the key.
● Place the new battery in the compartment rectly and with respect for the environ-
as shown ››› Fig. 80, pressing in the opposite ment. If the vehicle has the Keyless Access locking
direction to that shown by the arrow ››› . and ignition system, it may only be locked
with the ignition off and the driver's door
● Fit the cover as shown ››› Fig. 79, pressing it
closed.
onto the vehicle key casing in the opposite di- Synchronize the vehicle key
rection to that shown by the arrow until it
If the  button is pressed frequently outside WARNING
clicks into place.
of the vehicle range, it is possible that the ve- The incorrect use of the central locking
WARNING hicle can no longer be locked or unlocked us- system may cause serious injuries.
ing the key. In this case, the key must be re- ● The central locking system will lock all
Swallowing a battery with a 20 mm diame-
synchronised as described below: doors. A vehicle locked from the inside can
ter or any other button battery can cause
serious and even fatal injuries within a very prevent any non-authorised individual from
While the vehicle is open: opening the doors and accessing the vehi-
short time.
● Press the  button on the vehicle key. cle. Nevertheless, in case of emergency or
● Keep the vehicle key and key fobs with
● Then close the vehicle using the key shaft accident, locked doors will complicate ac-
batteries out of reach of children. cess to the vehicle interior to help the pas-
within one minute. If necessary, remove the
● If you suspect that someone may have sengers.
cover from the driver door lever ››› page 106.
swallowed a battery, seek immediate med- ● Never leave children or disabled people
ical attention. alone in the vehicle. The central locking
While the vehicle is closed:
● Press the  button on the vehicle key. button can be used to lock all the doors
CAUTION from within. Therefore, passengers will be
● Then close the vehicle using the key shaft locked inside the vehicle. Individuals locked
● If the battery is not changed correctly, within one minute. If necessary, remove the in the vehicle can be exposed to very high
the vehicle key may be damaged. cover from the driver door lever ››› page 106. or very low temperatures.
● Use of unsuitable batteries may damage
● Depending on the time of the year, tem-
the vehicle key. For this reason, always re-
peratures inside a locked and closed
96
Opening and closing

vehicle can be extremely high or extremely Self-locking system to prevent involuntary Turn signals
low resulting in serious injuries and illness unlocking The turn signals will flash twice when the ve-
or even death, particularly for young chil- It is an anti-theft system and prevents the un- hicle is unlocked and once when the vehicle
dren. intentional unlocking of the vehicle. If the ve- is locked.
● Never leave individuals locked in a closed hicle is unlocked and none of the doors (in-
If it does not flash, this indicates that one of
and locked vehicle. In case of emergency, cluding the boot) are opened within 30 sec-
the doors, the rear lid or the bonnet is not
they may not be able to exit the vehicle by onds, it re-locks automatically.
themselves or get help.
closed correctly.

Unlocking one side of the vehicle only


Accidental lock-out
When you lock the vehicle with the key, the
Description The central locking system prevents you from
doors and the rear lid are locked. When you
being locked out of the vehicle in the follow-
open the door, you can either unlock only the
Central locking allows all doors, the rear lid ing situations:
driver door, or all the vehicle doors. To select
and the tank flap to be unlocked centrally: the required option, use the Infotainment sys- ● If the driver door is open, the vehicle cannot
tem setting ››› page 98. be locked with the central locking switch
● From outside, using the vehicle key
››› page 98. ››› page 99.
Automatic locking (Auto Lock)
● From outside with the Keyless Access Lock the vehicle with the remote control key,
››› page 99 system, The Auto Lock function locks the doors and
when all the doors and the rear lid have been
the rear lid when the vehicle exceeds a speed
● From inside, by pushing the central locking closed. This prevents the accidental locking
of about 15 km/h (9 mph). The fuel tank flap is
button ››› page 99. of the vehicle.
unlocked so that you can refuel without get-
Various functions are available to improve the ting out of the vehicle.
Note
vehicle safety: The vehicle is unlocked again when the igni- ● Never leave any valuable items in the ve-
tion key is removed. Alternatively, the vehicle hicle unattended. Even a locked vehicle is
● Security system “Safe” ››› page 102
can also be unlocked via the central locking not a safe.
● Self-locking system to prevent involuntary switch or by pulling one of the inside door
● If the LED on the driver door sill lights up
unlocking handles.
for about 30 seconds when the vehicle is
● Selective unlocking system locked, the central locking system or anti-
In the event of an accident in which the air-
● Automatic speed dependent locking and bags inflate, the doors will be automatically theft alarm is not working properly. You
unlocking system (Auto Lock) unlocked to facilitate access and assistance. should have the fault repaired at a SEAT

● Emergency unlocking system


Official Service or specialised workshop. »

97
Operation

● Vehicle interior monitoring by the anti- Unlock and lock from the outside flap. All other doors and the rear lid remain
theft alarm system will only function as in- locked.
tended if the windows and sunroof are
closed. Unlocking the driver's door and tank flap:
● Press (once) the  button on the remote
control key or turn the key once in the open-
ing direction.
Central locking settings
Unlocking all the doors, the rear lid and the
Central locking settings can be changed in tank flap simultaneously:
the Infotainment system.
● Within 5 seconds, press (twice) the  but-
ton on the remote control key, or turn the key
Unlocking doors
twice within 5 seconds in the opening direc-
Fig. 81 Remote control key: buttons.
● Select: button  > Settings > Opening tion.
and closing > Central locking > Un- ● Lock: press the  ››› Fig. 81 button.
locking the doors. The Safe security system and the anti-theft
● Locking the vehicle without the “Safe” se- alarm deactivate immediately when only the
You can choose to unlock all the doors or curity system: push the  button again and driver door is opened.
only the driver door when you unlock the hold for 2 seconds.
In vehicles with Infotainment system, you can
vehicle. In all the options, the fuel tank flap is ● Unlock: press the  button.
programme the security central locking sys-
also unlocked.
● Unlocking the rear lid: hold down the  tem directly ››› page 98.
With the Driver setting, when you press the button for at least 1 second.
 button on the remote control key once, only WARNING
the driver door is unlocked. If that button is The vehicle will be locked again automatical-
ly if you do not open one of the doors or the Observe the safety warnings ››› in Lock-
pressed twice, the rest of the doors and the
ing system “Safe” on page 103.
rear lid will be unlocked. rear lid within 30 seconds after unlocking the
car. This function prevents the vehicle from
If the  button is pressed, all the vehicle remaining unlocked if the unlocking button is Note
doors are locked. At the same time, a confir- pressed by mistake. This does not apply if you ● Do not use the remote control key until
mation signal is heard. press the  button for at least one second. the vehicle is visible.
● Other functions of the remote control key
Selective unlocking system
››› page 109, Convenience open/close
The selective unlocking system allows you to function.
only unlock the driver door and the fuel tank
98
Opening and closing

Unlocking and locking from the in- be automatically unlocked to facilitate ac- Unlock and lock the vehicle with
cess and assistance.
side Keyless Access
WARNING
● The central locking switch also works
with the ignition switched off, except when
the “safe” system is activated.
● The central locking switch does not oper-
ate if the vehicle is locked from the outside
and the security system is switched on.
● Locked doors could delay assistance in
an emergency. Do not leave anyone, espe-
cially children, in the vehicle.
Fig. 82 Centre console: central locking but- Fig. 83 Keyless Access: proximity zones.
ton. Note
● Lock: press the  ››› Fig. 82 button. Your vehicle will lock automatically when it
reaches a speed of about 15 km/h (9 mph)
● Unlock: Press the  button again ››› Fig. 82.
(Auto Lock) ››› page 97. You can unlock the
vehicle again using the  button on the
Please note the following when using the
central locking switch.
central locking switch ››› Fig. 82to lock your
vehicle:
● It is not possible to open the doors or the
rear lid from the outside (for safety reasons,
e.g. when stopped at traffic lights).
● The central locking lamp ››› Fig. 82 lights Fig. 84 Door handle: sensor surfaces
up when all the doors are closed and locked.
● You can open the doors individually from
››› Fig. 84
the inside by pulling the inside door handle.
A Unlocking sensor surface on the inside of
the door handle.
● The fuel tank flap remains unlocked.
B Locking sensor surface on the outside of
● In the event of an accident in which the air-
the door handle. »
bags inflate, doors locked from the inside will
99
Operation

Depending on the equipment, the vehicle one of the sensor surfaces on the front door Unlocking and opening the doors
may have the Keyless Access system. handles is touched. (Keyless-Entry)
Keyless Access is a key-free locking and igni- The following features are then available ● Grip the driver door handle. When you do
tion system to unlock and lock the vehicle without having to use the vehicle key actively: this, you touch the sensor surface ››› Fig. 84
without actively using its key. To do this, all A (arrow) of the handle and the vehicle un-
● Keyless-Entry: unlocking the vehicle using locks.
that is required is to have a valid vehicle key in
the detection area where you are attempting the handle of the front driver’s door or the
● Open the door.
to access the vehicle ››› Fig. 83 and to touch softtouch/handle on the rear lid.
one of the sensor surfaces on the door han- ● Keyless-Exit: locking the vehicle using the On vehicles with selective opening or info-
dles ››› Fig. 84 ››› . sensor on the driver door handle. tainment system configuration, pulling the
● Press & Drive: keyless starting of the engine door handle twice will unlock all doors.
The vehicle can only be unlocked and locked
via the driver's door. When doing so, the re- with the starter button ››› page 189.
In vehicles without the “Safe” security sys-
mote control key must be no further than ap-
The central locking and locking systems op- tem: closing and locking the doors
prox. 1.5 m away from the door handle.
erate in the same way as a normal locking (Keyless-Exit)
It does not matter where you carry the key, and unlocking system. Only the controls ● Switch the ignition off.
e.g. in your jacket pocket. change.
● Close the driver's door.
Once the doors have been locked, they can- Unlocking the vehicle is confirmed with a ● Touch (once) the locking sensor surface
not be opened again immediately. This will double flash of the indicator lights; locking by
››› Fig. 84
B (arrow) on the driver's door
enable you to check that the doors are prop- a single flash.
handle. The door that is used must be closed.
erly closed.
If the vehicle is locked and then all doors and
If you wish you may unlock only the corre- the rear lid are closed leaving the last key In vehicles with the “Safe” security sys-
sponding door or the entire vehicle. The nec- used inside the vehicle and none outside, the tem: closing and locking the doors
essary adjustments can be made in vehicles vehicle will not lock immediately. All the ve- (Keyless-Exit)
with a driver information system hicle's indicator lights will flash four times. ● Switch the ignition off.
››› page 92››› page 71. The vehicle will lock after a few seconds if
● Close the driver's door.
you do not open any door or the rear lid.
General information ● Touch (once) the sensor surface ››› Fig. 84
The vehicle will lock again after a few sec-
B (arrow) on the driver's door handle. The
If a valid key is in the proximity of the car onds if you unlock the vehicle but fail to open
vehicle locks with the “Safe” security system
››› Fig. 83, the Keyless Access locking and any door or boot hatch.
starting system gives the key entry as soon as ››› page 102. The door that is used must be
closed.

100
Opening and closing

● Touch (twice) the sensor surface ››› Fig. 84 of a bush rubbing against it), all proximity on the door handle. The door should not
B (arrow) of the driver door handle to lock sensors are disabled for a certain period of open.
the vehicle without activating the “Safe” se- time.
curity system ››› page 102. The next time the door can only be unlocked
Sensors will again be enabled: via the remote control or the lock cylinder.
Unlocking and locking the boot hatch The next time the door is locked/unlocked,
● After a time.
Keyless Access will be active again.
When the vehicle is locked, the rear lid auto- ● OR: if the vehicle is unlocked with the but-
matically unlocks on opening if there is a val- ton  on the key. Convenience functions
id vehicle key in the proximity ››› Fig. 83. ● OR: if the boot is opened.
To close all the electric windows using the
Open or close the rear lid normally. ● OR: if the vehicle is unlocked manually with comfort function, keep a finger on the lock-
After closing, the hatch locks automatically. If the key. ing sensor surface ››› Fig. 84 B (arrow) of
the complete vehicle is unlocked, the rear lid the door handle for a few seconds until the
will not lock automatically after closing it. Keyless Access temporary disconnection windows have closed.
function
How the doors open when touching the sen-
What happens when locking the vehicle You can deactivate the vehicle's Keyless sor surface on the door handle will depend
with a second key Access unlocking for one locking and unlock- on the settings that have been activated in
If there is a vehicle key inside the vehicle and ing cycle. the infotainment system, using the button 
it is locked from the outside with a second ve- > Settings > Opening and closing.
● Move the gear lever to position P (if the ve-
hicle key, the key inside the vehicle is blocked
hicle has automatic gearbox), since other- CAUTION
for engine ignition ››› page 189. In order to
wise the vehicle cannot be locked.
enable engine ignition, press the  button on The sensor surfaces on the door handles
● Close the door.
the key inside the vehicle. could engage if hit with a water jet or high
● Push the central locking button  on the re- pressure steam if there is a valid vehicle
Automatically disabling sensors mote control and touch the locking sensor key in the proximity. If at least one of the
surface of the driver door handle electric windows is open and the sensor
If the vehicle is not locked or unlocked for a
››› Fig. 84 B within the following 5 seconds. surface ››› Fig. 84 B (arrow) on one of the
long period of time, the proximity sensors on
Do not grasp the door handle; otherwise the handles is activated continuously, all win-
the passenger doors are automatically disa- dows will close.
vehicle will not unlock. Deactivation is also
bled.
possible if the vehicle is locked through the
If one of the sensor surfaces on the door han- driver’s door lock. Note
dles is often activated in an unusual manner ● To check that the function has been deacti- ● If the vehicle battery has little or no
with the vehicle locked (e.g. by the branches
vated, wait at least 10 seconds, grip and pull charge, or the vehicle key battery is almost »
101
Operation

or entirely out of charge, you will probably ● If the sensors are very dirty, e.g. have a Lock the vehicle and activate the “Safe”
not be able to lock or unlock the vehicle layer of salt, the correct functioning of the security system.
with the Keyless Access system. The vehi- sensors on the door handles may be affec- ● Press the locking button  once on the ve-
cle can be unlocked or locked manually ted. In this case, clean the vehicle. hicle key.
››› page 106. ● If the vehicle is equipped with an auto-
● To control the proper locking of the vehi- matic gearbox, it may only be locked in the Lock the vehicle without activating the
cle, the release function is disabled for ap- gear stick is in position P. “Safe” system.
prox. 2 seconds. ● To improve the safety of your vehicle, the ● Press the locking  button on the vehicle
● If the message Keyless access system remote control of the system is equipped key twice.
faulty is displayed on the screen of the with a position sensor. If this remote control
dash panel, abnormalities may occur in the does not detect movement for a certain ● On vehicles with the Keyless Access locking
operation of the Keyless Access system. length of time, the system will conclude and ignition system: touch the sensor surface
Contact a specialised workshop. SEAT rec- that the vehicle cannot be opened (e.g. on on the outside part of the door handle twice.
ommends visiting a SEAT dealership for a night table) so it will be disabled.
this. When the “Safe” security system is disa-
● Depending on the function set on the in- bled, the following needs to be taken into
fotainment system for the mirrors, the exte- account:
Locking system “Safe”1)
rior mirrors will unfold and the surround ● The vehicle can be opened and unlocked
lighting will come on when unlocking the When the vehicle is locked, the “Safe” securi- from the inside using an inside door handle.
vehicle using the sensor surface on the
ty system puts the door handles out of opera- ● The anti-theft alarm is activated.
driver and passenger door handles
tion and makes it difficult for unauthorized
››› page 122. ● The vehicle interior monitoring system and
people to enter. The doors cannot be opened
● If there is no valid key inside the vehicle the anti-tow system are disabled.
from inside ››› .
or the system fails to detect one, a warning
will display on the dash panel screen. This Depending on the vehicle, when switching the “Safe” status
could happen if any other radio frequency ignition off, a warning may be displayed on
On the driver door, there is warning lamp visi-
signal interferes with the key signal (e.g. the control panel screen stating that the
ble from outside the vehicle through the win-
from a mobile device accessory) or if the “Safe” security system is activated.
dow which shows the “Safe” system status.
key is covered by another object (e.g. an
aluminium case). We will know that “Safe” system is activated
by the flashing warning lamp. The indicator

1) Available depending on market and version.


102
Opening and closing

will flash on all vehicles, fitted and nor fitted that the alarm and the locking security sys- ● When the ignition is switched on with a non-
with an alarm, until they unlock. tem (double lock) have been turned on. authorised key.
If any of the doors or the bonnet are open, ● Undue manipulation of the alarm.
● “Safe” activated with or without the alarm:
continuous flashing of the warning lamp. they will not be included in the protection ● Disconnection of the vehicle battery.
zones of the vehicle when the alarm is con- ● Movement inside the vehicle (in vehicles
● “Safe” deactivated without the alarm: the
nected. If the door or the bonnet are subse-
lamp stays off. with interior monitoring ››› page 104).
quently closed, they will be automatically in-
● “Safe” deactivated with the alarm: the ● When the vehicle is towed (in vehicles with
cluded in the protection areas of the vehicle
warning lamp stays off. and the turn signals will flash accordingly anti-tow system ››› page 104).
when the doors close. ● When the vehicle is raised (in vehicles with
WARNING anti-tow system ››› page 104).
● The turn signal light will flash twice on
Do not leave anyone (especially children) ● When the vehicle is transported on a ferry
opening and deactivating the alarm.
in the vehicle if it is locked from the outside or by rail (vehicles with an anti-tow system or
and the “Safe” security system is activa- ● The turn signal light will flash once on clos-
vehicle interior monitoring ››› page 104).
ted, as the doors and windows cannot then ing and activating the alarm.
● When a trailer connected to the anti-theft
be opened from the inside. Locked doors
could delay assistance in an emergency. alarm system is disconnected.
When does the system trigger an alarm?
The anti-theft alarm siren will be triggered for How to turn OFF the alarm
about 30 seconds alongside a sound and
● Unlock the vehicle with the unlock button 
Anti-theft alarm system optical (flashing) warning signals and will be
of the key.
repeated about ten times when the vehicle is
locked and the following unauthorised ac- ● OR: turn the ignition on with a valid key.
Description tions are attempted:
If the driver’s door is unlocked mechanically
The anti-theft alarm makes it more difficult to ● Opening a door that is mechanically un- using the key, the key must be inserted into
break into the vehicle or steal it. The system locked using the vehicle key without switching the ignition, and the ignition must be turned
will initiate acoustic and optical warning sig- on the ignition in the next 15 seconds (in cer- on within 15 seconds of opening the door.
nals when your vehicle is tried to be forced. tain markets, such as the Netherlands, there is Otherwise, the alarm will trigger for 30 sec.
The anti-theft alarm is automatically turned no 15 second waiting time and the alarm is and the ignition will be blocked.
on when the vehicle is locked with the key. activated immediately on opening the door).
The system is immediately activated and the ● A door is opened. CAUTION
turn signal light located on the driver door will ● Opening the bonnet. If the anti-theft security system is switched
flash along with the turn signals, indicating
● The rear lid is opened. off, the vehicle interior monitoring and the »
103
Operation

tow-away protection are automatically Interior monitoring and the anti- The vehicle interior monitoring and the anti-
tow system are automatically switched on
disconnected. tow system
again next time the vehicle is locked.

Note It is a monitoring or control function incorpo- If you wish to switch off the vehicle interior
rated in the anti-theft alarm which detects monitoring and the anti-tow system, it must
● After 28 days, the indicator light will be
unauthorised vehicle entry by means of ultra- be done each time that the vehicle is locked;
switched off to prevent the battery from ex-
sound. if not, they will be automatically switched on.
hausting if the vehicle has been left parked
for a long period of time. The alarm system The vehicle interior monitoring and anti-tow The vehicle interior monitoring and the anti-
remains activated. sensor (tilt sensor) are automatically switch- tow system should be switched off if animals
● If, after the audible warning goes off, an- ed on when the anti-theft alarm is switched are left inside the locked vehicle (otherwise,
other monitored area is accessed (e.g. the on. In order to activate it, all the doors and their movements will trigger the alarm) or
rear lid is opened after a door has been the rear lid must be closed. when, for example, the vehicle is transported
opened), the alarm is triggered again. or has to be towed with only one axle on the
If the “Safe” ››› page 102 security system is
● The anti-theft alarm is not activated switched off, the vehicle interior monitoring ground.
when the vehicle is locked from within using and the tow-away protection are automati-
the central locking button . cally disconnected. Deactivation through the infotainment
● If the driver door is unlocked mechanical- system
ly with the key, only the driver door is un- Activation ● Turn off the ignition and select: button  >
locked, the rest of the doors remain locked. Settings > Opening and closing >
● It is automatically switched on when the
Only when the ignition has been turned on
anti-theft alarm is activated. Central locking > Interior monitor-
will the other doors be available - but not
ing.
unlocked - and the central locking button
will be activated. Deactivation ● When the vehicle is locked now, the vehicle

● If the vehicle battery is run down or flat ● Open the vehicle with the key, either me-
interior monitoring and the tow-away protec-
then the anti-theft alarm will not operate
tion are switched off until the next time the
chanically or by pressing the  button on the
correctly. door is opened.
remote control. The time period from when
● Vehicle monitoring remains active even if the door is opened until the key is inserted in
the contact should not exceed 15 seconds, False alarms
the battery is disconnected or not working
for any reason. otherwise the alarm will be triggered. Interior monitoring will only operate correctly
● The alarm is triggered immediately if one ● Press the  button on the remote control if the vehicle is completely closed. Please ob-
of the battery cables is disconnected while twice. The volumetric sensor and tilt sensors serve related legal requirements.
the alarm system is active. will be deactivated. The alarm system re-
mains activated.
104
Opening and closing

The following cases may cause a false once all the doors are closed (including the ● Open and close the doors and the rear lid
alarm: rear lid). only when there is nobody in the way.
● Open windows (partially or fully).
● Panoramic/tilting sunroof open (partially or CAUTION
completely).
Doors When opening and closing in an emergen-
● Movement of objects inside the vehicle, cy, carefully disassemble components and
such as loose papers, items hanging from the then reassemble them carefully to avoid
Introduction damage to the vehicle.
rear vision mirror (air fresheners), etc.
The doors and rear lid can be locked man-
Note ually and partially opened, for example if the
● If the vehicle is relocked and the alarm is key or the central locking is damaged.
activated without the volumetric sensor
function, relocking will activate the alarm WARNING
with all its functions, except the volumetric
Opening and closing doors carelessly can
sensor. This function is reactivated when
cause serious injury.
the alarm is switched on again, unless it is
deliberately switched off. ● If the vehicle is locked from outside, the
doors and windows cannot be opened from
● If the alarm has been triggered by the
the inside.
volumetric sensor, this will be indicated by
a flashing of the warning lamp on the driver ● Never leave children or disabled people
door when the vehicle is opened. The flash alone in the car. They could be trapped in
is different to the flash indicating the alarm the car in an emergency and will not be
is activated. able to get themselves to safety.
● The vibration of a mobile phone left in- ● Depending on the time of the year, tem-
side the vehicle may cause the vehicle in- peratures inside a locked and closed vehi-
terior monitoring alarm to trigger, as both cle can be extremely high or extremely low
sensors react to movements and shakes in- resulting in serious injuries and illness or
side the vehicle. even death, particularly for young children.
● If on activating the alarm, any door or the
rear lid is open, only the alarm will be acti- WARNING
vated. The vehicle interior monitoring and
Getting in the way of the doors and the rear
the anti-tow system will only be activated
lid is dangerous and can lead to serious in-
jury.
105
Operation

Emergency unlocking or locking of As a general rule, when the driver door is ● Folding/unfolding the exterior mirrors.
locked manually all other doors are locked.
the driver’s door ● Unlocking of the central locking (only oper-
When it is unlocked manually, only the driver ates the driver's door).
door opens. Please observe the instructions
relating to the anti-theft alarm system Note
››› page 103.
The anti-theft alarm is not activated when
● Unfold the vehicle key blade ››› page 94. the vehicle is locked manually using the
key shaft ››› page 96.
● Insert the key shaft into the lower opening in
the cover on the driver door handle ››› Fig. 86
then remove the cover upwards.
● Insert the key blade into the lock cylinder to Emergency lock of doors without
unlock or lock the vehicle. lock cylinders
Fig. 85 Driver door handle: Concealed lock
cylinder. Special characteristics
● The anti-theft alarm will remain active
when vehicles are unlocked. However, the
alarm will not be triggered ››› page 103.
● After the driver door is opened, you have 15
seconds to switch on the ignition. Once this
time has elapsed, the alarm is triggered.
● Switch the ignition on. The electronic immo-
bilizer recognises a valid vehicle key and de-
activates the anti-theft alarm system. Fig. 87 Locking the door manually.

Functions from the driver’s door lock cylin- If the central locking system should fail to
der work at any time, doors with no lock cylinder
Fig. 86 Driver door handle: lever the cover off If the vehicle does not have the “Safe” func- will have to be locked separately.
tion, the following comfort functions will not The emergency lock is located on the front of
If the central locking system should fail to op-
be available from the lock cylinder: the front passenger's door and the rear
erate, the driver door can still be locked and
doors. It can only be seen if the door is open.
unlocked by turning the key in the lock. ● Raising and lowering the side windows.

106
Opening and closing

● Pull the cap out of the opening. This function is independent of the vehicle
Rear lid
● Insert the key in the inside slot and turn it to electronic opening and locking systems. It
the right as far as it will go (if the door is on only affects rear doors. It can only be activa-
ted and deactivated manually, as described Introduction
the right side) or to the left (if the door is on
the left side). below:
The rear lid unlocks and locks together with
● Replace the cap. the doors.
Activating the childproof lock
Once the door has been closed it can no lon- – Unlock the vehicle and open the door in
On vehicles with Keyless Access, the rear lid
ger be opened from the outside. Pull the inte- unlocks automatically when it is opened
which you wish to activate the childproof
rior door handle once to unlock and open the lock. ››› page 99.
door.
– With the door open, rotate the groove in the WARNING
door using the ignition key, clockwise for
Careless and unsuitable locking, opening
the left hand side doors ››› Fig. 88 and anti-
Childproof locks and closing of the rear lid can cause acci-
clockwise for the right hand side doors. dents and serious injury.
● The rear lid must not be opened when the
Deactivating the childproof lock
reverse or rear fog lights are lit. This may
– Unlock the vehicle and open the door damage the tail lights.
whose childproof lock you want to deacti- ● Do not close the rear lid by pushing it
vate. down with your hand on the rear window.
– With the door open, rotate the groove in the The glass could smash. Risk of injury!
door using the ignition key, anti-clockwise ● Ensure the rear lid is locked after closing
for the left hand side doors ››› Fig. 88 and it. If not, it may open unexpectedly while
clockwise for the right hand side doors. driving.
● Closing the rear lid without observing
Fig. 88 Childproof lock on the left hand side Once the childproof lock is activated, the and ensuring it is clear could cause serious
door. door can only be opened from the outside. injury to you and to third parties. Make sure
that no one is in the path of the rear lid.
The childproof lock prevents the rear doors ● Never drive with the rear lid open or half-
from being opened from the inside. This sys- closed, exhaust gases may penetrate into
tem prevents minors from opening a door ac- the interior of the vehicle. Danger of poi-
cidentally while the vehicle is running. soning! »

107
Operation

● Never leave the vehicle unattended or al- Opening and closing the rear lid Emergency unlocking of the rear lid
low children to play inside or next to it, es-
pecially if the rear lid is open. Children
could enter the luggage compartment,
close the rear lid and become trapped. A
locked vehicle can reach extremely high
and low temperatures, depending on the
time of year, thus causing serious injuries,
illness or even death.

CAUTION
Before opening or closing the rear lid, make
sure that there is enough space to open or Fig. 89 Rear lid: handle Fig. 90 Detail of the luggage compartment:
close it, e.g. when pulling a trailer or in a emergency unlocking
garage. The rear lid opening system operates electri-
cally. It is activated by exerting slight pressure The rear lid can be unlocked from inside in
on the handle ››› Fig. 89. the event of an emergency (e.g. no battery).
Note
To lock or unlock the rear lid, press the  or There is a groove in the luggage compart-
Before closing the rear lid, make sure that
the key has not been left inside the luggage  buttons of the vehicle key. ment allowing access to the emergency
compartment. opening mechanism.
A warning appears on the instrument panel
display if the rear lid is open or not properly
Unlocking the rear lid from inside the lug-
closed. An audible warning is also given if it is
gage compartment
opened while the vehicle is moving faster
than 6 km/h (4 mph). ● Insert the key blade into the slot and move
the key in the direction of the arrow until the
Opening and closing lock unlocks ››› Fig. 90.
● To open: place slight pressure on the han-
dle. The rear lid opens automatically.
● Close: hold the gate by one of the handles
fitted to the inner lining and close it by moving
it downwards.

108
Opening and closing

Window controls The front and rear electric windows can be Convenience opening:
operated by using the controls on the driver ● Press and hold the  button on the remote
door. The other doors each have a switch for control key until all the windows and the sun-
Electrically opening and closing their own window. roof have reached the desired position.
the windows
Always close the windows fully if you park the ● OR: First unlock the vehicle using the  but-
vehicle or leave it unattended ››› . ton on the remote control key and then keep
the key in the driver door lock until all the win-
You can use the electric windows for approx.
dows and the sunroof have reached the re-
10 minutes after switching off the ignition if
quired position.
neither the driver door nor the front passen-
ger door has been opened and the key has Convenience closing:
not been removed from the ignition.
● Press and hold button  on the remote
control key until all the windows and the sun-
Safety switch 
roof are closed ››› .
The safety control ››› Fig. 91 5 on the driver ● OR: Keep the key in the driver door in the
door can be used to disable the electric win-
"lock" position until all the windows and the
dow buttons on the rear doors.
sunroof are closed.
Safety switch not pressed: buttons on rear
Fig. 91 Detail of the driver's door: window con- doors are activated. Different settings can be changed using the
trols. infotainment system. Select: button  >
Safety switch pressed: buttons on rear doors Settings > Opening and closing >
● Opening the window: press the button . are deactivated. Window operation > Convenience open-
● Closing the window: pull the button . The safety control symbol  lights up in yel- ing.
low if the buttons on the rear doors are
Buttons on the driver door switched off. One-touch opening and closing
1 Window on the front left door The one-touch automatic opening and clos-
Convenience open/close function ing is used to open or close the windows
2 Window on the front right door
The electric windows can be opened or completely. It will not be necessary to hold
3 Window on the rear left door the button of the corresponding electric win-
closed from outside using the vehicle key:
4 Window on the rear right door dow.
5 Safety switch for deactivating the electric For the automatic raising function: pull the
window buttons in the rear doors. button for the corresponding window up-
wards until it reaches the second position. »
109
Operation

For the automatic lowering function: push ● If the ignition is switched on, the electric Window anti-trap function
the button for the corresponding window up- equipment could be activated with risk of
wards until it reaches the second position. injury, for example, in the electric windows. The roll-back function reduces the risk of in-
jury when the electric windows close.
Stop automatic movement: push or pull on ● The doors can be locked using the re-
the button of the corresponding window. mote control key. This could become an ● If a window is obstructed when closing au-
obstacle for assistance in an emergency
tomatically, the window stops at this point
Resetting one-touch opening and closing situation.
and lowers immediately ››› .
● Therefore always take the key with you
The one-touch opening and closing function ● Next, check why the window does not close
when you leave the vehicle.
is not active after the vehicle battery has before attempting it again.
been disconnected or is flat and will have to ● The electric windows will work until the
ignition has been switched off and one of ● If you try within the following 10 seconds
be reset.
the front doors has been opened. and the window closes again with difficulty or
● Pull the button of the corresponding win- ● If necessary, use the safety switch to dis-
there is an obstruction, the automatic closing
dow and hold it for one second in this posi- able the rear electric windows. Make sure
will stop working for 10 seconds.
tion. that they have been disabled. ● If the window is still obstructed, the window
● Release the button and pull upwards and ● For safety reasons, you should only use will stop at this point.
hold again. The one-touch function is now the remote control open and close func- ● If there is no obvious reason why the win-
ready for operation. tions within about 2 metres of the vehicle. dow cannot be closed, try to close it again by
To avoid injuries, always keep an eye on the pulling the tab within ten seconds. The win-
The automatic one-touch electric windows windows when pressing the button to close dow closes with maximum force. The roll-
can be reinitialised individually or several at a them. The windows stop moving as soon as back function is now deactivated.
time. the button is released.
● If more than 10 seconds pass, the window

WARNING will open fully when you operate one of the


Note buttons. One-touch closing is reactivated.
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Intro-
If the window is not able to close because it
duction on page 105. WARNING
is stiff or because of an obstruction, the
● Incorrect use of the electric windows can window will automatically open again
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Elec-
result in injury. ››› page 110. If this happens, check why the trically opening and closing the windows
● Never close the rear lid without observing window could not be closed before at-
on page 110.
and ensuring it is clear, to do otherwise tempting to close it again.
● The roll-back function does not prevent
could cause serious injury to you and third
fingers or other parts of the body getting
parties. Make sure that no one is in the path
of a window.
110
Lights

pinched against the window frame. Risk of Lights verified. They will switch off after a few sec-
onds.
accident.

Vehicle lighting WARNING


Observe the safety warnings ››› in Con-
Control lamps trol and warning lamps on page 87.

 It lights up
Driving light totally or partially faulty.
Headlight switch

Fault in the cornering light system.

 It lights up
Rear fog light switched on ››› page 113.

 It lights up
Left or right turn signal.
The control lamp flashes twice as fast when a turn
signal is faulty.
Fig. 92 Dash panel: lights control.
Hazard warning lights on ››› page 117.
● Turn the switch to the required position
 It lights up ››› Fig. 92.
Trailer turn signals
Sym- Ignition switch- Ignition is
bol ed off switched on
 It lights up
Fog lights, dipped Light off or day-
Main beam on or flasher on ››› page 113.  beam and side time driving light
lights off. on »
Several warning and control lamps light up
for a few seconds when the ignition is switch-
ed on, signalling that the function is being
111
Operation

● The rain sensor detects rain and activates ● Deactivation: when reducing the speed of
Sym- Ignition switch- Ignition is
bol ed off switched on the wipers. They switch off when the wipers the vehicle below 100 km/h (62 mph), the
have not been activated for a few minutes. dipped beam immediately returns to its nor-
The “Coming mal position.
Automatic control
home” and “Leaving Daytime running lights
of dipped beam
 home” guide lights
and daytime run- Audible warnings to advise the driver that
may be switched The daytime running lights consist of individu-
ning light. the lights have not been switched off
on. al lights, integrated in the front headlights.
These lights come on when the daytime run- If the key is not in the ignition and the driver
Daylight running
 Side light on.
lights switched on. ning lights are switched on. On vehicles door is open, an audible warning signal is
equipped with LED tail lights, the rear side heard in the following cases: this will remind
Dipped beam head- Dipped beam light is switched on as well ››› . you to turn the light off.
 light off switched on.
The daytime running lights turn on every time ● When the parking light is on ››› page 113.
The driver is personally responsible for the the ignition is switched on, if the switch is in
● When the light switch is in position  or .
correct use and adjustment of the lights in all position  or , according to the level of ex-
situations. terior lighting.
WARNING
When the light switch is in position , a light
Automatic dipped beam headlight control If the road is not well lit and other road
sensor automatically switches dipped beam users cannot see the vehicle well enough
 on and off (including the control and instru- or at all, accidents may occur.
The automatic dipped beam control is merely ment lighting) or the daytime running lights
● The automatic dipped beam control
intended as an aid and is not able to recog- depending on the level of exterior lighting.
( ) only switches on the dipped beam
nise all driving situations. when there are changes in light conditions
Motorway light but not, for example, when it is foggy.
When the light switch is in position , the
vehicle lights and the instrument panel and The motorway light is available on vehicles
switch lighting switch on automatically in the equipped with full-LED lights. WARNING
following situations ››› : The function is connected and disconnected The side lights or daytime running lights
● The photo sensor detects darkness, for ex- via the corresponding Infotainment system are not bright enough to illuminate the road
ample, when driving through a tunnel. They menu. ahead and to ensure that other road users
switch off when adequate lighting is detec- are able to see you.
● Activation: when going above 110 km/h
ted. ● Always use your dipped beam head
(68 mph) for more than 10 seconds, the dip-
lights if it is raining or if visibility is poor.
ped beam raises slightly to increase the driv-
er's visibility distance.
112
Lights

● Never drive with daytime lights if the road Fog lights Turn signal and main beam lever
is not well lit due to weather or lighting
conditions.
● On vehicles with rear lights with bulbs,
when activating the daytime running light
the rear lights are not switched on. A vehi-
cle which does not have the rear lights on
may not be visible to other drivers in the
darkness, in the case of heavy rain or in
conditions of poor visibility.

WARNING
Fig. 93 Dash panel: lights control. Fig. 94 Turn signal and main beam lever.
If the headlights are set too high and not
used correctly, there is a risk of dazzling or
distracting other road users. This could re-
The warning lamps  or  also show, on the More the lever to the required position:
sult in a serious accident. light switch or instrument panel, when the
front fog lights are on. 1 Right turn light or right-hand parking light
● Always make sure that the headlights are (ignition switched off).
correctly adjusted. ● Turning on the front fog lights : pull the 2 Left turn light or left-hand parking light
light switch out from its first click position (ignition switched off).
Note ››› Fig. 93 1 , from positions ,  or .
3 Main beam on: control lamp  lit up on
● The legal requirements regarding the use ● Turning on the rear fog light : pull the
the instrument panel.
of vehicle lights in each country must be light switch fully out 2 from position ,  or
4 Light flash: on with the lever pushed. Con-
observed. . This control has only one position in ve-
trol lamp  lit up.
● The dipped beam headlights will only hicles without fog lights.
work with the ignition on. The side lights ● To switch off the fog lights, press the light Push the lever all the way down to turn off the
come on automatically when the ignition is switch or turn it to position . corresponding function.
turned off.
Note Convenience turn signals
The rear fog light can dazzle drivers behind When the ignition is switched on, move the
you. You should use the rear fog light only lever as far as possible upwards or down-
when visibility is very poor. wards and release the lever. The turn signal
will flash three times. »
113
Operation

The convenience turn signals are activated WARNING ● The parking light does not activate auto-
and deactivated in the infotainment system matically if the left- or right-hand turn sig-
Incorrect use of the headlights may cause
using button  > Settings > Light > nal is left on and the ignition is disconnec-
accidents and serious injury, as the main
Light assistance > Convenience turn ted.
beam may distract or dazzle other drivers.
signals ››› page 92.

In vehicles that do not have the correspond-


Note
ing menu, this function can be deactivated in Main beam assist (Light Assist)
a specialised workshop. ● If the turn signal lever is left on after the
key has been taken out of the ignition lock, The main beam assist automatically prevents
an acoustic signal sounds when the driver glare from vehicles moving in the opposite di-
Parking light 
door is opened. This is intended as a re-
rection or ahead in the same direction. In ad-
The parking lights will only work with the igni- minder to switch off the turn signal, unless
dition, the main beam assist detects illumina-
tion off. If said light is on, an audible warning you wish to leave the parking light on.
ted areas and disconnects the main beam
will sound while the driver door is open. ● If the convenience turn signals are oper- headlight when passing, e.g. by populated
ating (three flashes) and the other conven- areas.
● Switch the ignition off.
ience turn signals are switched on, the ac-
● Move the turn signal lever up or down. tive part stops flashing and only flashes Within its limitations, the assist system auto-
once in the new part selected. matically connects or disconnects the main
When the parking light is switched on, the beam headlight depending on the environ-
● The turn signal only works when the igni-
front side light and the tail light on the corre- mental and traffic conditions, as well as the
tion is switched on. The hazard warning
sponding side of the vehicle turn on. speed ››› .
lights also work when the ignition is switch-
ed off.
WARNING Switching the main beam assist on 
● If a trailer turn signal malfunctions, the
Improper or lack of use of the turn signals, control lamp will stop flashing (trailer turn ● Turn on the ignition and turn the light switch
or forgetting to deactivate them can con- signals) and the vehicle turn signal will to the position  ››› Fig. 92.
fuse other road users. This could result in a flash at double speed.
serious accident. ● From the base position, press the turn signal
● The main beam headlights can only be
● Always give warning when you are going
and main beam headlights lever forwards
switched on if the dipped beam headlights
to change lane, overtake or when turning, ››› Fig. 94 3
are already on.
activating the turn signal in good time.
● In cold or damp weather conditions, the When the main beam assistant is on, the 
● As soon as you have finished changing indicator lamp lights up on the instrument
headlights, tail lights and turn signals may
lane, overtaking or turning, switch the turn mist up inside temporarily. This is normal cluster display.
signal off. and in no way effects the useful life of the
vehicle lighting system.
114
Lights

When the main beam light is on, the  main ● On roads with traffic in the opposite direc- CAUTION
beam indicator lamp lights up on the instru- tion and with a central reservation barrier
To avoid affecting the operation of the sys-
ment cluster. where the driver can see over it e.g. lorry driv-
tem, take the following points into consid-
ers.
eration:
Switching the main beam assist off  ● In the event of fog, snow or heavy rain
● Clean the field of vision of the camera
● Turn the light switch to a position other than ● In the event of dust or sand storms regularly and make sure it is free of snow
 ››› Fig. 92. ● If the windscreen is damaged in the cam- and ice.
● OR: if the main beam assist is on, pull the era's field of vision. ● Do not cover the field of vision of the
turn signal and main beam headlight lever camera.
● If the camera's field of vision is misted up,
backwards ››› Fig. 94 4 . ● Check that the windscreen is not dam-
dirty or covered by a sticker, snow or ice.
● OR: if the main beam assistant is on, but the aged in the area of the field of vision of the
● If the camera is damaged or if the power
main beam does not turn on, press the turn camera.
supply has been cut off.
signal and main beam lever forwards to turn
the main beam on manually. Pull the turn sig- Note
WARNING
nal and main beam lever back to switch off
The convenience features of the main ● The headlight flasher can be turned on
the main beam manually, if necessary.
beam assist should not encourage the tak- and off manually at any time with the turn
● OR: switch off the ignition. signal and main beam lever ››› page 113.
ing of risks. The system is not a replace-
ment for driver concentration. ● If there are objects that radiate light in
System limitations
● You are always in control of the main the camera's area of influence, e.g. a port-
In the following cases, the main beam head- beam and adapting it to the light, visibility able navigation system, this may affect the
light must be switched off manually because and traffic conditions. operation of the main beam assist system.
the main beam assist will not disconnect it on ● It is possible that the main beam head-
time or disconnect it at all: light control does not recognise all driving
● On roads with insufficient lighting with very
situations and is limited under certain cir- Fog lights with cornering light func-
cumstances.
reflective signs tion
● When the field of vision of the camera is
● If road users are insufficiently lit up, e.g. pe- 3 Not available on vehicles equipped with full-
dirty, covered or damaged, operation of
destrians or cyclists. LED headlights and bulb fog lights.
the main beam control may be affected.
● On closed curves, when the traffic in the This also applies when changes are made
The cornering light function is an additional
opposite direction is partially hidden, on pro- to the vehicle lighting system, for example,
function to the dipped beam headlights to
nounced slopes or inclinations. if additional headlights are installed.
improve lighting of the side of the road when
taking a sharp turn at low speed. »
115
Operation

The cornering light function works when the Activating the “Coming Home” function Activating the “Leaving Home” function
dipped beam headlights are already on and For vehicles with light and rain sensors. ● Unlock the vehicle using the remote control.
it is activated when driving at speeds below
● Switch off the engine and remove the key ● The “Leaving Home” function is only activa-
approximately 40 km/h (25 mph).
from the ignition with the light switch in posi- ted when the light switch is in position 
● If the steering wheel is turned or the turn tion  ››› page 111. and the light sensor detects darkness.
signal is switched on, the front fog light grad- ● The automatic “Coming Home” function is
ually turns on. After the turn, the cornering only active when the light sensor detects The “Leaving Home” lighting switches off
light function is gradually switched off. darkness. in the following cases:
● When engaging reverse gear, both front fog ● Automatically, when the “Leaving Home”
lights turn on. For vehicles without light and rain sensors. delay period ends (default 30 sec).
● Switch the ignition off.
● When the vehicle is locked using the remote
● Activate the headlight flashers for approxi- control.
“Coming home” and “Leav- mately 1 second. ● When the light switch is turned to position .
ing home” function ● With the ignition is switched on.
When the driver door is opened, the “Coming
Home” lighting comes on. The delay in
The “Coming home” and “Leaving home”
switching off the headlights is counted from Note
function lights up the vehicle’s immediate
when the last door or boot hatch is closed. To activate the “Coming Home” and “Leav-
proximity when getting into and out of it in the
dark. When switched on, the front position ing Home” function, the rotary light switch
and dipped beam lights, tail lights and li- The “Coming Home” lighting turns off in must be in position  and the light sensor
cense plate light come on. the following cases: must detect darkness.
● Automatically, once the headlight turn off
The “Leaving Home” is controlled by a photo-
delay has elapsed.
sensor.
● Automatically, when a vehicle door or the
In the vehicle settings menu of the infotain- rear lid is still open 30 seconds after starting
ment system you can adjust the duration of the engine.
the light switch-off delay, and activate and
● When the rotary light switch is turned to po-
deactivate the function.
sition  ››› page 111.
● With the ignition is switched on.

116
Lights

Hazard warning lights  7. Always take the vehicle key with you when Note
you leave the vehicle.
● The battery will run down if the hazard
All turn signals flash simultaneously when the warning lights are left on for a long time,
hazard warning lights are switched on. The even if the ignition is switched off.
two turn signal turn signal lamps   and the ● The use of the hazard warning lights de-
turn signal lamp in the switch  will flash at scribed here is subject to the relevant stat-
the same time. The simultaneous hazard utory requirements.
warning lights also work when the ignition is
switched off.
Light range control
Emergency braking warning

Fig. 95 Dash panel: hazard warning lights If the vehicle brakes suddenly and continu-
switch ously at a speed of more than 80 km/h (50
mph), the brake light flashes several times per
The hazard warning lights are used to draw second to warn the vehicles driving behind. If
the attention of other road users to your vehi- you continue braking, the hazard warning
cle in emergencies. lights will come on automatically when the
vehicle comes to a standstill. They switch off
If your vehicle breaks down:
automatically when the vehicle starts to
1. Park your vehicle at a safe distance from move again.
moving traffic.
WARNING Fig. 96 Next to the steering wheel: headlight
2. Press the button to switch on the hazard
warning lights ››› . ● The risk of an accident increases if your range control.
vehicle breaks down. Always use the haz-
3. Switch the ignition off. ard warning lights and a warning triangle to The headlight range control ››› Fig. 96 is
draw the attention of other road users to modified according to the value of the head-
4. Apply the handbrake.
your stationary vehicle. light beam and the vehicle load status. This
5. For a manual gearbox, engage 1st gear; offers the driver optimum visibility and the
● Due to the high temperatures that the
for an automatic gearbox, move the gear headlights do not dazzle oncoming drivers
catalytic converter can reach, never park
lever to P. in an area where the catalytic converter ››› .
6. Use the warning triangle to draw the at- could come into contact with highly inflam- The headlights can only be adjusted when
tention of other road users to your vehicle. mable materials, for example dry grass or the dipped beam is switched on. »
spilt petrol. This could start a fire.
117
Operation

To reset, turn switch ››› Fig. 96: Driving abroad Note


“Tourist light” is only allowed temporarily. If
Value Vehicle load statusa) The light beam of the dipped beam lights is
you are planning a long stay in a country
asymmetric: the side of the road on which
Two front occupants, luggage compart- that drives on the other side, you should
 ment empty
you are driving is lit more intensely.
take the vehicle to an Authorised Technical
When a car that is manufactured in a country Service to change the headlights.
All seats occupied, luggage compart-
 ment empty that drives on the right travels to a country
that drives on the left (or vice versa), it is nor-
All seats occupied, luggage compart- mally necessary to cover part of the head-
 ment full. With trailer and minimum light bulbs with stickers or to change the ad- Interior lights
drawbar load.
justment of the headlights to avoid dazzling
Driver only, luggage compartment full other drivers. Lighting of the instrument panel,
 With trailer and maximum drawbar load. displays and switches
In such cases, the regulations specify certain
a) If the vehicle load does not correspond to those light values that must be complied with for
shown in the table, it is possible to select intermediary designated points of the light distribution. This Depending on the model, the lighting of the
positions. is known as “Tourist light”. instrument cluster and switches can be ad-
justed in the infotainment system, using the
Dynamic headlight range control The light distribution of the HIGH headlights button  > Settings > Light > Interi-
allows the specific “tourist light” values to be or lighting button; OR:  > Interior
The control is not mounted in vehicles with met without the need for stickers or changes settings > Light > Instrument clus-
dynamic headlight range control. The head- being made to the settings. ter ››› page 92.
light range is automatically adjusted accord-
ing to the vehicle load status when they are For ECOLED headlamps, it is necessary to With the ignition on and without light activa-
switched on. lower the mechanical adjustment of the tion, the analogue instrument panel lighting
headlamps by 0.15° (2.6 cm at 10 m). To do remains activated in daytime light conditions.
WARNING this, open the bonnet and adjust the vertical The lighting is reduced as the exterior light di-
adjustment screws on both headlights. When minishes. In some cases, e.g. when driving
Heavy objects in the vehicle may mean
the vehicle returns to its country of origin, the through a tunnel without the  function ac-
that the headlights dazzle and distract oth-
mechanical adjustment must be reset to its tive, the instrument panel lighting may even
er drivers. This could result in a serious ac-
original status. If you do not have experience switch off. The objective of this function is to
cident.
with this type of adjustment, SEAT recom- provide the driver with a visual indication that
● Adjust the light beam to the vehicle load
mends that you go to a technical service he or she should activate the dipped beam.
status so that it does not blind other driv-
centre.
ers.

118
Lights

If your vehicle is equipped with a digital in- The light controls may vary depending on the position selected. This prevents the battery
strument panel (Digital SEAT Cockpit), the vehicle version. from discharging.
following message will appear Turn on the
lights on the instrument panel. Luggage compartment lighting
The light is activated when the rear lid is
open, even when the ignition and lights are
Interior and reading lights turned off. For this reason, ensure that the
rear lid is always closed.

Background lighting
The background lighting lights up the area of
the centre console and the footwell area and,
depending on the version, the front door pan-
els and the air vents as well.
It will be switched on at full brightness when
the doors are opened and the lights will be
dimmed during driving, when the light selec-
Fig. 97 Detail of roof lining: front lighting of the tor is set to ,  or .
passenger compartment. The intensity of the background lighting can
be adjusted through the infotainment system
Knob Function menu. The colour can also be changed in
versions with lighting on the front door panel
 Turning the interior lights on or off.
(select  > Settings > Background
The interior lights come on automati- lighting; OR:  > Background light-
cally when you unlock the vehicle, ing››› page 88).
open a door or remove the key from
 the ignition. Note
 The light goes out a few seconds after
closing all the doors, when locking the If not all the vehicle doors are closed, the
vehicle or connecting the ignition. interior lights will be switched off after ap-
prox. 10 minutes, providing the ignition key
/ Turning the reading light on and off has been removed and the courtesy light

119
Operation

Visibility More the lever to the required position: other obstacles on the windscreen may
damage the wiper and the windscreen wip-
Short wipe. Brief press, short clean. er motor.
Windscreen wiper and rear 4  Hold the lever down for more time to in-
● If necessary, remove snow and ice from
crease the wipe frequency.
window wiper systems the windscreen wipers before starting your
Windscreen washer. The windscreen journey.
washer function is activated by push-
● Do not switch on the windscreen wipers if
Window washer lever 5  ing the lever towards the steering
wheel, and the wipers operate simulta- the windscreen is dry. Cleaning with the
neously. windscreen wipers while dry can cause
damage.
Interval wipe for rear window. The wip-
● In icy conditions, always check that the
6  er will wipe the window approximately
wiper blades are not frozen to the glass be-
every six seconds.
fore using the wipers. In cold weather, it
The rear window wash function is acti- may help to leave the vehicle parked with
7  vated by pressing the lever, and the the wipers in service position ››› page 47.
rear wiper starts simultaneously.

Note
WARNING
● The windscreen and window wipers only
In cold conditions you should not use the
Fig. 98 Operating the windscreen wiper and function when the ignition is switched on
wash/wipe system unless you have
rear wiper. and the bonnet or rear lid, respectively, are
warmed the windscreen with the heating
closed.
and ventilation system. The windscreen
More the lever to the required position: washer fluid could otherwise freeze on the ● The interval wipe speed varies according
windscreen and obscure your view of the to the vehicle speed. The faster the vehicle
0  Windscreen wipers off.
road. is moving, the more often the windscreen is
cleaned.
Wiper intervals.
Use control ››› Fig. 98 A to set the in- CAUTION
● The rear wiper is automatically switched
1  terval (vehicles without rain sensor), or on when the windscreen wiper is on and the
the sensitivity of the rain sensor. If the ignition is switched off while the wind- car is in reverse gear.
screen wipers are switched on, they com-
2  Slow wipe. plete their wipe and return to the rest posi-
tion. When the ignition is switched back on,
3  Continuous wipe.
the windscreen wiper will continue to oper-
ate at the same wiping level. Ice, snow and

120
Visibility

Wiper functions sequence will begin without performing the The rain sensor controls the frequency of the
last wipe. For the “drip” function to work windscreen wiper intervals, depending on the
Windscreen wipers performance in differ- again, you have to turn the ignition off and amount of rain ››› . The sensitivity of the rain
ent situations then on again. sensor can be adjusted manually. Manual
● If the vehicle is stopped, the activated posi-
wipe ››› page 120.
tion temporarily moves to the previous posi- Move the lever to the required position
tion. Rain sensor ››› Fig. 99:
● The air conditioner comes on for approxi-
0 Rain sensor off.
mately 30 seconds in air recirculation mode
when the windscreen washer is activated,  1 Rain sensor on; automatic wipe if neces-
to prevent the smell of the windscreen wash- sary.
er fluid entering the inside the vehicle. A Setting sensitivity level of rain sensor
● When wiping at intervals, the intervals vary – Set control to the right: high sensitivity.
according to the speed. The higher the vehi- – Set control to the left: low sensitivity.
cle speed the shorter the intervals.
When the ignition is switched off and then
Note back on, the rain sensor stays on and starts
● The wiper will try to wipe away any ob- operating again when the windscreen wipers
Fig. 99 Wiper lever: adjust the rain sensor A.
are in position 1 and the vehicle is travelling
stacles that are on the windscreen. The
wiper will stop moving if the obstacle at more than 16 km/h (10 mph).
blocks its path. Remove the obstacle and
switch the wiper back on again. Modified behaviour of the rain sensor
● If you stop the vehicle with the wind- Possible causes of faults and mistaken read-
screen wiper in position 1 or 2, it will auto- ings on the sensitive surface ››› Fig. 100 of
matically change to a lower position the rain sensor include:
speed. The set speed will be resumed when
the vehicle pulls away. ● Damaged wipers: a film of water on the
● The windscreen will be wiped again ap- damaged blades may lengthen the activa-
proximately 5 seconds after the wind- tion time, reduce the washing intervals or re-
screen washer has been activated, provi- sult in a fast and continuous wipe.
ded the vehicle is moving (“drip” function). Fig. 100 Rain sensor sensitive surface
● Insects: insects on the sensor may trigger
If you activate the wipers less than 3 sec- the windscreen wiper. »
onds after the “drip” function, a new wash
121
Operation

● Salt on the road: in winter, salt spread on


Mirrors Note
the roads may cause an excessively long
● If the light falling on the interior mirror is
wipe when the windscreen is almost dry.
Interior mirror anti-dazzle function obstructed (e.g. with the sun blind), the an-
● Dirt: dry dust, wax, coating on glass (Lotus ti-dazzle mirror with automatic adjustment
effect) or traces of detergent (car wash) may Rear view mirror with automatic anti-daz- will not operate perfectly.
reduce the effectiveness of the rain sensor or zle function ● When the interior lights are on or reverse
make it react more slowly, later or not at all. gear engaged, the mirrors do not darken
The anti-dazzle function is activated every
● Windscreen crack: the impact of a stone with automatic adjustment for anti-dazzle
time the ignition is switched on.
will trigger a single wipe cycle with the rain position.
sensor on. Next the rain sensor detects the re- When the anti-dazzle function is enabled, the ● If you have to stick any type of sticker on
duction in the sensitive surface area and interior rear vision mirror will darken auto- the windscreen, do not do so in front of the
adapts accordingly. The behaviour of the matically according to the amount of light it sensors. Doing so could prevent the anti-
sensor will vary with the size of the damage receives. The anti-dazzle function is cancel- dazzle function from working well or even
caused by the stone. led if reverse gear is engaged. from working at all.

WARNING WARNING
The rain sensor may not detect enough rain In the event that an automatic anti-dazzle Manually folding the exterior mir-
to switch on the wipers. rear vision mirror breaks, an electrolyte flu-
id may leak. This could cause irritation to
rors
● If necessary, switch on the wipers man-
the skin, eyes and respiratory organs. If you
ually when water on the windscreen ob- The exterior mirrors of the vehicle may be fol-
come into contact with this liquid, it must
structs visibility. ded in. For this, press the mirror housing to-
be rinsed with large quantities of water. If
necessary, get medial help. wards the vehicle.
Note
Note
● Clean the sensitive surface of the rain CAUTION
sensor regularly and check the blades for Before washing the vehicle with an auto-
In the event that an automatic anti-dazzle matic car wash, fold in the exterior mirrors
damage ››› Fig. 100 (arrow).
rear vision mirror breaks, an electrolyte flu- to avoid damage.
● To remove wax and coatings, we recom- id may leak. This liquid attacks plastic sur-
mend a window cleaner containing alco- faces. Clean it with a wet sponge as soon
hol. as possible.
● Do not put stickers on the windscreen in
front of the rain sensor. This may cause
sensor disruption or faults.

122
Visibility

Adjusting the exterior mirrors ● The exterior mirror heating is not activated ● When moving the mirror, take care not to
in temperatures above approximately +20°C trap fingers between the mirror and the
(+68°F). mirror bracket.

Fold the rearview mirrors when locking the


CAUTION
vehicle
● If one of the mirror housings is knocked
Button  > Settings > Mirrors and
out of position (e.g. when parking), the mir-
wipers > Mirrors in the infotainment sys- rors must first be fully retracted with the
tem can be used to have the exterior mirrors electric control. Do not readjust the mirror
fold in when the vehicle is parked and locked housing by hand, as this will interfere with
››› page 88. the mirror adjuster function.
When the vehicle is locked with the remote ● Before washing the vehicle in an auto-
Fig. 101 Detail of the driver's door: control for
control, the exterior mirrors are retracted au- matic car wash, please make sure to re-
the exterior mirror.
tomatically. When the vehicle is opened with tract the exterior mirrors to prevent them
the remote control, the exterior mirrors are from being damaged. Electrically retracta-
Turn the control to the corresponding posi-
deployed automatically. ble exterior mirrors must not be folded in or
tion:
out by hand. Always use the electrical
WARNING power control.
L/R Turning the knob to the desired position,
adjust the mirrors on the driver side (L, Convex or wide-angle exterior mirrors give
left) and the passenger side (R, right) to a larger field of vision. However, they make Note
the direction desired. objects look smaller and further away than ● If the electrical adjustment should fail to
 Folding in mirrors. they really are. If you use these mirrors to operate, both of the mirrors can be adjus-
estimate the distance to vehicles behind ted by hand by lightly pressing the edge of
Heated exterior mirrors you when changing lane, you could mis- the mirror glass.
judge the distance. Risk of accident! ● The fold-in function on the exterior mir-
● Press the demisting switch  next to the air
conditioning controls ››› page 137. rors will not activate at speeds over
WARNING 40 km/h (25 mph).
● The mirrors demist for some minutes to pre-
vent draining the battery unnecessarily. Fold and unfold the exterior mirror, taking
care to avoid injuries.
● If necessary, press the button again to re-
● Only fold or unfold the exterior mirror
peat the function.
when there is no-one in the way of the mir-
ror.

123
Operation

Sun protection ● Always store sun blinds and visors in their Seats and headrests
housing when not in use.

sun blind Adjusting seats


Manual adjustment of the front
seats

Fig. 102 Sun visor on the driver side.

Options for adjusting driver and front pas-


senger sun visors
● Lower the sun visor towards the wind-
screen. Fig. 103 Front seats: manual seat settings.
● The sun visor can be pulled out of its
mounting and turned towards the door 1 Forwards/backwards: pull the lever and
››› Fig. 102
1 . move the seat. The seat must engage
● Swing the sun visor towards the door, longi- when the lever is released!
tudinally backwards. 2 Raise/lower: pull the lever up or push
down (several times if necessary) from its
There is a vanity mirror on the sun visor, with a home position.
cover 2 .
3 Tilting the backrest: turn the hand wheel.
WARNING
WARNING
Folded sun blinds can reduce visibility.
Incorrect seat adjustment may lead to ac-
cidents and severe injuries.
124
Seats and headrests

● Only adjust the seats when the vehicle is Keep the back of your head always as close CAUTION
stationary, as the seats could move unex- to the headrest as possible.
When assembling and disassembling the
pectedly while the vehicle is in motion and
headrests, do not let them meet the top lin-
you could lose control of the vehicle. Fur- Adjusting the headrest for short people
ing of the vehicle, the back rest of the front
thermore, an incorrect position is adopted
Lower the headrest completely, even if your seat or other parts of the vehicles. If not,
when adjusting the seat.
head is below its upper edge. In the lowest this could damage the vehicle.
● Adjust the height, position and inclination position, there may be a small distance be-
of the front seats only when their move- tween the headrest and the backrest.
ment area is empty.
● Make sure there are no objects in that
Adjusting the headrests
Adjusting the headrest for tall people
area.
Push the headrest up as far as it will go.
● Make sure that the movement and lock-
ing areas of the seats are clean. WARNING
If travelling with the headrests removed or
improperly adjusted, the risk of severe or
Headrest fatal injuries in the event of accidents and
sudden braking or manoeuvres increases.
● Always travel with the headrest correctly
Introduction
installed and adjusted.
The possibilities for the adjustment and disas- ● To decrease the risk of cervical injuries in
the event of an accident, adjust the head- Fig. 104 Front seat: headrest adjustment.
sembly of the headrests are described below.
Always make sure that the seats are correctly rest correctly based on your height, always
adjusted ››› page 13. making sure that its upper edge is at the
same height as the top of the head, but
All seats are equipped with a headrest. The never below eye level. Keep the back of
central rear headrest is only intended for the your head always as close to the headrest
central seat of the rear bench. Therefore, do as possible and centred.
not install it on any other seat. ● Never adjust the headrest while the vehi-
cle is in motion.
Correct adjustment of headrest ● Under no circumstances should the rear
Adjust the headrest so that its upper edge is passengers travel while the headrests are
at the same level as the top of your head and in the non-use position.
under no circumstances below eye level. Fig. 105 Rear headrest: headrest adjustment. »
125
Operation

Adjusting the height of the headrests Removing the rear headrests


● Move the headrest up or down in the direc- To remove the headrest, the corresponding
tion of the corresponding arrow. Regarding backrest must be partially folded forward.
the rear headrest, to both raise and lower,
● Unlock the backrest ››› page 127.
press the button ››› Fig. 104 1 ; for the rear
headrests it is only necessary to press the ● Move the headrest upwards until it arrives
button ››› Fig. 105 1 to lower them ››› in to the top.
Introduction on page 125. ● Press button ››› Fig. 107 1 , while simulta-
● The headrest must lock correctly in one po- neously pressing on the security hole 2 with
sition. a flat screwdriver a maximum of 5 mm wide,
Fig. 107 Rear headrest: removal. and remove the headrest.
● Move the backrest until it engages properly
Removing the front head restraints
Removing and fitting the headrests ››› in Folding down and raising the rear
● Lower the head restraint if necessary.
seat backrest on page 127.
● To unlock it, look for the rabbet on the bot-
tom of the backrest and press in the direction Fitting the rear headrests
of the arrow ››› Fig. 106 1 .
To mount the external headrests, the corre-
● Remove the head restraint in the direction sponding backrest must be partially folded
of the arrow 2 . forward.

Fitting the front head restraints ● Unlock the backrest ››› page 127.

● Place the head restraint in the correct posi- ● Insert the headrest bars into the guides until
tion on the guides of the corresponding back- they perceptibly engage. It should not be
rest and insert it. possible to remove the headrest from the
Fig. 106 Front headrest: removal. backrest.
● Press the head restraint downwards until
the bars lock. ● Move the backrest until it engages properly

● Adjust the head restraint according to the


››› in Folding down and raising the rear
seat backrest on page 127.
instructions on the correct position of the
seat.

126
Seats and headrests

WARNING down. The rear seat backrest is not engaged ● When the rear seat backrest is lowered or
when the red marking of the button 2 is visi- is not properly engaged nobody else can
Remove the rear headrests only when it is
ble. travel in the corresponding seats (not even
necessary to fit a child seat. After removing
a child).
a child seat, refit the headrest immediately.
Converting the table to a seat
● Raise and lock in the back rest. The red CAUTION
marking on the tab 2 should no longer be
Serious damage can be caused to the vehi-
Seat functions visible when the backrest is properly secured. cle and other objects if the rear seat back-
rest is lowered or lifted without due care
Folding down and raising the rear WARNING and attention.
seat backrest Serious injuries can be caused if the rear ● Before lowering the rear seat backrest,
seat backrest is lowered or lifted without always adjust the front seats so that nei-
due care and attention. ther the headrests nor the cushions of the
● Never lower or lift the rear seat backrest rear backrest can hit them.
while driving.
● Do no trap or damage the seat belt when
raising the rear seat backrest.
● When lowering or lifting the rear seat
backrest, keep your hands, fingers, feet
and other body parts out of its path.
● For the rear seat belts to offer the neces-
sary protection all the parts of the rear
Fig. 108 Rear seat: folding the backrest. backrest must be properly engaged. This is
particularly important in the case of the
On split rear seats, the backrest can be low- centre rear seat. If someone is seated in a
ered in two sections. seat whose backrest is not properly engag-
ed they will fly forward, along with the
Folding the backrest forwards backrest, during an accident or a sudden
driving or braking manoeuvre.
● Completely lower the rear headrests
● A red signal on the button 2 warns that
››› page 125.
the backrest is not engaged. Always check
● Press the unlock button ››› Fig. 108 1 for-
that the red marking is not visible when the
wards and at the same time fold the backrest backrest is in the upright position.
127
Operation

Transport and practical ● In vehicles equipped with tyre control sys-


tem, adjust to the new load status if necessa-
WARNING

equipment ry ››› page 295. The transport of heavy object changes ve-
hicle handling and increases braking dis-
tance. Heavy objects that are not properly
WARNING
Storing objects placed or secured may cause loss of con-
Loose or unsecured objects can cause seri- trol of the vehicle and thus severe injuries.
ous injury in case of sudden manoeuvring ● Never put too much load in the vehicle.
Positioning the luggage and cargo or braking or in case of an accident. Partic-
Both the carrying capacity as well as the
ularly if the airbag hits them when deploy-
It is possible to carry objects and luggage in distribution of the load in the vehicle have
ing and they are thrown across the inside of
effects on the driving behaviour and brak-
the vehicle, in a trailer ››› page 256 and on the vehicle. Please observe the following
ing ability.
the roof ››› page 132. When doing so, please rules to minimise the risk of injury:
consider all legal provisions. ● When transporting heavy objects, the
● Place all objects inside the vehicle safe-
driving behaviour of the vehicle varies due
ly.
to the displacement of the centre of gravi-
Placing luggage inside the vehicle safely
● Secure all objects, little and large. ty.
● Distribute the load in the vehicle as evenly
● Place the objects in the cabin in such a ● Always distribute the load in the vehicle
as possible. way that they can never reach the airbag as evenly and horizontally as possible.
● Always place equipment and heavy ob- deployment areas while the vehicle is in ● Always place heavy objects in the boot
jects in the boot ››› . motion.
before the rear axle and as far away from it
● Position heavy items in the boot as far for- ● Keep the storage compartments closed as possible.
ward as possible. at all times while the vehicle is in motion. ● Objects in the luggage compartment
● Take into account the maximum authorised ● Place the objects in such a way that they that are unsecured could move suddenly
weight per axle, as well as the maximum au- never force any occupant of the vehicle to and modify the handling of the vehicle.
sit in an incorrect position.
thorised weight of the vehicle ››› page 316. ● Adapt your speed and driving style at all
● When transporting objects that take up a times to suit visibility, weather, road and
● Secure the objects to the fastening rings of
seat, never let anyone use that seat. traffic conditions.
the boot using appropriate chains or belts
● Never leave hard, sharp or heavy objects ● Accelerate with particular care and cau-
››› page 131.
loose in open storage compartment of the tion.
● Also place small objects safely.
vehicle, on the cover behind the rear seat ● Avoid sudden braking and manoeuvres.
● Adapt tyre pressure to the load. Take into or on the dashboard.
● Brake earlier than usual.
account the pressure adhesive of the tyres ● Remove all hard, sharp or heavy objects
››› page 291. from the fabrics and bags inside the cabin
and store them safely.
128
Transport and practical equipment

WARNING Luggage compartment ● Remove the rear shelf from the side sup-
ports ››› Fig. 110 by pulling it upwards and
● Never leave your vehicle unattended, es-
then take it out.
pecially when the rear lid is open. Children Luggage compartment shelf
could climb into the luggage compartment,
Storing the rear shelf
closing the door behind them; they will be
trapped and run the risk of death. Depending on the equipment, once the lug-
● Close and lock all the doors and the rear gage compartment shelf has been removed,
lid when you leave the vehicle. Before you it can be stored under the boot's variable
lock the vehicle, make sure that there are floor ››› page 130.
no adults or children in the vehicle.
● Remove the side cover sliding it upwards
and place the shelf in the bottom.
CAUTION
● Replace the side cover.
Electrical wires or, depending on the fea-
tures, the antenna embedded into the rear To remove it proceed in reverse order.
windows could be damaged, even irrepara- Fig. 109 In the luggage compartment: remov-
bly, if they are in contact with objects. ing and fitting the shelf.
Fitting
● Insert the cover horizontally so that the “re-
Note cess” fits onto the axis of the supports
Straps for securing the load to the fasten- ››› Fig. 110 and press down until it engages.
ing rings are commercially available from ● Hook the loops ››› Fig. 109 B to the rear lid.
accessory shops.
WARNING
Animals, loose or unsecured or objects car-
ried on the rear shelf can cause serious in-
jury in case of sudden manoeuvring or
braking or in case of an accident.
Fig. 110 In the luggage compartment: remov- ● Do not leave hard, sharp or heavy ob-
ing and fitting the shelf. jects or in bags on the rear shelf.

Removing ● Never transport animals on the rear shelf. »


● Detach the cord loops ››› Fig. 109 B from
their hooks A .
129
Operation

CAUTION Variable luggage compartment


● Before closing the rear lid, ensure that floor
the rear shelf is correctly fitted.
● An overloaded luggage compartment
could mean that the rear shelf is not cor-
rectly seated and it may be bent or dam-
aged.
● If the luggage compartment is overloa-
ded, remove the tray.

Fig. 112 Variable luggage compartment floor:


Note inclined position.
Ensure that, when placing items of clothing
Variable floor in high position
on the luggage compartment cover, rear
visibility is not reduced. ● To move from the low position to the high
position, lift the floor using the handle
››› Fig. 111 1 , and pull it back until the front of
the floor has fully passed the supports 2 .
● Move the floor forward over the supports as
far as the rear seat backrest and then lower
the floor with the handle 1 .

Variable floor in low position


Fig. 111 Variable luggage compartment floor:
● To move from the high position to the low
 raised position;  lowered position.
position, lift the floor using the handle
››› Fig. 111 1 , and pull it back until the front of
the floor has fully passed the supports 2 .
● Now let the front part fall to the floor and
slide the floor forwards as far as the rear seat
backrest; lower the floor at the same time
with the handle 1 .

130
Transport and practical equipment

Variable floor in the tilted position guide it downwards in a controlled manner. ● Always use belts or straps that are suita-
When the variable floor is tilted you can ac- Otherwise, the lining and the floor of the ble and in good condition.
cess the spare wheel or anti-puncture kit luggage compartment could be damaged. ● Tighten the belts and straps in a cross
area. layout over the load placed on the boot
floor and secure them to the fastening rings
● Lift the variable floor in the high position us- safely.
ing handle ››› Fig. 111 1 , pull it up and push it
Fastening rings
● Never exceed the maximum tensile load
towards the backrest of the rear seats until it
of the fastening rings when securing ob-
folds along the hinge line and the movable jects.
part of the floor is resting on itself.
● Make sure that, particularly for flat ob-
● Rest the floor on its housings ››› Fig. 112 (ar- jects, the upper edge of the load is higher
rows). than the fastening rings.
● Depending on the features, take into ac-
WARNING count the instruction panels on the boot on
● Always secure objects, even when the how to place the load.
luggage compartment floor is properly lif- ● Never secure a child seat to the fastening
ted. rings.
● Only objects that do not protrude more Fig. 113 Location of fastening rings in luggage
than 2/3 the height of the floor may be car- compartment.
Note
ried between the rear seat and the raised
luggage compartment floor. There are fastening rings ››› Fig. 113 on the ● The maximum tensile load that the fas-

● Only objects that do not weigh than ap- front and rear of the boot to secure loose ob- tening rings can support is approx. 3.5 kN.
proximately 7.5 kg may be carried between jects and luggage with fastening belts and ● Belts, straps and securing systems for the
the rear seat and the raised luggage com- cords. appropriate load can be obtained from
partment floor. specialised dealerships. SEAT recom-
WARNING mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this.

CAUTION If unsuitable or damaged belts or retaining


straps are used, they could break in the
● The maximum weight that can be loaded
event of braking or an accident. Objects
on the luggage compartment variable floor
could then be launched across the passen-
in the top position is 100 kg.
ger compartment and cause serious or fa-
● Do not let the luggage compartment tal injuries.
floor fall when closing it. Always carefully

131
Operation

Roof carrier CAUTION Securing the crossbars and the


● Remove the cross bars and the roof carri- roof carrier system
Introduction er system before entering a car wash.
● Vehicle height is increased by the instal-
The vehicle roof has been designed to opti- lation of cross bars or a roof carrier system
mise aerodynamics. For this reason, cross and the load secured on them. For this pur-
bars or conventional roof carrier systems pose, check that your vehicle's height does
cannot be secured to the roof water drains. not surpass the headspace limit, for exam-
ple, for underpasses or for entering garage
As the roof water drains are integrated in the
doors.
roof to reduce air resistance, only SEAT-ap-
● Any cross bars, roof carrier systems or
proved cross bars and roof carrier systems
can be used. loads secured to them must not interfere
with the roof aerial or block the path of the
rear lid.
Cases in which cross bars and the roof
● On opening the rear lid make sure that it
carrier system should be disassembled. Fig. 114 Attachment points for the roof railings
does not knock into the roof load.
● When they are not used. for the roof carrier system.
● When the vehicle is washed in a car wash.
For the sake of the environment The crossbars are the basis of a series of
● When the vehicle height exceeds the maxi- special roof carrier systems. For safety rea-
When cross bars and a roof carrier system
mum height, for example, in some garages. are installed, the increased air resistance
sons, special fixtures must be used to safely
means that the vehicle uses more fuel. transport luggage, bicycles, skis, surf boards
WARNING or boats on the roof. Suitable accessories
● Always secure the load properly using can be acquired at SEAT dealerships.
belts or retaining straps that are suitable Always secure the crossbars and the roof
and in a good condition. carrier system properly. Always take the as-
● Bulky, heavy, long or flat loads have a sembly instructions that come with the cross-
negative effect on aerodynamics, the cen- bars and the roof carrier system in question
tre of gravity and driving performance. into account.
● Avoid sudden braking and manoeuvres.
The crossbars are assembled on the roof rail-
● Adapt your speed and driving style at all ings. The distance between cross bars
times to suit visibility, weather, road and
traffic conditions.

132
Transport and practical equipment

››› Fig. 114 A should be 75 cm and the dis- Maximum authorised cargo on the roof WARNING
tance between the cross bars and the brack- The maximum authorised cargo permitted for ● Never exceed the maximum authorised
ets of the roof railings B should be 5 cm. transporting on the roof is 75 kg. This figure load on the roof and on the axles or the ve-
comes from the combined weight of the roof hicle's maximum authorised weight.
WARNING carrier, the cross bars and the load itself on ● Never exceed the load capacity of the
Incorrect attachment and use of the cross- the roof ››› . cross bars and the roof carrier system,
bars and the roof carrier system may cause
Always check the weight of the roof carrier even if the maximum authorised roof load
the whole system to detach from the roof
system, the cross bars and the weight of the has not been reached.
and cause an accident and injuries.
load to be transported and weigh them if ● Secure heavy items as far forward as
● Always take the manufacturer assembly
necessary. Never exceed the maximum au- possible and distribute the vehicle load
instructions into account.
thorised roof load. uniformly.
● Check threaded joints and attachments
travelling and if necessary tighten them af- If you are using cross bars and a roof carrier
ter you have travelled a short distance. with a lower weight rating, you will not be WARNING
When making long trips, check the threa- able to carry the maximum authorised roof If the load is loose or not secured, it could
ded joints whenever you stop for a rest. load. In this case, do not exceed the maxi- fall from the roof carrier system or cause
● Do not modify or repair the crossbars or mum weight limit for the roof carrier which is accidents and injuries.
roof carrier system. listed in the fitting instructions. ● Always use belts or retaining straps that
are suitable and in a good condition.
Distributing a load
Note
Distribute loads uniformly and secure them
Always read the assembly instructions that
correctly ››› .
come with the crossbars and the roof carri- Storage compartment
er system carefully and keep them in the
vehicle. Check attachments
Once the cross bars and roof carrier system
Introduction
have been installed, check the bolted con-
Use the storage compartments only for small
nections and attachments after a short jour-
Loading the roof carrier system or light items.
ney and subsequently with a certain frequen-
The load can only be secured if the crossbars cy.
WARNING
and the roof carrier system are properly in-
Objects inside the vehicle that are not se-
stalled ››› . »
cured could be thrown across the cabin in

133
Operation

the event of sudden braking or manoeu- could lead to severe burns and damage to Glove compartment
vring. This may cause severe injuries as the vehicle.
well as loss of control of the vehicle. ● Before moving a seat, make sure there
● Do not carry animals or sharp, hard or are no lighters in the moving part area of
heavy items in open storage compartments the vehicle.
of the vehicle, on the dashboard or on the ● Before closing a storage compartment,
cover behind the rear seats, or inside make sure there are no lighters in the clos-
pieces of clothing or bags inside the vehi- ing area.
cle.
● Never leave a lighter inside a storage
● Keep the storage compartments closed
compartment or any other surface of the
at all times while the vehicle is in motion. vehicle as it could ignite due to the high
temperatures on such surfaces, particular-
WARNING ly during the summer. Fig. 115 On the front passenger side: glove
compartment.
Objects in the driver's footwell could diffi-
cult the use of the pedals. This may cause CAUTION This compartment can hold documents in A4
loss of control of the vehicle and increases ● Do not store heat- or cold-sensitive ob- format, a water bottle of 1.5 L, etc.
the risk of severe injuries. jects, food or medicines in the cabin. Heat
● Make sure that nothing prevents you from and cold could damage them or render Opening and closing the glove compart-
using the pedals at any time. them useless. ment
● Always secure the mat in the footwell. ● Objects made from transparent materi-
Opening: Pull the handle ››› Fig. 115 and open
● Never place other mats or other type of als left inside the vehicle, such as glasses,
the glove compartment.
covers on the factory-fitted mat. magnifying glasses or transparent suction
pads stuck to the windows can concentrate Closing: Press the glove compartment up-
● Ensure that no objects can fall into the
sunlight and damage the vehicle. wards.
driver's footwell while the vehicle is in mo-
tion.
WARNING
● When the vehicle is stationary, remove
the objects in the footwell. If the glove compartment is left open, the
risk of causing severe injuries in the event
of an accident, sudden braking or manoeu-
WARNING vring increases.
If you leave lighters inside the vehicle, they ● Always keep the glove compartment
might be damaged or lit inadvertently. This closed while the vehicle is in motion.

134
Transport and practical equipment

Object holder under front seats CAUTION Drink holder


The drawer can contain 1.5 kg at most.
Introduction

Bottle holder
Other object holders
The storage compartments of the driver and
You will find more object holders, compart- passenger doors contain a bottle holder.
ments and supports in other parts of the vehi-
cle: WARNING
Incorrect use of the bottle holders may
● In the centre console.
cause injuries.
● Inside the central armrest.
Fig. 116 Storage compartment under the right ● Never put hot drinks in the drink holders.
front passenger seat. ● Other storage compartments are found in In the event of sudden braking or an acci-
the rear seat, to the left and the right of the dent while driving, hot beverages in the
Opening: Press the tab on the drawer handle seats. bottle holders might spill and cause burns.
and take the drawer out. ● There is a storage pocket on the rear of the ● Ensure that no bottles or other objects
Closing: Push the drawer under the seat until front seats. are dropped in the driver footwell while
it engages. driving, as they could get under the pedals
CAUTION and obstruct their working.
Depending on the equipment, under the driv- ● Never place glasses, food or other heavy
er's seat there may be a magazine holder Do not place overly large objects in the
pockets on the front seat backrests (e.g. objects drink holders. These heavy objects
(about the size of the instruction manual) in- may be thrown across the cabin in the
stead of the storage compartment. bottles) or objects with sharp edges. Risk
of damage to the pockets and the uphols- event of an accident and cause serious in-
tery. juries.
WARNING
If the drawer is left open, it could prevent WARNING
use of the pedals. This may cause serious
accidents and injuries. Closed bottles may explode inside the ve-
hicle due to cold or heat.
● Always keep the drawer closed while the
● Never leave closed bottles in the vehicle
vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, the drawer
and any objects in it could fall into the driv- if the temperature inside is very high or very
er's footwell and obstruct the pedals. low. »
135
Operation

CAUTION Power sockets there is a possibility that they may be in-


jured.
Do not leave open cans in the drink holders
when the vehicle is in motion. If the drink is Vehicle power sockets
spilled (e.g. due to sudden braking) it may CAUTION
damage the vehicle and its electrical sys-
Always use the correct type of plugs to
tem.
avoid damaging the sockets.

Note
Note
The inside elements of the drink holders
● The use of electrical appliances with the
can be extracted for cleaning.
engine switched off will cause a battery
discharge.
● Should the connected appliance over-
Front drink holders heat, immediately switch it off and discon-
Fig. 118 Front power socket. nect it from the socket.
● Before switching the ignition on or off, un-
● Remove the plug from the socket located in plug the appliances from the USB ports to
the centre console ››› Fig. 118. protect them from any damage caused by
● Insert the plug of the electrical appliance fluctuations in voltage.
into the power socket.

Electrical equipment can be connected to


the 12 volt power socket.
The appliances connected to each power
socket must not exceed a power rating of 120
Fig. 117 Front drink holders in the centre con-
Watt.
sole.

In the central console, next to the hand brake, WARNING


there are two drinks holders ››› Fig. 117. The power socket works only when the igni-
tion is on. Improper use may cause serious
injury or even fire. Children should there-
fore not be left in the vehicle unattended if
the button is also left behind. Otherwise
136
Air conditioning

Air conditioning The dust and pollen filter must be changed


regularly so that air conditioner performance
● Never leave the fresh air fan turned off or
use the air recirculation for long periods of
is not adversely affected. time; the air in the vehicle interior will not
Heating, ventilation and If the filter loses efficiency prematurely due to be refreshed.

cooling use in areas with very high levels of air pollu-


tion, the filter must be changed more fre- CAUTION
Introduction quently than stated in the Service Schedule. ● To replace the pollen filter, always visit a
service centre.
Depending on the vehicle’s equipment, sever- WARNING
● Switch the climate control or air condi-
al systems may have been fitted: Reduced visibility through the windows in- tioner off if you think it may be broken. This
creases the risk of serious accidents. will avoid additional damage. Have the cli-
● The heating and ventilation heats and
● Always ensure that all windows are free mate control or air conditioning checked
ventilates the passenger compartment. It by a specialised workshop.
of ice and snow, and that they are not fog-
cannot cool.
ged, so as to maintain good visibility of ev- ● Repairs to the climate control or air con-
● The manual air conditioning and the Cli- erything outside. ditioning require specialist knowledge and
matronic cool and dehumidify the air. They ● Only drive when you have good visibility. special tools. SEAT recommends visiting a
operate most effectively with the windows SEAT Official Service.
● Always ensure that you use the air condi-
and the sunroof closed.
tioning, heater or rear window heating to
To switch a specific function on, press the ap- maintain good visibility to the outside. Note
propriate button. Press the button again to ● Never leave the air recirculation on for a ● When the cooling system is turned off, air
switch off the function. long period of time. If the cooling system is coming from the outside will not be dried.
switched off and air recirculation mode To prevent fogging of the windows, SEAT
The LED on each control lights up to indicate switched on, the windows can mist over recommends leaving the cooling system
that the respective function of a control has very quickly, considerably limiting visibility. (compressor) turned on. To do this, press
been switched on.
● Switch air recirculation mode off when it the  button. The button lamp should
is not required. light up.
Dust and pollen filter
● The maximum heat output required to de-
The dust and pollen filter with its activated frost windows as quickly as possible is only
WARNING
charcoal cartridge serves as a barrier available when the engine has reached its
against impurities in the air taken into the ve- Stuffy or used air will increase fatigue and normal running temperature.
hicle interior. reduce driver concentration possibly re-
● Keep the air intake slots in front of the
sulting in a serious accident.
windscreen free of snow, ice and leaves to »
137
Operation

ensure heating and cooling are not im- ● Do not smoke while air recirculation a Technical Service should be consulted to
paired, and to prevent the windows from mode is on, as smoke drawn into the air check the system.
misting over. conditioning system leaves residue on the ● When the engine is under extreme strain,
● The air from the vents flows through the evaporator, producing a permanent un- switch off the compressor for a moment.
vehicle interior and is extracted by slots in pleasant odour.
the luggage compartment designed for this ● It is advisable to turn on the air condition-
purpose. Therefore, you should avoid ob- ing at least once a month, to lubricate the
structing these slots with any kind of ob- system gaskets and prevent leaks. If a de-
ject. crease in the cooling capacity is detected,

Climatronic control

Fig. 119 In the centre console: Climatronic con-


trols.

Automatic mode  Temperature 1 / 2 for the passenger side to set a different tem-
Automatic adjustment of temperature, fan, The temperature of the right and left sides perature.
and air distribution. Automatic mode is disa- can be adjusted separately using the adjust-
bled when the ventilation is modified manual- ers. The selected temperature is shown on Blower 
ly. the display of the climate control panel. The power of the fan is automatically adjus-
ted.
Synchronisation: press button  so that
Cooling mode 
settings on the driver's side apply to the pas- Press the buttons to manually adjust the fan.
Press the button to switch on or off the cool- senger side. Use the temperature regulator
ing system.
138
Air conditioning

Air distribution  /  /  is automatically switched off. To defrost the To avoid possible damage to the battery, an
The airflow adjusts automatically for comfort. windscreen more quickly, the air is dehumidi- automatic temporary disconnection of this
It can also be manually distributed to the de- fied at temperatures over approximately function is possible, coming back on when
sired zone by pressing the corresponding +3°C (+38°F) and the fan runs at maximum normal operating conditions are re-establish-
button: output. ed.

 The airflow is directed towards the chest Heated rear window  Air recirculation 
 The airflow is directed towards the foot- This only works when the engine is running ››› page 141
well. and switches off automatically after a maxi-
 The airflow is directed at the windscreen. mum of 10 minutes. Seat heating  
It should be switched off as soon as the glass ››› page 142
Defrost/demist function  is demisted. By saving electrical power you
The air drawn in from outside the vehicle is di- can also save fuel. Switching off
rected at the windscreen and air recirculation Press button  or manually set the fan to .

Manual air conditioning controls / Heating and fresh air system

Fig. 120 In the centre console:  controls for the manual air conditioning;  heating and fresh air system controls. »

139
Operation

Cooling mode  fan power to clear the windscreen of con- Economic use of the air conditioning
Manual air conditioning: Press the button to densation as soon as possible. To dehumidify When the air conditioning is switched on, the
switch on or off the cooling system. the air, the cooling system will automatically compressor consumes engine power and has
switch on. influence on fuel consumption.
Temperature 1
Heated rear window  The air conditioner operates most effectively
Turn the control to adjust the temperature. with the windows and the panoramic sliding
This only works when the engine is running
sunroof closed. However, if the vehicle has
Heating and fresh air system: The tempera- and switches off automatically after a maxi-
heated up after standing in the sun for some
ture cannot be lower than that of the exterior mum of 10 minutes.
time, the air inside can be cooled more quick-
air temperature, as this system cannot cool or
It should be switched off as soon as the glass ly by opening the windows and the panoram-
dehumidify the air.
is demisted. By saving electrical power you ic sliding sunroof briefly.
can also save fuel.
Blower 
Change the temperature unit (Climatron-
Turning the regulator 2 sets the fan power. To avoid possible damage to the battery, an
ic)
automatic temporary disconnection of this
At level 0 the fan and manual air conditioning function is possible, coming back on when The temperature display can be changed
are disconnected. Level 4 is the maximum. normal operating conditions are re-establish- from Celsius to Fahrenheit on the screen of
ed. the Infotainment system using the Infotain-
Air distribution  / /  /  /  ment button  /  >  Settings > Units.
Turning regulator 3 distributes the air to the Air recirculation 
desired zone: The cooling system cannot be activated
››› page 141
If the air conditioning system cannot be
 The airflow is directed towards the chest
Seat heating   switched on, this may be caused by the fol-
 The airflow is directed towards the foot- lowing:
well. ››› page 142
● The engine is not running.
 The airflow is directed towards the wind-
screen and the footwell area. ● The fan is switched off.
Climate control usage instructions ● The air conditioner fuse has blown.
Defrost/demist function  ● The outside temperature is lower than ap-
The interior cooling system only works when
Manual air conditioning: When control 3 is in the engine is running and fan is switched on. proximately +3°C (+38°F).
position  the air flow is directed at the wind-
screen and air recirculation is disconnected
automatically or not activated. Increase the
140
Air conditioning

● The air conditioner compressor has been ● Change the air direction using the ventila- WARNING
temporarily switched off because the engine tion grille lever.
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Intro-
coolant temperature is too high.
There are other additional, non-adjustable air duction on page 137.
● Another fault in the vehicle. Have the air
vents in the dash panel, in the footwells and in ● If the cooling system is switched off and
conditioner checked by a specialised work-
the rear area of the passenger compartment. air recirculation mode switched on, the
shop.
windows can mist over very quickly, con-
Note siderably limiting visibility.
Special characteristics
Food, medicine and other heat or cold sen- ● Switch air recirculation mode off when it
If the humidity and temperature outside the sitive objects should never be placed in is not required.
vehicle are high, condensation can drip off front of the air outlets as they may be dam-
the evaporator in the cooling system and aged or made unsuitable for use by the air. CAUTION
form a pool underneath the vehicle. This is
normal and does not indicate a leak! Do not smoke when air recirculation is
switched on in vehicles with an air condi-
Note Air recirculation  tioner. The smoke taken in could lie on the
cooling system vaporiser and on the acti-
After starting the engine, any residual hu- Air recirculation mode prevents the ambient vated charcoal cartridge of the dust and
midity in the air conditioner could mist over air from entering the interior. pollen filter, leading to a permanently un-
the windscreen. Switch on the defrost func- pleasant smell.
tion as soon as possible to clear the wind- When the outside temperature is very high,
screen of condensation. selecting manual air recirculation mode for a
short period refreshes the vehicle interior Note
more quickly. Climatronic: air recirculation mode is acti-
vated to prevent exhaust gas or unpleasant
Air vents For safety reasons, air recirculation mode is
switched off when the button  is pressed odours from entering the vehicle interior
when it is in reverse and while the automat-
To ensure proper heating, cooling and venti- or the air distributor is turned to .
ic windscreen wiper is working.
lation in the vehicle interior, the air vents must
remain open. Switching the manual air recirculation
mode on and off Note
● To close the air vents on the left side, move
● Press the button  to connect or discon- If the temperature regulator is turned to the
the corresponding diffuser vent lever fully to
nect manual air recirculation. coldest setting (blue point), the air recircu-
the right. To close the air vents on the rights
lation function and the  button are auto-
side, move the corresponding diffuser vent
matically activated. »
lever fully to the left.
141
Operation

● If the function is not deactivated by WARNING ● Liquids, sharps objects and insulating
pressing the button, it will deactivate after materials (e.g. covers or child seats) can
People who cannot perceive pain or tem-
approximately 20 minutes. damage the seat heating.
perature because of medications, paralysis
or chronic diseases (e.g. diabetes) or have ● In the event of smells, switch off the seat
a limited perception of these, may suffer heating immediately and have it inspected
Seat heating burns to the back, buttocks or legs when by a specialised workshop.
using seat heating.
The seat cushions can be heated electrically ● People with limited pain and temperature For the sake of the environment
when the ignition is switched on. The backrest thresholds must never use seat heating.
The seat heating should remain on only
is also heated in some versions. ● If an abnormality in the device's temper- when needed. Otherwise, it is an unneces-
ature control is detected, have it checked sary fuel waste.
Control seat heating by a specialist workshop.
● Press buttons  or  on the control panel
to turn on the seat heating as high as possi- WARNING
ble.
If the fabric of the cushion is wet, this can
● Press buttons  or  repeatedly to adjust it adversely affect the operation of the seat
to the required level. heating, increasing the risk of burns.
● To turn off the seat heating, press button  ● Make sure the seat cushion is dry prior to
or  repeatedly until no LEDs are lit. using the seat heater.
● Do not sit on the seat with clothing that is
Cases in which the heat seating should wet or damp.
not be switched on ● Do not leave clothing that is wet or damp
Do not switch the seat heating on if any of the on the seat.
following conditions are met: ● Do not spill liquid on the seat.

● The seat is not occupied.


CAUTION
● The seat has a cover.
● To avoid damaging the heating elements
● A child seat has been installed on the seat.
of the seat heaters, please do not kneel on
● The seat cushion is wet or damp. the seat or apply sharp pressure to a single
● The outdoor or indoor temperature is great- point on the seat cushion or backrest.
er than +25°C (77°F).

142
Introduction

Infotainment system Current documentation attached Radio stations and owners of data media and
audio sources are responsible for the infor-
For using infotainment and its components,
take into account, together with this instruc- mation they transmit.
Introduction tion manual, the following documentation: Bear in mind that parking lots, tunnels, tall
buildings, mountains or due to the operation
● Supplements to your vehicle’s on-board
of other electrical devices, such as chargers,
First steps documentation.
can also interfere with the reception of the ra-
● Instruction Manual of the mobile phone de- dio signal.
Introduction vice or audio sources.
Foils or adhesives with metallic layers on the
● Operating instructions for data media and
Infotainment functions and settings depend antenna and on the window panes can inter-
external players. fere with radio reception.
on the country and equipment
● Manuals for the Infotainment accessories
Before first use subsequently installed or used additionally. WARNING
Before the first use, bear in mind the following ● Description of services when running SEAT The infotainment central computer is inter-
points, to take full advantage of the functions CONNECT services. connected with the control units mounted
and settings offered: on the vehicle. Therefore, there is a serious
danger of accident and injury if the central
● Observe the basic safety warnings computer is repaired or disassembled and
Safety instructions reassembled incorrectly.
››› page 143.
● Reset the Infotainment factory settings. Some function areas may include links to ● Never replace the central computer with
third-party websites. SEAT, S.A. is not the another used, recycled or from another ve-
● Search and store favourite radio stations on
owner of the third-party websites accessible hicle at the end of its useful life.
the preset buttons so you can tune them
through the links, and assumes no liability for ● The repair or disassembly and reassem-
quickly.
their content. bly of the central computer should only be
● Use only suitable audio sources and data carried out at specialised workshops. SEAT
media. Some function areas may include outside in- recommends visiting a SEAT dealership for
formation from third-party providers. SEAT, this.
● Pair a mobile phone to use phone manage-
S.A. is not responsible for such information
ment through the Infotainment system.
being correct, up-to-date or complete, or for
● Use current maps for navigation. ensuring it does not infringe the rights of third
WARNING
● Register in SEAT CONNECT to run the cor- parties. The factory assembled radio with integra-
responding services. ted software is interconnected with the
control units mounted on the vehicle. »
143
Infotainment system

Therefore, there is a serious danger of acci- at all times (e.g. emergency services si- connected to the telephone interface of
dent and injury if the radio is repaired or rens). the vehicle, inside it there is an “unlocked”
disassembled and reassembled incorrect- ● Hearing may be impaired if using too high SIM card with sufficient balance to make
ly. a volume setting, even if only for short peri- calls and with sufficient network signal
● Never replace the radio with another ra- ods of time. coverage.
dio that is used, recycled or from another
vehicle at the end of its useful life. WARNING
WARNING
● The repair or disassembly and reassem-
The following circumstances may result in Read and observe the operating instruc-
bly of the radio should only be carried out tions provided by the manufacturer in
at specialised workshops. SEAT recom- an emergency call, phone call or data
transmission not being made or being inter- question when using mobile phone devices,
mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this. data media, external devices, external au-
rupted:
dio and multimedia sources.
● When in areas with zero or insufficient
WARNING
mobile telephony or GPS signal. Also in
Any distraction affecting the driver in any tunnels, confined areas between very tall WARNING
way can lead to an accident and cause in- buildings, garages, underpasses, moun- Position the connection cables of the audio
juries. Reading the information on the tains and valleys. sources and external devices so that they
screen and managing the infotainment sys- ● When in areas with sufficient mobile do not interfere with the driver.
tem can distract your attention from traffic phone or GPS signal, the telephony net-
and cause an accident. work of the telecommunications provider
● Always drive as carefully and responsibly
WARNING
has interference or is not available.
as possible. ● When the vehicle components necessary When changing or connecting an audio or
to make emergency calls, phone calls and multimedia source may cause sudden
to transmit data are damaged, do not work changes in the volume.
WARNING
or do not have sufficient electrical power. ● Lower the volume before connecting or
Connecting, inserting or removing an audio switching to audio or multimedia sources.
● When the battery of the mobile phone
source or data media while driving can dis-
tract your attention from the traffic and device is discharged or its charge level is
cause an accident. insufficient. WARNING
If mobile phone and radiocommunication
WARNING WARNING devices are used without connection to an
In some countries and some telephone net- external antenna, the maximum electro-
Select volume settings that allow you to magnetic radiation levels inside the vehicle
easily hear signals from outside the vehicle works it is only possible to make an emer-
gency call, if a mobile telephone device is might be surpassed, thus posing a risk to
the health of the driver and passengers.
144
Introduction

This is also the case if the external antenna WARNING ● When the speakers and the vehicle com-
has not been correctly installed. ponents necessary for radio reception are
The centre armrest may obstruct the driv-
● Keep a distance of at least 20 centime- damaged, do not work or do not have suffi-
er's arm movements, which could cause an
tres between the antennas of the mobile cient electrical power.
accident and severe injuries.
phone device and an active medical de- ● Keep the storage compartments of the
● When the infotainment is switched off.
vice, such as a pacemaker, as mobile
centre armrest closed at all times while the
phones might alter the functioning of these
vehicle is in motion. WARNING
devices.
● Do not carry a mobile phone switched on Switch off mobile phone devices in areas
very close or directly on top of an active
WARNING with a risk of explosion!
medical device, for instance in a chest If the light conditions are not good and the
pocket. screen is damaged or dirty, the indications WARNING
● Immediately turn off the mobile phone if and information displayed on the screen
The driving recommendations and traffic
you suspect it is causing interferences in an may not be read or be read incorrectly.
indications shown on the navigation system
active medical device or any other medical ● The indications and information dis- may differ from the current traffic situation.
device. played on the screen should never induce
● Traffic signs, signalling systems, traffic
to take any risk that compromises safety.
regulations and local circumstances pre-
The screen is not a replacement for driver
WARNING vail over driving recommendations and
awareness.
Mobile phones, external devices and ac- navigation system indications.
cessories that are loose or not properly se- ● Adapt your speed and driving style to suit
cured could move around the passenger
WARNING visibility, weather, road and traffic condi-
compartment during a sudden driving or Radio stations can transmit disaster or haz- tions.
braking manoeuvre or an accident and ard announcements. The following condi- ● Certain circumstances can significantly
cause damage or injury. tions prevent such notices from being re- initially planned lengthen both the duration
● Set mobile phone devices, external devi- ceived or issued: of the trip and the route to the destination,
ces and their accessories outside the air- ● When in areas with zero or insufficient ra- or even temporarily prevent navigation to
bag deployment areas or store them se- dio signal. Also in tunnels, confined areas it, for example, if a road is closed to traffic.
curely. between very tall buildings, garages, un-
derpasses, mountains and valleys.
Note
● When the frequency bands of the radio
In areas where special regulations apply or
station have interference or are not availa-
the use of mobile phones is forbidden, the
ble in areas with sufficient radio signal re-
mobile device in question must be switched
ception.
off at all times. The radiation produced by »
145
Infotainment system

a mobile phone device when switched on


may interfere with sensitive technical and
medical equipment, possibly resulting in
malfunction or damage to the equipment.

Note
If the playback volume is excessive or dis-
torted, the speakers may be damaged.

146
Introduction

Overview and controls


Connect System

Fig. 121 Overview of the controls

1 Touch screen. The infotainment functions 4 Turn volume up 7 HOME button.


can be used through the screen. 5 Turn volume down : main menu with widget views.
2 Navigation Menu ››› page 176 6 Turn the infotainment on/off : main menu in mosaic mode.
3 Full Link menu ››› page 160

147
Infotainment system

Media System

Fig. 122 Overview: control unit and indication in


the 8.25-inch version

1 Touch screen. The infotainment functions 9 Vehicle settings ››› page 92


can be used through the screen.
2 Rotary push button (to adjust the volume
and to switch the infotainment on/off)
3 Rotary push button (to search and select)
4 HOME button (to open the home page)
5 Radio/Multimedia ››› page 169
6 Telephone ››› page 183
7 Full Link ››› page 160
8 Vehicle information ››› page 91

148
Introduction

General instructions for use ● If a function button is missing on the screen, switched off and the vehicle's 12-volt battery
it is not a device defect, but corresponds to charge level is low.
the specific equipment of the country or ver- ● On vehicles with park assist, the audio
Operating indications sion. source volume is automatically lowered when
● The infotainment needs a few seconds for ● Some infotainment functions can only be reverse gear is selected, as well as when the
the complete start-up of the system and dur- selected when the vehicle is at a standstill. In doors are opened. The volume reduction can
ing that time it does not react to inputs. Only some countries, the selector lever must also be adjusted.
the image of the rear view camera system be in the parking position P or in neutral posi- ● Information about the included software
can be displayed during system start-up. tion N. It is not a malfunction, but is due to and the license conditions can be found in
compliance with legal provisions. Settings > Copyright.
● The display of all indications and the exe-
cution of functions only takes place once the ● Restrictions on the use of devices using ● When selling or lending the vehicle, make
infotainment system has finished booting. The Bluetooth® technology may apply in some sure that all saved data, files and settings
duration of the system booting depends on countries. For further information, contact the have been deleted and, if necessary, external
the number of infotainment functions and local authorities. audio sources and data media have been re-
may take longer than normal in the event of ● If you disconnect the 12-volt battery, turn moved.
very high or very low temperatures. on the ignition before restarting the infotain-
● When using the infotainment system and ment system. Note
corresponding accessories, e.g., head- ● If the setup is changed, this may change You will find more information and tips for
phones, bear in mind country-specific regu- the display on the screen and in some cases, using the infotainment system in the Help
lations and legal provisions. the infotainment system may behave in a menu.
● Some functions of the infotainment system manner different to that described in this in-
require an active SEAT CONNECT user ac- struction manual.
count and an Internet connection for the ve- ● Ensure that any repairs or modifications HOME screen
hicle. The data transmission must not be limi- that need to be carried out on the infotain-
ted to perform the functions. ment system are carried out by a specialised In the control and display unit you can set up
● To use the infotainment system, simply workshop. SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT the views and representation on the home
lightly press a button or touch the screen. dealership for this. screen or use the factory setting templates.
● For the correct operation of the infotain- ● Using a mobile phone device inside the ve- If an icon is missing on the screen, it is not a
ment system it is important that it is switched hicle may cause noise in the speakers. device defect, but corresponds to the specific
on and that, if necessary, the time and date ● In some countries, the infotainment system equipment of the country or version.
of the vehicle are set correctly. automatically shuts off when the engine is The following menus can be included as an
icon on the home screen: »
149
Infotainment system

Main menus on the home screen Depending on the equipment, the infotain- Moving objects and adjusting volume
Navigation ››› page 176 ment system has different controls: Move objects on the screen to adapt settings,
 ● Touch screen. for example, with scrollable buttons or to
Radio ››› page 169, Multimedia move the areas of a menu.
 ››› page 173
● Touch zones outside the screen, for exam-
ple, Volume (+ -). Depending on the equipment, menus and
Telephone ››› page 183
 ● Function buttons, for example, RADIO or displays can be customised.
MEDIA.
 Full Link ››› page 160 Increasing and reducing images or map
Help Menu sizes
 Setup ››› page 151 This menu displays information on the opera- Tip: use your thumb and index finger.
 Vehicle ››› page 92 tion of the infotainment system and gives
practical tips.
● Press on the map with both fingers at the
same time and leave them on the screen.
 Data ››› page 91 ● Press  Help. ● To enlarge views, slowly separate one fin-

 Air conditioning ››› page 137 Connecting and disconnecting the info-
ger from the other. To reduce views, slowly
bring one finger towards the other.
 Sound tainment system
Note
The infotainment system turns on when the
 Users ignition is switched on, unless it has been If you turn on the infotainment system man-
manually turned off beforehand. ually with the ignition off, it will automati-
 Store The infotainment system starts-up with the
cally turn off after about 30 minutes.

 Legal last set volume, provided that this does not


exceed the preset maximum start-up volume.
 Help Customising the infotainment sys-
The infotainment system automatically turns
off when the driver's door is opened, provided
tem
the ignition has been switched off before-
Customise the menus and infotainment views
Managing the infotainment system hand.
to quickly access your favourite or most fre-
quently used functions.
Execute the functions and settings with the in-
fotainment controls. The main menu contains function buttons for
accessing all of the Infotainment apps.

150
Introduction

Customise shortcuts Modifying settings System settings


At the bottom of the screen you will find The meaning of the following symbols are Accessing the system settings: press  Set-
shortcuts to customisable system functions. valid for all system and sound settings. tings.
Use the settings to delete or replace them, or
All changes are automatically applied when In the system settings there may be the fol-
change their order.
the menus are closed. lowing functions, information and setting op-
● Press and hold one of the icons (or press + tions:
of an empty position) to display an additional Symbol and its meaning
● Screen.
window.
The setting is selected and activated or ● Time and date.
● Select one of the icons from the apps bar.   / connected.
● Language.
● Press  to delete an icon. The setting is not selected, disabled or
● Click on an icon in the additional window to   / disconnected. ● Additional keypad languages.

replace the value. ● Units.


 To open a drop-down list.
● Voice control.
● Hold your finger on one of the icons and
drag it to the desired position.  To increase a setting value. ● Wi-Fi.
● To close the edit more, press  in the addi-  To increase a setting value. ● Data connection.
tional window, or press . ● Manage mobile devices.
 To go back step by step.
● Reset factory settings.
Note
 To go forward step by step.
● System information.
The shortcut bar cannot be edited when
the vehicle is moving. To change a setting value with the ● Copyright.
 scrollable button without adjusting.
● Configuration wizard.

Sound settings
Settings (system and sound) Adjust the volume of external audio sour-
Accessing the sound settings: press  Sound ces
The selection of possible settings varies de- In the sound settings there may be the follow- If you need to increase the playback volume
pending on the country, the equipment in ing functions, information and setting options: for the external audio source, first lower the
question and the equipment of the vehicle. volume on the infotainment system.
● Equaliser.
If the sound from the connected audio source
● Position.
is very low, increase the output volume on
● Settings. the external audio source. If this is not »
151
Infotainment system

enough, change the input volume to medi- may damage the equipment and “darken”
● Bluetooth® is a registered trademark of
um or high. the screen. Bluetooth® SIG, Inc.iPod®, iPad® and
iPhone® are trademarks of Apple Inc.
If the sound from the connected external au-
dio source is too loud or distorted, lower the ● MirrorLink™ and MirrorLink Logo are certi-
output volume on the external audio source. Trademarks, licenses and copy- fied trademarks of Car Connectivity Consor-
If this is not enough, change the input vol- tium LLC.
rights
ume to medium or low. ● Windows® is a registered trademark of Mi-
Registered trademarks and licenses crosoft Corporation, Redmond, USA.

Certain terms in this manual bear the symbol ● MPEG-4 HE-AAC audio coding technology
Clean the screen ® or ™. These symbols indicate that it is a and patents are licensed by Fraunhofer IIS.
trademark or a registered trademark. The ab- ● This product is protected by certain Micro-
Remove persistent dirt carefully and without
sence of this symbol, however, does not nec- soft Corporation industrial and intellectual
using aggressive cleaning products. To clean
essarily mean that the term in question can property rights. The use or commercialization
the screen we recommend that:
be used freely. of technology of this type outside the config-
● The infotainment system is switched off. uration of this product, without a licence from
Other product names are registered trade-
Microsoft or an authorised Microsoft branch
● Use a clean, soft cloth dampened with wa- marks or trademarks of the respective rights
is prohibited.
ter ››› page 301. holders.
● In case of persistent dirt: soften the dirt by Copyright
● Manufactured under license from Dolby
moistening with a little water. Then carefully Laboratories. Dolby and the double-D sym-
remove with a clean, soft cloth. As a general rule, audio and video files stored
bol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. on data media and audio sources are subject
CAUTION ● Manufactured under license from Dolby to intellectual property protection in accord-
Laboratories. Dolby and the double-D sym- ance with the national and international pro-
Cleaning the screen with inappropriate bol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. visions applicable in each case. Please bear
cleaning products or when dry, may dam- in mind all legal provisions!
● Android Auto™ is a trademark of Google Inc.
age it.
● When cleaning, only press lightly. ● Apple CarPlay™ is a trademark of Apple
Inc.
● Do not use aggressive cleaning products
or that contain solvents. Such products

152
Introduction

Technical data The corresponding indications are shown on ■ 4 speakers: 2 x 20 W


the control and display unit screen and partly ■ 6 speakers: 4x 20 W
Radio with integrated hardware (8.25 ")1) on the instrument panel. ■ Setting options:
The factory-mounted radio in the vehicle with ■ Capacitive colour screen: ■ Equaliser, depending on the system:
integrated hardware includes country-specif- ■ Using the equipment with: ■ 4 speakers: treble, mid and bass.
ic components and software for connectivity ■ Touch zones Touch operation. ■ 6 speakers: 5 frequency bands or pre-
and for the execution of vehicle, comfort and defined settings.
■ Buttons on the multifunction steering
infotainment functions.
wheel. ■ Sound distribution, depending on the sys-
The corresponding indications are shown on ■ Approach sensors (driver and passenger tem:
the radio screen and partly on the instrument side recognition, gesture control). ■ 4 speakers: Balance (left / right)
panel. ■ 6 speakers: Balance + Fader (left /
■ Capacitive colour screen: Vehicle and comfort functions right / front / rear).
■ 8.25 inch version, TFT, WVGA: 1082 x 480 ■ Driver assistance system settings. ■ Sound optimisation by zones (valid for the
pixels. ■ Heating and air conditioning settings. 6-speaker system):
■ Touch operation via the device screen, ro- ■ Lights and visibility function settings. ■ Manual (Driver and All)
tary push-button, menu button and buttons ■ Vehicle comfort settings. ■ Automatic depending on the seats oc-
on the multifunction steering wheel. cupied.
■ Parking and manoeuvring settings.

Central computer with control and display Optional sound system


unit (9.2")2)
Sound system The infotainment system can be extended
The factory-mounted central computer in the with an optional sound system as follows:
vehicle includes country-specific compo- Basic equipment: ■ 7 speakers in different locations and with
nents and software for connectivity and for different power levels (watts).
The infotainment system that is supplied from
the execution of vehicle, comfort and infotain-
the factory is equipped as follows: ■ 300W external amplifier (Ethernet or CAN,
ment functions.
■ Speakers in different locations and with dif- depending on the infotainment system),
ferent power levels (watts). which processes the audio signals sent by
■ Internal amplifier depending on the system:
the central computer. »

1) Equipment name: Media System


2) Equipment name: Connect System.
153
Infotainment system

■ Excitation of speaker channels through ■ Pairing process simplified by WPS or QR


class AB final stages. code
■ Audio signal processing in digital internal
signal processor (DSP). Bluetooth® profiles
■ Independent subwoofer in the luggage There can be a maximum of two mobile devi-
compartment. ces connected to the Bluetooth® hands-free
■ Setting options: and a third device connected to the Blue-
■ User equaliser: 5 bands. tooth® as a music player.
■ Sound distribution: Balance + Fader (left / When a mobile phone is connected to the tel-
right / front / rear). ephone management system, a data ex-
■ Sound optimisation by zones: change takes place via one of the Bluetooth®
■ Manual (Driver, Front and All) profiles.
■ Subwoofer volume. ● Hands-free telephone profile (HFP): the
HFP can be used to manage calls through the
infotainment system.
Connectivity ● Audio profile (A2DP): This profile allows
audio to be transmitted with stereo quality. It
Wi-Fi may require connecting other profiles for
■ Wi-Fi conforming to IEEE 802.11 b/g/n managing and controlling playback.
■ 2.4 GHz and 5 GHz transfer (depending on ● Phone book access profile (PBAP): Allows
the country) phone book contents to be downloaded from
■ Apple CarPlay and Android Auto over Wi-Fi. the mobile telephone.
■ Simultaneous connection of up to 8 Wi-Fi ● Message profile (MAP): It allows short
devices. messages (SMS) and emails to be downloa-
■ Media System: ded and synchronised.
■ 5GHz access point for Full Link Wireless
only
■ Connect System:
■ Access point
■ Tethering

154
Data transfer

Connectivity statuses
Data transfer CAUTION
 (white) Full connectivity, all services active The vehicle may be damaged by factors
SEAT CONNECT Limited connectivity, some services
outside the control of SEAT, S.A. These
damaged can include:
 (grey) may not be available.
● Misuse of mobile terminals
Introduction
No connectivity, no services availa- ● Data loss during transmission.
no icon
ble.
To use it, SEAT CONNECT must first be activa- ● Unsuitable or defective third party appli-
ted online by entering into a SEAT CONNECT SEAT CONNECT's voice recognition or search cations.
contract with SEAT, S.A. and is subject to a technology does not recognise or offer re- ● Malicious software on data storage devi-
temporary use limitation depending on the sults for all words. ces, computers, tablets or mobile phones.
country.
There are SEAT CONNECT services for which
Both the SEAT CONNECT service portfolios registration is mandatory and others for
offered by SEAT and individual services can which it is not mandatory. Services portfolio
be modified, cancelled, deactivated, reacti-
vated, renamed and extended, even without The initial service allocation shown here cor-
Description of services
prior notification. responds to the third generation of SEAT
Before running SEAT CONNECT services, CONNECT services and represents the maxi-
In https://my.seat you can create the user read and take into account the description of mum services portfolio. The maximum possi-
account, see the description of services and the corresponding services. Descriptions are ble portfolio is only available on some vehicle
more information. updated non-periodically and are available models. During the useful life of the vehicle,
The execution and availability of the SEAT online at https://my.seat. you can change the assignment shown here.
CONNECT services and service portfolios
● Always use the most up-to-date version of After activating the services management in
may vary depending on the country, as well
the corresponding service description. the infotainment system you can check if the
as the vehicle, its equipment and connectivi-
vehicle has services and what they are.
ty.
WARNING
In some countries and in the event of a con-
In areas with insufficient mobile phone and tract renewal, the services offered may be
GPS coverage, neither emergency calls or combined differently than indicated here.
phone calls can be made, and data cannot They may also vary depending on the year of
be transmitted. Change location if possi- production of the vehicle. The services men-
ble.
tioned correspond to the third generation of
SEAT CONNECT. »
155
Infotainment system

SEAT CONNECT services and functions ● Zone warning ● Departure times


that do not require activation ● Speed warning ● plus all SEAT CONNECT services in the pre-
The following services also work without the ● Online map update vious section ››› page 156.
activation of SEAT CONNECT:
● Search for points of interest
SEAT CONNECT individual options
● Public emergency call service. ● Petrol stations
● In-Car Applications. These applications
● Privacy mode. ● Online traffic information can be purchased and installed directly in
● Legal. ● Parking lots the infotainment system through the In-Car
● Online infotainment system update store.
SEAT CONNECT services ● Full Link.
● Online route calculation
The SEAT CONNECT services are: ● Data package. Pay per use data rates for
● Information on risks
● Private emergency call the use of online functions, for example, 2 GB
● Dictation
● Public emergency call
per month.
● Natural voice control for destinations and
● Roadside assistance call addresses Note
● Customer support ● Online radio ● The public emergency call service is
● Service appointment planning ● Online media available regardless of whether the info-
● Online system update tainment system is logged in.
● Online route import
● Customisation and purchase of In-Car
● Customisation ● Online destination import
applications require logging into infotain-
● Activating SEAT CONNECT ● Remote auxiliary ventilation ment system, but the activation of the vehi-
● Private mode (deactivation of services) ● Parking position cle in a SEAT CONNECT account is not nec-
essary.
● Delete user / Reset factory settings ● Privacy mode
● Remote independent heating ● Legal
● Remote opening
Activation of SEAT CONNECT and S-
● Horn and turn signals SEAT CONNECT services for hybrid vehi-
cles
PIN
● Vehicle status incl. doors and lights
Available only in electric and hybrid vehicles. Activating SEAT CONNECT
● Driving data
● Vehicle status report ● Remote air conditioning The following steps are necessary for the ac-
tivation of SEAT CONNECT (including regis-
● Anti-theft alarm warning ● Electrical power manager
tration):
156
Data transfer

● Create a user account at https://my.seat or More information at https://my.seat/faqs. 9.2” Infotainment system
directly through the infotainment system in To become a main user and thus prove own-
the User Management menu. S-PIN ership of the vehicle, you need both of the ve-
● Place the SEAT CONNECT order and acti- The S-PIN is a sequence of several digits, hicle’s physical keys. Ownership accredita-
vate it. which can be selected when completed the tion takes place in the vehicle during registra-
● Add the vehicle to your user account. SEAT CONNECT registration. tion or, if you already have a SEAT CONNECT
user account, you must log in through the in-
● Prove ownership. When creating the S-PIN, avoid easy-to-
fotainment system and then go to Manage
● Prove your identity. It is only necessary if guess number sequences and known dates
users
you are to run SEAT CONNECT services rele- of birth. You can change the S-PIN in the SEAT
vant to security. CONNECT user account in “Account set- ● Switch on the ignition and the infotainment
tings”. system.
● You can activate it at https://my.seat or di-
rectly through the infotainment system. To The S-PIN is necessary, for example, to pro- ● In the infotainment system, register in SEAT
activate it through the infotainment system, tect your user profile or to run a SEAT CON- CONNECT.
proceed as follows: NECT service relevant to the security of your ● Or: open the menu Manage users > Set-
vehicle. tings > Become primary user and follow the
9.2" HOME > Manage users > Become pri-
You must manage this S-PIN with absolute instructions.
mary user.
confidentiality. If you reveal the S-PIN to third ● Press the unlock button on the first vehicle
8.25" MENU > Settings > SEAT Connect > parties, for security reasons you must change key.
Settings it immediately. ● Press the unlock button on the second vehi-
Follow the rest of the indications and the in- cle key.
formation shown in the infotainment system.
During activation, you may be asked to cre- Ownership and identity accredita- 8.25” Infotainment system
ate an S-PIN. tion To become the main user and therefore ac-
credit ownership of the vehicle, you will need
Update option Depending on the Infotainment system, the
the registration code found on the SEAT Web
ownership accreditation method will be the
9.2” Infotainment yes Portal and in the APP after linking the vehicle
2-key method or the registration code meth-
to your account (My Garage > Add Vehicle
8.25” Infotainment yes od.
> Accept terms and conditions and SEAT
SEAT CONNECT portal yes privacy policy). Ownership is accredited in-
side the vehicle. Go to Vehicle settings >
SEAT CONNECT application yes SEAT CONNECT > Registration and enter »
157
Infotainment system

the registration code shown on the Web Por- Legal provisions Therefore, before moving off, ask all the vehi-
tal or in the App. cle occupants if they agree with the activa-
During the use of SEAT CONNECT services, ted services. If they do not, deactivate the
Once the infotainment system has processed
information is transferred and processed on- service in question (if possible) or do not al-
the orders by radiofrequency, the accredita-
line through the vehicle. Such data can also low the occupants to use the vehicle.
tion of the ownership will have been comple-
provide (at least indirectly) information about
ted. You can control the current status in the
the driver in question, for example, driving be- GPS tracking: marking
SEAT CONNECT portal.
haviour and location. As a contracting party If the vehicle has a factory-assembled con-
in the SEAT CONNECT contract with SEAT, trol unit that transmits the its current geo-
How is ownership accredited?
S.A., you must ensure that when your vehicle graphical position and speed, the vehicle
9.2” Infotainment 2-Key method. is used by other drivers (for example, family or usually has this GPS marking (e.g., on the roof
friends), data protection and personal rights console). The absence of the marking on the
8.25” Infotainment Registration code
are respected. Therefore, you must inform vehicle does not guarantee that the control
SEAT CONNECT portal No, it is not possible drivers in advance that the vehicle transfers unit does not transmit the vehicle’s current
and receives data online, and that you can geographical position and speed.
SEAT CONNECT appli- No, it is not possible access such data.
cation
Not taking into account this obligation to in- Personal information
Identity accreditation (SEAT Ident) form, can infringe certain rights of the occu- SEAT protects your personal data and only
pants. uses them, as long as the law allows it or you
Identity accreditation must be done before
you can use SEAT CONNECT services that Users can manage data sending and trans- have given your consent on the occasion of a
are relevant to security, such as the “Remote fers through the privacy mode at any time. use. You will find detailed information on data
Opening” service. Identity accreditation can More information at: https://my.seat/faq. processing in relation to SEAT CONNECT
be done in two ways: services in the Privacy Policy, which you can
Follow-up services: ask all occupants access in its corresponding current version
● In person at the SEAT dealership. on the SEAT website.
The follow-up services need geographical
● You can find more information about SEAT and vehicle data to determine whether the
Ident on the SEAT CONNECT portal at Permanent transfer of the vehicle
vehicle is being used within defined speed
https://my.seat. ranges, where it has been parked or if it is be- If another person has left you the vehicle for
ing used in an established geographical area. permanent use (for example, if you buy a
This information is displayed on the SEAT used vehicle), SEAT CONNECT may already
CONNECT portal and in the SEAT CONNECT be activated and the previous user still has
app.

158
Data transfer

the possibility of accessing the data regis- Note ● When in areas with zero or insufficient mo-
tered through SEAT CONNECT and control bile telephony or GPS signal. Also, for exam-
The services required by law and their data
certain functions of your vehicle. ple, in tunnels, confined areas between very
transmission, such as the public emergen-
tall buildings, garages, underpasses, moun-
In the infotainment system you can check if cy call system, cannot be disconnected or
tains and valleys.
your vehicle is assigned to a person as the deactivated.
main user. In this case, you can register your- ● External information from third party sup-
self as the main user of the vehicle and thus plies available with limitations, incomplete or
automatically delete the previous main user. incorrect, e.g. representations of maps.
Faults
Alternatively, through the infotainment sys- ● Countries and regions where SEAT CON-
tem you can directly and permanently delete Even if the prerequisites for the use of SEAT NECT is not offered.
the previous user as the main user, as well as CONNECT services are met, there may be
put the vehicle in offline mode and thus limit factors beyond the control of SEAT, S.A. that
both the communication of your vehicle with interfere with the execution of such services Service management
the SEAT, S.A. data server and the processing or prevent them. These may be specifically:
of personal and vehicle data. Open the settings in Users and go to Privacy
● Maintenance, repair, deactivation, software settings and services. In vehicles equipped
update and technical expansion of telecom- with the 9.2” Infotainment, it is accessed from
Deactivating SEAT CONNECT serv- munication equipment, satellites, servers and Users > Settings > Private Mode (deactiva-
data banks. tion of services). In vehicles equipped with
ices
● Change of the mobile telephony standard the 8.25” Infotainment it is accessed from
The following functions are available in the for the transmission of mobile data by the tel- Settings > SEAT Connect > Privacy set-
infotainment system to deactivate and acti- ecommunications service provider, for exam- tings and services. You can do the following
vate SEAT CONNECT services: ple, from UMTS to EDGE or GPRS. in the infotainment system:
● Disconnection of an existing mobile phone
● Central deactivation or activation ● Check which SEAT CONNECT services are
standard by the telecommunications service
● Individual deactivation or activation currently available in the vehicle.
provider.
● The number of SEAT CONNECT services
You can rerun the corresponding services af- ● Interference, disturbance or interruption in
that are enabled or disabled.
ter cancelling their deactivation in the info- the reception of the mobile phone and GPS
● Activate or deactivate SEAT CONNECT
tainment system. signal due to aspects such as high-speed
driving, solar storms, meteorological influen- services.
ces, topography, blocking equipment and the
More information at https://my.seat. »
intensive use of mobile phones in the radio
cells in question.
159
Infotainment system

Privacy and Services Settings


Full Link ● Click on  Full Link.

SEAT CONNECT services can be activated


and deactivated individually. To do this, just Configure Wireless Full Link
Introduction
check the box corresponding to the service In order to use Wireless Full Link, you must first
you want to activate or deactivate. Use the With Full Link it is possible to view and use the pair the mobile phone device with the info-
privacy mode option if you want to deacti- contents and functions that are shown on the tainment system. To do this, proceed as fol-
vate all of the services at the same time. mobile phone device on the infotainment lows:
screen.
Privacy mode Connect a mobile phone device for the first
To do this, the mobile phone device must be time.
Allows you to deactivate or activate the serv- connected with the infotainment system ● Unlock the mobile phone device.
ices depending on the selected privacy level. through a USB interface.
● Enable Wi-Fi reception and Bluetooth® on
Share location. Main users and co- Some technologies can also be used by the mobile phone device.
 users can view position data on the Wireless Full Link through the Bluetooth® in-
● Connect the mobile phone device to the in-
Tracking SEAT CONNECT portal or app. terface and a Wi-Fi connection.
fotainment system using a USB cable or via
Use location. Position, vehicle, and Bluetooth®.
 The following technologies may be availa-
Location user data are used for services. ● Access the Full Link main menu, unless it
ble:
appears automatically.
No location. Only the vehicle data ● Apple CarPlay™
 ● Select the mobile phone device and the
Personal and user data are used for services. ● Android Auto™
technology you want.
Maximum privacy. Your services are ● MirrorLink®
● Confirm authorisation inquiries on the mo-
 disabled. Only services required for bile phone device to grant the necessary au-
Incognito legal reasons use data. The availability of the technologies that Full
Link includes depends on the country and the thorisations to the infotainment system.
Setting options are not available in all mar- mobile phone device used. ● Disconnect the USB connection and con-
kets or in all vehicle models. nect with the infotainment system again via
You will find more information on the SEAT
Wi-Fi or Bluetooth®. Wireless Full Link is now
website (www.seat.com).
Note configured.
If you deactivate each and every SEAT Access the Full Link main menu The pairing has concluded. The connected
CONNECT service, the OCU may continue mobile phone device can also use Wireless
Browsing the Full Link main menu depends on
to transmit data.
the infotainment system used. Full Link from now on without the USB con-
nection.
160
Data transfer

If pop-up menus are rejected during the con- coverage of the network, the loss of data It cannot be guaranteed that all the applica-
nection process, Wireless Full Link will not be during transmission or the improper use of tions offered will work on all mobile phone
available. In this case, SEAT recommends de- mobile phone devices. devices or with all their operating systems.
leting the devices in both the telephone set-
The applications offered by SEAT can be
tings and the infotainment system, and re-
Note modified, cancelled, deactivated, reactivated
starting the connection process.
● Wireless Full Link may not be compatible
and extended without prior notification.
WARNING with all technologies. To avoid distracting the driver while driving,
● Wireless Full Link (Android Auto ™ and Ap- only certified applications can be used.
The use of applications while driving can
distract your attention from the traffic. Any ple CarPlay ™) is disabled in countries
distraction affecting the driver in any way whose radio frequency regulations do not
can lead to an accident and cause injuries. allow it to operate. Full Link symbols and settings
● Always drive as carefully and responsibly
as possible.  To show more information
Applications (apps)  To open the Full Link settings menu
WARNING  To select Apple CarPlay technology.
With SEAT Full Link, the display of the con-
Any applications that are not suitable or tents of SEAT applications and other provid-  To select Android Auto™ technology.
execute incorrectly may cause damage to ers installed on mobile phone devices can be  To select MirrorLink® technology.
the vehicle, accidents and serious injuries. transferred to the infotainment screen.
● Protect the mobile phone device and its
In the case of third-party applications, there
applications from inappropriate use.
may be compatibility problems. Apple CarPlay™
● Never carry out modifications to the ap-
plications. Applications, their use and the necessary
In order to use Apple CarPlay, the following
● Follow instructions in the instruction
mobile phone connection may be pay per
requirements must be met:
manual for the mobile phone device. use.
● The iPhone™ must be compatible with Ap-
The offer of applications can be varied and ple CarPlay™.
CAUTION designed for a vehicle or a specific country.
● Voice control (Siri ™) must be active on the
The content and volume of applications, as
SEAT cannot be held liable for any damage iPhone™.
well as the companies that offer them, may
caused to the vehicle as a result of the use ● Apple CarPlay™ must be active without
vary. Some applications also depend on the
of applications that are of poor quality or
availability of third-party services. limitations in the iPhone™ settings. »
are defective, the inadequate program-
ming of the applications, the insufficient
161
Infotainment system

● The iPhone ™ must be connected to the in- Special characteristics ● Press this button for a long time to start
fotainment system via a USB connection. On- During an active Apple CarPlay™ connection, voice control (Siri™) of the connected
ly USB connections with data transmission the following characteristics are applicable: iPhone™.
are suitable for the use of Apple CarPlay™.
● Bluetooth® connections between the Note
● The USB cable used must be an original
iPhone™ and the infotainment system are not
Apple™ cable. ● The availability of technologies depends
possible.
on the country and may vary.
Apple CarPlay™ Wireless: Bluetooth® and ● If there is an active Bluetooth® connection,
● You will find information about technical
Wi-Fi must also be activate on the iPhone™. it is automatically interrupted.
requirements, compatible iPhones, certi-
● The phone functions are only available fied applications and their availability on
Establish connection through Apple CarPlay™. The functions de- the SEAT (www.seat.com) and Apple Car-
When you first connect an iPhone™, follow scribed for the Infotainment system are not Play ™ websites, or at SEAT dealerships.
the instructions on the infotainment system available.
screen and on the iPhone ™. ● The connected iPhone™ cannot be used as
The requirements must be met to use Apple a multimedia device in the Media main menu. Android Auto™
CarPlay™. ● It is not possible to use the built-in naviga-
tion system and the Apple CarPlay™ naviga- Requirements for Android Auto™
Launch Apple CarPlay™: tion system at the same time. The last route In order to use Android Auto™, the following
● Press  Full Link to access the Full Link started interrupts the one that was previously requirements must be met:
main menu. active.
● The mobile phone device, called smart-
● Press Apple CarPlay™ to establish a con- ● Depending on the infotainment system you phone from here on, has to be compatible
nection with the iPhone™. use, on the instrument panel screen you can with Android Auto™.
view data from the Telephone and Media
● The smartphone must have an Android Au-
Disconnecting mode.
to™ application installed.
● On the Apple CarPlay™ mode, press the ● With the multifunction steering wheel you
● The smartphone has to be connected
SEAT icon to access the Full Link main menu. can accept or reject incoming calls, as well
through the USB connection with data trans-
● Press  to interrupt the active connection.
as end an ongoing telephone conversation.
mission with the infotainment system.
● The USB cable used must be an original ca-
The representation of function buttons on the voice control
ble provided by the smartphone manufactur-
screen may vary. ● Press  briefly to start voice control using
er.
the infotainment system.

162
Data transfer

Android Auto™ Wireless: Bluetooth® and Wi-Fi telephone function of the infotainment can and Android Auto™ websites, or at SEAT
also have to be activated on the device. also be used. dealerships.
● An active Android Auto™ device cannot be
Establish connection used as a multimedia device in the Media
When you first connect a smartphone, follow main menu. MirrorLink®
the instructions on the infotainment system ● It is not possible to use the built-in naviga-
screen and on the smartphone. tion system and the Android Auto™ navigation Requirements for MirrorLink®
The requirements must be met to use Android system at the same time. The last route star- In order to use MirrorLink™, the following re-
Auto™. ted interrupts the one that was previously ac- quirements must be met:
tive.
● The mobile device must be compatible with
Launch Android Auto™: ● On the instrument panel screen you can
MirrorLink™.
● Press  Full Link to access the Full link view data from the Telephone and Media
● The mobile phone device must be connec-
main menu mode.
ted to the infotainment system via a USB con-
● Press Android Auto™ to establish a connec- ● With the multifunction steering wheel you
nection that is suitable for data transmission.
tion with the smartphone. can accept or reject incoming calls, as well
● The USB cable used must be an original ca-
as end an ongoing telephone conversation.
ble provided by the mobile phone device
Disconnecting
voice control manufacturer.
● In Android Auto™ mode, press the Exit/SEAT
● Depending on the mobile phone device
icon to access the Full Link main menu. ● Press  briefly to start voice control using
used, a Car-Mode application that is suitable
● Press  to interrupt the active connection. the infotainment system.
for using MirrorLink® must be installed.
● Press and hold this button to start voice
Special characteristics control (Google Assistant) on the connected Establish connection
smartphone.
During an active Android Auto™ connection, When you first connect a mobile phone de-
the following characteristics are applicable: vice, follow the instructions on the infotain-
Note
● An active Android Auto™ device can be ment system screen and on the mobile phone
● The availability of technologies depends
connected at the same time via Bluetooth® device.
on the country and may vary.
(HFP profile) with the infotainment system. The requirements must be met to use Mirror-
● You will find information about technical
● It is possible to use the phone’s functions
requirements, compatible mobile phone Link™. »
through Android Auto™. If the Android Auto™ devices, certified applications and their
device is connected at the same time via availability on the SEAT (www.seat.com)
Bluetooth® with the infotainment system, the
163
Infotainment system

Launch MirrorLink®: ● With the multifunction steering wheel you


WLAN access point
● Press  Full Link to access the Full Link can accept or reject incoming calls, as well
main menu. as end an ongoing telephone conversation.
Introduction
● Press to establish the connection with the
Function buttons 3 Not available for model: Media System
mobile phone device.
Function buttons and their function: The infotainment system can be used to
Disconnecting APP Return the Full Link main menu. Here you share a WLAN connection with up to 8 devi-
● In the MirrorLink® mode, press the APP icon can end the MirrorLink® connection, ces ››› page 165, Configuration for sharing
to access the Full Link main menu. connect another mobile phone device or a connection over WLAN.
select another technology.
● OR: press  to access the MirrorLink® main The infotainment system can also use the
menu.  Press to close the open apps. Then press WLAN hotspot of an external device to pro-
● Press  to interrupt the active connection. the apps to be closed or the Close all vide Internet to the devices connected to the
function button to close all the open ap- hotspot (WLAN client) ››› page 165.
plications.
Special characteristics
Press to display the mobile phone device Note
During an active MirrorLink® connection, the  screen on the infotainment system ● Data transmission may incur charges.
following characteristics are applicable:
screen. Due to the high volume of data exchanged,
● An active MirrorLink® device can be con- SEAT recommends the use of a flat rate tar-
 To open the MirrorLink® settings.
nected to the infotainment system at the iff for data transmission. Mobile phone op-
Press to return to the MirrorLink® main
same time via Bluetooth®.  menu.
erators can provide the relevant informa-
● If the MirrorLink® device is connected to the tion.
infotainment system via Bluetooth®, the tele- ● The exchange of data packages may
Note
phone function of the infotainment system generate additional costs, depending on
can be used. You will find information about technical re- your mobile phone rate, particularly if you
quirements, compatible mobile phone de- are abroad (for example, roaming rates).
● You cannot use an active MirrorLink® de-
vices, certified applications and their avail-
vice as a multimedia device in the Media ability on the SEAT (www.seat.com) and
main menu. MirrorLink® websites, or at SEAT dealer-
● On the instrument panel screen you can ships.
view data from the Telephone mode.
● The instrument panel screen does not dis-
play any indication to turn or the Media
mode.
164
Data transfer

Configuration for sharing a con- ● SSID: WLAN Network name (maximum of 32 ● Press the WPS button on the WLAN device.
characters). The wireless (WLAN) connection is establish-
nection over WLAN
ed.
The wireless (WLAN) connection is establish-
Establishing the connection with the wire-
ed. To complete the connection, it may be Repeat this process to connect other devices.
less network (WLAN)
necessary to enter other data into the device.
● Press the  Settings button.
Repeat this process to connect other devices.
● Activate the wireless network. To do this, Configure Internet access
press the function button Wi-Fi > Infotain- There is also the option of scanning the QR
ment system as hotspot. code by connecting the device directly to the The infotainment system can use the WLAN
infotainment system’s Wi-Fi network without hotspot of an external device to establish an
● Activate the wireless network (WLAN) on the
having to enter the password: select Settings Internet connection.
device that is to be connected. If necessary,
> Wi-Fi > Quick connection to infotainment
refer to the manufacturer’s instruction man-
system. Establishing the connection with the wire-
ual.
less network (WLAN)
● Activate the mobile device assignment in
the infotainment system. To do this, press the ● Activate and check the wireless hotspot on
Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS) the external device. If necessary, refer to the
function button Enable as hotspot and
check the checkbox. 3 This depends on the equipment and the coun- manufacturer’s instruction manual.
try in question. ● Press the  Settings button; OR access
● Enter and confirm the network key dis-
played on the device. Wi-Fi Protected Setup can be used to create the Media and press the Settings menu.
a ciphered local wireless network quickly and ● Press the Wi-Fi > Connect to Wi-Fi menu
The following adjustments can also be made and put a check in the checkbox.
simply.
in the Infotainment system as hotspot
● Press the Search for Wi-Fi button and se-
menu: ● Establish the connection with the wireless
lect the device you want from the list.
network (WLAN).
● Security level: WPA2 encryption automati- ● If necessary, enter the network key of the
● Press the WPS button on the WLAN router
cally generates a network key. device in the infotainment system and con-
until the warning light on the router starts
● Network key: Network key automatically firm with OK.
flashing. If the WLAN router does not support
generated. Press the function button to man-
WPS the network must be configured man-
ually change the network key. The network Manual settings:
ually.
key must have a minimum of 8 characters ● To manually enter the network settings of
and a maximum of 63. ● OR: Press and hold the WLAN button on the
an external (WLAN) device. »
WLAN router until the WLAN light on the router
starts flashing.
165
Infotainment system

The wireless (WLAN) connection is establish-


ed. To complete the connection, it may be
necessary to enter other data into the device.

Note
Due to the large number of devices on the
market, it is not possible to guarantee fault-
free operation of all functions.

166
Infotainment operation

Infotainment operation Requirements


● Online and offline: voice control with the
Connect and disconnect the activation
word
corresponding infotainment installed in the ● Press  Settings > Voice control > Acti-
voice control vehicle. vate/deactivate wake word.
● Online current SEAT CONNECT Plus con-
Introduction tract active. Activation word: Hola Hola

Voice control works both online and offline. In Note Commands


online mode, commands are recorded more
● Voice control only recognises commands For voice control to recognise commands re-
accurately, as more data is available.
in the language that is set in the infotain- liably, bear in mind the following tips for the
Voice control understands questions and ex- ment system. commands to work properly:
pressions without having to learn commands. ● Test the voice control with the vehicle
Commands can be formulated freely and stopped before starting to move to famili- ● Pronounce clearly. Confusing commands
can be colloquial. You will find proposals for arise yourself with its operation. are not recognised. Speak in a normal tone of
commands in the infotainment system. voice. Speak a little louder if you are driving
● Additional information and examples can
at high speed.
Functions are reduced in offline mode. be found in the menu  Help > Voice con-
trol ● Avoid outside noises. Open windows and
Loud noises inside or outside the vehicle can doors can interfere with voice control.
cause malfunctions, as well as confusing
● Avoid other secondary noises, such as con-
phrases and answers.
Activation word and commands versations in the vehicle. Do not direct the air
flow from the outlets towards the microphone
Languages available depending on the
Voice control activation words or the interior lining of the roof.
market
If you have connected the voice control via ● Do not use a very strong accent or dialec-
Online and offline: German, American Eng-
the wake word, the connected infotainment tal.
lish, British English, French, Italian, Spanish
and Czech. These languages have advanced responds with How can I help you?. It then ● Do not make long pauses.
functions such as Online Commands, natural scans the words spoken in the vehicle after
interaction, etc. the activation word. Voice control is active and recognises the
 words pronounced.
The other languages of the infotainment sys- Voice control starts when the infotainment
tem do not offer Online Commands, air con- recognises the activation word.
Note
ditioning control or natural interaction.
● When the activation word is disconnec-
ted, the infotainment system cannot be »
167
Infotainment system

activated by means of the activation word. Start voice control Manually ending voice control
Voice control is still available via the  ● Voice control activation: say the word that Voice control can be cancelled with the Can-
button on the multifunction steering wheel. activates voice control. cel command.
● Availability depends on the country and ● Multifunction steering wheel: press the
● Multifunction steering wheel: press the
equipment. voice control button .
voice control button  twice in a row, or a
● Depending on the content of the phone
The voice control ends automatically, if you long press.
book and to ensure reliable recognition of
the names of the phone book, it may be use infotainment functions, if the parking sys-
useful to change the order of the first and tem is activated or by incoming calls.
last name of the contact in question.
In some cases you can also start voice con-
trol of the connected mobile phone device,
by pressing and holding the voice control
Start and stop voice control button.

Depending on the equipment, you can start


voice control in different ways.

168
Infotainment operation

Radio mode
Introduction

Fig. 123 Schematic representation: Radio view

In Radio mode you can tune in the available Access the settings ● You have a corresponding data package
radio stations in different frequency bands ● Press HOME >  > . acquired from the In-Car store or have a data
and memorise your favourites on the preset volume for your own mobile phone device via
buttons to access them quickly. Online functions in Radio mode Wi-Fi access point.
The types of reception and frequency bands Online functions in Radio mode are only Note
available depend on the equipment and the available under the following conditions:
country. In certain countries, frequency ● For streaming services you need to have
bands may stop broadcasting or not be ● SEAT CONNECT or SEAT CONNECT Plus an account with the provider in question.
available again. equipment. ● Radio stations are responsible for the
● You have an active SEAT CONNECT user content of the information they transmit.
Access the RADIO menu account. Additional electrical equipment connected
to the vehicle can cause interference in the
● Press HOME >  ››› Fig. 123. ● Add the vehicle is assigned to your user ac-
reception of the radio signal and noise in
count. the speakers. »

169
Infotainment system

● Foil or metal-coated stickers attached to TP Next to the name of the station, monitor-  Show online radio stations whose pro-
the windows may affect reception on vehi- ing of active traffic information stations gramme belongs to the desired musical
cles with a window aerial. (TP). genre.

Symbols on the FM/DAB frequency band

Radio equipment and symbols  To display the frequency band for man- Selecting, tuning and saving a sta-
ual selection of the FM frequency. Only tion
The functions, as well as the types of recep- possible when the summary station list is
tion and frequency bands available depend disconnected. Select the frequency band
on the equipment and the country.  DAB not available. Before selecting a station you have to select
● AM tuner.  DAB stations support presentations (sli- a frequency band or a type of reception. Dif-
deshow). ferent stations are available depending on
● Dual FM receiver (diversity antenna). the frequency band selected or the type of
● Summarised FM station list. Symbols on the AM frequency band reception.
● Fusion of DAB and FM stations into one list. The types of reception and frequency bands
 Manually updating the station list.
● Fusion of all stations stored in preset but- available depend on the equipment and the
 To display the frequency band for man-
tons into one list. Maximum 36 favourite sta- country.
ual selection of the AM frequency.
tions.
● Select the frequency band or type of re-
● Station logos. Menus in Internet radio mode ception: AM, FM/DAB, FM (for devices that do
● DAB presentation (slideshow). Images that  Show station selection. not have DAB), Internet radio.
are emitted sequentially.
 Open text search.
● Internet radio. Search and select a station
Show the last online radio stations
 heard. You can select radio stations in different
Universal symbols in Radio mode ways. The options vary depending on the fre-
Show the 100 most played radio stations
AM To select the desired AM frequency  and podcasts.
quency band and the type of reception.
band.
Show available online radio podcasts. Select via the frequency band (AM and
FM/DAB To select the desired FM/DAB fre- 
FM)
quency band.  Show online radio stations, grouped by
country. ● Activate the frequency band.
Online radio To select the type of Internet
radio reception.  Show online radio stations by the de-
sired language.
170
Infotainment operation

● Click on the cursor, scroll through the fre- ● Select the category by which the stations ● Access the preset buttons.
quency band and release it when you reach are to be filtered. ● Press the preset button and keep it pressed
the frequency band you want. ● OR: press  to start the text search. The in- until the station is stored.
● OR: press on a point on the frequency put field is displayed. ● OR: press the station on the station list and
band. The cursor will automatically jump to ● Enter the name of the station you want. The keep it pressed. The preset buttons are dis-
the corresponding frequency. list of the stations found is updated while en- played.
tering the text. ● Press the preset button.
The station of the set frequency is tuned.
● Press the station you want.
The station is stored in the selected preset
Select from the station list (AM and
The selected station is tuned. button.
FM/DAB)
The station list shows the stations that are If a station was already stored in the preset
Search in SCAN mode (AM and FM/DAB)
currently tunable. In the AM frequency band, button, it is overwritten with the new station.
In SCAN mode the stations are automatically
you may have to update the station list if you
tuned in a sequential manner and each of
are no longer in the area where you last ac-
them is played for approx. 5 seconds. Special functions in Radio mode
cessed the station list. In the FM/DAB fre-
quency band, the station list is automatically ● To start the SCAN mode, under Settings
updated. Traffic information (TP)
press SCAN.
The TP function monitors the announcements
● Open the station list
SCAN mode starts and the station currently of a station with traffic information and auto-
● Press the station you want. tuned in is shown on the screen. Next to it is a matically reproduces them in the Radio mode
SCAN function button. or in the multimedia playback that is active.
The selected station is tuned. In the case of
To do this, you have to be able to tune into a
FM/DAB and if the station is available, the ● To select a station press SCAN.
station with traffic information.
best quality reception is automatically selec-
ted. SCAN mode stops and the station is tuned. Some stations without their own traffic infor-
The SCAN function button is hidden. mation support the TP function by broad-
Search and filter stations (Internet radio) casting traffic information from other stations
Storing the station on the preset buttons (EON).
In Online Radio mode, stations can be filtered
by categories and can be searched by text. You can store up to 36 stations of different In the AM frequency band or in the Multime-
frequency bands and reception types as fa- dia mode, a station with traffic information in
● Open the station list. vourites using the preset buttons. the background is automatically tuned while »
● Tune the station you want.

171
Infotainment system

it is possible to tune into a station with traffic net transmission, reception is not limited to If in the FM/DAB frequency band settings the
information. the region. automatic selection of station logos is ac-
tivated, station logos are automatically as-
If no station with traffic information can be Online radio is only available through the In-
signed to the stations.
tuned in, the device automatically searches ternet connection of the active infotainment
for stations with tunable traffic information. system. The use of online radio can generate In the Online radio mode, the infotainment
expenses due to the transmission of data system accesses the station logos of the on-
Stations with traffic information are not avail-
from the Internet. line database and automatically assigns
able in all countries.
them to the stations
● In Online radio mode, press and set the au-
Activating and deactivating the TP func- dio quality to high or low to tune the online ra- Assign station logos manually
tion dio. ● In FM/DAB mode, press Station logos.
● In Radio mode or Multimedia mode, press
● Press on the  icon and then select the
Settings > Traffic station (TP). Station logos
station to which a station logo is to be as-
In the case of some frequency bands, station signed.
Online radio logos may already be pre-installed in the in-
● Select the station logo. If desired, repeat
Online radio is a type of reception for Internet fotainment system.
the same process with other stations.
radio stations and podcasts that are inde-
● OR, via the menu Settings > Station logos.
pendent of AM, FM and DAB. Thanks to Inter-

172
Infotainment operation

Media Mode
Introduction

Fig. 124 Schematic representation: Multimedia


view

In Media mode you can play multimedia files ● Video files (depends on the system). Limitations and indications of data media
from data media and streaming services Data media may not work if they have been
through the infotainment system. You can also use streaming services. The
availability of streaming services depends on exposed to high temperatures or have been
Depending on the equipment, the following the equipment and the country. damaged. Please bear in mind the manufac-
data media can be used: turer’s indications.
To use streaming services you need to have
● USB storage support (for example, a USB your own user account in the streaming serv- Quality differences between data media pro-
stick, a mobile phone connected via USB). ice in question. duced by different manufacturers can cause
multimedia playback malfunctions.
● Bluetooth® device (for example, a mobile
phone or a tablet). Access the MEDIA menu Incorrect configuration on a data media may
● Press HOME >  ››› Fig. 124. cause the data media to be unreadable.
Depending on the equipment, the following
Playlists only specify a playback order and
types of multimedia files can be played: Access the settings refer to the storage location of the multime-
● Audio files. ● Press HOME >  > . dia files within the folder structure. In a »
173
Infotainment system

playlist there are no multimedia files saved.  To change to the previous title. Playing audio and video files
To play a playlist, multimedia files have to be  To change to the next title. You can search and play multimedia files
found in the storage places of the data media from an available multimedia source in differ-
 Repeat the current track.
to which the playlist refers. ent ways.
 Repeat all titles.
Note  To activate the shuffle playback order. Search in the folder structure
SEAT assumes no liability for any deteriora-  To display the favourites list. Multimedia files can be catalogued by cate-
tion or loss of files on data storage devices.
 Add multimedia file as favourite. gories (for example, album, artist, title). In My
 Top right: Select multimedia source. media this category view is always dis-
played. The classic folder structure of individ-
Features of the multimedia equip-  Access the settings.
ual USB data media is also found in My me-
ment and symbols  Open the search. dia.
 To return to the top folder of the multi-
Audio, multimedia and connectivity: 1. Activate the folder structure.
media source.
● Multimedia playback and control via Blue-
The folder structure of the selected mul-
timedia source is displayed. When My
tooth®.
media is selected, the categories (mu-
● Audio playback in these formats: AAC, Select and play a multimedia
sic, videos, playlists) and connected
ALAC, AVI, FLAC, MP3, MP4, WMA. source multimedia sources are displayed first.
● Video playback in these formats: MPEG-1 2. Search for the title you want in the folder
Select multimedia source
and MPEG-2 (.mpg, .mpeg), ISO MPEG4, DivX structure.
3, 4 and 5 Xvid (.avi), ISO MPEG4 H.264 Before playing multimedia files you must first
connect a multimedia source. OR: press  to start the text search. The
(.mp4, .m4v, .mov), Windows Media Video 10
input field is displayed.
(.wmv, .asf).
To use streaming services you must be con-
● Playlists on any type of device.
3. Enter the name of the desired title. The
nected to the Internet.
list of the titles found is updated while
● Multimedia streaming (online). entering the text.
● Connect an external multimedia source.
● Multimedia search. 4. Press the desired title.
● Select the connected media source to be
used for playback. If at the beginning of the playback your
Universal symbols in Media mode
selection is in a folder of a multimedia
 To start playback. source, the multimedia files that are in it
 To pause playback. are also added to the playback.

174
Infotainment operation

If a playlist is played, all available titles 2. Select the streaming service you want. dia file. If the music genre is not indicated in
in the playlist are added to the play- 3. Follow the steps indicated by the info- the music files, for example, you cannot save
back. tainment system. the music genre as favourite.
5. Close your selection with . The streaming service is added to the list If a video file is playing, only that video can
of multimedia sources as a new function be saved as favourite.
Select favourites button.
In favourites you can save titles, music gen-
res, artists and albums individually for play- Save favourites Playing entertainment content in
back. Only multimedia files in My media of the info- the infotainment system
● Access favourites . tainment system can be saved as favourites.
You can save up to a maximum of 30 titles, al- Depending on the infotainment system, vid-
● Press the favourite you want. eos can be played.
bums, artists and music genres individually as
favourites.
Depending on your selection, all the titles be-
Video mode
longing to the favourite are added to the 1. Start playback.
playback. When in video mode, a video can be played
2. Access favourites. on the infotainment screen if this is stored on
Configure streaming services 3. Tap a favourite that is not assigned. a data media, in My media or is sourced from
OR: press on an existing favourite and a streaming service. In this case, the video
Depending on the equipment you can use
old for approx. 3 seconds. sound is played through the vehicle's speak-
streaming services directly through the info-
ers.
tainment system. For this you need to have a 4. Select from the selection list: Title, Al-
premium user account of the streaming serv- bum, Artist, Music genres, Playlist. The image is only displayed if the vehicle is
ice in question and you have to log in with it in stopped. When the vehicle is in motion, the in-
the infotainment system. You also need to be The selection is saved instead of the previ- fotainment screen turns off. The sound of the
connected to the Internet. ously selected favourite. If the favourite was video can still be heard.
already assigned, the previously saved fa-
1. Select  Streaming as the multimedia vourite is overwritten. A stable Internet connection is required for
source. playback from a streaming service. In this
The selectable options in the selection list case, telephony costs may be generated.
A list of available streaming services is depend on the data attached to the multime-
displayed.

175
Infotainment system

Navigation
Introduction

Fig. 125 Schematic representation: Navigation


view

A global satellite system determines the cur- on the screen when travelling above a certain If the exact destination cannot be reached
rent position of the vehicle and the sensors speed. It is not a malfunction, but is due to because, for example, it is in a non-digitised
mounted on the vehicle analyse the routes compliance with legislation. area, indications relating to the address and
taken. All measured values and possible traf- the distance to the destination are displayed
fic events are compared with the available Navigation announcements on the screen.
maps to allow optimal navigation to the des-
Navigation announcements are acoustic indi- During dynamic route guidance, you will re-
tination.
cations for driving referred to the current ceive information about reported traffic con-
Navigation announcements and graphic rep- route. gestion on the route. An additional navigation
resentations will guide you to your destina- announcement is provided if the route is re-
The type and frequency of navigation an-
tion. calculated due to traffic congestion.
nouncements depend on the driving situation,
Navigation management is carried out on the for example, starting the guide to the destina- While a navigation announcement is playing,
screen. tion, driving on the motorway or on a round- its volume can be adjusted. The following
about and the settings. navigation announcements provided will be
Depending on the country, some functions of
played with the newly adjusted volume.
the infotainment system will not be available
176
Infotainment operation

Limitations during navigation Zoom out the view (tip: use your index and Rotate view (tip: use your index and middle
If the infotainment system cannot receive da- middle fingers). fingers).
ta from GPS satellites, for example, in a tunnel ● Press on the map with both fingers at the ● Press on the map with both fingers at the
or in an underground garage, navigation con- same time. same time and keep them pressed.
tinues using the vehicle's sensors. ● To rotate the map view, turn your fingers
Change view (tip: use your index finger).
In areas that are not digitised or are only par- clockwise anticlockwise.
● Press twice on the map and keep your fin-
tially digitised on the infotainment memory, ger pressed on the screen.
the infotainment system will still attempt to Saved data
● To zoom out the view of the map, move your
provide route guidance. The infotainment system saves certain data,
finger upwards. To zoom in the view of the
for example, frequent routes and position da-
In the case of missing or incomplete naviga- map, move your finger downwards.
ta, to make the entry of the destination more
tion data, it may not be possible to determine
agile and optimise the route guidance.
the exact position of the vehicle. This may Change view (tip: use your index and middle
mean that navigation is not as precise as usu- fingers).
Delete saved data
al. ● Press on the map with both fingers at the
● Press Settings > Basic function settings >
Roads and streets are subject to constant same time and keep them pressed.
Delete and then OK
change (e.g. new roads, road works, roads ● To zoom out the view of the map, move one
closed to traffic, changes to street names finger towards the other. To zoom in the view WARNING
and building numbers). If the navigation data of the map, move one finger away from the
Select the settings, enter the destination
is obsolete, this may lead to errors or inaccur- other.
and the modifications for navigation only
acies during the route guidance. with the vehicle at a standstill.
Tilt the view (tip: use your index and middle
Managing the navigation map fingers).
● Press on the map with both fingers at the Note
To allow an optimal view, you can also man-
same time and horizontal to each other, keep ● If a detour is passed during route guid-
age the navigation map with additional finger
them pressed. ance, navigation may recalculate the
movements.
● To tilt the view of the map forward, move route.
Move the map (tip: use your index finger). your fingers upwards. To tilt the view of the ● The quality of the navigation recommen-
● Move the map with your finger. map backward, move your fingers down- dations given by the Infotainment system
wards. depends on the navigation data available
Zoom in the view (tip: use your index finger). and any reported traffic congestions. »
● To increase the view in a certain position,
double-click on the map.
177
Infotainment system

● Navigation announcements are not emit-  Current position Other symbols


ted if the sound is muted in the infotainment  Search for destinations.  Entering the detailed destination for an
system. address.
 Destinations along the route.
 Final destination  Search for destinations.
 Home address  Frequent destinations.
Navigation functions and symbols
 Work address  Last destinations.
Navigation  Favourite destinations  Favourite destinations
Navigation functions depend on the equip-  Additional window with more options.  Back
ment and country.
 Additional window with route options.
Symbols in the route details
Functions  Centre the map on the current position.
 Current position.
● Entering destination and route calculation  Change view: 2D oriented to the north,
(offline and online).  Destination of the current guidance.
or 2D oriented to the direction of travel,
● Displaying two navigation maps at the or 3D to the direction of travel.
POI symbols (points of interest)
same time (display and instrument cluster). Information about the current route
 guidance. POIs (points of interest) are shown on the
● Update of online maps.
map, provided the navigation has said data.
● Predictive navigation.  Map scale.
Click on the desired POI (point of interest) to
● 3D urban maps.
Symbols in the additional window start a route guidance ››› page 179.
● Online traffic information
● To open the additional window, press .  Petrol station.
● Dynamic POIs (points of interest)
 Repeat the last navigation announce-  Parking lot.
Symbols on the map ment.  Tourist information offices.
The buttons and indications depend on the  Volume of navigation announcements.  Train station.
settings and the current driving situation.  Map lighting in Automatic, Day or Night  Restaurant.
Symbols for traffic events and points of inter- mode.
est (POIs) are displayed on the map, for ex-  Offer new guidance routes. Traffic information.
ample, petrol stations, train stations or inter- POIs (points of interest) are shown on the
esting stopovers, provided navigation has map, provided the navigation has said data
such data ››› page 181. ››› page 181.
178
Infotainment operation

Click on a traffic event to open an additional Using obsolete data may lead to errors dur- WARNING
window with further details ››› page 181. ing navigation. Current routes cannot be
If you update the navigation data manually
traced or the route guidances will lead to
Slow traffic. while driving, it may cause accidents with
 mistaken destinations.
serious injuries.
Traffic jam. Ensure navigation data is updated at all
 ● Update the navigation data only with the
times. vehicle at a standstill.
Accident.

Broken down vehicle. Online updating of navigation data
 Note
The navigation data of the regions through
Slippery surface (ice or snow). Automatic update of the navigation data is
 which you travel frequently is automatically
subject to the privacy settings. In “Incogni-
Road closed to traffic. updated in the background if the Internet
to” mode, no update is carried out.
 connection is established and the privacy
Slippery road hazard. settings are valid.

 Danger. ● With the ignition switched on, the naviga- Start route guidance
tion data is updated automatically.
Road works. Depending on the country and equipment,

Manual update of navigation data different functions are available to enter des-
Strong wind.
 Current navigation data for large regions, for tinations.
Reduced visibility. example Western Europe, can be downloa-
 The different functions for entering destina-
ded from www.seat.com and stored on USB tions are found in the navigation main menu.
data devices. Navigation through USB data
devices is not possible. Opening the Navigation main menu
Navigation data
● Download the navigation data to a USB da- ● Press HOME > .
The Infotainment system is equipped with a ta device.
built-in navigation data memory. Depending Select the destination and start naviga-
● Turn on the ignition of the vehicle.
on the country, the necessary navigation da- tion
ta may already be pre-installed. ● Connect the USB data device to the info-
tainment system. Navigation data is automat- 1. Press .
To provide correct route guidance and make 2. Select the desired destination. You can
ically updated in the background.
the most of the functions offered, the infotain- chose from  Frequent destinations, 
ment system should be updated on a regular The map version is displayed in HOME >  > Last destinations and  Favourite
basis. System information. destinations. »
179
Infotainment system

OR: press  and enter the address in  Favourite destinations state of the data and it is not possible for all
the input screen. Save up to 20 destinations as favourites. positions.
OR: detailed address. To start “offroad navigation”, press an empty
To save a destination as a favourite press 
3. Press Start. in the split screen when entering the destina- area without position data.
tion.
 Frequent destinations Start navigation
Select the destination and start naviga- ● Press .
The destination synopsis uses recorded data
to propose possible destinations. tion ● Move the view on the map until the desired
1. Press  and then . position can be selected. The navigation map
Select the destination and start naviga- 2. Press the desired destination. can be used by means of additional finger
tion movements ››› page 177.
3. Press Start.
1. Press  and then . ● Press the desired destination on the map.
2. Select the desired destination. The route Note ● Press Route.
guidance starts automatically.
Enter the destination as accurately as pos-
sible. If you enter a destination incorrectly, Offroad navigation
Quick start: for a quick start, press and hold
the route guidance will not be able to start “Offroad navigation” calculates routes to se-
the desired destination for a few seconds.
or it will guide you to an incorrect destina- lected destination points using unknown da-
tion. ta. When a destination point is outside the
 Last destinations
known roads or position data, navigation
Navigation saves the last destinations to finds the route to the next point of the known
make them available for a route guidance. road and completes the path to the next des-
Start route guidance by selecting
tination point with a direct connection.
Select the destination and start naviga- from the map
tion Start navigation
1. Press  and then . The navigation map includes active areas at
● Move the view on the map until the desired
many points that are suitable for entering the
2. Press the desired destination. destination. To do this, press the desired posi- position can be selected. The navigation map
3. Press Start. tion or place on the map. If there is map data can be used by means of additional finger
at this point, you can start a route guidance. movements ››› page 177.
Quick start: for a quick start, press and hold ● Press on any point on the map without posi-
the desired destination for a few seconds. Whether it is possible to enter the destination
tion data.
through the navigation map depends on the
● Press Route.

180
Infotainment operation

Start route guidance using contact With an active route guidance, traffic inci- Function descriptions
dents that are on the current route are shown
details
in the route details. Such traffic incidents can Route details
Start route guidance with the saved address be avoided ››› page 181.
The route details contain information on all
data of a contact. Contacts saved without incidents, for example, the starting point,
address data cannot be used for route guid- Hazard information stopovers, traffic events, POIs and destina-
ance. Hazard information is shown on the naviga- tion, provided the navigation has such data.
tion map with symbols in the same way as
Start navigation If you press on an incident, an additional win-
traffic incidents. In this case, the source of this
● Press . dow opens providing more options. The avail-
information is another vehicle that has detec-
able options depend on the incident and the
● Press on the contact you want. ted the hazard and has uploaded the infor-
current settings.
mation to the service provider.
● Press Route.
The hazards shown are: accident, broken Open and close the route details
Note down vehicle and slippery road surface. ● To open, press | or swipe it.
If the address details of a contact are ob-
solete, the route guidance will nevertheless Traffic flow indication ● To close, press | or swipe it.
take you to the registered address. Check The navigation map shows traffic flow ac-
that the contact address is updated. cording to current traffic events, highlighting Edit route guidance
the road network in colour. To edit route guidance, move the stopovers to
the destination in the TripView view.
● Orange: Slow traffic.
Traffic information
● Red: Traffic jam. ● Hold the desired destination pressed until it
The infotainment system receives detailed is visibly highlighted.
traffic information automatically if the Inter- Note ● Move the destination to the desired posi-
net connection is established. This informa- Traffic information receipt is subject to the tion.
tion is shown with symbols and highlighting privacy settings. In maximum Privacy ● Remove your finger from the screen. The
the road network in colour on the map. mode, no traffic information is received. route will recalculate.
Tracking or Location level setting is neces-
Traffic incidents sary.
Avoid traffic incidents
Traffic incidents, for example, traffic jams or The details of the route show the current traf-
congested traffic, are shown on the naviga- fic incidents if the navigation has such data. »
tion map using symbols.

181
Infotainment system

Avoid traffic incidents by editing route details Functions in the additional window: The route guidance follows the selected route
››› page 181. until the vehicle deviates from it. In that case,
Delete Delete a stopover from the route the route is recalculated and takes you back
● Press on a traffic event. guidance. along the most direct path to the initially se-
● Press on Avoid. The route will recalculate.
Avoid Avoid traffic jam. The route will re- lected destination.
calculate. Important traffic jams are taken into account
Split screen
Stopping route Ends the current route guidance. in the route guidance, and are avoided if al-
When handling navigation functions, an addi- guidance ternative routes are available, provided navi-
tional window with other options may open. gation has such data.
Possible options depend on the function be-  Close the additional window.
You can activate and deactivate the function
ing used.
 Add a destination to favourites. whenever you want.
Close the additional screen
● Press on an empty area outside the addi- Learn usage pattern Enable and disable learning usage pattern
tional window. When the vehicle is in motion, navigation The setting is in the corresponding navigation
● OR: press . saves routes and destinations used to auto- menu  > Basic function settings.
matically generate destination proposals.
● OR: press Accept. ● To activate the function, activate Learn us-
Destinations are learned based on the time of
age pattern.
day and the day of the week.
Functions in the additional window: ● To disable the function, disable Learn us-
Navigation can propose up to 5 routes at the
Show on map Show what is selected on the age pattern.
same time. The proposed routes may be dif-
map. ● To delete saved data, press Delete usage
ferent from the routes of the normal route
Add stopover Add a stopover to the route guid- guidance. pattern.
ance.
If one of the proposed destinations is selec-
Direct route Starts direct route guidance. ted, the guide to that destination is started.

182
Infotainment operation

Telephone interface
Introduction

Fig. 126 Schematic representation: Phone view

You can use the telephone interface to con- Note Telephone interface equipment and
nect your mobile to the infotainment system
● As a general rule, pairing a device (for ex- symbols
and operate phone functions through it. The
ample, a mobile phone device) is only nec-
sound is played through the vehicle's speak- Equipment features
essary once. You can restore the device
ers.
connection via Bluetooth® or Wi-Fi with the ● Hands-free function.
You can connect up to two mobile phone de- infotainment system whenever you want
● Use up to two phones at the same time.
vices simultaneously to the infotainment sys- without having to pair the device again.
tem. ● Phone book with up to 5,000 contacts, de-
● The availability of some telephone func-
tions will depend on the mobile phone con- pending on the infotainment system.
High speeds, poor weather or road conditions
nected to the infotainment system. ● SMS functions via Bluetooth®: SMS reading,
and a noisy ambience (even outside of the
SMS writing (templates included), SMS play-
vehicle), as well as the quality of reception
back, message history.
can all affect the quality of a telephone con-
versation in the vehicle. ● Email functions via Bluetooth®: reading
email, writing email. »
183
Infotainment system

● Connection to wireless charging option.  Obtain information on the SEAT brand Places with special regulations
● Connection to the microphone mounted on and selected additional services related
the vehicle. to traffic and your travel. Switch off the mobile telephone and the tele-
 Voice mail. phone interface in places with a risk of explo-
Symbols in the main menu sion. These places are not always clearly
Call list symbols marked. They include, for example:
 Contacts.
● To open the call lists, press . ● The vicinity of chemical pipelines and
 List of incoming and outgoing calls.
tanks.
 Enter telephone number.  Incoming call.
● The lower decks of boats and ferries.
 Text messages (SMS and emails).  Outgoing call.
● In the proximity of vehicles that run on liq-
 Telephone interface settings.  Missed call. uefied gas (such as propane or butane).
 Telephone number (company). ● Places where the air is laden with chemi-
Symbols for calls
 Telephone number (private). cals or particles such as flour, dust or metal
The symbols may be different depending on powder.
Mobile telephone number (company).
the infotainment system.  ● All other places where the vehicle engine or
 Mobile telephone number (private). telephone must be switched off.
 Start a call or bringing it to the fore-
ground.  Fax (private).
 End or reject a call.  Fax. WARNING

 Open contact list. Switch off the mobile phone in areas with a
Symbols for text messages risk of explosion!
 Enter telephone number.
The symbols may be different depending on
 Mute the sound of the hands-free
the infotainment system. Note
 Hold call.
● To open the text messages, press . In areas where special regulations apply or
 Continue call. the use of mobile phones is forbidden, it
 Start conference call.  Activate voice control input ››› page 167. must be switched off at all times. The radi-
ation produced by the mobile phone when
 Pass call to private mode  Templates for text messages.
switched on may interfere with sensitive
 Make an emergency call. technical and medical equipment, possibly
 Get help in case of breakdown. resulting in malfunction or damage to the
equipment.

184
Infotainment operation

Pair, connect and manage ● Optional: confirm the data transfer mes- Connect a mobile phone device
sage on the mobile phone device. Requirement: the mobile phone device is
Requirement for pairing: paired with the infotainment system.
Active and passive connection
● Bluetooth® is activated on the mobile ● Bluetooth® is activated on the mobile
phone device. To use the functions of the telephone inter- phone device.
face, there must be at least one mobile
● Bluetooth® is activated on the infotainment
phone device connected to the infotainment Establish an active connection
system. system. If there are several mobile phone de-
● Depending on the mobile device, it will be vices connected to the infotainment system, Requirement: several mobile phone devices
necessary to have the Bluetooth® menu open you can switch between active and passive are connected to the infotainment system at
or activate the Visibility option so that the connections. To use the telephone interface the same time.
device is visible from the infotainment system. with the desired mobile phone device, estab- ● Select the desired mobile phone device
lish the active connection with the infotain- from the drop-down menu. All other mobile
Pair a mobile phone device suitable for tel- ment system. phone devices are automatically in the pas-
ephony with the infotainment system to use
sive connection.
the telephone interface functions. On the first Difference between connection types
connection, the mobile phone device is
The mobile phone device is paired and User profiles
paired with the infotainment system. Doing so connected. The functions of the tele-
saves a user profile ››› page 185. Primary For each of the paired mobile phone devices
phone interface are performed with the
data of said mobile phone device. an individual user profile is automatically cre-
The pairing can take a few minutes. The func- ated. In the user profile, data from the mobile
tions available depend on the mobile phone The mobile phone device is paired and phone device is stored, for example, contact
device used and its operating system. Secon- connected. Calls can be managed but
details or settings. A maximum of four user
dary the phone book, messages or other
functions will not be active. profiles can be saved in the infotainment sys-
Pair a mobile phone device tem at the same time.
● Open the list of available Bluetooth® devi- Paired mobile phone devices are stored in the
ces on the mobile phone device and select infotainment system, even if they are not cur- WARNING
the name of the infotainment system. rently connected. If you perform the pairing while driving, it
● Please note and, if necessary, confirm the could cause an accident or injury.
messages that appear on the mobile phone ● Perform pairing only with the vehicle at a
device and on the infotainment system. If the standstill. »
pairing was successful, the phone data is
saved in the user profile.

185
Infotainment system

Note The Comfort phone interface can be equip- ● OR: press a favourite in the telephone inter-
ped with the wireless charging function face main menu to start the call.
● In the pairing of some mobile phone devi-
››› page 187.
ces, a PIN number is shown on the screen of
In order to use the functions of the wireless
 Calls
the mobile phone device. Enter that number
in the infotainment system to complete the charging function, you have to place a suita- The telephone interface shows the call list of
pairing. ble mobile phone device correctly in the stor- the mobile telephone device. Start a call from
● While the infotainment system is in the age compartment. The mobile phone device the call list.
Known mobile phones menu, the wireless will then connect to the vehicle antenna. This
● Press  > All and press a number on the list
charging function is disabled. When you improves the reception and sound quality of
exit this menu, the wireless charging func- calls. to start the call.
tion is activated again. ● OR: press  and filter the call list entries
(for example, missed calls or dialled num-
To call bers). In filtered list, press a number to start
the call.
Basic and Comfort Telephony
Open the telephone interface
Depending on the equipment, two types of  Dial
● Press HOME > .
telephone interface can be used: Manually enter a phone number to start a
Make a call call. While entering the phone number, con-
● Basic telephone interface.
tacts that match that number are shown on
● Comfort telephone interface. Select a phone number to start a call. Differ-
the infotainment screen.
ent functions are available for selecting a
phone number: ● Press  and enter telephone number.
Basic telephone interface
● Press  to start the call
The Basic telephone interface uses the Blue-  Contacts
tooth® HFP profile for transmission. This inter- The last call is dialled by pressing and hold-
face allows the use of telephone functions If a contact has several registered phone
numbers you have to select one. ing the  button on the multifunction steering
through the infotainment system and play- wheel.
back through the vehicle's speakers. ● Press  and press a number on the list to
start the call.
Comfort telephone interface
● OR: press  and enter the contact name in Send messages
Like the Basic telephone interface, the Com- the input field to search for it. Press on the
fort telephone interface also uses the Blue- contact to start the call. Depending on the mobile phone device and
tooth® HFP profile. the infotainment system used, you can send

186
Infotainment operation

and receive SMS and e-mails through the tel- Each time the phone is reconnected, the Call a favourite
ephone interface. phone book is updated. ● Press the assigned speed dial button.
If conference calls are supported, the phone
Send an SMS Note
book can be accessed during a call. If there
● Press  > Text message > Enter new is a saved image for a contact, it can be dis- Favourites are not updated automatically.
message and enter the message on the played in the list next to the entry. If you change a contact's phone number,
screen. you have to reassign the speed dial button.
● Enter the contact you want in the search Favourites
bar. A speed dial button can be assigned to a
● To send the message press OK. maximum of 5 or 6 favourites from the phone Connectivity Box
book (depending on the equipment). If there
Send an e-mail is a registered photo saved to the contact, it is
shown on the speed dial button.
● Press  > E-mail > Enter new message
and enter the message on the screen. All speed dial buttons have to be manually
● Enter the contact you want in the search edited and will be assigned to a user profile.
bar.
Assign the speed dial button
● To send the message press OK.
● In the Favourites menu, press the  button,
then open the phone book to select a con-
tact as a favourite. If the contact has several
Phone book, favourites and speed phone numbers, press on the number in the
dial buttons Fig. 127 In the centre console: pad for the mo-
list.
bile phone connection.
In the first connection of a telephone with the
Edit the speed dial button The Connectivity Box includes the Wireless
infotainment system, the phone book is saved
in the infotainment system. It may be neces- ● To edit or delete a favourite contact press Charger functionality. »
sary to confirm the data transmission on the on the icon  in the Favourites menu screen.
mobile phone. You can delete one or more favourites.

187
Infotainment system

Wireless Charger Note Multimedia


The Wireless Charger allows mobile devices ● Your mobile device must support the Qi
with Qi1) technology to be charged without a inductive charging interface standard for USB port
cable. proper operation.
To charge your mobile phone wirelessly: ● The charging time and the temperature
vary in accordance with the device used.
● Place your mobile device in the middle of
● The maximum charging capacity is 5 W.
the pad with the screen facing up ››› Fig. 127
● Qi technology does not allow you to
››› .
charge more than one mobile device simul-
Make sure there are no objects between the taneously.
pad and the mobile phone. ● You are advised to keep the engine run-
ning to guarantee proper wireless charg-
The mobile phone will start charging auto-
ing.
matically. For further information about
● When a telephone with Qi technology is
whether your mobile device uses Qi technol- Fig. 128 Centre console: USB port.
ogy, check your phone's user manual or visit connected by USB, it will be charged by the
means specified by the manufacturer.
the SEAT website. Depending on the equipment and the coun-
try, the vehicle may have different types of
WARNING USB connections.
● The mobile phone may heat up due to the The USB port can be found in the storage
wireless charging. Think about this before compartment area of the front centre con-
you pick it up, and take care when removing sole ››› Fig. 128.
it.
● There must be no metallic or other ob-
jects between the mobile phone and the
housing, to prevent the functionality of the
Connectivity Box from being affected.

1) Qi technology allows you to charge your mo-

bile phone wirelessly.


188
Start and driving

Driving locks. Depending on the country, in vehicles


with automatic transmission, in order to re-
Note
● If it is difficult to turn the ignition key to
move the key, move the gear shift to the P po-
the position 2 , move the steering wheel to
Start and driving sition. If necessary, press the gear shift block-
ing key and release it.
both sides to release the steering lock.
● If the vehicle battery is disconnected and
● Unlock the steering wheel: put the key into
Starting and stopping the the ignition and turn it at the same time as the
reconnected, the key must remain in the
position 2 for around 5 seconds before
engine steering wheel in the direction indicated by starting up.
the arrow. If it is not possible to turn the steer-
● Vehicles with automatic transmission,de-
ing wheel, it may be because it is locked.
Ignition lock pending on the country, after switching off
the ignition, you can only remove the igni-
Start-Stop system tion key if the selector lever is in position
If the vehicle is stopped and the Start-Stop “P” (parking lock). Next, the selector lever
system switches off the engine, the ignition is locked.
remains switched on.
Automatic transmission: before leaving the
vehicle, make sure that the ignition is switch- Ignition and start button
ed off and the selector lever is in position P.

WARNING
● Always remove the key from the ignition
Fig. 129 Ignition key positions.
when leaving the vehicle, even if only for a
short period. This is especially important if
Key positions ››› Fig. 129
children or disabled people are left alone
1 Ignition off. Key can be removed from the in the vehicle. They could accidentally
vehicle. start the engine or operate electrical
2 Ignition is switched on. equipment, resulting in an accident.
● The ignition key must NOT be removed
3 Starting the engine.
from the lock until the vehicle comes to a Fig. 130 In the lower part of the centre con-
standstill. Otherwise, the steering could be sole: start button.
Locking and unlocking the steering wheel
immediately blocked- Risk of accident!
● Lock the steering wheel: remove the key The engine can be started with a start button
from the ignition and turn the wheel until it (Press & Drive). To do so, there must be a valid »
189
Driving

key inside the vehicle in the area of the front Automatic deactivation of the ignition on When entering the vehicle, the start button
or rear seats, or on the centre console. vehicles with the Start-Stop system ››› Fig. 130 flashes to draw attention to it.
In vehicles with the Keyless Access The ignition is switched off automatically When the ignition is on/off, the engine start
››› page 96system, the engine can also be when the vehicle is stopped and the auto- button flashes. With the ignition is switched
started with the key in the luggage compart- matic engine shutdown is active, if: off, the start button goes off after a few sec-
ment. onds.
● The driver's seat belt is not fastened,
Opening the driver's door when exiting the ● the driver does not step on any pedal, With the engine running, the start button light
vehicle activates the electronic lock on the stays on, indicating that the engine is running.
● the driver door is opened.
steering column if the ignition is disabled. The time elapsed between the moment the
user starts the engine with the start button
After automatically turning off the ignition, if
Switching the ignition on/off manually and the lighting changes from flashing to
the dipped beam  is on, the side light re-
fixed will depend on specific engine size
If you only want to switch on the ignition mains on for approx. 30 minutes (if there is
characteristics. When the start button is used
(without starting the engine), briefly press the enough charge in the battery). If the driver
to stop the engine, the button starts flashing
start button once without pressing the brake locks the vehicle or manually turns off the
again.
pedal or the clutch pedal ››› . light, the side light goes out.
In vehicles with the Start-Stop system, the
The    push-button text flashes
Engine restart feature “My Beat” function also offers additional in-
like a heartbeat when the system is ready for
If no key is detected inside the vehicle after formation:
the ignition to be turned on or off.
the engine stops, you will only have 5 sec- ● When the engine stops during the Stop
Automatic ignition disconnection onds to restart it. A warning will display on the phase, the light of the start button stays on,
dash panel screen. as the Start-Stop system remains active even
If the driver leaves the vehicle, taking the key
with them but leaving the ignition on, the igni- After this interval, it will not be possible to though the engine is off.
tion does not switch off automatically. The ig- start the engine without a valid key inside the ● When the engine cannot be started again
nition is switched off by pressing the lock but- vehicle. with the Start-Stop system, ››› page 194,
ton on the remote control  or by pressing and needs to be started manually, the start
the sensor surface on the door lever “My Beat” function button flashes to indicate this situation.
››› Fig. 84. For vehicles with a convenience key there is
the “My Beat” function. This feature provides WARNING
an additional indication of the vehicle ignition When switching on the ignition, do not
system. press the brake or clutch pedal, otherwise
the engine could start immediately.

190
Start and driving

WARNING Starting the engine ● Once the engine starts, release the start-up
button.
If vehicle keys are used negligently or with-
Before starting the engine ● If the engine does not start, stop and wait
out due care, this may cause accidents and
serious injury. ● Vehicles with manual gearboxes: put the for around 1 minute to try again. If necessary,
gear lever in neutral, press the clutch pedal perform an emergency start ››› page 193.
● Never leave any key inside the vehicle
when you leave it. Otherwise, a child or un- and keep it in this position until the engine
authorised person could lock the vehicle, starts. WARNING
start the engine or connect the ignition and ● Vehicles with automatic transmission: put Do not keep the engine running in confined
operate any of the electrical equipment. the lever in position P or N. spaces, as there is a danger of poisoning.
● The exhaust gases contain carbon mon-
Note Vehicles with ignition locks oxide, an odourless and colourless poison-
● Turn the key to position ››› Fig. 129 2 .
ous gas that can cause loss of conscious-
● Before leaving the vehicle, always dis-
ness and death.
connect the ignition and, if appropriate, ● Keep turning the key to position
take into account the instructions on the ››› Fig. 129 3 without stepping on the accel-
screen of the dash panel. WARNING
erator.
● If the vehicle is stationary for a long time Do not get out of the vehicle with the en-
● Once the engine starts, release the key.
with the engine off and the ignition on, the gine running, especially if a gear is engag-
When it is released, the key returns to position
vehicle battery might be discharged and it ed. The vehicle could then suddenly move
2 .
might not be possible to start the engine. or something strange could happen that
● If the engine does not start, stop and wait would cause damage, fire or serious injury.
● If during the STOP phase you press the
   button, the ignition is switch-
for around 1 minute to try again.
ed off and the button flashes. WARNING
Vehicles with start buttons
● If the indication is displayed on the in-
Never use cold start sprays, they could ex-
strument panel display “Start-Stop system ● Press and hold the brake pedal until the en-
plode or cause the engine to run at high
deactivated: Start the engine manually”; gine starts. revs. Doing this risks injury.
the    button will flash. ● Press the starter button ››› Fig. 130; do not
press the accelerator. There needs to be a
CAUTION
valid key inside the vehicle for the engine to
start. After starting the engine, the lighting of ● The starter motor or the engine may be

the START ENGINE STOP button changes to damaged if you try to start the engine while
driving or if you restart it immediately after
steady lighting, indicating that the engine has
started.
switching it off. »
191
Driving

● When the engine is cold, you should ● With manual transmission, press the clutch
strength to steer when the engine is switch-
avoid high engine speeds, driving at full all the way down. If the vehicle is automatic, ed off.
throttle and over-loading the engine. Risk set the selector lever to the P position.
● If the ignition is switched off, the steering
of engine damage. ● Apply the handbrake. column could be locked, making it impossi-
● Vehicles with ignition locks: Turn the key to ble to control the vehicle.
For the sake of the environment position ››› Fig. 129 1 . ● Never remove the key from the ignition if

Do not warm-up the engine by running the ● Vehicles with start buttons: Briefly press the the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, the
steering could suddenly lock, making it im-
engine with the vehicle stationary. Start off start-up button ››› Fig. 130.
immediately, driving gently. This helps the possible to steer the vehicle: risk of acci-
engine reach operating temperature faster dent!
Emergency disconnection
and reduces emissions.
If the engine does not switch off after briefly
WARNING
pressing the starter button, an emergency
Note disconnect will be required: Always take the key with you when you
● Electrical components with a high power leave the vehicle. This is particularly impor-
consumption are switched off temporarily ● Press the starter button twice within 3 sec- tant if there are children in the vehicle, as
when the engine starts. onds or press it once for more than 1 sec- they might otherwise be able to start the
ond ››› in Ignition and start button on engine or use power-operated equipment
● When starting with a cold engine, noise
page 190. (e.g. the electric windows), which could
levels may briefly increase. This is quite cause injuries.
normal, and no cause for concern.
WARNING
● In vehicles with a natural gas engine
Never switch off the engine while the vehi- CAUTION
(CNG), by default, the engine starts with
gas, with the exception of the following ca- cle is moving. This could cause loss of con- ● If the vehicle is stopped and the Start-
ses: trol of the vehicle, accidents and serious in- Stop system switches off the engine, the ig-
jury. nition remains switched on. Make sure that
– Coolant temperature below -15°C.
● The airbags and belt tensioners do not the ignition is switched off before leaving
– After refuelling CNG.
work when the ignition is switched off. the vehicle, otherwise the battery could
● The brake servo does not work with the
discharge.
engine off. Therefore, you need to press the ● If the engine has been driven at high
Turning off the engine break pedal harder to brake the vehicle. speed for a prolonged period of time, it
● Power steering does not work when the
may overheat when turned off. To avoid en-
● Bring the vehicle to a full stop ››› . gine damage, allow the engine to run for
engine is not running. You need more
approximately two minutes in neutral be-
fore switching it off.
192
Start and driving

Note Note Start-Stop system


After the engine is switched off the radiator A perfect operation of the vehicle is ensur-
fan may run on for up to 10 minutes, even if ed if genuine SEAT keys are used. Control lamps
the ignition is switched off. It is also possi-
ble that the fan turns itself on once more if
the coolant temperature increases due to
 It lights up
the heat accumulated in the engine com- Emergency starting function The Start-Stop system is available, the automatic en-
partment or due to its prolonged exposure gine shutdown is active.
to solar radiation.

 It lights up
The Start-Stop system is not available or has been
Electronic immobilizer disconnected.

The electronic immobiliser prevents unau-


thorised persons from driving the vehicle. Instructions for the driver on the instru-
ment panel display
Inside the key there is a chip that deactivates
Start-Stop system deactivated. Start
the electronic immobiliser automatically
the engine manually
when the key is inserted into the ignition. Fig. 131 On the right of the steering column:
emergency start. ● This indication shows that the Start-Stop
The electronic immobiliser will be activated
system cannot restart the engine.
again automatically as soon as you pull the
If no valid key is detected inside the vehicle,
key out of the ignition lock. For vehicles with This happens for 2 reasons: if the driver's door
an emergency start-up will be required. The
the “Keyless Access” system, the key has to has been opened or if the driver has unbuck-
relevant message will appear in the dash
be outside the vehicle. led the seat belt.
panel display. This may happen when, for ex-
If the following message is shown on the in- ample, the vehicle key battery is very low:
Start-Stop system: Fault! Function
strument panel display: SAFE, the vehicle
● Immediately after pushing the starter but- not available
cannot be started.
ton, keep the key next to the right trim of the ● There is a fault in the Start-Stop system.
The engine can only be started using a genu- steering column ››› Fig. 131, as close as possi- Take the vehicle to a workshop to have the
ine SEAT key with its correct code. ble to the Kessy logo. fault repaired.
● The ignition connects and the engine starts
automatically.

193
Driving

Description and operation the display. The engine can be stopped be- ● The interior temperature is very high/low.
fore stopping completely (approximately 7 or ● Defrost function button activated
The Start-Stop system helps you to save fuel 2 km/h depending on the vehicle's gearbox). ››› page 137.
and reduce CO2 emissions. ● When you take your foot off the brake ped- ● Park assist is switched on.
In Start-Stop mode, the engine will automati- al the engine will start up again. The warning
● The battery is very low.
cally switch off when the vehicle stops or is lamp will switch off.
● The steering wheel is overly turned or is be-
stopping. The ignition remains switched on.
The engine automatically switches back on Basic requirements for the Start-Stop ing turned.
when required. mode ● If there is a danger of misting.
● The driver door must be closed. ● After engaging reverse gear.
In this scenario, the light of the   
button stays lit1). ● The driver's seat belt must be fastened. ● In case of a very steep gradient.

When the ignition is switched on, the Start- ● The bonnet must be closed.
 is displayed on the instrument cluster
Stop function is automatically activated. ● The engine has reached operating temper- screen; it is also displayed in the driver infor-
ature. mation system, .
Vehicles with a manual gearbox ● The reverse gear must not be engaged.
● When the vehicle or when it is stopped, put ● The vehicle must not be on a very steep The engine starts by itself
it into neutral and release the clutch pedal. slope. When stopped, the normal system mode may
The engine will switch off. The warning lamp be interrupted in the following situations. The
 will light up. The engine can be stopped The engine does not turn off for various engine restarts by itself without involvement
before stopping completely (approximately 7 reasons from the driver.
km/h).
Before stopping the vehicle, the system veri- ● The interior temperature differs from the
● When the clutch pedal is pressed the en-
fies whether certain conditions are met. The temperature selected on the climate control.
gine will start up again. The warning lamp will
engine does not switch off, in the following
switch off. ● Defrost function button activated
situations for example:
››› page 137.
Vehicles with an automatic gearbox ● The engine has not yet reached the re- ● The brake has been pressed several times
● Brake until the vehicle stops and keep your quired temperature for the Start-Stop mode. consecutively.
foot on the brake pedal. The engine will ● The temperature selected on the climate ● The battery is too low.
switch off. The warning lamp  will appear in control has not been reached.

1) Only in vehicles with Keyless Access.


194
Start and driving

● High power consumption. ● To avoid injury, make sure that the Start- Manually connecting and discon-
Stop system is switched off when working necting the Start-Stop system
Additional information related to the auto- in the engine compartment ››› page 195.
matic gearbox
The engine stops when the selector lever is in CAUTION
the positions P, D, N and S in addition to when
The Start-Stop system must always be
in Tiptronic mode. With the selector lever in P,
switched off when driving through flooded
the engine will also remain switched off when areas ››› page 208.
you take your foot off the brake pedal. In or-
der to start the engine up again the accelera-
tor must be pressed, or another gear engag- Note
ed or the brake released. ● In vehicles with an automatic gearbox,
you can control whether the engine should
If the selector lever is placed in R while stop-
switch off or not by reducing or increasing Fig. 132 Centre console: Start-stop system
ped, the engine will start up again.
the brake force applied. While the vehicle button.
Change from D to P to prevent the engine remains stopped, the engine will not stop if
from accidentally starting when passing the brake pedal is slightly pressed, in traffic If you do not wish to use the system, you can
through R. jams with frequent stopping and starting switch it off manually.
for example. As soon as strong pressure is
applied to the brake pedal, the engine will ● To manually switch on/off the Start-Stop
Additional information about vehicles with
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
stop. system, press the  button ››› Fig. 132.
● When stopped, the brake pedal must be
In vehicles with ACC function, the engine will The button symbol  remains lit up yellow
kept pressed to ensure that the vehicle
start up again in certain operating conditions does not move. when the system is switched off.
if the radar sensor detects that the vehicle
● If the engine “stalls” with a manual gear-
ahead drives off again. Note
box, it can be directly started up again by
immediately pressing the clutch pedal. The system switches on every time the en-
WARNING gine is turned off voluntarily.
● With an automatic gearbox, if the lever is
● Never switch the engine off until the vehi-
placed in position D, N or S after engaging
cle is stationary. The operation of the brake reverse gear, 10 km/h (6 mph) in a forwards
and steering will not be fully guaranteed. direction must be reached for the system to
More force will be needed to turn the steer- be in a status to stop the engine.
ing wheel or to brake. You could suffer an
accident and even serious injuries.

195
Driving

Manual gearbox ● With the gearbox lever in neutral, push it CAUTION


downwards, move it to the left as far as it will
When travelling at high speeds or at high
go and then forwards to select reverse
Changing gears ››› Fig. 133 R .
engine speeds, selecting a gear that is too
low can cause considerable damage to the
● Release the clutch. clutch and the gearbox. This can also oc-
cur if the clutch pedal is pressed and held
Changing down gears and it does not engage.
While driving, changing down a gear must al-
ways be done gradually, i.e. to the gear di- CAUTION
rectly below and when the engine speed is To prevent damage and avoid premature
not too high ››› . Changing down while by- wear, please observe the following:
passing one or various gears at high speeds
● Do not rest your hand on the gear lever
or at high engine speeds can damage the
while driving. The pressure applied by your
clutch and the gearbox, even if the clutch
hand is transmitted to the gearbox selector
Fig. 133 Gear shift pattern of a 5 or 6-speed pedal remains depressed ››› . forks.
manual gearbox.
● Do not leave your foot on the clutch ped-
WARNING
al; although the pressure may seem insig-
The position of the gears is indicated on the When the engine is running, the vehicle will nificant, it can cause the premature wear of
gearbox lever ››› Fig. 133. start to move as soon as a gear is engaged the clutch plate. Use the foot rest when you
and the clutch released. This also happens do not need to change gear.
● Press the clutch pedal and keep your foot
if the electronic parking brake is switched
right down. ● Always ensure that the vehicle is com-
on.
● Move the gearbox lever to the required po- pletely stopped before engaging the re-
● Never engage reverse gear when the ve- verse gear.
sition. hicle is moving.
● Always press the clutch to the floor when
● Release the clutch.
changing gears.
WARNING ● Never hold the vehicle “on the clutch” on
Selecting reverse gear
If the gear is changed down inappropriate- hills with the engine on.
Engage reverse gear only when the vehicle is ly by selecting a gear that is too low, you
stopped. may lose control of the vehicle, causing an
accident and serious injuries.
● Press the clutch pedal and keep your foot
right down.

196
Start and driving

Automatic gearbox/DSG au- Selector lever positions To move the lever to position R, the lock but-
ton must be pressed and held while pressing
tomatic gearbox the brake pedal at the same time. The reverse
lights come on when the lever is in the R posi-
Introduction tion with the ignition on.

Your vehicle is equipped with an electronical-  – Neutral


ly controlled manual gearbox. Torque be- With the lever in this position, the gear is in
tween the engine and the gearbox is trans- neutral.
mitted via two independent clutches. They
replace the torque converter found on con- Press the brake pedal to move the lever from
ventional automatic gearboxes and allow for N to D/S when the vehicle is stationary or at
smooth, uninterrupted acceleration of the ve- speeds below 3 km/h (2 mph) ››› .
Fig. 134 Selector lever lock.
hicle.
The Tiptronic system allows the driver to The selector lever position is shown when the  – Permanent forward drive position
change gears manually ››› page 199, corresponding sign lights up. With the selec- The lever in the D/S position enables the
Changing gear in Tiptronic mode. tor lever in the manual gearbox positions M, D gears to be operated in normal mode (D) or
and S, the engaged gear is also shown on the sport mode (S). To select Sport mode S,
display. move the lever backwards. Pushing the lever
again will select normal mode D. The selec-
Control lamps
 – Parking lock ted driving mode is shown on the instrument
panel display.
When the lever is put in this position, the drive
 It lights up green
wheels are locked. The lever must only be put In normal mode (D), the gearbox selects the
The brake is not pressed. in P when the vehicle is stationary ››› . best gear ratio. This depends on the engine
To select a gear range, press the brake pedal. load, the road speed and the dynamic gear
To put the lever in P or take it out of P , the
control programme (DCP).
locking button must be pressed and held and
 Flashes green the brake pedal pressed simultaneously. Sport mode (S) should be selected for a
The selector lever locking button is not engaged. sporty driving style. This setting makes use of
The vehicle is prevented from moving forwards. En-  – Reverse gear the engine's maximum power output. When
gage the selector lever lock. accelerating the gear shifts will be noticea-
Reverse gear must be engaged only when
the vehicle is stationary and the engine is ble. »
idling ››› .

197
Driving

Under certain circumstances (e.g. on moun- position P. While the key is not in the ignition, ble to move the lever. If this should happen
tain roads) it can be advantageous to switch the selector lever is locked in position P. the manual release can be used
tiptronic mode ››› page 199, to adapt the ››› page 202.
gears to suit the road conditions. WARNING
● Take care not to press the accelerator Note
Selector lever lock pedal when the vehicle is stopped. The ve-
● If the lever lock does not engage, there is
In P or N, the lever lock prevents a gear range hicle could start moving immediately (in
some cases even if the parking brake is en- a fault. The transmission is interrupted to
from being engaged, and prevents the vehi- prevent the vehicle from accidentally mov-
cle from moving off accidentally. gaged) resulting in the risk of an accident.
ing. Follow the procedure below in order for
● Never move the lever to R or P when driv-
To release the gear lever lock, press and hold the lever lock to engage again:
ing. Failure to follow this instruction could
the brake pedal with the ignition on. At the result in an accident or failure.
– With a 6-speed gearbox: press the
same time, press the lever lock in the direc- brake pedal and release it again.
● With lever in any position (except P), the
tion of the arrow ››› Fig. 134. – With a 7-speed gearbox: press the
foot brake must be pushed down whenever
As a reminder to the driver, when the lever is the engine is running. This is because an brake pedal. Move the lever to posi-
tion P or N and subsequently engage a
in positions P or N the following indication will automatic gearbox still transmits power
even at idling speed. gear.
be shown on the screen:
● Despite a gear being engaged, the vehi-
● While you are selecting a gear and the
When stationary, apply footbrake cle does not move forwards or back. Pro-
vehicle is stopped with the engine running,
while selecting a gear. ceed to the next mode:
do not accelerate. Failure to follow this in-
The lever is not locked if it is moved quickly struction could result in an accident. – When the vehicle does not move in the
through position N (e.g. when shifting from R ● As a driver you should never leave your required direction, the system may not
to D). This makes it possible, for instance, to vehicle if the engine is running and a gear is have the gear range correctly engag-
“rock the vehicle backwards and forwards” if engaged. Apply the parking brake and se- ed. Press the brake pedal and engage
it is stuck in snow or mud. The lever lock en- lect the parking lock (P). the gear range again.
gages automatically if the brake pedal is not – If the vehicle still does not move in the
pressed and the lever is in position N for more required direction, there is a system
Note
than about one second at a speed of less malfunction. Seek specialist assistance
than 5 km/h (3 mph). ● If the lever is moved accidentally to N and have the system checked.
when driving, release the accelerator and
Safety interlock for ignition key let the engine speed drop to idling before
selecting gear range D or S again.
Once the ignition has been turned off, the key
● Should the power supply to the lever be
may be removed only if the gear selector is in
interrupted in position P, it will not be possi-
198
Start and driving

Changing gear in Tiptronic mode system is not changing gear automatically If the paddles are not operated for some time
due to a traffic situation. and the lever is not in the Tiptronic selection
position, it will automatically exit from Tip-
Using Tiptronic with the selector lever tronic mode.
It is possible to change to Tiptronic mode,
CAUTION
both when the vehicle is stopped and while
driving. ● When accelerating, if a higher gear is not
selected, it will automatically change
● Starting from the D/S position, move the shortly before reaching the maximum per-
lever to the right. The instrument panel will mitted RPM.
show whether the lever is in manual or Tip- ● Also, if a lower gear is selected, the sys-
tronic mode (e.g. M4). tem will not change until it detects that the
Fig. 135 Lever in the Tiptronic position ● Push the lever forwards + or backwards – engine will not reach its maximum RPM.
to move up or down a gear ››› Fig. 135.
● To exit Tiptronic mode, move the lever to the
left. Driving with an automatic gearbox

Using Tiptronic with the steering wheel The gearbox changes gear ratios automati-
paddles cally as the vehicle moves.
The gearshift paddles can be used when the The engine can only start with the selector
selector lever is in the D/S or M (Tiptronic) lever in position P or N. At low temperatures,
positions. below -10 °C (+14 °F), the engine can only
start with the selector lever in position P.
● Press the gearshift paddle + to select a
Fig. 136 Steering wheel: automatic transmis- higher gear ››› Fig. 136.
sion levers Driving down hills
● Press the gearshift paddle – to select a
Under certain circumstances it may be ad-
Tiptronic gives the driver the option to lower gear.
vantageous to use the Tiptronic mode to se-
change gears manually. ● To exit the Tiptronic mode, pull the right- lect the gear manually according to driving
When you change to the Tiptronic pro-
hand lever towards the steering wheel for ap- conditions ››› . »
proximately 1 second or move the lever to the
gramme, the vehicle remains in the currently
left.
selected gear. This is possible as long as the

199
Driving

Stop/Park matic gearbox will operate in with the backup WARNING


On level ground, just use the lever to engage programme. It is still possible to drive the ve-
Please note that if the road surface is slip-
position P. On slopes you should first apply hicle, however, at low speeds and within a se-
pery or wet, the kick-down feature could
the parking brake and then set the lever to P. lected range of gears. Driving in reverse
cause the driving wheels to spin, which
This makes it easier to remove the lever from gear may not be possible.
could result in skidding.
position P when starting.
Kick-down
If the driver door is opened and the lever is CAUTION
The kick-down system provides maximum ac-
not in position P, the vehicle could move. The ● If you stop the vehicle on a gradient, do
celeration when the gear selector lever is in
following warning is displayed on the instru- not attempt to stop it from rolling by de-
the positions D, S or in the Tiptronic position.
ment panel:  Gear change: selector pressing the accelerator when a gear has
lever in the drive position!. Addi- When the accelerator pedal is pressed right been selected. This could cause overheat-
tionally, a buzzer will sound. down, the automatic gearbox will shift down ing and damage the automatic gearbox.
to a lower gear, depending on road speed ● If you allow the vehicle to roll with the
Stopping on a downhill and engine speed. This takes advantage of lever in position N and the engine off, the
Always press the brake pedal firmly to pre- the maximum acceleration of the vehicle automatic gearbox will be damaged by
vent the vehicle from moving; if necessary, ››› . lack of lubrication.
apply the handbrake ››› . The upshift to the next higher gear is delayed ● In certain driving situations or traffic con-
until the engine reaches maximum rpm. ditions, the gears could overheat and be
Do not accelerate while a range of gears is
damaged! If the warning lamp  lights up,
engaged to prevent the car from rolling
WARNING stop the vehicle as soon as you can and
downhill ››› . wait for the gearbox to cool ››› page 202.
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Selec-
● If the gearbox operates with the backup
Hill starts tor lever positions on page 198.
programme, take the vehicle to a special-
● Apply the handbrake. ● Never allow the brake to rub and do not
ised workshop and have the fault repaired
use the brake pedal too often or for long without delay.
● Once you have engaged a gear press the
periods, as the brakes can overheat. This
accelerator carefully and disengage the reduces the braking power, increases the
handbrake. braking distance or even causes a brake
system fault. downhill assistant
Back-up programme ● If you have to stop on a hill, keep the vehi-
Downhill speed control is activated when the
If all the positions of the lever are shown over cle’s brakes applied with the brake pedal or
parking brake. lever is in the D/S position and the brake is
a light background on the instrument panel
applied. An appropriate lower gear is engag-
display, there is a system fault and the auto-
ed.
200
Start and driving

The assistant attempts to maintain the speed Activation of the inertia mode less of how smoothly you remove your foot
at which the vehicle was travelling when the Condition: lever in position D, slopes of less from the accelerator.
brake was applied, within logical limits. It may than 12% and speeds between 20 and 130
be necessary to correct the speed by press- km / h (12 and 80 mph). WARNING
ing the brake. ● If the inertia mode has been switched on,
● Gently take your foot off the accelerator. take into account, when approaching an
The assistant can only change down as far
as 3rd gear. It is possible that on very steep obstacle, that the vehicle will not deceler-
The indication will be shown on the instru-
slopes you have to switch to tiptronic mode ate in the usual manner: risk of accident!
ment panel , the engaged gear and current
and change down to 2nd or 1st gear to take consumption will disappear and the word In-
● When using inertia mode while travelling
advantage of engine braking and take the down hills, the vehicle can increase speed:
ertia will appear.
load off the brake system. risk of accident!
The gears will automatically disengage and ● If other users drive your vehicle, warn
Downhill speed control is deactivated as the vehicle will roll freely, without the effect of them about inertia mode.
soon as the road levels out again or you press the engine brake. While the vehicle rolls, the
the accelerator pedal. engine runs at idling speed.
Note
On vehicles with a cruise control system
››› page 212, downhill speed control is acti- Stopping inertia mode ● The driver message Inertia is only dis-
vated when you set a cruising speed. played with the current consumption. In in-
● Press the brake or the accelerator pedal.
ertia mode the gear will no longer be dis-
WARNING To take advantage of the engine's inertia played (for example “D” or “E” will appear
instead of “D7” or “E7”).
mode, simply remove your foot from the ac-
The downhill speed control cannot defy the
celerator. ● The inertia mode will be automatically
laws of physics. Therefore, speed cannot
disconnected on gradients steeper than
be maintained constant in all situations. Al- Applying both the inertia mode (= prolonged 15%.
ways be prepared to use the brakes! section with less energy) and inertia discon-
● In the case of the 1.6l TDI engine, the iner-
nection (= shorter section without the need
tia mode will only work with the Eco driving
for fuel) facilitates improved fuel consumption
profile.
Inertia mode and emission balance.
If the vehicle has SEAT Drive Profile
The inertia mode allows you to travel certain
››› page 204, the inertia mode can be activa-
distances without using the accelerator,
ted in the Normal, Eco and Individual pro-
which saves fuel. Plan ahead and use the in-
files. In the Eco profile, it is activated whenev-
ertia mode to “let” the vehicle “roll”.
er the operating conditions are met, regard-

201
Driving

Indications on the instrument panel Take the vehicle to a specialised workshop Manual release of the selector lev-
and have the fault repaired.
display er
 Gearbox: System fault! You can
Clutch continue driving in D until
 Clutch overheating! Please stop! switching off the engine

The clutch has overheated and could be Park the vehicle in a safe place. Seek special-
damaged. Stop and wait for the gearbox to ist assistance.
cool with the engine at idling speed and the  Gearbox: too hot. Adapt your
selector lever in position P. When the warning driving accordingly
lamp and the driver message switch off, have
the fault corrected by a specialised work- Continue driving at moderate speeds. When
shop without delay. If they do not turn off, do the warning lamp switches off, you can con-
not continue driving. Seek specialist assis- tinue driving in a normal manner.
Fig. 137 Gear selector lever: manual release
tance.  Gearbox: press the brake and en- from the parking position.
gage a gear again.
Faults in the gearbox In the event of a power failure when starting
If the warning was caused by the tempera-
 Gearbox: Fault! Stop the vehicle (e.g. discharged battery), the lever will remain
ture of the gearbox, this driver message will
and place the lever in the posi- locked in position P. To move it to position N to
be displayed when the gearbox has cooled
tion P. move the vehicle, there is an emergency re-
again.
lease device under the centre console, on the
There is a fault in the gearbox. Stop the vehi-
right side. Releasing the selector lever re-
cle in a safe place and do not continue driv-
quires a certain degree of practical skill.
ing. Seek specialist assistance.
 Gearbox: System fault! You may Removing the cover from the selector lev-
continue driving. er
Have the fault corrected by a specialised ● Apply the handbrake firmly  ››› .
workshop without delay. ● Carefully pull the corners of the selector
 Gearbox: System fault! You can lever boot and twist it upwards over the lever
continue driving with restric- handle.
tions. Reverse gear disabled

202
Start and driving

Releasing the selector lever No recommendation will appear if the opti- Note
● Using the flat part of a screwdriver, press mal gear is engaged. The current gear will be
The recommended gear indication turns off
the yellow tab sideways and keep it pressed displayed.
when the clutch pedal is pressed or when
down ››› Fig. 137. the lever is removed from the tiptronic posi-
Display Meaning tion.
● Press the lock button on the selector lev-
er and move it to position N.  Optimum gear.
● After completing the emergency release,
Changing to a higher gear is rec-
reattach the selector lever boot to the gear-  ommended. Steering
box console.
Changing to a lower gear is rec-
 ommended. Information relating to different ve-
WARNING
Do not move the lever from position P if the
hicle processes.
Information regarding the “cleanliness” of
parking brake is not firmly engaged. If you
the particulate filter Electro-mechanical power steering adapts
still think the car could move, press the
brake pedal. Danger! The vehicle could When the exhaust system detects that the electronically to the speed of the car, torque
move in an unforeseen way and cause an particulate filter is close to saturation, this and steering angle.
accident or serious injury. system’s self-cleaning function recommends Even if the power steering fails or the engine
the optimal gear for that function is stopped, it is possible to continue to rotate
››› page 275. the steering wheel as long as the key remains
in the ignition lock, but more force must be
Gear-change recommenda- WARNING applied.
tion The gear change recommendation is an
auxiliary function and in no case should be Steering assist
Selecting the optimal gear a substitute for careful driving. This help assists the driver in critical situa-
● Responsibility for selecting the correct tions. It recommends turning the steering
Depending on the equipment on the instru- gear, depending on the circumstances, wheel to perform a corrective manoeuvre
ment panel screen, a recommendation is rests solely with the driver. (counter-steering), turning slightly to avoid
shown with the gear that should be engaged skidding ››› . »
to optimise consumption. For the sake of the environment
On vehicles with automatic transmission, the Selecting the correct gear can help to save
lever must be in Tiptronic mode ››› page 199. fuel.

203
Driving

WARNING  It flashes yellow SEAT Drive Profiles


Steering assist helps the driver in critical The steering column is jammed.
situations. The driver is the person who has When stopped, turn the steering wheel in both direc- Introduction
to control the vehicle's steering at all times. tions.
The SEAT Drive Profile enables the driver to
OR: The steering column does not unlock or lock.
choose between the Eco, Normal, Sport and
Remove the key from the ignition switch and recon-
Individual profiles, which modify the be-
Control lamp nect it. Consider the messages shown on the instru-
ment panel display. haviour of several vehicle functions, providing
Do not continue driving if the steering column re- different driving experiences.
 It lights up red mains locked after switching on the ignition. Seek
specialist assistance. The Individual profile can be configured
Faulty steering. according to personal preferences. The other
Do not continue driving, stop the vehicle as soon as
The control lamp should light up for a few profiles have a fixed configuration.
possible and in a safe manner.
Take the vehicle to a specialised workshop and have seconds when the ignition is switched on. It
the fault repaired as soon as possible. should go out once the engine is started.
Description
 It lights up yellow WARNING
Never ignore the warning lamps or messag- Depending on the equipment fitted in the ve-
Limited steering operation. hicle, SEAT Drive Profile can operate on the
es.
Drive carefully to a specialised workshop to have the
following functions:
steering checked. ● If the warning lamps and the correspond-
If the warning light does not come on again after re- ing messages are ignored, the vehicle may
starting the engine and driving a short distance, it is stall in traffic, causing serious damage or Engine
not necessary to check the steering. accidents and injuries. Depending on the profile selected, the engine
OR: The 12-volt battery was disconnected and re- ● Stop the vehicle at the next opportunity responds more quickly or smoothly to the ac-
connected. and in a safe place. celerator being pressed. When the Eco profile
Drive a short distance at 15-20 km / h (9-12 mph). is selected, the Start-stop function is activa-
ted.
In vehicles with automatic transmission, the
gear change timing is changed to put the
changes at higher or lower revolutions. The
Eco profile activates the Inertia function,
thereby reducing consumption. The rest of
the driving profiles will activate the inertia use
204
Start and driving

function when the selector lever is not in the S Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Driving pro-
position, depending on how the accelerator Characteristics
The ACC’s acceleration and braking mode file
pedal is released ››› page 201. When the ve- varies according to the driving profile
hicle is turned on again, the function is activa- Places the vehicle in a low state
››› page 219. of consumption, facilitating a
ted by default to reduce consumption.  fuel-saving driving style that is
With manual transmission, the Eco profile respectful to the environment.
changes the gear change recommendations Setting the driving profile
to facilitate more efficient driving.  Offers a balanced driving experi-
Normal ence, suitable for everyday use.

“Dual Ride” suspension Provides a complete dynamic


The “Dual Ride” suspension sets the suspen-  performance in the vehicle, ena-
sion to comfortable in the Eco and Normal Sport bling the user a more sporty driv-
ing style.
profiles, and to sport in the Sport profile. In
the Individual profile the suspension can It allows you to personalise the
be switched between Normal or Sport, de-  configuration. The functions that
pending on personal preference. Individual can be adjusted depend on the
equipment fitted in the vehicle.
In the event of a fault in the “Dual Ride” sus-
pension, the following message is displayed
Fig. 138 Next to the gear lever: MODE button. Kick-down
on the instrument panel screen Fault:
shock absorber regulation. The kick-down feature allows maximum ac-
You can select from Normal, Sport, Eco and celeration ››› page 200.
Individual.
Steering If the Eco profile has been selected in the
The desired profile can be selected by suc- SEAT Drive Profile, and the accelerator is
Power steering becomes harder in the Sport
cessively pressing the selection button pressed beyond a hard point, the engine
profile to enable a sportier driving style.
››› Fig. 138. power is automatically controlled to give
Air conditioning An icon on the touch screen provides infor- your vehicle maximum acceleration.
mation about the active profile.
In vehicles with Climatronic, this can operate WARNING
in the Eco profile, especially restricting fuel The illumination of the button  lights up
consumption. when the active profile is anything other than When operating SEAT Drive Profile, pay at-
Normal. tention to all traffic: doing otherwise could
cause an accident. »

205
Driving

Note “irregularly”. For the first 1000 km or Economical and environmentally


600 miles, please note:
● Your speed and driving style must always friendly driving
be adjusted to visibility, weather, and traf- ● Do not use full throttle.
fic conditions. Fuel consumption, environmental pollution
● Do not force the engine above two thirds of
● The Eco profile is not recommended when
and wear to the engine, brakes and tyres all
its maximum speed. depend largely on driving style. Consumption
towing a vehicle.
● Do not tow a trailer. can be reduced between 10-15% with an effi-
cient driving type. The following section gives
Between 1000 and 1500 kilometres (600 you some tips on lessening the impact on the
to 1000 miles), gradually increase power
Driving tips until reaching the maximum speed and high
environment and reducing your operating
costs at the same time.
engine speeds.
Running in
Active cylinder management (ACT®)
Running in new tyres and brake pads
Please observe the instructions for running-in Depending on vehicle equipment, the active
● Replacement of wheel rims and new tyres
new components. cylinder management (ACT®) may deacti-
››› page 289. vate some of the engine cylinders if the driv-
Running-in the engine ● Information about brakes ››› page 234. ing situation does not require too much pow-
er.
A new engine must be driven through a run-in
For the sake of the environment
period during its first 1500 kilometres (1000 The number of active cylinders can be seen
miles). During its first few hours of running, the If the engine is run in gently, the life of the on the instrument panel display. ››› page 69.
internal friction in the engine is greater than engine will be increased and the engine oil
later on when all the moving parts have bed- consumption reduced. Foresight when driving
ded down.
If you think ahead when driving, you will need
How the vehicle is driven for the first 1500 km to brake less and thus accelerate less. Take
(1000 miles) influences the future engine per- Off-roader? advantage of the inertia of the vehicle when-
formance. Throughout the life of the vehicle, it ever possible, with a gear engaged. This
should be driven at a moderate speed (espe- Your SEAT vehicle is not an off-roader: it does takes advantage of the engine braking effect,
cially when the engine is cold) this will reduce not have enough ground clearance to be reducing wear on the brakes and tyres. Emis-
engine wear and increase its useful life. Never used as such. It is therefore best to avoid sions and fuel consumption will drop to zero.
drive at extremely low engine speeds. Always rough tracks and uneven terrain as much as
engage a lower gear when the engine works possible.

206
Start and driving

Changing gear to save energy The engine takes a long time to warm up rolling resistance, under-inflation also increa-
An effective way of saving is to change in ad- when it is idling. Mechanical wear and pollu- ses tyre wear and impairs handling.
vance to a higher gear. tant emissions are also especially high during
Do not use winter tyres all year round as
this initial warm-up phase. It is therefore best
Manual transmission: shift up from first to they increase fuel consumption by up to 10%.
to drive off immediately after starting the en-
second gear as soon as possible. Choosing gine. Avoid running the engine at high speed.
the right gear enables fuel savings. Select the Avoid carrying unnecessary loads
highest possible gear appropriate for the Regular maintenance Given that every kilo of extra weight will in-
driving situation (the engine should continue crease the fuel consumption, it is advisable
Regular servicing helps in saving fuel even
functioning with cyclical regularity). make sure that no unnecessary loads are be-
before the engine is started. A well-serviced
ing transported.
Automatic transmission: accelerate gradu- engine gives you the benefit of improved fuel
ally and without reaching the “kick-down” efficiency as well as maximum reliability and Since the luggage rack increases the aero-
position. an enhanced resale value. A badly serviced dynamic drag of the vehicle, you should re-
engine can consume up to 10% more fuel move it when not needed. At speeds of
Avoid driving at high speed than necessary. 100-120 km/h (62-75 mph), this will save 12%
Avoid travelling at your vehicle’s top speed, of fuel.
whenever possible. Fuel consumption, emis- Avoid short journeys
sion of harmful gases and noise pollution Save electrical energy
The engine and catalytic converter need to
multiply as speed is increased. Driving at reach their optimal operating temperature The engine drives the alternator, thereby
moderate speeds will help to save fuel. in order to minimise fuel consumption and generating electricity. This implies that any
emissions. increase in power consumption also increa-
Reduce idling time ses fuel consumption! For this reason, switch
A cold engine consumes a disproportionate
In vehicles with the Start-Stop system idling is off any unneeded electrical devices. Devices
amount of fuel. The engine reaches its work-
automatically reduced. In vehicles without that use a lot of electricity include the blower
ing temperature after about four kilometres
the Start-Stop system it is worth switching off at a high setting, the rear window heating or
(2.5 miles), when fuel consumption will return
the engine, for example, at level crossings the seat heating.
to a normal level.
and at traffic lights that remain red for long
periods of time. When an engine has reached Note
Check tyre pressure
operating temperature, and depending on ● If you have the Start-Stop system, it is
Always make sure the tyres are inflated to the recommended that it should not be discon-
the cylinder capacity, keeping it switched off
for a minimum of about 5 seconds already
correct pressures ››› page 291 to save fuel. If nected. »
the pressure is below half bar, fuel consump-
saves more than the amount of fuel necessa-
tion may increase by 5%. Due to the greater
ry for restarting.
207
Driving

● It is recommended that you close the CAUTION SEAT importers and distributors will provide
windows when driving at more than information about the technical preparation
● Driving through flooded areas may dam-
60 km/h (37 mph). that your vehicle requires and also about
age vehicle components such as the en-
● Do not drive with your foot resting on the
necessary maintenance and repair possibili-
gine, transmission or electrical system.
clutch pedal, as the pressure can make the
ties.
● Whenever driving through water, the
plate slip. This causes wear and can dam-
Start-Stop system must be switched off CAUTION
age the clutch plate.
››› page 193.
● Do not ride the clutch on a hill, use the SEAT does not accept liability for any dam-
brake. The fuel consumption will be lower age to the vehicle due to the use of a lower
and you will prevent the clutch plate from
Note quality fuel, an inadequate service or the
being damaged. ● Check the depth of the water before en- non-availability of genuine spare parts.
● Use the engine brake on downhills by tering the flooded zone.
changing to the gear that is best suited for ● Do not stop in the water, drive in reverse,
the gradient. Fuel consumption will be or stop the engine.
“zero” and the brakes will not suffer. ● Vehicles travelling in the opposite direc-
tion cause waves that could exceed your
vehicle's critical height.
Driving on flooded roads ● Avoid driving through salt water (corro-
sion) ››› page 301.
To prevent damage to the vehicle driving on
flooded roads, take the following into ac-
count:
Trips abroad
● The water should never come above the
● With petrol vehicles, it should be ensured
lower edge of the bodywork.
that lead-free petrol is available throughout
● Drive at pedestrian speed.
the journey ››› page 272, Fuel types. Seek
information about service station networks
WARNING
selling unleaded fuel.
After driving through flooded zones, brak- ● In some countries, it is possible that your
ing effectiveness can decrease if the brake
vehicle is not sold and some spare parts may
discs or pads are damp ››› page 234.
not be available or the technical services
may only be able to make limited repairs.

208
Driver assistance systems

Driver assistance systems sives, additional headlights or similar Note


items, as this could have a negative impact ● Due to the system's detection limits in the
on the operation of the assistants. If the ve-
General notes hicle is not properly repaired or structural
surroundings, the systems may not give
warnings or intervene on time, or they
modifications are made to it, the operation
might do so even if it is not desired. In addi-
Safety advice of the assistants may be affected.
tion, the auxiliary systems may incorrectly
● The repair and adjustment of sensors and interpret a manoeuvre and, as a result,
WARNING cameras requires special knowledge and warn the driver in an unexpected manner.
tools. It is recommended to visit a SEAT ● When the towing mode is selected, some
● Responsibility for driving rests with the dealership for this purpose.
driver at all times. The drive assist systems assist systems may react with limitations,
are not a replacement for driver attention. in an unusual way or may not be available.
Focus all your attention on driving and be Keep in mind the instructions relating to the
prepared to intervene at all times. System limits towing mode.

● Use the drive assist systems only when


conditions allow. The driving style must al- WARNING
ways be suitable for the weather, visibility, ● Drive assist systems can not overcome
road and traffic conditions. the laws of physics. Depending on the cir-
● In order for drive assist systems to react cumstances, a collision may not be avoida-
correctly, sensors and cameras must oper- ble.
ate without limitations. Please read the ● Warnings, notices and indicator lamps
notes on sensors and cameras in this chap- may not be displayed on time, or may be
ter. displayed incorrectly, e.g. if a vehicle ap-
proaches too quickly.
Note ● Corrective interventions by drive assist
● Keep in mind the specific rules of each systems (e.g. interventions in the steering
country, especially when it comes to driv- or brakes) may be insufficient or may never
ing, formation of an emergency corridor, occur, depending on the circumstances. As
braking distance, speed, parking position, a driver, you must be prepared to act at all
wheel position, etc. The driver is solely re- times.
sponsible for always complying with the
specific regulations of each country.
● The area in front of and around the radar
sensor should not be covered with adhe-
209
Driving

zone ››› Fig. 140 and provides support for the


Drive assist sensors and ● The operation of the radar can be affec-
following functions: ted by strong reflections of the emitted sig-
cameras nal. This may occur, for example, in an en-
● Front Assist ››› page 216.
closed car park or due to the presence of
Front radar ● Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) metallic objects (e.g. guard rails or sheets
››› page 219. used in road works).
● The sensor may not be adjusted correct-
The radar can have a range of up to 120m
ly if it receives an impact. This may com-
(400ft) depending on road and weather con-
promise the system's efficacy or discon-
ditions. nect it. If you have the feeling that the ra-
dar sensor is damaged or adjusted incor-
WARNING rectly, switch off the Front Assist and ACC
The visibility of the radar sensor can be im- functions to avoid any damage. If this oc-
paired by dirt or environmental influences curs have it adjusted.
such as rain, fog, snow, mud, dust, insects
etc. In this case the Front Assist and ACC
functions may stop working. The instrument
Fig. 139 On the front bumper: radar sensors. Front camera
panel displays the following message: No
sensor vision! And the Front Assist un-
available or ACC unavailable warning
lights come on.
● Clean the sensor area on the bumper as
indicated in ››› page 303, Cleaning the ex-
terior . When the radar sensor starts cor-
rectly detecting again, the message disap-
pears from the screen and the functions
become available again.

CAUTION
Fig. 140 Detection area. Fig. 141 On the windscreen: field of vision of
● If the radar sensor is dirty or poorly ad- the Lane Assist system.
A radar sensor may be fitted to the front justed, the Front Assist system may give un-
necessary warnings and apply the brakes Depending on the equipment, the vehicle
bumper of the vehicle ››› Fig. 139. The front
inappropriately. may be fitted with a front camera on the front
radar detects any objects in its detection
windscreen ››› Fig. 141. This camera detects
210
Driver assistance systems

lane boundaries (lines) to provide support for Rear radar ● Lane departure warning (Side Assist)
the following functions: ››› page 230.
● Rear cross traffic alert (RCTA) ››› page 232.
● Lane Assist ››› page 224.
● Travel Assist ››› page 226.
Automatic deactivation of supported func-
tions
CAUTION
The rear radar sensors deactivate automati-
To avoid affecting the operation of the sys-
cally when, among other reasons, one of the
tems, take the following points into consid-
sensors is detected to be permanently cov-
eration:
ered. This may be the case if, for example,
● Clean the field of vision of the camera there is a layer of snow or ice over one of the
regularly and make sure it is free of snow sensors.
and ice. Fig. 142 Rear view of the vehicle: radar sensor
● Do not cover the field of vision of the zones. The relevant text message will appear in the
camera.
dash panel display.

● Check that the windscreen is not dam-


CAUTION
aged in the area of the camera's field of vi-
sion. ● The radar sensors on the rear bumper
may be damaged or shifted in the event of
a collision, for example, when entering or
exiting a parking space. This may result in
the system disconnecting itself, or at least
possibly having its functionality diminished.
● In order to ensure that the radar sensors
work properly, keep the rear bumper free of
Fig. 143 Sensor detection zones snow and ice and do not cover it.
● The rear bumper should only be painted
The radar sensors are located on the left and with paint authorised by SEAT. The lane de-
right of the bumper and are not visible from parture warning's functions may be limited
the outside ››› Fig. 142. The sensors monitor or work incorrectly if other paints are used.
both the blind spot and traffic behind the ve- ● The visibility of radar sensors may be af-
hicle ››› Fig. 143. fected due to leaves, snow, strong haze or »
They support the following functions:
211
Driving

dirt, among others. Clean the area in front ice, and do not cover them with stickers or WARNING
of the sensors. other objects.
Fitting a number plate frame may interfere
● Never use the blind spot detector or the ● If you use high-pressure or vapour equip- with the view shown on the screen, as it
parking assistant if the radar sensors are ment for cleaning, do not apply it directly, may reduce the camera’s field of vision.
dirty. unless you do so very briefly, and always
keep a distance of more than 10 cm away.
CAUTION
● Fitting certain accessories to the front of
the vehicle, such as a plate holder with ad- ● In order to guarantee good system oper-
Ultrasound sensors ation, keep the cameras clean, free of snow
vertising, may interfere with the operation
of the Park Assist. or ice, and do not cover them with stickers
The bumpers are fitted with ultrasound sen-
or other objects.
sors to perform the following functions:
● Never use abrasive cleaning products to
● Park Assist ››› page 240. clean the camera lens.
Rear View Camera
● Parking aid Plus ››› page 249. ● Do not use hot or warm water to remove
ice or snow from the camera lens. Doing so
● Rear parking aid ››› page 252.
could damage the camera.

CAUTION
● Damage to the radiator grille, bumper,
wheel arch and vehicle underbody can Cruise control system (CCS)
modify the orientation of the sensors. This
can affect the parking aid function. Have
Introduction
the function checked by a specialised
workshop.
The cruise control system (GRA) helps main-
● A number plate or number plate holder tain a constant speed set by you.
with dimensions that exceed the space for Fig. 144 In the rear lid handle: location of the
the number plate, or a cured or deformed reverse assist camera.
Speed range
number plate can cause false detections or
a loss of visibility for the sensors. A camera installed in the rear lid handle as- The cruise control system is available when
sists the driver with reverse parking or ma- driving in forward gear at a speed of over ap-
noeuvring. This provides support to the fol- prox. 20 km/h (15 mph).
Note lowing function:
● In order to guarantee good operation,
keep the sensors clean, free of snow and ● Rear View Camera ››› page 254.

212
Driver assistance systems

Temporarily switching off the cruise con- using the cruise control system may cause Operating the cruise control
trol accidents and serious injuries may occur.
The saved speed can be exceeded at any ● Do not use Travel Assist when visibility is
time, e.g. for overtaking. The cruise control is bad, on steep roads, on windy roads or in
suspended during acceleration and is then slippery circumstances (such as snow, ice,
resumed with the saved speed. rain or loose gravel), or on flooded roads.
● Only use the cruise control system on
Status display paved roads with a firm surface.
When the cruise control system is switched ● Adapt your speed and safety distance to
on, the instrument cluster display shows the the vehicle in front of you at all times to suit
saved speed and the system status: the visibility, weather, road and traffic con-
ditions.
Fig. 145 On the multifunction steering wheel:
 It lights up grey ● After use, always switch off the speed
buttons to operate the speed limiter.
limiter to prevent the speed being regula-
The cruise control system is switched on, but regula- ted against your wishes.
tion is not active. Connecting
● It is dangerous to use a set speed which is
● Press the  button.
too high for the prevailing road, traffic or
 It lights up green weather conditions.
There is no speed saved and regulation is not
The cruise control system is switched on and regula- yet operating.
tion is active.
Start regulation
If there is no speed saved, the instrument
cluster display shows  instead of speed. ● When the vehicle is moving, press the but-
ton .
Changing gears
The cruise control system saves and regu-
As soon as the clutch pedal is depressed, lates the current speed.
regulation is suspended and resumes once
the gear change has been made. Adjusting the speed
While the GRA is set, the stored speed can be
WARNING
adjusted:
If it is impossible to drive with sufficient
braking distance and at a constant speed,  + 1 km/h (1 mph) »
213
Driving

 - 1 km/h (1 mph) Troubleshooting Speed range


 + 10 km/h (5 mph) The speed limiter helps avoid exceeding a
Temporarily switching off the cruise
 - 10 km/h (5 mph)  control
programmed speed, from 30 km/h (20 mph)
approx. and faster.
The cruise control system only operates the
The control lamp switches on yellow.
acceleration, it does not brake the vehicle. By selecting the speed limiter
● Abnormal operation. Switch off the cruise
The speed limitation can be interrupted at
Interrupting the adjustment control system and take the vehicle to a spe- any time by depressing the accelerator ped-
● Briefly press the button  on the multifunc- cialist workshop. al fully, beyond the point of resistance. As
tion steering wheel or press the brake pedal. soon as the saved speed is exceeded, the
The adjustment is interrupted unexpect- green indicator light flashes and an audible
The speed is stored. edly warning signal sounds. The speed is stored.
● If the clutch pedal is pressed for a long
Reinstating the cruise control The limiter is reactivated automatically after
time. returning to less than the set speed.
● Press the  button.
● The vehicle has exceeded the saved speed

The cruise control system resumes the saved for a long time. Status display
speed and regulates it. ● No forward gear has been selected. When the speed limiter is switched on, the in-
● A brake assistance system has intervened, strument cluster display shows the saved
Switching off e.g. TCS or ESC. speed and the system status:
● Press and hold the button . ● Front Assist has braked the vehicle.
 It lights up grey
● If the fault continues, disconnect the Emer-
The cruise control system switches off and
gency Assist and consult a specialised work- The speed limiter is switched on but regulation is not
the saved speed is deleted.
shop. active.

Switching off the speed limiter


 It lights up green
● Press the  button.
● Select the speed limiter on the instrument Speed limiter The speed limiter is switched on and active.

cluster display.
Introduction WARNING
The cruise control system is switched off. After use, always switch off the speed limit-
The speed limited helps the driver not to ex- er to prevent the speed being regulated
ceed a set speed. against your wishes.
214
Driver assistance systems

● The speed limiter does not relieve the Start regulation Switch to cruise control (GRA) or adaptive
driver of their responsibility to drive at the ● When the vehicle is moving, press the but- cruise control (ACC)
appropriate speed. Do not drive at high ton . ● Press the  button.
speed if not necessary.
● Observe the corresponding message on
● Using the speed limiter under adverse The current speed is saved as a limit speed.
the instrument cluster display.
weather conditions is dangerous and can
cause serious accidents, e.g. aquaplaning, Adjusting the speed The speed limiter is switched off.
snow, ice, leaves, etc. Only use the speed The programmed speed can be set:
limiter when the status of the road and the
weather conditions allow it.  + 1 km/h (1 mph)
Troubleshooting
 - 1 km/h (1 mph)

Operating the speed limiter


 + 10 km/h (5 mph)   The speed limiter is not active.
 - 10 km/h (5 mph)
The control lamp switches on yellow.
Interrupting the adjustment ● Malfunctions Switch off the speed limiter
● Press the  button. and go to a specialist workshop.

The speed is stored. The adjustment is interrupted unexpect-


edly
Reinstating the cruise control
● You have switched off the Electronic Stabili-
● Press the  button.
zation Control (ESC).
The limiter will re-activate as soon as the ve- ● The brakes have overheated. Wait for the
hicle is moving at a speed lower than the brakes to cool down and check the operation
Fig. 146 On the multifunction steering wheel:
saved one. again.
buttons to operate the speed limiter.
● If the fault continues, consult a specialised
Connecting Switching off workshop.
● Press the  button. ● Press and hold the button .
For safety reasons, the speed limiter only
The speed limiter switches off and the speed switches off fully whenever the driver stops
It does not take effect yet.
is deleted. pressing the accelerator pedal or switches
the system off manually.

215
Driving

Emergency brake assistance travelling in the same lane and direction. It Critical warning
may not activate in other hazard situations If the driver fails to react to the advance
system (Front Assist) ››› . warning, the system may actively intervene
Front Assist is active between 4 km/h in the brakes and generate a brief jolt to warn
Introduction (2.5 mph) and 250 km/h (156 mph). Depend- the driver of the imminent danger of a colli-
ing on a range of conditions, some of the sion.
functions described below are omitted to op-
timize the behaviour of the system. Automatic braking
Front Assist is a driving assistance function If the driver also fails to react to the critical
that can never replace the driver’s atten- warning, the system may initiate independ-
tion. ent emergency braking by progressively in-
creasing the braking in accordance with how
Safety distance warning critical the situation is.

If the system detects that you are driving too


Driver emergency brake assistance sys-
close to the vehicle in front, it will warn the
tem
Fig. 147 On the instrument panel display: ad- driver with this indication on the instrument
vance warning indications. panel display . The system may detect that the driver is not
braking hard enough to avoid the collision. In
The timing of the warning varies according to this case, it will increase the braking intensity.
The objective of the system is to prevent
other factors: driver behaviour and speed.
head-on collisions against objects that may
The system cannot prevent a collision, al-
be in the vehicle’s path or minimise the con-
Advance warning though it can significantly minimise the con-
sequences of such impacts.
sequences by reducing the speed and the
If the system detects a possible collision with
Depending on several factors and how criti- force of the impact.
the vehicle in front, it alerts the driver by
cal the situation is, the system operates in a
means of an audible warning and an indica-
staggered manner. First it warns the driver, WARNING
tion on the instrument panel display
and if the driver’s reaction does not occur or Observe the safety warnings ››› in Con-
is insufficient, it activates independent emer-
››› Fig. 147.
trol and warning lamps on page 87.
gency braking. The warning moment varies depending on
the traffic situation and driver behaviour. At
The function is intended to prevent collisions WARNING
the same time, the vehicle will prepare for a
with parked vehicles or vehicles in the same
possible emergency braking ››› . Front Assist cannot change the laws of
lane travelling in the same direction, or with
physics or replace the driver in terms of
pedestrians crossing the vehicle’s path or
216
Driver assistance systems

keeping control of the vehicle and reacting ● The Front Assist does not react to pedes- SEAT recommends leaving the Front Assist
to a possible emergency situation. trians walking head-on in the same lane. activated. Exceptions ››› page 218, Deacti-
vating Front Assist temporarily in the fol-
● The driver must always be ready to take
lowing situations.
WARNING over the control of the vehicle.

Following a Front Assist emergency warn- Switching the Front Assist on and off
ing, pay immediate attention to the situa- Note
With the ignition switched on, the Front Assist
tion and try to avoid the collision as appli- ● When Front Assist is connected, the indi-
cable.
can be deactivated or activated as follows:
cations of other functions on the screen
● If the Front Assist does not work as de- may be hidden. ● Using the infotainment system with the but-
scribed in this chapter (e.g. it repeatedly ton  > Driver assistance ››› page 92.
● When the Front Assist causes a braking,
intervenes unnecessarily), switch it off. the brake pedal is “harder”.
Have the system checked by a specialised
When Front Assist is deactivated, the indica-
workshop. SEAT recommends visiting a
● Automatic interventions by the Front As- tion  will be displayed on the instrument
SEAT dealership. sist on the brakes may be interrupted by cluster.
pressing the clutch, accelerator or moving
● Always adapt your speed and distance
the wheel. Activating or deactivating the pre-warning
away from the vehicle in front of you at all
times to suit visibility, weather, road and
● The Front Assist may brake the vehicle (advance warning)
traffic conditions. until it stops completely. However, the
The advance warning can be switched off
brake system does not halt the vehicle per-
● The Front Assist alone cannot avoid acci- and on in the infotainment system using but-
manently. Use the foot brake!
dents and serious injuries. ton  > Driver assistance ››› page 92.
● If the Front Assist does not work as de-
● In complex driving situations, Front Assist The system will store the setting for the next
scribed in this chapter (e.g. in intervenes
may issue warnings and intervene in brak- several times unnecessarily), switch it off. time the ignition is switched on.
ing unnecessarily.
SEAT recommends keeping advance warning
● If the operation of the Front Assist is im-
active.
paired by dirt or because the radar sensor
has lost its settings, the system may issue Operation of the emergency brake Depending on the vehicle’s infotainment sys-
unnecessary warnings and intervene inop- assistance system (Front Assist) tem the advance warning function may be
portunely in the braking. adapted in the following modes:
● The Front Assist does not react to animals The Front Assist is active whenever the igni-
tion is switched on. ● Advance
or vehicles crossing your path or ap-
proaching head-on down the same lane. When the Front Assist is switched off, so too ● Medium
are the advance warning and the distance ● Delayed »
warning functions.
217
Driving

● Deactivated ● When the vehicle is going to be loaded onto ● If the Front Assist is switched off or dam-
transportation. aged.
SEAT recommends driving with the function in
● If the radar sensor is dirty or covered.
“Medium” mode.
● On taking tight bends or complex paths.
System limitations
Switching distance warning on and off ● Pressing the accelerator all the way down.
The distance warning can be switched on ● If the ASR has been disconnected or the
and off in the infotainment system using the ESC activated in Sport mode ››› page 239.
button  > Driver assistance ● If the ESC is controlling.
››› page 92.
● If several brake lights of the vehicle or elec-
The system will store the setting for the next trically connected trailer are damaged.
time the ignition is switched on.
● If there are metal objects, e.g. guard rails or
SEAT recommends keeping the distance sheets used in road works.
warning active. ● If the vehicle is reversing.
● In case of snow or heavy rain.
Fig. 148 On the instrument panel display: ini-
● In case of narrow vehicles, such as motor-
Deactivating Front Assist tempora- tial system self-calibration indication.
bikes.
rily in the following situations
Front Assist has certain limitations inherent to ● Misaligned vehicles.
In the following situations the Front Assist the system. Thus, in certain circumstances, ● Vehicles crossing the other's path.
should be deactivated due to the system's some of the reactions may be inappropriate
● Vehicles approaching in the opposite direc-
limitations: from the driver's standpoint. So pay attention
tion.
in order to intervene if necessary.
● When the vehicle is to be towed. ● Loads and accessories of other vehicles
● If the vehicle is on a test bed. The following conditions may cause the that protrude over the sides, backwards or
Front Assist not to react or to do so too over the top.
● When the radar sensor is damaged.
late:
● If the radar sensor receives a violent im-
● In the first few instants of driving after
pact.
switching on the ignition, due to the system’s
● If it intervenes several times unnecessarily.
initial auto-calibration. During this period, a
● If the radar sensor is temporarily covered status icon ››› Fig. 148is displayed.
by an accessory.

218
Driver assistance systems

ACC - Adaptive Cruise Con- Driver intervention prompt ● Do not use the ACC in poor visibility, or
ACC is subject to certain limitations in- on roads that are steep, with lots of curves
trol  herent to the system. This means that or slippery.
the driver will have to control the speed ● Never use ACC when driving off-road or
Introduction and distance from other vehicles in cer- on unpaved roads.
tain situations. In this case, the instru- ● The system does not react to stationary
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) maintains a ment cluster display will tell you to in- obstacles (such as a traffic jam queue). Re-
constant speed set by the driver. When ap- tervene by applying the brake, and an act soon enough to avoid a hazardous sit-
proaching another vehicle in front, the ACC audio warning will be played. uation.
detects it and adapts the speed automatical-
● The system does not react to people, ani-
ly, maintaining a distance set by the driver. Radar sensors mals or vehicles that are crossing or ap-
The ACC uses the front radar technology. proaching in the opposite direction.
Does my vehicle have ACC?
Read its maintenance instructions and infor- ● If you are driving with a spare wheel fit-
Your vehicle has ACC if it has a configuration mation about its limitations ››› page 209. ted, the ACC system could automatically
menu in the infotainment system ››› page 92 switch off. Switch off the system when
and if it has the ACC function buttons on the WARNING starting off.
multifunction steering wheel ››› Fig. 149. ● Brake immediately if the ACC does not
The ACC’s technology cannot overcome
the system's inherent limitations or change slow down enough.
Speed range
the laws of physics. If used negligently or ● Brake immediately when a driver inter-
ACC regulates speeds between 30 km/h (20 involuntarily, it may cause serious acci- vention instruction is displayed on the in-
mph) and 210 km/h (130 mph). dents and injuries. The system is not a re- strument cluster screen.
placement for driver awareness. ● If the vehicle continues to move involun-
If the vehicle is fitted with an automatic gear-
● Always be prepared to brake or acceler- tarily after a driver intervention prompt,
box, the ACC can bring the vehicle to a
ate. brake the vehicle.
standstill if a vehicle in front of it stops.
● If you press the accelerator pedal the
If your vehicle is fitted with a manual gearbox, ACC will stop working. Therefore, it will not Note
you must pay attention to speed and gear brake or request any braking intervention.
changes. The ACC is deactivated if the If the ACC does not work as described in
● Adapt your speed and safe distance to
speed is too low (less than 30 km/h) of the this chapter, do not use it until it has been
the vehicle in front of you at all times to suit checked by a specialised workshop. Visit-
engine RPM is too low or high.
visibility, weather, road and traffic condi- ing a SEAT dealership is recommended.
tions.

219
Driving

ACC operation automatic transmission, the gear lever must km/h (1 mph). You can then press  to de-
be in the D, S or M position. crease it by 1 km/h (1 mph).
Depending on the driving situation, the fol-
Setting your distance level
lowing indicator lamps come on:
The distance can be set to one of five levels,
 It lights up green from very short to very long:

The ACC is activea). ● Press the button  and then the button  or

a)
 ››› Fig. 149.
Only on analogue instrument clusters.
● Alternatively, press the button  as many
It lights up greena) times as necessary to set the desired dis-
 tance.
Fig. 149 On the multifunction steering wheel: ACC connected, no vehicle detected in front.
buttons to operate the ACC Keep in mind each country’s regulations on
a)It lights up white on the analogue instrument clus- minimum braking distances.
ter.
Connecting
● Press the  button on the multifunction Suspend regulation (standby)
 It lights up greena)
steering wheel. ● Briefly press the button  on the multifunc-
ACC connected, vehicle detected in front. tion steering wheel or press the brake pedal.
The ACC does not regulate anything yet
a)It lights up white on the analogue instrument clus-
(standby). The ACC indicator lamp is grey; the speed
ter.
and distance are saved.
Start regulation When the ACC is in standby, the indicator If the ESC or ASR is disconnected
● To start regulation, press the button  lamps light up grey. ››› page 239, the ACC is automatically sus-
››› Fig. 149. pended.
Setting speed
The ACC sets the current speed, or the clos-
To program the speed, press the  or  Reinstating the cruise control
est speed within the valid range (30-210
››› Fig. 149 buttons to the desired speed. The ● Press the  button. The ACC regulates to
km/h), as the cruise speed.
speed is adjusted at intervals of 10 km/h (5 the last speed and distance setting.
With manual transmission, the gear lever mph).
● OR: Press the  button to use the current
must be in any gear except first and reverse,
When the ACC is active, the button  can be speed.
and the speed must be higher than approxi-
pressed to increase the desired speed by 1
mately 30 km/h (18 mph). On vehicles with
220
Driver assistance systems

Switching off ACC settings will be the same as those in the Status display
● Press and hold the button . The set speed SEAT Drive Profile.
is cleared.
WARNING
Exceeding the speed regulated by the Before driving off, check that the road is
ACC clear. The radar sensor may not detect ob-
stacles on the road. This could cause an
While driving with the ACC switched on, the
accident and serious injuries. If necessary,
driver can increase speed by pressing the apply the brake.
accelerator pedal. ACC regulation is suspen-
ded until you release the accelerator pedal
››› . CAUTION
If you increase speed using the accelerator
Fig. 150 On the instrument panel display:
Adjusting the default distance level at the pedal, the ACC may not be able to safely
ACC active.
start of your journey adjust the speed of the distance due to the
limitations of the system.
In the Infotainment system, you can pre-se- 1 Vehicle ahead detected. It will light up if
● Be prepared to react if required by the
lect the distance level when connecting the the distance to the vehicle is adjusted.
ACC from: situation.
2 Selected distance level 2.
● Very short, Short, Medium, Long and Very
This information can be displayed on the
long using the Infotainment system:  > Driv- central panel of the Assists view, or in the left
er assistance > ACC ››› page 92. hand information profile ››› page 68. If these
views are not selected, it will be automatical-
Changing the driving profile ly displayed in the lower central part of the
In vehicles with SEAT Drive Profile, the driving instrument cluster in a simplified manner.
profile selected can have an influence on the The set speed will be displayed next to the
ACC’s acceleration and braking behaviour function status indicator described in
››› page 204. ››› page 220, Start regulation.
In vehicles without SEAT Drive Profile, the be-
haviour of the ACC can also be affected if
any of the following drive profiles are selec-
ted in the infotainment system in Drive assist.

221
Driving

Special driving situations The function works at speeds over 80 km/h The system can only keep the car stopped
(50 mph). It may not be available in certain for a few seconds. After this, the Brake warn-
countries. ing will be displayed and an audio warning
will be played. Press the brake pedal. The ve-
Overtaking hicle may start moving forward if you do not
do this Accident hazard!
When the turn signal is switched on for over-
taking, the ACC reduces the distance from The ACC is deactivated while stopped in the
the vehicle in front to help with the overtaking following cases:
manoeuvre. The set cruising speed will not be
exceeded. ● If the vehicle stops for several minutes.
● If a door is opened.
The function works at speeds over 80 km/h
(50 mph). It may not be available in certain
Fig. 151 On the instrument panel display: ACC WARNING
countries.
active, vehicle detected in an outer lane.
If the message ACC ready to start is dis-
Stop&Go function played on the instrument cluster display
Be aware of the limitations and warnings de-
and the vehicle in front moves off, your ve-
scribed at the beginning of this chapter. ››› 3 Valid for: vehicles with an automatic gearbox
hicle will move off automatically. In this
in Introduction on page 219. The ACC can bring the vehicle to a standstill case, any obstacles in the road may not be
(0 km/h) if the vehicle in front stops. detected. This may cause serious acci-
Avoid undertaking on the right1) dents and injuries.
The ACC remains active and the message
If a vehicle is detected in the left lane that is ACC ready to start is displayed on the in-
● Always check the road before moving off,
travelling at a speed slower than that set by and apply the vehicle brakes yourself if
strument cluster for a few seconds. During
the driver, it will brake the vehicle within the necessary.
this time, the vehicle will move off again if the
comfort limits of the system to avoid passing vehicle in front moves forwards.
it on the right ››› Fig. 151.
If the vehicle in front does not move off, the
You can cancel this regulation by changing vehicle can be kept at a standstill with the
the set speed or by pressing the accelerator status ACC ready to start by pressing the
pedal. brake.

1) Or on the left, in countries that drive on the left

hand side of the road.


222
Driver assistance systems

ACC system limitations ● On roads with embedded metal objects


such as train or tram tracks.
● On roads with loose gravel.

Pay special attention when using ACC in the


following situations:

On curves
The ACC may not detect the vehicle in front
on a curve, or may regulate the distance from
vehicles in other lanes ››› Fig. 152 .

Vehicles outside the sensor zone


In the following situations the ACC may not
Fig. 153  Vehicle changing lanes.  One ve- react, or may react slowly or inappropriately:
hicle turning and another stationary.
● Vehicles that are not aligned while driving
Fig. 152  Vehicle on a bend.  Motorcyclist
ahead, out of range of the radar sensor. The limits of the ACC system mean that it is or that are outside the sensor's detection
not appropriate in all situations ››› in Intro- area, such as motorcycles ››› Fig. 152 
duction on page 219. ● Vehicles that move into your lane, a short
SEAT does not recommend using the function distance from your vehicle ››› Fig. 153 .
in the following cases ››› : ● Vehicles with loads or accessories that pro-
trude from the sides, rear or roof.
● Heavy rain, snow or fog.
● When going through tunnels. Objects that are not detected
● In sections with roadworks. The ACC function only detects and reacts to
● On routes with curves, e.g. on mountain vehicles moving in the same direction. There-
roads. fore it does not detect:
● On off-road routes. ● People
● In covered car parks. ● Animals »

223
Driving

● Vehicles travelling in the opposite direction The ACC does not work as expected
Lane Assist
or crossing the road. ● Make sure that the conditions are met for
● Other stationary obstacles the radar sensor to operate properly Introduction
››› page 210.
The ACC does not react to stationary vehi-
● If the brakes overheat, regulation stops au- The Lane Assist System helps the driver
cles. If, for example, a vehicle detected by the
tomatically. Wait for them to cool down and stay in his/her lane within the physical lim-
ACC turns or moves over and there is a sta-
check the operation again. its of the system. This function is not suita-
tionary vehicle in front of it, the ACC will not
ble and is not designed to keep the vehicle
react to the second vehicle ››› Fig. 153 . ● Unusual noises during automatic ACC
automatically in the lane.
braking are normal and do not indicate any
WARNING anomalies. Using the camera located in the windscreen,
Using the ACC in the above situations can the Lane Assist system detects the limits (lane
cause serious accidents and injuries, and The following conditions may lead the lines) dividing the lanes in which the vehicle is
you could break the law. ACC not to react: travelling. If the vehicle gets too close to the
● The accelerator or brake is depressed. detected lane limits, the system alerts the
driver through a corrective motion of the
● No gear is engaged or the vehicle is in gear
steering wheel. The driver can cancel the
Problems and solutions R. steering corrective action at any time.
● The vehicle is reversing.
ACC not available No warning is produced with the turn signals
 ● ESC is operating. activated, given that the Lane Assist system
The indicator lamp lights up yellow: ● The driver is not wearing his/her seat belt. understands that a lane change is required.
● A vehicle or trailer brake light is faulty.
● The radar sensor is dirty or adjusted incor- System limits
rectly. Take into account the warnings descri- ● The RPM is too high or too low.
Use the Lane Assist system only on large,
bed in this section ››› page 210 ● The parking brake is applied.
well-maintained motorways and highways.
● There is a fault or defect. Turn off the vehi- ● Driving on an excessive slope.
cle's ignition and turn it on again after a few The system is not available under the follow-
minutes. ing conditions:

● If the problem persists, consult a special- ● The driving speed allowed is below approx.
ised workshop. 55 km/h (30 mph).
● The system has not detected any lane
lines.

224
Driver assistance systems

● On tight bends. check certain functions. They will switch off


at all. In these situations, special attention
● Temporarily in very sporty driving situations. is required from the driver and, where ap- after a few seconds.
propriate, the temporary deactivation of
WARNING the lane assist warning system: WARNING

The intelligent technology in the Lane As- – In very sporty driving situations. Observe the safety warnings ››› in Con-
sist system cannot change the limits im- – In adverse weather conditions and trol and warning lamps on page 87.
posed by the laws of physics and by the roads in poor condition.
very nature of the system. Careless or un- – When passing through areas undergo-
controlled use of the Lane Assist system ing works. Driving with the Lane Assist System
may cause accidents and injury. The sys-
– Before gradient changes of grade and
tem is not a replacement for driver aware-
ness or manoeuvres when driving. river beds.
● Always observe the vehicle surroundings
● Always adapt your speed and the dis-
tance to the vehicles ahead in line with visi- carefully and drive proactively.
bility, weather conditions, the condition of ● When the area of vision of the camera
the road and the traffic situation. becomes dirty, covered or is damaged, the
● Always keep your hands on the steering Lane Assist system function can be affec-
wheel so it can be turned at any time. The ted.
responsibility of staying in the lane is al-
ways the driver's.
● The Lane Assist system does not detect Control lamp Fig. 154 On the instrument panel display: indi-
all road markings. The road surfaces, road cations of the Lane Assist System.
structures or objects in poor condition can
 or  It lights up green
be incorrectly detected as road markings 1 Lane line detected. The system inter-
under certain circumstances by the Lane Lane Assist system active and available. venes assisting on the represented side.
Assist system. Immediately counter any un-
wanted intervention of the system. 2 Lane line detected. The system does not
 or  It lights up yellow intervene.
● Please observe the indications on the in-
strument panel and act as is necessary if
The Lane Assist system intervening with a rectifica- Switching the lane assist system on or off
the traffic situation permits. tion of the steering.
● In the following situations there may be In some countries, the Lane Assist System is
undesired interventions of the system or it Some control and warning lamps will light up always activated when the ignition is switch-
may be that the system does not intervene briefly when the ignition is switched on to ed on. The connection status is shown in the
Assistants menu of the Infotainment system »
225
Driving

or the assistant systems menu after pressing display and acoustic warnings, the driver is ● Do not cover the field of vision of the cam-
the corresponding button. The Lane Assist also prompted to drive through the centre of era.
system can be activated and deactivated in the lane if the steering correction lasts more ● Check that the windscreen is not damaged
these menus. than reasonable. in the area of the camera's field of vision.
The Lane Assist system is ready to actively in- ● Do not mount objects on the steering
Steering wheel vibration
tervene as of approximately 60 km/h (35 wheel.
mph) and if it has detected the lane limits The following situations may result in a steer-
(system status: active). The control lamp  ing wheel vibration: In the event of doubts or queries, go to a spe-
emits a green light. When the system inter- cialised workshop.
● The lane ceases to be recognised during a
venes by rectifying the direction, the control
lamp  emits a yellow light. sudden intervention in the direction of the
system.
If the control lamp of the instrument panel Driving Assist (Travel Assist)
display is off, it means that the Lane Assist It is also possible to select steering wheel vi-
system is connected but not ready to inter- bration in the Assistants menu of the infotain-
Introduction
vene or it is disconnected. ment system. In this case, when a vehicle with
Lane Assist switched on crosses over a detec- The driving assist (Travel Assist) combines
When you activate a turn signal, the system
ted lane marking, the steering wheel will vi- adaptive cruise control (ACC) and adap-
temporarily goes into a passive state in order
brate. tive lane guidance. Within the limitations
to allow manual lane change.
of the system, the vehicle can maintain a
An energetic rotation or rectification of the distance from the vehicle in front that is
steering wheel by the driver causes the sys- Troubleshooting preselected by the driver and remain in
tem to temporarily switch to a passive state. the preferred position within the lane.
Error message, the system disconnects
Driver intervention prompt Travel Assist uses the same sensors as Adap-
● Clean the windscreen. ››› page 301
tive Cruise Control (ACC) and Lane Assist.
If the steering is not corrected manually, the ● Check that the windscreen is not damaged Therefore, carefully read the information
system prompts the driver through an indica- in the area of the camera's field of vision. about the ACC ››› page 219 and the Lane As-
tion on the instrument panel display and sist ››› page 224 and take into account the
acoustic warnings. limitations of the systems and the indications
System behaviour is different than expec-
If no reaction is obtained from the driver, the ted given in the information.
system switches to a passive state. ● Clean the field of vision of the camera reg-
Regardless of the steering manoeuvres, ularly and make sure it is free of dirt, snow
through an indication on the instrument panel and ice.
226
Driver assistance systems

Speed range WARNING ● Brake when, after an indication to brake,


Travel Assist adjusts at speeds between ap- the vehicle rolls without it being desired.
The Travel Assist smart technology cannot
prox. 30 km/h (approx. 20 mph) and approx. overcome the limits imposed by the laws of ● Keep your hands on the steering wheel at
210 km/h (approx. 130 mph); in the case of physics and it only works within the limits of all times, to ensure you have control over
the adaptive lane guidance function, be- the system. If Travel assist is used negli- the steering at all times. The driver is al-
tween 0 km/h (0 mph) and approx. 250 km/h gently or involuntarily, it may cause serious ways responsible for keeping the vehicle in
(approx. 155 mph). accidents and injuries. The system is not a its own lane.
replacement for driver awareness. ● If possible, do not wear gloves while driv-
Driving with Travel Assist ● Bear in mind the system limitations and ing. The system could interpret this as no
the indications regarding the control of the driving activity.
Travel Assist automatically controls the ac-
celerator pedal, the brakes and the steering. Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) and Lane ● If driver intervention is requested on the
Assist. instrument panel display, immediately re-
In addition, Travel Assist may, within its limita-
tions, decelerate the vehicle until it stops be- ● Adapt your speed and safety distance to sume control of the vehicle.
hind another that stops and automatically the vehicle in front of you at all times to suit ● Always be prepared to adjust the speed
starts again. visibility, weather, road and traffic condi- yourself.
tions.
You can override assisted adjustment at all ● Do not use Travel Assist when visibility is
times.
bad, on steep roads, on windy roads or in
slippery circumstances (such as snow, ice,
How to know if the vehicle is fitted with rain or loose gravel), or on flooded roads.
Travel Assist
● Do not use Travel Assist offroad or on
The vehicle is fitted with Travel Assist if the roads where the surface is not firm. Travel
multifunction steering wheel has the button Assist has been designed for use on paved
 ››› Fig. 157. roads only.
● Travel Assist does not react to people or
Driver intervention prompt animal or vehicles crossing your path or
which approach you head-on in the same
If you remove your hands from the steering
lane.
wheel, after a few seconds the system asks
you to take over the steering with an indica- ● Brake immediately if Travel Assist does
tion on the instrument panel display and not slow down enough.
acoustic warnings. ● Brake immediately when a braking mes-
sage is displayed on the instrument panel
screen.
227
Driving

Indications on the instrument panel 2 Distance set. Operating Travel Assist


display In addition, depending on the equipment,
control lamps indicate the status of the sys-
tem on the instrument panel display:

››› Fig. 156


A Travel Assist active, adaptive cruise con-
trol and adaptive lane guidance function
are active.
B Travel Assist active, adaptive cruise con-
trol active and adaptive lane guidance
function passive.
Fig. 157 Left side of the multifunction steering
Fig. 155 On the instrument panel display: indi-
C Travel Assist active, adaptive cruise con- wheel: buttons for operating Travel Assist.
cation with active adjustment. trol passive and adaptive lane guidance
function active. Connecting
D Travel Assist active, adaptive cruise con- ● Press the  button on the multifunction
trol and adaptive lane guidance function steering wheel.
are passive.
The control lamp  will light up green. The
E Inactive Travel Assist. following warning is also displayed on the in-
Depending on the equipment, more details strument panel screen: The Travel Assist
may be displayed on the instrument cluster, maintains the current speed and the preset
such as dashed lines or other vehicles on the distance from the vehicle in front. At the same
road. time, if it detects road markings it keeps the
vehicle in the lane by moving the steering
wheel.
Fig. 156 On the instrument panel display: con-
trol lamps.
Interrupting the adjustment
Displays on the screen ● Briefly press the button  on the multifunc-
››› Fig. 155 tion steering wheel or press the brake pedal.
1 The adaptive lane guidance function is The set distance remains saved.
active.
228
Driver assistance systems

Making other adjustments Travel Assist disconnects automatically occur if the blind spot detection system or
For all else, Travel Assist is operated like the Vehicles without Emergency Assist: You have the rear cross traffic alert are used negli-
ACC ››› page 220. released the steering wheel for a long period. gently or involuntarily. The system is not a
replacement for driver awareness.
● Abnormal operation. Contact a specialised ● Adapt your speed and safe distance to
workshop. the vehicle in front of you at all times to suit
Troubleshooting
visibility, weather, road and traffic condi-
The adjustment is interrupted unexpect- tions.
 Travel Assist is not available or does edly
not work as expected ● Keep your hands on the wheel at all times
Vehicles without lane departure warning: You to be ready to intervene in the steering at
The control lamp switches on yellow. A rele-
have turned on the turn signal. any time.
vant warning is also displayed on the instru-
● Pay attention to the indicator lamps that
ment panel screen.
may come on in the external rear view mir-
● There is a fault in the sensors. Check the rors and on the instrument cluster, and fol-
causes and solutions described in Side Assist with Rear Cross low any instructions they may give.
››› page 210. Traffic Alert (RCTA) ● The lane departure warning could react
● The system limits are exceeded. to any special constructions that might be
present to the sides of the vehicle, e.g. high
● If the fault continues, consult a specialised Introduction or irregular dividers. This may cause erro-
workshop. neous warnings.
The lane departure warning (LCA) helps de-
● Never use the lane departure warning on
tect traffic that is at the rear of the vehicle.
 Take the wheel unpaved roads. The lane departure warn-
The warning lamp comes on white or red, de- The rear cross traffic alert (RCTA) helps the ing has been designed for use on paved
pending on the urgency of the intervention. A driver when backing out of a parallel parking roads.
message is also displayed. spot and when manoeuvring. ● Always pay attention to the vehicle's sur-
roundings.
● You released the steering wheel for a few WARNING
● The control lamps of the lane departure
seconds. Take hold of the steering wheel and
The smart technology incorporated into warning may have limited functionality due
take control of the vehicle. the blind spot detector (BSD) with parking to solar radiation. »
● The system limits have been reached. Take assistance (RCTA) included cannot over-
hold of the steering wheel and take control of come the limits imposed by the laws of
the vehicle. physics; it only works within the limits of the
system. Accidents and severe injury may

229
Driving

Note Control lamp in external rear view mirrors: WARNING


If the blind spot detector with parking as-  It lights up Failure to pay attention to any lit warning
sistant does not work as described in this lamps and the corresponding messages
chapter, stop using it and contact a speci- It turns on once briefly: the lane departure warning is could cause serious accidents and injuries.
alised workshop. activated and ready to operate, i.e. when activating
the system. ● Never ignore the warning lamps or mes-
sages.
It lights up continuously: the lane departure warning
● Carry out the necessary operations.
has detected a vehicle in the blind spot.
Control lamp
CAUTION
 Flashes
Failure to heed the control lamps and cor-
A vehicle has been detected in the adjacent lane and
responding text messages when they light
the turn signal has been engaged in the direction of
the detected vehicle ››› . up may result in damage to the vehicle.

For vehicles that are also equipped with Lane Assist


››› page 224, a warning to switch lanes will also ap-
pear even though the turn signal has not been en- Lane departure warning (Side As-
gaged (Lane Assist “Plus” ››› page 231). sist)
The control lamps light up when the ignition is The lane departure warning uses radar sen-
switched on and should turn off after approxi- sors to monitor the areas behind the vehicle
mately 2 seconds. This is the time taken for ››› page 8. The system does this by measur-
the function check. ing the vehicle's distance from other vehicles
If there are no indications from the control and its speed differential. The lane departure
lamp of the lane departure warning, this warning will not work at speeds of less than
means that the lane departure warning has approx. 15 km/h (9 mph). The system uses
not detected any other vehicles at the rear optical signals in the external rear view mir-
area ››› . rors to notify the driver.

When the exterior lighting is low, the intensity The lane width is not detected individually,
with which the control lamps come on is dim- but is rather pre-configured in the system.
Fig. 158 Control lamp of the lane departure
med. The user can modify the intensity of the Thus if you are driving in wide lanes or in be-
warning.
control lamps with up to 5 levels in the info- tween two lanes, the indications may be in-
tainment system menu. correct. Furthermore, the system can detect

230
Driver assistance systems

vehicles driving in the lane next to you (if ● The lamp flashes in the corresponding rear-
there are any), and can also detect station- view mirror even though the turn signal has
ary objects such as dividers, and thus give an not been activated.
incorrect indication. ● The steering wheel vibrates to warn the
driver of the risk of collision.
Indication on the exterior mirror
● torque is applied to correct the steering
The control lamp provides an indication on and return the vehicle to its lane.
the corresponding side regarding the traffic
situation behind the vehicle, if it is deemed to
be critical. The control lamp on the left-hand
Driving situations
side indicates the traffic situation to the rear
left of the vehicle, and the control lamp on
the right-hand side indicates the traffic situa-
tion to the rear right of the vehicle ››› Fig. 158.
In the case of retrofitted tinted windows or
windows with tinted film, the indications of the
external mirrors may not be seen clearly or
correctly.
Fig. 160 Schematic representation:  Situa-
Keep the external mirrors clean and free of tion of passing and then moving into the right-
snow and ice, and do not cover them with ad- hand lane.  Indication from the blind spot de-
hesives or other similar materials. tector in the right-hand external mirror.

In the following situations, an indication will


Lane assist Plus. be displayed in the external mirror ››› Fig. 159
 (arrow) or ››› Fig. 160  (arrow):
The Lane Assist Plus function can be used by ● When being overtaken by another vehicle
activating the Lane Assist ››› page 224 and
››› Fig. 159 .
Side Assist functions. In this case its functions
are expanded as described below. ● When passing another vehicle ››› Fig. 160
Fig. 159 Schematic representation:  Passing  with a speed differential of approx. 10 km/h
If the driver initiates a lane change manoeu- situation with traffic behind the vehicle.  Indi- (6 mph). If the vehicle is passing at a consid-
vre in a potential critical situation: cation from the blind spot detector in the left- erably higher speed, no indication will be dis-
hand external mirror. played. »
231
Driving

The faster a vehicle approaches, the sooner Rear cross traffic alert (RCTA) played in the form of a red or yellow strip at
an indication will be displayed in the exterior the back of the image of the vehicle on the in-
mirror, because Side Assist takes into account fotainment system screen. This strip displays
the different in speed compared to other ve- the side of the vehicle towards which traffic is
hicles. Thus even though the distance from approaching in transverse direction1).
the other vehicle is identical, the indication
will appear sooner in some cases and later in Automatic braking to reduce damages
others.
If the rear cross traffic alert detects that
someone else on the road is approaching the
Physical limitations inherent to the system rear of the vehicle and the driver does not
In some situations the lane departure warning step on the brake, the system will engage the
may not interpret the traffic situation correct- brakes automatically.
ly. I.e. in the following situations: Fig. 161 Schematic representation of the rear
The parking system helps the driver by auto-
cross traffic alert assistant: zone monitored
● on tight bends; around the vehicle while leaving a parking matically engaging the brakes to reduce any
space. damage. The automatic intervention on the
● in the case of lanes with different widths;
brakes takes place when driving in reverse at
● in areas with significant gradient changes; Park Assist uses the radar sensors on the rear approx. 1-12 km/h (1-7 mph). After detecting
● in adverse weather conditions; bumper ››› page 210 to monitor the traffic that the vehicle is stationary, the system
● in the case of special constructions to the crossing behind the vehicle as it backs out of keeps it that way for around 2 seconds.
side of the vehicle, e.g., high or irregular divid- a parallel parking space or as it is being man-
After automatically braking to reduce dam-
ers. oeuvred, for example in very low visibility con-
age, the system will not be able to automati-
ditions.
cally brake again for approximately 10 sec-
When the system detects a relevant vehicle onds.
on the road that is approaching the rear of
You can interrupt the automatic braking by
the vehicle ››› Fig. 161, an acoustic alarm
stepping hard on the accelerator pedal or
may sound if the relevance so requires it.
the brake pedal in order to regain control of
In addition to the acoustic alarm, the driver is the vehicle.
also informed by means of a visual signal on
infotainment system display. This signal is dis-

1) It is only displayed if the vehicle is equipped

with a parking system.


232
Driver assistance systems

WARNING Open the Assistants menu. switched off manually when driving with a
●  Side Assist trailer.
The smart technology incorporated into
the rear cross traffic alert cannot over- ●  Rear cross traffic alert
come the limits imposed by the laws of
physics; it only works within the limits of the If the verification box on the instrument panel
system. The parking assistant function or the infotainment system is checked , the
should not tempt you into taking any risks. functionality will be automatically activated
The system is not a replacement for driver when switching on the ignition.
awareness.
When the Side Assist is ready to operate, the
● The system should never be used in limi- indicator turns on briefly on the exterior rear
ted visibility conditions or complicated view mirrors as confirmation.
traffic, e.g., in high-traffic areas or when
crossing multiple lanes. When the vehicle is restarted, the last adjust-
● Be sure to always be aware of the vehi-
ment in the system will remain active.
cle's surroundings, since the system often
fails to detect things such as bicycles or Trailer mode
pedestrians. Side Assist and the rear cross traffic alert are
● The rear cross traffic alert itself will not automatically deactivated and cannot be
brake the vehicle to a complete stop. switched on if the factory-fitted tow-bar is
electrically connected to a trailer or similar
device.
Managing the assist systems As soon as the driver starts to drive with a
trailer connected electrically to the vehicle, a
Enabling and disabling the assist systems message is displayed on the instrument pan-
The blind spot detector with parking assistant el display indicating that the Side Assist and
can be switched on and off by accessing the the rear cross traffic alert are switched off.
Assistants menu on the dash panel display Once the trailer has been unhooked from the
using the steering wheel controls. If the vehi- vehicle, if you want to use the Side Assist and
cle is equipped with a multifunction camera, the rear cross traffic alert, you will have to re-
it can also be accessed by means of the as- activate them in the corresponding menu.
sistants systems key located on the main If the tow-bar is not factory fitted, Side Assist
beam headlight lever. and the rear cross traffic alert should be

233
Driving

Braking and parking ● If the brake warning lamp lights up  to- Wet roads or road salt
gether with the ABS lamp  this could be In certain situations (for example, on driving
due to an ABS fault. When this function through flooded areas, in severe downpours
Braking system fails, the rear wheels can lock up. Under or after washing the vehicle) the braking ac-
certain circumstances, the rear of the vehi- tion could be delayed if the discs and pads
Control lamps cle may skid, with the danger of losing con- are damp, or frozen in winter. In this case the
trol. Stop and seek technical assistance.
brakes should be “dried” by pressing the
 It lights up red brake pedal several times.

Brake fluid level too low ››› page 284 or fault in the At high speed and with the windscreen wipers
Information about the brakes activated, the brake pads will briefly touch
brake system.
 Do not carry on driving! the brake discs. This takes place, although
New brake pads
unnoticeable to the driver, at regular intervals
For the first 200 to 300 km (100 to 200 to improve the response time of the brakes
 It lights up red
miles), new brake pads have not yet reached when they are wet.
Handbrake applied ››› page 236. their maximum braking capacity, and need to
The warning lamp turns off when the handbrake is re- be “run in” first. However, you can compen- The effectiveness of the brakes can also be
leased. sate for the slightly reduced braking effect by temporarily reduced if the vehicle is driven for
applying more pressure on the brake pedal. some distance without using the brakes when
WARNING Avoid overloading the brakes while running there is a lot of salt on the road in winter. The
them in. layer of salt that accumulates on the discs
● When the ignition is switched on, the sta-
and pads can be removed by gently apply-
tus of the brake system and the brake as-
ing the brakes a few times.
sist functions is automatically checked. Wear
The control lights on the instrument cluster
The rate of wear on the brake pads depends Corrosion
light up briefly and then turn off again. If a
a great deal on how you drive and the condi-
warning light stays on permanently, there There may be a tendency for corrosion to
tions in which the vehicle is operated. This is a
is a fault. Seek qualified technical assis- form on the discs and dirt to build up on the
particular problem in urban traffic and short
tance immediately. brake pads if the vehicle is used infrequently
stretches, or with very sporty driving.
● If the brake warning lamp  does not go or the brakes are not used very often.
out or if it lights up when driving, the brake Depending on the speed, the braking force
and the environmental conditions (e.g. tem- If the brakes are not used frequently, or if rust
fluid level in the reservoir is too lo so there
is a risk of an accident ››› page 284, Brake perature, air humidity, etc.) noises may be has formed on the disks, it is advisable to
fluid. Stop the vehicle and do not drive on. produced when braking. clean off the pads and disks by braking firmly
Obtain technical assistance. a few times at a moderately high speed ››› .

234
Braking and parking

Fault in the brake system ● Brakes can overheat if used excessively sulting in longer stopping distances and
If the brake pedal travel should ever increase on slopes. Before driving down a long steep greater wear.
suddenly, this may mean that one of the two slope, it is advisable to reduce speed and ● Before driving down a long, steep gradi-
brake circuits has failed. Drive immediately to change down into a lower gear or range. ent, it is advisable to reduce speed and se-
the nearest specialised workshop and have Therefore, using the engine brake relieves lect a lower gear. This makes use of engine
the fault repaired. Drive there slowly and re- the brakes. braking and relieves the brakes. If you still
member that you will have to apply more ● Gentle continuous braking causes the have to use the brakes, it is better to brake
pressure on the brake pedal and allow for brakes to overheat and the braking dis- firmly at intervals than to apply the brakes
longer stopping distances. tance will increase. Apply and then release continuously.
the brakes alternately.
Low brake fluid level ● Apply the brakes heavily to clean the Note
brake system only in a suitable traffic situa-
Malfunctions can occur in the brake system if ● If the brake servo is out of action, for ex-
tion. Do not put other road users in danger:
the brake fluid level is too low. The brake fluid there is risk of causing an accident. ample when the car is being towed, you will
level is monitored electronically. have to press the brake pedal considerably
● Ensure the vehicle does not move while in
harder than normal to make up for the lack
neutral, when the engine is stopped. The of servo assistance.
Brake servo
braking distance is increased considerably
● If you wish to equip the vehicle with ac-
The brake servo increases the pressure you when the brake servo is not active.
cessories such as a front spoiler or wheel
apply to the brake pedal. It works only when ● If the brake is subjected to high stresses,
covers, it is important that the flow of air to
the engine is running. vapour bubbles may form in the brake sys- the front wheels is not obstructed, other-
tem's pipes. This reduces the efficiency of wise the brakes can overheat.
WARNING the brakes.
Any anomaly in the brake system can in- ● Non-standard or damaged front spoilers
crease the braking distance, with the re- could restrict the airflow to the brakes and
sulting risk of an accident. cause them to overheat. Before purchasing
● New brake pads and discs must be run in accessories please read the relevant in-
and do not have the correct friction during structions.
the first 200 km (124 miles). This reduced
braking capacity may be offset by pressing CAUTION
on the brake pedal a little harder.
● Never let the brakes “drag” by leaving
● If you are driving on roads which have
your foot on the pedal when it is not neces-
been salted, braking effectiveness may be sary to brake. This overheats the brakes, re-
decreased.

235
Driving

Handbrake WARNING use the handbrake, making start-up easier,


more comfortable and safer.
● Never use the handbrake to stop the vehi-
cle when it is in motion. The braking dis- These are the basic operation conditions:
tance is considerably longer, because
● being on a ramp or hill/slope,
braking is only applied to the rear wheels.
Risk of accident! ● driver door closed,
● Failure to fully lower the handbrake lever ● vehicle completely stationary,
can affect the operation of the system, and
● engine running and foot on the brake,
can also cause heating and wear of the
rear brakes. ● having a gear engaged or being in neutral
for a manual gearbox, or with the selector
lever at positions D/S or R for an automatic
CAUTION
Fig. 162 Handbrake between the front seats. gearbox.
Always apply the handbrake before you
The handbrake should be applied firmly to leave the vehicle. In addition, engage first WARNING
prevent the vehicle from accidentally moving. or rear gear in the gradient function, or set
● If you do not start the vehicle immediate-
Apply the handbrake when you leave your the selection lever to P.
ly after taking your foot off the brake pedal,
vehicle and when you park. the vehicle may roll back under certain
conditions. Depress the brake pedal or use
Applying the handbrake Hill driving assistant the hand brake immediately.
– Pull the handbrake lever up ››› Fig. 162. 3 Valid for vehicles: with ESC ● If the engine stalls, depress the brake
pedal or use the hand brake immediately.
Releasing the handbrake The hill driving assistant helps the driver to ● When following a line of traffic uphill, if
move off and upward on a hill, both forwards you want to prevent the vehicle from rolling
– Pull the lever up slightly and press the re-
and backwards, when the vehicle is station- back when starting off, hold the brake ped-
lease knob in the direction of the arrow
ary. al down for a few seconds before starting
››› Fig. 162 and guide the handbrake lever
The system maintains brake pressure for ap- off.
down fully ››› .
proximately two seconds after the foot is tak-
Always pull the handbrake all the way up, to en off the brake pedal, to prevent the vehicle Note
avoid driving off while the brake is on ››› . from moving when it is started. During these 2
The Official Service or a specialist work-
seconds, the driver has enough time to re- shop can tell you if your vehicle is equip-
lease the clutch pedal and accelerate with- ped with this system.
out the vehicle moving and without having to
236
Braking and parking

Stabilisation and brake as- WARNING The ASR can be deactivated when wheel spin
is desirable ››› page 239.
sistance systems When the ignition is switched on, the status
of the brake system and the brake assist
Anti-lock brake system (ABS)
functions is automatically checked. The
Control lamps control lights on the instrument cluster ABS prevents the wheels from locking up un-
light up briefly and then turn off again. If a der braking until the vehicle has reached a
 It lights up warning light stays on permanently, there virtual standstill. You can continue to steer the
is a fault. Seek qualified technical assis- vehicle even when the brakes are on full.
Fault in the ESC or ABS, or disconnection caused by tance immediately. Keep your foot on the brake pedal and do not
the system.
The ESC works in combination with the ABS. If the pump the brakes. You will feel the brake pedal
ABS fails, the lamp also lights up. pulsate while the ABS is working.
Brake assist systems If the running gear or brake system is modi-
 Flashes fied, the effectiveness of the ABS could be se-
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) verely limited.
ESC or ASR activated.
The ESC helps to improve safety. It reduces
the tendency to skid and improves the stabili- Hydraulic Brake Assist (HBA)
 It lights up ty and roadholding of the vehicle. The ESC The brake assist system can reduce the re-
Fault in the ASR or disconnection caused by the sys- detects critical handling situations, such as quired braking distance. The braking force is
tem. vehicle understeer or oversteer, or wheelspin automatically boosted if you press the brake
on the driving wheels. It stabilises the vehicle pedal quickly in an emergency. You must
Flashes by braking individual wheels or by reducing
 the engine torque. The warning lamp will
keep pressing the brake pedal until the dan-
ger has passed.
ASR working. flash on the instrument panel when the ESC is
intervening .
Traction control system (ASR)
 It lights up The ESC includes the anti-lock brake system In the event of wheelspin, the traction control
ASR manually deactivated. (ABS), the hydraulic brake assist (HBA), the system reduces the engine torque to match
traction control system (ASR), electronic dif- the amount of grip available. This helps the
Or: ESC in Sport mode ››› page 239. ferential lock (EDS), electronic torque control car to start moving, accelerate or climb a
(XDS). gradient. »
 It lights up
ESC also helps stabilise the vehicle by
ABS faulty or does not work. changing the torque.

237
Driving

Electronic differential lock (EDL) hand, the outer wheel is receiving a lower ● When the braking pressure through press-

When the EDL detects wheelspin, it brakes drive torque than it could transmit. This can ing the brake pedal is greater than the sys-
the spinning wheel and directs the power to cause a loss of grip on the drive axle, in this tem’s braking pressure the vehicle will brake
the other driven wheel. This function is active case the front axle, which results in under- automatically.
up to approximately 100 km/h (62 mph). steer or “lengthening” of the trajectory. ● Multi-collision braking will not be available
The XDS can detect and correct this effect if there is an anomaly in the ESC system.
To prevent the disc brake of the braked wheel
from overheating, the EDL cuts out automati- via the sensors and signals of the ESC.
WARNING
cally if subjected to excessive loads. The ve- Via the ESC, the XDS will brake the inside
hicle can still be driven. The EDL will switch on wheel and counter the excess driving torque Driving at high speed on icy, slippery wet
again automatically when the brake has ground can result in loss of vehicle control
of that wheel. This means that the requested
cooled down. and serious injury to the driver and passen-
trajectory is much more precise.
gers.
XDS works in combination with the ESC and is ● The ESC, ABS, ASR, EDS and the electron-
Tractor-trailer sway mitigation
always active, even when ASR is disconnec- ic torque control system cannot exceed the
If the vehicle is pulling a trailer, it will control ted, or when the ESC is in Sport mode or dis- limits imposed by the laws of physics. Al-
the following: tractor-trailers tend to sway. connected. ways bear this in mind, especially on wet or
When the swaying of the trailer is felt by the slippery roads. If you notice the systems
vehicle and detected by the ESC, it will auto- Multi-collision brake cutting in, you should reduce your speed
matically brake the towing vehicle within the immediately to suit the road and traffic
The multi-collision brake consists of automat-
limits of the system and mitigate the sway. conditions. Do not be encouraged to take
ic braking activated by the Airbag control
Tractor-trailer sway mitigation is not available risks by the presence of more safety sys-
unit. It is activated when, in the event of an
in all countries ››› page 262. tems. If you do, an accident may occur.
accident, the Airbag control unit detects de-
● Please remember that the accident risk
celerations above the activation level, and
Electronic engine torque management always increases if you drive fast, espe-
braking is managed by the ESC system.
(XDS) cially in corners or on a slippery road, or if
When taking a curve, the driveshaft differen- In the event of an accident, the multi-collision you follow too close behind the vehicle in
brake can help the driver by braking to avoid front of you. The ESC, ABS, brake assist,
tial allows the outer wheel to turn at a higher
the risk of skidding during the accident and EDS and the electronic torque control sys-
speed than the inner wheel. In this way, the
causing other collisions. tem cannot prevent accidents: risk of acci-
wheel that is turning faster (outer wheel) re-
dents!
ceives less drive torque than the inner wheel. The following actions control automatic brak-
● Accelerate with caution on slippery sur-
This may mean that in certain situations the ing during the accident:
faces (for example, icy or snow-covered).
torque delivered to the inner wheel is too
● When the driver presses the accelerator, Despite the control systems, the driven
high, causing the wheels to spin. On the other
the automatic braking does not take place.
238
Braking and parking

wheels could spin, affecting the stability of Depending on the finishes and versions, there ● With ESC in Sport mode, the stabilising
the vehicle: risk of accident! is the possibility of disconnecting only the function will be limited to allow for a sporti-
ASR or activating the ESC in “Sport” mode. er drive. The driving wheels could spin and
the vehicle could skid.
Note
Disconnecting and connecting the ASR
● The ABS and ASR will only operate cor-
● The ASR can be switched off and on using Note
rectly if the four wheels have identical
the infotainment system ››› page 88. In vehi-
tyres. Any differences in the rolling radius If the ASR is disconnected or the Sport
of the tyres can cause the system to re-
cles with a driver information system the cor- mode is selected, cruise control will be
duce engine power when this is not desired. responding indication will be displayed. switched off.
● The regulating processes of the systems When the ASR is disconnected, the control
can make noises due to their operation. warning light  lights up on the instrument
● If the warning lamp  or  lights up, cluster.
there could be a fault ››› page 86.
Parking
● Any modifications made to the vehicle Disconnecting and connecting the ESC in
(for example, to the engine, brake system, “Sport” mode To park the vehicle
running gear or to the combination of ● In “Sport” mode, the ESC can be discon- When parking your vehicle, all legal require-
wheels and tyres) may affect the operation
nected and connected using the infotainment ments should be observed.
of the ABS, ASR and EDS.
system ››› page 88. In vehicles with a driver
information system the corresponding indica- Always note the following points when park-
tion will be displayed. ing the vehicle:
Connecting and disconnecting the ● Park the vehicle on a suitable surface ››› .
When “Sport” mode is turned on, ESC inter-
ESC and ASR ● Apply the handbrake ››› page 236.
ventions to stabilise the vehicle, and anti-slip
regulation (ASR) are limited. In addition, the  ● For an automatic gearbox, move the selec-
The ESC is switched on automatically when
control lamp lights up on the instrument pan- tor lever to position P.
the engine is started, and only works when
el.
the engine is running and includes the ABS, ● Switch the engine off and remove the key
EDS and ASR systems. from the ignition. Turn the steering wheel
WARNING
The ASR function should only be switched off slightly to engage the steering lock.
The ESC Sport mode should be activated
in situations in which traction is insufficient. ● With a manual gearbox, engage first gear
only when traffic conditions and the ability
of the driver allow it. Danger of skidding! on flat ground and slopes, or even reverse
gear on hills, and release the clutch pedal. »
239
Driving

● When leaving the vehicle, take all keys with


you.
Note Help with parking and ma-
In vehicles with automatic transmission, the
key can only be removed from the ignition
noeuvring
Additionally, on steep slopes and inclines
when the lever is in position P.
Before switching off the engine, rotate the Assisted parking system
steering wheel so that if the vehicle should
move, it will be held by the kerb. (Park Assist)
● On slopes, turn the front wheels so that
Introduction
they are against the edge of the kerb.
● Uphill, turn the wheels towards the centre of The Park Assist system is an additional
the road. ParkPilot function ››› page 247 and helps the
driver to:
WARNING
● find a suitable parking space,
● Avoid parking the vehicle where the hot
● select a parking mode,
exhaust system could ignite inflammable
materials, such as dry grass, low bushes, ● park driving in reverse in suitable perpen-
spilt fuel or flammable materials. dicular and parallel spaces,
● Do not leave passengers inside a closed ● park driving forwards in suitable perpendic-
vehicle, they may not be able to open ular spaces,
doors or windows. Locked doors hinder the
● exit a parking space driving forwards from a
possibility of a rescue.
parallel space.
● Children should not be left alone in the
vehicle. They could tamper with the hand- In vehicles with a Park Assist system and fac-
brake or the gears, which could cause the tory infotainment system, the front, rear and
vehicle to move without control. side areas are represented, and the position
● Depending on weather conditions, it may of obstacles is shown relative to the vehicle.
become extremely hot or cold inside the
vehicle. This can be fatal.
The Park Assist system is subject to certain
limitations inherent to the system and its use
requires special attention by the driver ››› .

240
Help with parking and manoeuvring

WARNING WARNING not apply it directly unless very briefly and


always from a distance of more than 10 cm.
The technology used in the park assist sys- Quick turns of the steering wheel when
tem involves a series of limitations inherent parking or exiting a parking space with ● A registration plate or plate holder on the
in the actual system and in the use of ultra- Park Assist can cause serious injury. front with larger than the space for the reg-
sonic sensors. The use of Park Assist should ● Do not hold the steering wheel during
istration plate, or a registration plate that is
never tempt you to take any risk that may curved or warped can cause:
manoeuvres to park or exit a parking space
compromise safety. The system is not a re- until the system requests it. Doing so disa- – False detections.
placement for driver awareness. bles the system during the manoeuvre, re- – The sensors to lose visibility.
● Any accidental movement of the vehicle sulting in the parking being cancelled.
– Cancellation of the parking manoeuvre
could result in serious injury.
or defective parking.
● Adapt your speed and driving style at all CAUTION ● If one of the ultrasonic sensors is dam-
times to suit visibility, weather, road and
● In certain circumstances, the ultrasonic aged, the area corresponding to that group
traffic conditions.
sensors do not detect objects such as trail- of sensors (front or rear) is deactivated and
● Certain surfaces of objects and gar- cannot be activated until the fault is cor-
er tongues, bars, fences, posts or thin trees,
ments do not reflect the ultrasound sen- or an open (or opening) rear lid, which rected. However, you can still use the sen-
sors' signals. The system cannot detect, at could damage the vehicle. sors of the other bumper as per usual. If
least correctly, these objects or people there is a fault in the system, consult a spe-
● Retrofitting of certain accessories to the
wearing such clothes. cialist workshop. SEAT recommends visiting
vehicle, such as a bicycle rack, may inter-
● Ultrasound sensor signals may be affec- a SEAT dealership for this.
fere with the operation of the Park Assist
ted by external sound sources. In certain system and cause damage.
circumstances this may prevent them from
● The Park Assist system uses as a refer- Note
detecting people or objects.
ence parked vehicles, curbs and other ob- ● In order to guarantee good system oper-
● The ultrasound sensors have blind spots
jects. Make sure that the tyres and wheels ation, keep the ultrasound sensors of the
in which obstacles and people are not reg- are not damaged while parking. If necessa- bumper clean, free of snow or ice, and do
istered. ry, opportunely interrupt the parking ma- not cover them with adhesives or other ob-
● Monitor the area around the vehicle at all noeuvre to avoid damaging the vehicle. jects.
times, since the ultrasound sensors do not ● The ultrasound sensors on the bumper ● Certain sources of noise, such as rough
detect small children, animals or certain may be damaged or shifted in the event of asphalt or paving stones and the noise of
objects in all situations. a collision, for example, when entering or other vehicles can induce the Park Assist
exiting a parking space. system or ParkPilot to give erroneous warn-
● If you use high-pressure or vapour equip- ings. The presence of metal objects can al-
ment to clean the ultrasound sensors, do so affect the manoeuvre. »
241
Driving

● In order to become familiar with the sys- ● Speed when passing next to the parking ● Press the  button.
tem and its functions, SEAT recommends space (parallel parking): do not exceed ap- ● The speed exceeds approximately 7 km/h
that you practice operating the Park Assist prox. 40 km/h (25 mph). (4 mph).
system in an area where there is not too ● Speed when passing next to the parking ● The driver takes hold of the steering wheel.
much traffic or in a car park. space (angle parking): do not exceed approx.
● The parking manoeuvre does not end within
20 km/h (12 mph).
6 minutes from the activation of automatic
● Keep a distance between 0.5 and 2.0 me-
steering.
Description of the parking assist tres when driving past the parking space.
● There is a fault in the system (the system is
system ● Space length (parallel parking): vehicle
temporarily unavailable).
length + 0.8 meters.
● ASR is switched off.
● Space width (angle parking): vehicle width
● ASR or ESC intervene with regulation.
+ 0.8 meters.
● The driver door is opened.
● Do not exceed approximately 7 km/h
(4 mph) when parking. To restart the manoeuvre it is necessary that
none of these things occur and that the 
Requirements for leaving the parking button is pressed again.
space (only for parallel parking)
● The traction control system (ASR) must be Special characteristics
turned on ››› page 239. The Park Assist system is subject to certain
Fig. 163 In the centre console: button to switch ● Space length: length of the vehicle + 0.5 limitations inherent to the system. For exam-
on the Park Assist system. metres. ple, it is therefore not possible to enter or exit
● Do not exceed approximately 7 km/h a parking space on sharp bends.
The components of the Park Assist system
are the ultrasonic sensors located in the front (4 mph) when exiting the parking space. While entering or exiting a parking space, a
and rear bumpers, the  button ››› Fig. 163 to brief signal sounds to prompt the driver to
switch the system on and off and the mes- Prematurely stopping or automatically in- change between forward and reverse gears
sages on the instrument panel display. terrupting the manoeuvres for parking or (depending on the case). In successive ma-
exiting a parking space noeuvres, the assistant tells the driver to
Prerequisites for parking Park Assist interrupts the manoeuvres for change gears, at the latest, when the contin-
parking or exiting a parking space in any of uous audible signal is given (object present at
● The traction control system (ASR) must be
the following cases: a distance of ≤30 cm) by Park Pilot.
turned on ››› page 239.

242
Help with parking and manoeuvring

When the Park Assist system turns the steer- Selecting a parking mode  Reverse parallel parking.
ing wheel with the vehicle stationary, the in-  Reverse angle parking.
strument panel also displays the symbol .
 Forward angle parking.
Keep the brake pedal depressed while the
symbol remains on the dash panel display to
turn the wheels with the vehicle stopped. This Selecting a parking mode after passing in
way, the system will require fewer manoeu- front of the space
vres to complete the parking action. After activating the Park Assist system and af-
ter detecting a parking space, the display on
Trailer mode the instrument panel proposes a parking
mode. The Park Assist system selects the
The Park Assist system cannot be switched
parking mode automatically. The selected
on if the factory-fitted towing bracket
mode is shown on the instrument panel dis-
››› page 256 is electrically connected to a Fig. 164 On the instrument panel display: view
of the parking assist system with reduced view. play ››› Fig. 164. The reduced display of other
trailer.
possible parking modes is also shown
After changing a wheel
››› Fig. 165. If the mode selected by the sys-
tem does not correspond to the desired
If, after changing a wheel, the vehicle stops mode, you can select another mode by
entering and exiting parking spaces correct- pressing the  button ››› Fig. 163.
ly, the circumference of the new wheel may
be different and the system may need to ● The necessary conditions to park with Park
adapt to it. The adaptation is automatic and Assist have to be met ››› page 242.
takes place during driving. Making turns slow- ● Press the  button.
ly and in both directions (20 km/h [12 mph])
● A control lamp on the  button lights up
for a few minutes may contribute to this
when the system is switched on. Additionally,
adaptation process ››› in Introduction on
the selected parking mode is shown on the
page 241.
instrument panel display and the reduced
display shows another parking mode it can
be changed to.
Fig. 165 On the instrument panel display: indi-
cation of parking modes. ● Turn on the corresponding turn signal to-
wards the side of the road where you are
Parking assist has the following 3 parking parking. The instrument panel displays the
modes: side corresponding to the road. By default, if »
243
Driving

the turn signal is not on, it parks on the right in fic and drive the vehicle past the parking ● Press the  button once.
the direction of traffic. space. ● A control lamp on the  button lights up
● If necessary, press the  button again to when the system is switched on. Additionally,
change to the next parking mode. Special case of perpendicular parking the selected parking mode is shown on the
space to park forwards without driving instrument panel display without reduced
● Once you have switched to all possible
past first display.
parking modes, if the  button is pressed
again, the system switches off. ● The necessary conditions to park with Park ● Release the steering wheel ››› in Intro-
Assist have to be met ››› page 242. duction on page 241.
● Press the  button again to switch the sys-
tem back on. ● Drive forward towards the parking space
while paying attention to traffic and stop the
● Follow the instructions displayed on the in-
vehicle.
strument panel while paying attention to traf-

244
Help with parking and manoeuvring

Parking with the parking assist system

Fig. 166 On the instrument panel display: paral-


lel parking.  Finding a parking space.  Park-
ing position.  Manoeuvring.

Fig. 167 On the instrument panel display: angle


parking.  Finding a parking space.  Parking
position.  Manoeuvring.

1 Message to move forwards The necessary conditions have to be met to “appropriate” if the display on the instrument
2 Your vehicle park with Park Assist ››› page 242 and the panel shows the message to park 4 .
parking mode must be selected ››› page 243. ● Stop the vehicle and, after a brief pause,
3 Parking space detected
engage the reverse gear.
4 Message to park Parking
● Release the steering wheel ››› in Intro-
5 Message to press the brake pedal ● Look at the display on the instrument panel
duction on page 241.
to see if the space has been detected as “ap-
6 Progress bar ● Please note the following message: Auto-
propriate” and if the correct position for park-
ing has been reached ››› Fig. 166  matic steering enabled. Pay atten-
or ››› Fig. 167 . The space is considered tion to your surroundings. While you »
245
Driving

keep watch around you, carefully start accel- Progress bars 1 Your vehicle in reverse gear
erating up to no more than 7 km/h (4 mph). The progress bar 2 Message giving the proposed manoeuvre
During the parking manoeuvre, the system
››› Fig. 166 6 and ››› Fig. 167 6 on the to exit the parking space
only takes charge of the steering. You, as the screen of the instrument panel displays the 3 Progress bar to indicate the distance left
driver, have to accelerate, engage the relative distance to be covered. The greater to cover
clutch if necessary, change gears and the distance, the fuller the progress bar.
brake. When driving forward, the content of the pro- Leaving a parking space (parallel parking)
● Reverse until the continuous ParkPilot sig- gress bar decreases upwards, and when re-
nal sounds; OR: reverse until the indication to versing, it decreases downwards. The necessary conditions to exit a parking
move forward appears on the instrument space with Park Assist have to be met
panel display ››› Fig. 166  or ››› Fig. 167  ; Note ››› page 242.
OR: reverse until the Park Assist finish- ● Press the  button ››› Fig. 163. A control
If the manoeuvre is terminated prematurely
ed message appears on the instrument panel during parking, the result may not be the lamp on the  button lights up when the sys-
display. The progress bar 6 indicates the best. tem is switched on.
distance to cover ››› page 246.
● Turn on the corresponding turn signal to-
● Press the brake pedal until the parking as-
wards the road you will enter when exiting the
sist system completes the steering wheel
Leaving a parking space with the parking space.
turns; OR: until the symbol  goes out on the
instrument panel screen. parking assist system (only for par- ● Select reverse gear.

● Select first gear. allel parking) ● Release the steering wheel ››› in Intro-
duction on page 241. Please note the follow-
● Move forward until the continuous ParkPilot
ing message: Automatic steering ena-
signal sounds; OR: move forward until the re-
bled Pay attention to your surround-
verse indication appears on the instrument
ings. While you keep watch around you,
panel display. The Park Assist system steers
carefully start accelerating up to no more
the vehicle forward and back until it centres it
than 7 km/h (4 mph). When exiting the park-
in the space ››› Fig. 166  or ››› Fig. 167 .
ing space, the system only takes charge of
● For best results, wait at the end of each the steering. You, as the driver, have to ac-
manoeuvre until the Park Assist system has celerate, engage the clutch if necessary,
finished turning the steering wheel. The park- change gears and brake.
ing manoeuvre ends when a corresponding ● Reverse until the continuous ParkPilot sig-
message is displayed on the instrument pan- Fig. 168 On the instrument panel display: exit nal sounds; OR: reverse until the instrument
el and, in some cases, an acoustic signal a parallel parking space. panel display shows the forward indication.
sounds.
246
Help with parking and manoeuvring

The progress bar ››› Fig. 168 3 indicates the Automatic braking intervention to avoid ● The Park Assist system is subject to cer-
distance to cover ››› page 246. exceeding the speed limit tain limitations inherent to the system. In
● Press the brake pedal until the parking as- To avoid exceeding the allowed speed of ap- certain situations, the automatic braking
sist system completes the steering wheel prox. 7 km/h (4 mph) when entering or leaving intervention may only work in a limited way
turns; OR: press the brake pedal until the a parking space, the brakes may activate au- or not work at all.
symbol  goes out on the instrument panel tomatically. After automatically activating ● Always be ready to use the brakes your-
screen. the brakes, the manoeuvres to enter or exit a self!
● Move forward until the continuous ParkPilot parking space may continue. ● The automatic braking intervention will
signal sounds; OR: move forward until the re- end after approximately 1.5 seconds. After-
The brakes are only automatically activated
verse indication appears on the instrument wards, brake the vehicle yourself.
once for each attempt to enter or exit a park-
panel display. The Park Assist system steers ing space. If the speed of approximately
the vehicle forward and back until it can exit 7 km/h (4 mph) is exceeded again, the corre-
the space. sponding operation is halted.
● The vehicle can exit the space when a cor-
Parking aid parking and ma-
responding message is displayed on the in- Automatic braking to reduce damages noeuvring (ParkPilot)
strument panel and, in some cases, an Depending on certain conditions, the Park
acoustic signal sounds. Take charge of the Assist system can automatically brake the Introduction
steering with the turning angle set by the Park vehicle when faced with an obstacle, briefly
Assist system. actioning and holding down the brake ped- These assist systems help you when parking
● Paying attention to the traffic, exit the park- al ››› . Following this the driver must press and manoeuvring:
ing space. the brake pedal. – Park assist plus. It is an assistant that gives
Automatic braking intervention to reduce a visual and audio warning of obstacles de-
damage leads to the parking manoeuvre fin- tected in front and behind the vehicle
Automatic operation of the brakes ishing. ››› page 249.
by the parking assist system – Rear parking aid. An audio and visual as-
WARNING sistant that warns of obstacles located be-
Park Assist helps the driver by automatically hind the vehicle ››› page 252.
The automatic braking intervention by Park
braking in certain situations.
Assist should never tempt you to take any
The driver is always responsible for braking in risk that may compromise safety. The sys- WARNING
time ››› . tem is not a replacement for driver aware- ● Always pay attention, by looking directly,
ness.
to traffic and the area around the vehicle.
Assistance systems are not a replacement »
247
Driving

for driver awareness. Responsibility always being detected by the system, the obstacle – External ultrasound sources, such as
lies with the driver. in question may disappear from the meas- other vehicles equipped with ultra-
● The sensors have blind spots in which ob- urement sensors as the vehicle moves clos- sound systems.
stacles and people are not detected. Pay er, and the system will no longer warn of its – Heavy rain or snow, hail or dense ex-
special attention to children and animals. presence. In certain circumstances, ob- haust gases.
jects such as high kerbs that could damage
● Always keep visual control of the sur- – If the number plate is not properly se-
the underside of the vehicle are not detec-
roundings: use the mirrors for additional ted. cured to the surface of the bumper.
help. – Gradient changes.
● If the parking distance warning system is
ignored, the vehicle could suffer considera- ● In order to guarantee good operation,
CAUTION ble damage. keep the sensors clean, free of snow and
Parking distance warning system functions ● Damage to the radiator grille, bumper, ice, and do not cover them with stickers or
can be affected by different factors that wheel arch and vehicle underbody can other objects.
can cause damage: modify the orientation of the sensors. This ● If you use high-pressure or vapour equip-
● Under certain circumstances, the system can affect the parking aid function. Have ment for cleaning, do not apply it directly,
does not detect or display certain objects: the function checked by a specialised unless you do so very briefly, and always
workshop. keep a distance of more than 10 cm away.
– Chains, trailer draw bars, bars, fences,
● A number plate or number plate holder ● Fitting certain accessories to the front of
posts and thin trees.
with dimensions that exceed the space for the vehicle, such as a plate holder with ad-
– Objects that are located above the
the number plate, or a cured or deformed vertising, may interfere with the operation
sensors, such as protrusions in a wall. of the Park Assist.
number plate can cause false detections or
– Objects with certain surfaces or struc- a loss of visibility for the sensors. ● We recommend that you practice park-
tures, such as wire mesh fences or pow- ing in an area without traffic.
der snow.
Note ● The volume and tone of the signals and
● Certain surfaces of objects and gar-
● The display on the Infotainment system indications can be changed ››› page 253.
ments do not reflect the ultrasound sen-
screen shows a slight time delay. ● In vehicles without an infotainment sys-
sors' signals. The system cannot detect
these objects or people wearing such ● In certain situations, the system can give tem, these parameters can be modified in a
clothes correctly. a warning even though there is no obstacle SEAT Official Service or in a specialised
in the detected area: workshop.
● Sensor signals may be affected by exter-
● Please observe information on towing a
nal sound sources. This may prevent them – Rough or cobbled surfaces or surfaces
from detecting people or objects. with long grass. trailer ››› page 253.

● If the system warns you of the proximity


of a low obstacle, please note that after
248
Help with parking and manoeuvring

Parking System Plus B 1.60 m Parking Aid operation


C 0.90 m
Description As you approach the obstacle, the frequency
of the audible signals will increase. The signal
will sound continuously at around 0.30 m:
Stop!
If the separation is maintained, the warning
volume is reduced after about 4 seconds.
In order to view the entire periphery of the ve-
hicle, the vehicle must be moved a few me-
tres forwards or backwards. Thus, the missing
Fig. 170 Centre console: parking aid button
areas are screened and obstacles at the (depending on the version).
sides of the vehicle are displayed C .
Fig. 169 Parking aid view on the Infotainment Manually connecting and disconnecting
system display. Special features of ParkPilot with Area the parking aid
View
Parking aid plus assists the driver by giving ● Press the  button once.
visual and audio warnings about obstacles In the following situations the screened area
detected in front of and behind the vehicle. on the side of the vehicle is automatically hid- Manual disconnection of Parking Aid dis-
den: play (the audible sounds remain active)
The bumpers are fitted with sensors. When an
obstacle is detected, it is indicated by audible ● When a vehicle door is opened. ● Press the BACK function button.
signals and in the Infotainment system ● When the ASR is switched off.
››› Fig. 169. Automatic connection of Parking Aid
● When there is ASR or ESC regulation.
When moving close to an obstacle, it is possi- ● Select reverse gear.
● If the vehicle remains stationary for more
ble to know if the obstacle is in front of the ve- than approximately 3 minutes. ● OR: If you drive forward at a speed of less
hicle or behind it by choosing different than 15 km/h (9 mph) and an obstacle is en-
sounds. countered, it is detected when it is approx.
less than 95 cm. away. If the automatic con-
The approximate measurement range of the
nection is activated, a reduced view is shown.
sensors is:
● OR: if the vehicle moves backwards. »
A 1.20 m

249
Driving

Automatic disconnection of Parking Aid If it is switched off using the  button, one of CAUTION
● Move the selector lever to position P. the following actions must be taken for it to
The automatic connection of the Parking
reactivate automatically:
● OR: drive forwards at 15 km/h (9 mph) or Aid only works when you are driving slowly.
faster. ● Switch off the ignition and switch it on If driving style is not adapted to the circum-
again. stances, an accident and serious injury or
Temporary suppression of sound in Park- damage may be caused.
● OR: drive forward at over 15 km/h (9 mph)
ing Aid approx.
● Press the  function button. ● OR: move the lever into position P and pack
again.
Visual indication segments
Change from reduced view to full view
● OR: switch the automatic activation on and
● Select reverse gear. off in the Infotainment system.
● OR: press the car icon on the reduced view.
Automatic activation of the park assist can be
switched on and off in the infotainment sys-
Switch to the reverse assist image (Rear
tem ››› page 88:
View Camera “RVC”)
● Select reverse gear. ● Switch the ignition on.

● OR press the RVC function button. ● Select: Infotainment button  > Settings
> Parking and manoeuvring.
A short confirmation signal will be heard and ● Select Automatic activation. If the box
the button symbol will light up when the sys- Fig. 171 Parking aid view on the Infotainment
is checked , the function is connected.
tem is switched on. system display.
● OR, in the Park distance control function,
select Settings > Automatic activa- The optical indication of the segments works
tion. as follows:
Automatic activation
If activated automatically, an audible sound – White segments: the obstacle is more
When the Plus Parking Aid connects auto- warning will only be given when obstacles in than approx. 30 cm away from the path
matically, a diagram of the vehicle and the front are at a distance of less than 50 cm. ap- or in the direction opposite to travel.
segments will appear on screen. prox. – Yellow segments: the obstacles lie on
It only operates every time the speed is re- the vehicle’s path and are at a distance
duced below 15 km/h (9 mph) for the first of less than approx. 30 cm away.
time.
250
Help with parking and manoeuvring

– Red segments: obstacles are less than Rear volume Trailer mode
approx. 30 cm away. Volume in the rear area.
The Media System Plus or Navi System will
display the expected path, depending on Rear sound settings/sharpness
how the steering wheel is turned. Sound tone in the rear area.
If an obstacle is located in the vehicle’s way,
the corresponding audible warning will Adjust volume
sound. When the parking aid is switched on, the vol-
ume of the audio source will be reduced, de-
When the penultimate segment is displayed,
pending on the selected option.
the vehicle has reached the collision zone. In
the collision zone, the obstacles are repre-
sented in red, including those out of the path. Fig. 172 Parking assist display on the screen
Stop the vehicle! ››› in Introduction on Error messages with trailer attached.
page 247, ››› in Introduction on
If a an error or fault message appears on the On vehicles with a factory-fitted trailer hitch,
page 248 !
instrument cluster in Park Assist, there is a when the trailer is connected, the rear sen-
fault. sors will not activate when reverse gear is en-
gaged or button  is pressed. Therefore, any
Setting the indications and audio If the fault doesn't disappear before discon- objects behind or to the side of the vehicle
signals necting the ignition, it will not be indicated will not be indicated on the screen and no
next time the parking aid is connected. audio signals will sound.
The indications and audio signal settings are If a rear sensor is faulty, only the obstacles in The screen will only display objects detected
in the infotainment system ››› page 88. area A are displayed ››› Fig. 169. If a front at the front, and the vehicle's trajectory will
sensor is faulty, only the obstacles in area B be hidden.
Automatic activation are displayed. Symbol  is displayed.
 on –  off. We recommend taking the vehicle to a speci-
alised workshop to have the fault repaired. Manoeuvre braking function
Front volume
3 Only valid with Parking System Plus
Volume in the front and rear area.
The emergency braking function is used to
Front sound settings/sharpness minimise damage in the event of a collision. »
Sound tone in the front area.
251
Driving

Depending on the equipment, if the Parking appears on the Parking aid screen of the In- If the separation is maintained, the warning
Aid is active, the braking while manoeuvring fotainment system. volume is reduced after about 4 seconds.
function activates emergency braking when it ● Whenever any of the car doors, rear lid or
detects an obstacle in the vehicle’s path that bonnet are opened.
could cause a collision, driving forwards or in Parking Aid operation
reverse.
The function will not brake if the Parking Aid is Parking Aid connection
activated automatically. For the system to
Rear parking aid ● Select reverse gear.
operate, manoeuvring speed must be be-
tween 2.5 and 10 km/h (between 1.5 and 6 Description Parking Aid disconnection
mph) for the front area and between 1.5 and
The rear parking aid is an audible and visual ● Place the selector level in position P, N or D
10 km/h (between 1 and 6 mph) for the rear.
assistant that warns of obstacles located be- (for automatic gearboxes) or disengage re-
Following an intervention, the braking while hind the vehicle. verse (for manual gearboxes).
manoeuvring function will be inactive in the
same direction of travel for 5 metres. Once There are sensors integrated in the rear Set the lever to the N or D position to maintain
the gear is changed, or the selector lever’s bumper. When they detect an obstacle, you the system active for approximately 8 sec-
position is changed, the function will be ac- are alerted by audible and visible warnings onds before switching off. During that time,
tive again. The Parking Aid’s limitations apply. on the Infotainment system. Parking assist will switch off if:

The manoeuvre braking function is set in the Make particularly sure that the sensors are ● The selector lever is moved to position P.
infotainment system using the button  > not covered by adhesives, residues, dirt and
● OR: the vehicle accelerates to approx.
Settings > Parking and manoeuvring. the like, as this could affect the system's op-
15 km/h (9 mph) or faster.
eration. Cleaning instructions ››› page 302.
●  on – permits the use of the braking while
The approximate measurement range of the Manual disconnection of Parking Aid dis-
manoeuvring function.
rear sensors is: play (the audible sounds remain active)
●  off – does not permit the use of the
Side area: 0.60 m ● Press a button on the main menu of the fac-
braking while manoeuvring function.
tory-assembled infotainment system.
Central area: 1.60 m
Temporary suppression of emergency ● OR press the BACK  function button.
braking As you approach the obstacle, the frequency
of the audible signals will increase. The signal Temporary suppression of sound in Park-
● When the function is deactivated with the
will sound continuously at around 0.30 m: ing Aid
Braking while manoeuvring button that
Stop! ››› in Introduction on page 247,
● Press the  function button.
››› in Introduction on page 248!
252
Help with parking and manoeuvring

Change from reduced view to full view If there is a fault in a sensor, the  symbol is – White segments: the obstacle is more
● Select reverse gear. displayed on the infotainment system display. than approx. 30 cm away from the path
or in the direction opposite to travel.
● OR: on vehicles fitted with reverse assist We recommend taking the vehicle to a speci-
They are also displayed when the elec-
(Rear View Camera “RVC”) click on the car alised workshop to have the fault repaired.
tronic parking brake is activated.
icon of the reduced display.
Towing device – Yellow segments: the obstacles lie on
the vehicle’s path and are at a distance
Switch to the reverse assist image (Rear In vehicles equipped with a towing bracket
of less than approx. 30 cm away.
View Camera “RVC”) device from the factory, when the trailer is
connected, the parking aid will not be activa- – Red segments: obstacles are less than
● Select reverse gear.
ted when reverse gear is engaged. approx. 30 cm away.
● OR: press the RVC function button.
Whenever the obstacle is located in the vehi-
Setting the indications and audio signals cle’s direction of travel, the corresponding
Visual indication segments audible warning will sound.
The indications and audio signal settings are
in the infotainment system ››› page 88. As the vehicle approaches an obstacle, the
segments are displayed closer to the vehicle.
● Rear volume: volume in the rear area.
When the penultimate segment is displayed,
● Rear sound settings/treble: sound this means that the vehicle has reached the
tone in the rear area. collision zone. In the collision zone, the obsta-
● Lower volume: when the parking aid is cles are represented in red (including those
switched on, the volume of the audio source out of the path). Do not continue to reverse
will be reduced, depending on the selected ››› in Introduction on page 247, ››› in
option. Introduction on page 248!

Error messages Fig. 173 Parking aid view on the Infotainment


If a an error or fault message appears on the system display.
instrument cluster in Park Assist, there is a
fault. The distance to the obstacles can be estima-
ted with the help of the segments at the rear
If the fault doesn't disappear before discon- of the vehicle.
necting the ignition, it will not be indicated
next time the parking aid is connected. The optical indication of the segments works
as follows:

253
Driving

Reverse Assist (Rear View ● Do not be distracted from the traffic by Usage instructions
looking at the screen.
Camera) ● The images are only two-dimensional.
A camera installed in the rear lid handle as-
Protruding objects or holes in the road, for sists the driver with reverse parking or ma-
Operating and safety warnings example, are more difficult to detect or noeuvring ››› page 212.
may not be seen at all. The camera image is viewed together with
WARNING ● Vehicle load modifies the representation orientation lines projected on the Infotain-
● The reverse assist does not make it possi- of the guide lines ››› Fig. 174. The width rep- ment system screen. Part of the bumper can
ble to precisely calculate the distance from resented by the lines decreases with vehi- be seen at the bottom, which can be used by
obstacles and nor can it overcome the sys- cle load. Pay special attention to the sur- the driver as a reference point.
tem's own limits, hence its negligent use roundings when the inside of the vehicle of
may cause serious accidents and injuries if the luggage compartment are loaded. Rear assist settings
used without due care. The driver should be ● In the following situations, objects or oth-
Rear assist offers the user the possibility to
aware of his/her surroundings at all times er vehicles appear to be further away or
to ensure safe driving.
change the image's brightness, contrast and
closer than they actually are. Pay special
attention:
colour settings.
● The camera lens expands and distorts
the field of view and displays the objects – If moving from a flat surface to a slope To change these settings:
on the screen in a way that is different from and vice-versa.
reality. Distance perception is also distor- ● Stop the vehicle in a safe place without
– If the vehicle is heavily loaded.
ted. switching off the ignition or the infotainment
– When the vehicle approaches objects system.
● Due to the screen resolution or light con-
that are not on the ground surface or
ditions, some items may be blurry or not ● Apply the parking brake.
that protrude from it. These objects
displayed at all. Take care with thin posts, may be outside the camera angle when ● Select reverse gear.
fences, railings or trees that might not be reversing. ● Press the  function button displayed on
seen on the screen and could damage the
vehicle. the screen.
● The reverse assist has blind spots where
Note ● Make the desired adjustments on the menu
it cannot see people or objects. Monitor the ● It is important to take great care and pay by pressing the –/+ function buttons or by
vehicle's surrounding area at all times. special attention if the driver is not familiar moving the scroll button.
● The system is not a replacement for driv- with the system.
er awareness. Supervise the parking ma- ● Reverse assist will not be available if the
noeuvre and the vehicle's surrounding area rear lid is open.
at all times.

254
Help with parking and manoeuvring

Requirements for parking and manoeu- Parking and manoeuvring with re- Switching the system on and off
vring with the rear assist
verse assist ● Reverse assist is connected by a contact
The system should not be used in the follow- when engaging reverse gear.
ing cases: ● The system switches off 8 seconds after

● If the image displayed is not very reliable or disengaging reverse gear and immediately
after removing the contact.
is distorted, or if the lens is dirty.
● The camera will stop transmitting images
● If the area behind the vehicle is incomplete.
above the speed of 15 km/h (9 mph) with re-
● If the vehicle is heavily loaded.
verse engaged.
● If the position of the camera has changed
after a rear-end collision. Have the system In combination with the parking aid plus sys-
checked by a specialised workshop. tem ››› page 249, the camera image will no
longer be displayed when reverse gear is dis-
Fig. 174 Display on the Infotainment system engaged, and the system will display the op-
Familiarising yourself with the system
screen.: guide lines. tical information provided by the parking aid
To familiarise yourself with the system, the system.
orientation lines and their function, SEAT rec- Meaning of the orientation lines ››› Fig. 174
ommends practising in a place without too It is also possible to hide the reverse assist im-
1 Lateral lines: extension of the vehicle
much traffic or in a car park when there are age:
(approximately in its total width) on the
good weather and visibility conditions. road. ● By pressing one of the Infotainment system
2 End of the side lines: approx. 2 m behind buttons on the display.
the vehicle on the road. ● OR: by clicking on the miniature vehicle
3 Intermediate line: approx. 1 m behind the shown on the screen.
vehicle on the road.
If you wish to display the rear assist image
4 Horizontal red line: a safe distance of again:
approx. 40 cm at the rear of the vehicle
on the road. ● Disengage and re-engage reverse gear.
● OR: Press the RVC function button1) »

1) The RVC button will only be displayed when re-

verse gear is engaged.


255
Driving

Parking manoeuvre
Towing bracket device Start-Stop system operates as normal. No
special characteristics need to be taken into
● Stop the vehicle in front of a space and se-
lect reverse gear. account.

● Reverse slowly, and turn the steering wheel


Trailer mode If the system does not recognise the trailer or
so that the side lines lead towards the park- the trailer bracket has not been retrofitted by
ing space. Introduction SEAT, the Start-Stop system must be discon-
nected by pressing the corresponding button
● Guide the vehicle into the parking space so Take into account country-specific regula- in the lower part of the centre console before
that the side lines run parallel to it. tions about driving with a trailer and the use driving with the trailer, and it should remain
of a towing bracket. off for the rest of the journey ››› .
The vehicle has been developed primarily for
carrying people, although it can also be used Vehicles with driving profile selection
to tow a trailer if fitted with the corresponding If you are going to be towing a trailer, the use
technical equipment. This additional load has of the Eco driving profile is not recommen-
an effect on the useful life, fuel consumption ded. You are advised to select another of the
and vehicle performance and in some cases available driving profiles before beginning to
can reduce the service intervals. drive with a trailer.
Driving with a trailer requires more force from
the vehicle, and thus more concentration Trailer weight/drawbar load
from the driver. Never exceed the authorised trailer weight. If
In winter, winter tyres should be fitted on both you do not load the trailer up to the maximum
the vehicle and the trailer. permitted trailer weight, you can then climb
correspondingly steeper slopes.
Maximum vertical load technically permit- The maximum trailer weights listed are only
ted on the coupling device applicable for altitudes up to 1000 m above
The maximum technically permitted vertical sea level. Since higher altitude decreases en-
load of the tow bar on the hitch of the towing gine performance and the ability to climb
device is 55 kg. slopes, the tow load decreases proportional-
ly. The weight of the vehicle and trailer com-
Vehicles with the Start-Stop system bination must be reduced by 10% for every
1000 m of altitude. When possible, operate
If the vehicle has a factory-fitted towing the trailer with the maximum authorised
bracket or one that is retrofitted by SEAT, the
256
Towing bracket device

drawbar load on the ball joint of the towing WARNING system must be disconnected manually
bracket, but do not exceed the specified lim- whenever driving with a trailer. Otherwise
Driving with a trailer and transporting
it. the brake system could be damaged and
heavy or large objects can affect driving
could consequently cause a serious acci-
properties and even cause an accident.
WARNING dent or injury.
● Always secure the load properly using
Never use the trailer to transport people, ● Always disconnect the Start-Stop system
belts or straps that are suitable and in
since it would put their life in danger and is manually when using a towing bracket that
good condition.
also prohibited. has not been fitted by a SEAT workshop.
● Adapt your speed and driving style at all
times to suit visibility, weather, road and
WARNING traffic conditions. Note
Undue use of the towing bracket may ● Trailers with a high centre of gravity are ● Before hitching or unhitching a trailer, al-
cause injury and accidents. more likely to overturn than those with a ways deactivate the anti-theft alarm
● Only use the towing bracket if it is in a low one. ››› page 96. Otherwise, the tilt sensor could
perfect state of repair and is properly se- ● Avoid sudden braking and manoeuvres.
cause the alarm to go off.
cured. ● Do not drive with a trailer for the engine's
● Take great care when overtaking.
● Never modify or repair the towing bracket first 1000 km ››› page 206.
● Reduce speed immediately if you notice
in any way. ● If a removable and retractable tow hook
that the trailer is swaying, however slightly.
● In order to reduce the danger of injury in is fitted, it should not be mounted when not
● Never drive at more than 80 km/h in use. In the event of a rear-end collision,
the event of rear-end collisions and to
(50 mph) when towing a trailer (or at more the damage to the vehicle could be greater
avoid injury to pedestrians and cyclists
than 100 km/h (60 mph) in exceptional cir- if the tow hook is fitted.
when parking the vehicle, cover or remove
cumstances). This also applies in countries
the tow hook when you are not using a trail- ● Some retrofitted towing brackets cover
where driving at higher speeds is permit-
er. the rear towing eye. In these cases, the
ted. Take into account the speed limit for
● According to EU regulation 2021_535 it is towing eye should not be used for tow-
vehicles with trailers in the corresponding
not permitted to install a towing device that starting or for towing other vehicles. For
country, as it could be less than the speed
completely or partially covers the rear this reason, if the vehicle has been retrofit-
limit for vehicles without a trailer.
number plate. ted with a towing bracket, always keep the
● Never attempt to “straighten” the towing tow hook in the vehicle when you remove it.
● Never fit a towing bracket “with weight vehicle and trailer while accelerating.
distribution” or “load compensation”. The
vehicle has not been designed for this type
of towing bracket. The towing bracket
WARNING
could fail and the trailer could be released If the towing bracket has been retrofitted
from the vehicle. by a non-SEAT workshop, the Start-Stop
257
Driving

Technical requirements prepared for the additional effort involved in Trailer maximum electricity consumption
driving with a trailer. Never exceed the values indicated!
Vehicles that are factory-fitted with a towing
bracket meet all the technical and legal re- Trailer brakes Brake lights (total) 84 Watts
quirements for driving with a trailer If the trailer has its own brake system, please
››› page 263. Turn signal (on each side) 42 watts
take the relevant legal requirements into ac-
If the vehicle is retrofitted with a towing count. Never connect the trailer's brake sys- Side lights (on each side) 50 Watts
bracket, only a bracket that is authorised for tem to the vehicle's brake system.
Reverse lights (in total) 42 Watts
the maximum authorised load of the trailer
that is to be towed may be fitted. The towing Tow cable Rear fog light 42 Watts
bracket must be suitable for the vehicle and Always use a cable between the vehicle and
the trailer and must be properly secured to the trailer ››› page 259. WARNING
the vehicle's chassis. Only use a towing
If the towing bracket is wrongly fitted or is
bracket that has been authorised by SEAT for Trailer tail lights not the right one, the trailer could become
this vehicle. Always check and take into ac- detached from the vehicle and cause seri-
count the towing bracket manufacturer's in- The trailer's rear lights should comply with
ous injury.
structions. Never fit a towing bracket “with the statutory safety regulations ››› page 259.
weight distribution” or “load compensation”. Never connect the trailer's rear lights directly
CAUTION
to the vehicle's electric system. If you are not
Towing bracket fitted on the bumper sure that the trailer's electrical connection is ● If the rear lights of the trailer are not cor-
correct, have it checked by a specialised rectly connected, the vehicle's electronic
Never fit a towing bracket to the bumper or to
workshop. SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT system may be damaged.
the area where the bumper is mounted. The
towing bracket should not impair the bum- dealership for this. ● If the trailer absorbs excessive electric

per's function. Do not make modifications or current, the vehicle's electronic system
Exterior mirrors may be damaged.
repairs to the exhaust system or the brake
system. Make regular checks to ensure that ● Never connect the trailer's electric sys-
If you cannot see the area behind the trailer
the towing bracket is secure. tem directly to the electrical connections
with the exterior mirrors of the towing vehicle,
of the tail lights or any other power sour-
additional mirrors will have to be installed in
ces. Only use the connections intended for
Engine cooling system accordance with the regulations of the coun-
providing electric current to the trailer.
Driving with a trailer increases the load on the try in question. The exterior mirrors should be
engine and cooling system. The cooling sys- adjusted before you start driving and must
tem should have sufficient coolant and be provide a sufficient field of vision at the rear.

258
Towing bracket device

Hitching and connecting a trailer Pin Meaning that the vehicle can handle turns smoothly.
However, make sure that the cable does not
12 Unassigned rub on the ground while driving.
13 Earth for pin 9
Trailer tail lights

Power socket for trailer Always check the trailer's rear lights to ensure
they are working correctly and that they
The vehicle is fitted with a 13-pole power comply with the relevant safety regulations.
socket for the connection between the trailer Make sure that the maximum permissible
and the vehicle. With the engine running, power that can be absorbed by the trailer is
electrical devices on the trailer receive power not exceeded ››› page 258.
from the electrical connection (pin 9 and pin
Fig. 175 Schematic representation: assign-
10 of the trailer power socket).
ment of the pins of the trailer's electrical sock- Include in the anti-theft alarm
et. If the system detects that a trailer has been The trailer is included in the anti-theft system
connected, the consumers on the trailer will if the following conditions are met:
Pin Meaning receive electricity through this connection
(pins 9 and 10). Pin 9 has a permanent live. ● If the vehicle is factory-equipped with an
1 Left turn signal This powers, for example, the trailer's interior anti-theft alarm and towing bracket.
2 Rear fog light lighting. Electrical devices such as a fridge in ● If the trailer is electrically connected to the
a caravan only receive electrical power if the towing vehicle through the trailer power sock-
3 Earth for pins 1, 2, 4, 5, 6, 7 and 8 engine is running (through pin 10). et.
4 Right turn signal To avoid overloading the electrical system, ● If the electrical systems of the vehicle and
you cannot connect the ground wires of pin trailer are in perfect condition and have no
5 Rear light, right
3 , pin 11 or pin 13 to each other. faults or damage.
6 Brake lights
If the trailer has a 7-contact connector, you ● If the vehicle is locked with the key and the
7 Rear light, left will need to use an adapter cable. In this case anti-theft alarm is activated.
the function corresponding to pin 10 will not
8 Reverse lights When the vehicle is locked, the alarm is trig-
be available.
gered if the electrical connection with the
9 Permanent live
Tow cable
trailer is cut off. »
10 Live charge cable
The tow rope must always be securely fixed
11 Earth for pin 10 to the towing vehicle and loose enough so
259
Driving

Before hitching or unhitching a trailer, always ● Ensure that any repairs that need to be the anti-theft alarm system, have them in-
turn off the anti-theft alarm. Otherwise, the tilt carried out on the electrical system are spected by a specialised workshop.
sensor could cause the alarm to go off. carried out by a specialised workshop. ● If the trailer accessories consume energy
● Never connect the trailer's electric sys- through the power socket to the trailer and
Trailers with LED tail lights tem directly to the electrical connections the engine is turned off, the battery will dis-
For technical reasons, trailers fitted with LED of the tail lights or any other power sour- charge.
rear lights cannot be connected to the anti- ces. ● If the vehicle battery is running low, the
theft alarm system. electrical connection with the trailer will be
WARNING automatically cut.
When the vehicle is locked, the alarm does
not go off when the electrical connection Contact between the pins of the trailer
with the trailer is cut if it has rear lights with power socket can cause short circuits,
light-emitting diodes. overloading of the electrical system or fail- Trailer loading
ure of the lighting system, and consequent-
If the Eco driving profile was selected when ly can cause accidents and serious injuries. Technically permissible maximum trailer
hitching the trailer, this will automatically
● Never connect the pins of the trailer pow- weight and vertical load on the coupling
switch to the Normal profile. If the system
er socket to each other. device
cannot detect the attached trailer or if the
towing bracket has been retrofitted by an au- ● Make sure any work on bent pins is car- The technically permissible maximum trailer
to repair shop other than SEAT, you must ried out by a specialised workshop. weight is the weight that the vehicle can tow
manually select the Normal profile before ››› . The vertical load on the coupling is ex-
you start driving with a trailer attached. To re- CAUTION erted vertically from above on the hook of the
connect the Eco profile once the trailer has towing bracket.
Do not leave the trailer connected to the
been unhitched, switch the ignition off and The information on the maximum trailer
vehicle when parked; place it on its support
back on once. wheel or its supports. If the vehicle rises or weight and vertical load on the coupling de-
falls due, for example, to a variation of the vice contained in the type plate of the towing
WARNING load or a burst tyre, increased pressure will bracket are experimental values only. The
If the cables are improperly or incorrectly be placed on the towing bracket and the correct figures for your specific model, which
connected, it may lead to an excessive trailer, and both the vehicle and the trailer may be lower than these figures, are given in
amount of current supplied to the trailer, can be damaged. the vehicle documentation. The information in
which can cause abnormalities in the entire the vehicle documentation takes precedence
vehicle electronic system, as well as acci- Note at all times.
dents and serious injuries.
● In case of anomalies in the electrical sys- To promote safety while driving, SEAT recom-
tems of the vehicle or trailer, as well as in mends making the most of the maximum
260
Towing bracket device

vertical load technically permissible on the ● Distribute loads in the trailer so that heavy WARNING
coupling device ››› page 256. An insufficient objects are as near to the axle as possible or
A shift in weight could jeopardize the stabil-
vertical load has a negative influence on the above it.
ity and security of the towing vehicle and
behaviour of both the vehicle and trailer. ● Secure the trailer load properly. trailer, which could lead to accidents and
The vertical load increases the weight on the serious injuries.
rear axle, reducing the vehicle's carrying ca- Tyre pressure ● Always load the trailer correctly.
pacity. Set the tyre pressure of the trailer tyres in ac- ● Always secure the load properly using
cordance with the trailer manufacturer's rec- belts or straps that are suitable and in
Gross combination weight of the towing ommendations. good condition.
vehicle and trailer
When towing a trailer, inflate the tyres of the
The gross combination weight is the actual towing vehicle with the maximum allowable
weight of the loaded vehicle plus the actual pressure ››› page 291. Driving with a trailer
weight of the loaded trailer.
In some countries trailers are classified into WARNING Adjusting the headlights
distinct categories. SEAT recommends ob- If the maximum permissible axle weight, the The front part of the vehicle may be raised
taining information from a specialised work- maximum load technically permissible on when the trailer is connected and the light
shop regarding which type of trailer is most the coupling point, the maximum author- may dazzle the rest of the traffic.
suitable for your vehicle. ised vehicle weight or the gross combina-
tion weight of the towing vehicle and trailer Adapt the height of the headlights using the
are exceeded, accidents and serious inju- headlight range adjuster ››› page 117 1).
Trailer loading
ries may occur.
The weight of the towing vehicle and trailer Specific features of driving with a trailer
● Never exceed the values indicated!
must be balanced. In order to do this, the
● The actual weight on the front and rear ● If your trailer has an overrun brake, brake
load must be as close as possible to the max-
imum vertical load technically permissible on axles must never exceed the maximum per- gently at first and then rapidly. This will pre-
the coupling point, and it must be evenly dis- missible axle weight. The weight on the vent the jerking that can be caused by the
tributed between the back and front of the front and rear axles must never exceed the locking of trailer wheels.
trailer: maximum permissible weight. ● Due to the gross combination weight of the
towing vehicle and trailer, the braking dis-
tance increases. »

1) This does not apply for vehicles with Full LED

xenon headlights.
261
Driving

● When going down a slope, go into a lower ● Start driving slowly. To do this, in the case of Stabilisation of the towing vehicle
gear (if using a manual gearbox or the tip- a manual gearbox, slowly release the clutch
and trailer combination
tronic automatic gearbox mode) to take ad- pedal.
vantage of the braking power provided by the ● Do not release the hand brake until the en- The stabilisation of the vehicle and trailer
engine. Otherwise, the braking system could gine has sufficient power to start driving combination is an additional function of the
overheat and even fail. electronic stability control (ESC).
● The trailer weight, as well as the gross com- WARNING
If the system detects that the trailer is weav-
bination weight of the towing vehicle and If a trailer is pulled incorrectly, this may ing, it intervenes to reduce the swaying of the
trailer, change the centre of gravity and the lead to loss of control of the vehicle and trailer.
properties of the vehicle. serious injury.
● If the towing vehicle is empty and the trailer ● Driving with a trailer and transporting Vehicle and trailer combination stabilisa-
is loaded, then the load distribution is incor- heavy or large objects will change the ve- tion requirements
rect. Under these conditions, drive slowly and hicle handling and braking distances.
● The vehicle is factory-equipped with a tow-
with extra caution. ● Always drive cautiously and carefully.
ing bracket or has been retro-fitted with a
Brake earlier than usual. compatible towing bracket.
Hill starts with a trailer ● Adapt your speed and driving style at all
● The ESC and ASR are active. The control
Depending on the slope of the hill and the times to suit visibility, weather, road and
lamp  or  is not lit up on the instrument
combination weight of the towing vehicle and traffic conditions. Slow down, especially
cluster.
trailer, the vehicle might start rolling back- when driving down hills or slopes.
wards slightly when you first start up. ● The trailer is connected to the towing vehi-
● Accelerate with particular care and cau-
tion. Avoid sudden braking and manoeu- cle through the trailer power socket.
For hill-starting with a trailer, do the following:
vres. ● The vehicle is travelling at over 60 km/h
● Press and hold the brake pedal. ● Take great care when overtaking. Reduce (approx. 37 mph).
● If the vehicle is equipped with a manual speed immediately if you notice that the ● The maximum vertical load technically per-
gearbox, push the clutch pedal all the way trailer is swaying, however slightly. missible is not being exceeded on the cou-
down. ● Never attempt to “straighten” the towing pling device.
vehicle and trailer while accelerating. ● The trailer has a rigid draw bar.
● Put the vehicle into first gear or turn the se-
lector lever to position D/S ››› page 196. ● Take into account the speed limit for vehi-
● If the trailer has brakes, it must be equipped
cles with a trailer, as it could be lower than
● Apply the handbrake. with a mechanical overrun brake.
for vehicles without a trailer.
● Release the brake pedal.

262
Towing bracket device

WARNING repeated automatic braking may occur in the cover of the load area of the luggage
extreme driving conditions. compartment.
The enhanced safety provided by the elec-
tric stability control of the vehicle and trail- The tow hook is fitted and removed by hand
er should not lead you to take any risks that and is supplied with a key.
could compromise your safety.
● Adapt your speed and driving style at all
Towing bracket device 1 13-pin connector
times to suit visibility, weather, road and 2 Safety lug
traffic conditions. Description 3 Hook housing
● Accelerate with caution when the road is 4 Hook housing cap
slippery.
5 Protective cap of the ball head
● When adjusting any settings, stop accel-
erating. 6 Removable tow hook
7 Locking lever
WARNING 8 Lock cover
The electric stability control for the vehicle 9 Release bolt
and trailer may not correctly detect all 10 Lock
driving conditions.
11 Locking balls
● When the ESC is switched off, the stabili-
sation of the towing vehicle and trailer is al-
12 Key
so switched off.
● The stability system does not always de-
Operation and conservation
tect light trailers, so it may not stabilise Put the cover on the housing cavity so that
these correctly. dirt cannot get in.
● When driving on surfaces with poor grip, Before hooking up a trailer, always check the
the trailer can even interfere with the sta- ball head and apply suitable grease if neces-
bility system.
sary.
● Trailers with a high centre of gravity can Fig. 176 The towing device supports trailers /
tip over without having previously weaved. tow hook / key Use the protective cap to store the tow hook.
● If a trailer is not attached, but a connec- Clean the housing cavity surfaces and treat
tor is plugged into the power socket (e.g. Depending on the country or version, the re- them with an appropriate conservation prod-
installation of a bicycle rack with lights), movable hook of the towing device is under uct. »
263
Driving

WARNING Placing in the standby position


● Before each journey with the tow hook fit-
ted, make sure that it is correctly adjusted
and attached in its housing.
● If the tow hook is not properly fitted and
attached, do not use it.
● Do not use the towing bracket device for
towing if it is damaged or has missing parts.
● Do not modify or adapt the towing device
connection. Fig. 178 Reserve position: position verification
● Never unhook the tow hook while the
trailer is hitched. Before assembling it, place the tow hook in
the standby position with the following two
CAUTION steps.

● Handle the tow hook with care in order to ● Insert and turn the key in the direction of the
avoid damaging the bumper paintwork. arrow ››› Fig. 177 1 until the hole in the key
● The top part of the hook housing is faces upwards (arrow).
greased ››› Fig. 176 3 . When using the de- ● Grab the tow hook under the protective
vice, make sure that it has not been re- cover.
moved.
● Press the release bolt ››› Fig. 177 B in the
Fig. 177 Tow hook reserve position direction of arrow 2 , while pressing lever C
Note in the direction of arrow 3 as far as it will go.
● Contact a specialised workshop if you ● The lever will remain blocked in this posi-
lose your key. tion.
● Towing the vehicle with the tow hook
››› page 51. Verification of the reserve position
● Key ››› Fig. 178 A is in the released position
(the key hole is facing upwards).
● The release bolt ››› Fig. 178 B can be
moved.

264
Towing bracket device

● Lever ››› Fig. 178 C is in the lower position. Lever ››› Fig. 179 A automatically turns in
the direction of arrow 2 upwards, and the re-
When adjusted in this way, the tow hook is lease bolt B moves outwards (its red and
ready to be installed. green parts are visible) ››› .

CAUTION If lever A does not turn or the release bolt B


does not come out, the tow hook should be
The key cannot be removed or turned in the
removed by turning the lever as far as possi-
standby position.
ble downwards from the housing cavity, and
the tow hook’s support surfaces and the cavi-
ty should then be cleaned.
Fitting the tow hook
Step 2.
● Turn the key to the right just half a turn, until
the hole in the key faces downwards
››› Fig. 180 1 .

● Remove the key 2 .


● Place the cover B on the lock 3
››› Fig. 180 ››› .
● Check that the tow hook is correctly fixed in
Fig. 180 Putting the tow hook in place. Step 2.
place ››› page 266, Safety check.

Fig. 179 Putting the tow hook in place. Step 1.


Step 1.
WARNING
● Remove the hook housing cap ››› Fig. 176
● Keep your hands away from the lever
4 downwards.
when fitting the tow hook to avoid trapping
● Put the tow hook in its standby position your fingers ››› Fig. 179 A .
››› page 264. ● Do not try to force the lever up to turn the
● Hold the tow hook from below and fit it into key. The detachable ball would not be se-
the hook hosing in the direction of the arrow cured properly! »
››› Fig. 179 1 until it is heard to fit into place
››› .

265
Driving

CAUTION ● The red and green part of the unlocking Removing the tow hook
bolt B is completely visible ››› Fig. 181.
● After removing the key, place the cover
● The key has been removed.
over the lever's lock. If the lock becomes
soiled it will be impossible to insert the key. ● Cover C is over the lock ››› Fig. 181.
● Keep the device's housing cavity clean.
Dirtiness can prevent the tow hook from WARNING
being safety secured! ● Keep your hands away from the lever
● If the device is removed, always place when releasing the tow hook to avoid trap-
the cap in the hook's housing. ping your fingers ››› Fig. 181 A .
● The towing device should only be used if
the tow hook has been properly locked in
Safety check place!

Fig. 182 Removing the tow hook

Fig. 181 Tow hook fixed correctly

Make sure that the tow hook is correctly at-


tached before each use.

Tow hook fixed correctly:


● The tow hook will not fall out of the housing
cavity after a strong “impact”.
● Lever A is facing upwards ››› Fig. 181.
266
Towing bracket device

WARNING Connecting the trailer


● Never remove the tow hook while the
trailer is hitched.
● Never leave the tow hook loose in the lug-
gage compartment. It could cause damage
in the even of sharp braking, and even jeop-
ardise passenger safety!

CAUTION
Fig. 183 Removing the tow hook ● If the lever is not pressed down as far as it
will go, after removing the tow hook it will
● Remove cover A from lock 1 ››› Fig. 182. continue upwards and will not lock into its Fig. 184 Turning the 13-pin connector
standby position. The tow hook must re-
● Insert key B in the lock 2 ››› Fig. 182.
main in this position before being fitted ● Grip the connector in area A and remove it
● Turn the key to the left 3 just half turn, until
again. in the direction of the arrow ››› Fig. 184.
the hole in the key is facing upwards
● Store the device in the reserve position ● Remove the protective cap from the ball
››› Fig. 182. with the key inserted and with the same head ››› Fig. 176 5 .
● Hold the tow hook from below. side facing upwards. Risk of damaging the
● Attach the trailer to the ball head.
● Press the release bolt A in the direction of key!
arrow 1 , and at the same time press lever B ● When operating the lever, do not apply ● Open the cover of connector A and con-
as far as it will go in the direction of arrow 2 too much pressure (for example, do not nect the trailer ››› Fig. 184.
››› Fig. 183. stand on it)! ● Hook the trailer's pair cable to the safety
lug ››› Fig. 184 B . When hooked up, the pair
Now the tow hook has been released and cable should have some slack in all vehicle
Note
falls freely. If this does not occur, press with towing positions (sharp curves, reverse, etc.).
the other hand from above. ● Before extracting the tow hook, we rec-
ommend fitting the protective cover over Follow these steps in reverse to unhitch the
The tow hook is now in the standby position the ball head. trailer.
and is therefore ready to be reinserted into
● Remove dirt from the tow hook before
the hook housing ››› .
storing it with the vehicle tools. WARNING
● Fit cover 4 ››› Fig. 176 onto its housing. ● Never use the safety lug to tow! »

267
Driving

● After hooking up the trailer and connect- WARNING Retrofitting a towing bracket
ing the socket, check that all the trailer's
The incorrect use of the towing device with
rear lights are working properly.
a bicycle carrier mounted on the tow hook Description
can cause accidents and injury.
Note ● Never exceed the maximum weight or the
● If there is any fault in the trailer's lighting, limits indicated above.
check the fuses on the instrument panel ● The bicycle rack may not be mounted to
››› page 55. the neck of the hook below the ball be-
● The contact between the retainer cable cause, due to the shape of the neck and
and the safety lug may give cause wear in depending on the rack model, the rack
the lug. This wear does not stop it from op- could be incorrectly mounted on the vehi-
erating properly and is not a fault. It is ex- cle.
cluded from the warranty. ● Always read and take the manufacturer
● When hitching and unhitching the trailer, assembly instructions into account.
the vehicle's handbrake should be applied.
CAUTION
If the maximum weight and limits indicated
Installing a bicycle carrier on the above are exceeded, the vehicle may suf-
tow bar fer considerable damage.
● Never exceed the values indicated!
The maximum permitted weight of the bicy-
cle carrier system, including the load, is 50
Note
kg. The bicycle carrier system may not pro-
trude more than 700 mm behind the ball SEAT recommends removing, as far as pos-
head. Only bicycle carrier systems for a max- sible, all removable parts of the bicycles
imum of 2 bicycles are allowed to be instal- before setting off. These parts include, for
led. Heavier bicycles must be carried as example, baskets and saddlebags, child
close to the vehicle (tow hook) as possible. seats or batteries. This improves aerody-
namics and the centre of gravity of the rack Fig. 185 Limits and attachment points for ret-
system. rofitting a towing bracket.

SEAT recommends that towing brackets be


retrofitted at a specialised workshop. For

268
Towing bracket device

example, it may very well be necessary to ces. Only use suitable connectors to con-
adjust the cooling system or mount thermal nect the trailer.
protection plates. SEAT recommends visiting
● The towing bracket should be retrofitted
a SEAT dealership for this.
only at a specialised workshop.
If a towing bracket is retrofitted, the distance
specifications should always be kept in mind. WARNING
The distance between the centre of the ball If the towing bracket is badly fitted or un-
head and the road ››› Fig. 185 C must never suitable, the trailer may separate from the
be less than that indicated. This also applies vehicle while driving. This could cause seri-
when the vehicle is fully loaded, including the ous accidents and fatal injuries.
technically permissible maximum vertical
load on the coupling device. Note
Distance specifications ››› Fig. 185: ● According to regulation EU2021_535 it is

A Attachment points (lower part of the vehi- not permitted to install a towing device that
cannot be removed or retracted.
cle)
● Only use towing brackets that have been
B 65 mm (minimum)
approved by SEAT for the model in ques-
C 350 mm to 420 mm (fully laden vehicle) tion.
D 1,025 mm ● In some versions, the fitting of a conven-
E 322 mm tional towing hook solution is not recom-
mended. Please consult your Technical
F 448 mm Service.
G 854 mm

WARNING
If the cables are improperly or incorrectly
connected, this may lead to malfunctions
in the entire vehicle electronic system, as
well as to accidents and serious injuries.
● Never connect the trailer's electric sys-
tem to the electrical connections of the tail
lights or any other unsuitable power sour-
269
Practical tips

Practical tips ● Place it in the space on the hinge of the


open flap ››› Fig. 186.
● Do not smoke when filling the fuel tank or
a canister. Naked flames are forbidden in
● Start refuelling. The tank is full as soon as the vicinity due to the risk of explosion.
Checking and refilling lev- the pump’s automatic nozzle cuts off the fuel ● Observe legislation governing the use,
supply. Do not try to put in more fuel after the storage and carrying of a spare fuel canis-
els nozzle cuts out, as this will fill the expansion ter in the vehicle.
chamber in the fuel tank. ● For safety reasons we do not recommend
Refuelling ● Unscrew the cap by turning it to the right as carrying a spare fuel canister in the vehi-
far as it will go. cle. In an accident the canister could be
damaged and could leak.
Refuelling ● Close the lid.
● If, in exceptional circumstances, you
The correct fuel grade for your vehicle is giv- have to carry a spare fuel canister, please
en on a sticker on the inside of the fuel tank observe the following points:
flap. Further notes on fuel can be found at – Never fill fuel into the spare fuel canis-
››› page 272. ter if it is inside or on top of the vehicle.
This could cause an explosion. Always
The capacity of your vehicle's fuel tank is giv-
place the canister on the ground to fill
en in ››› page 316.
it.
– Insert the filling nozzle as far as possi-
Vehicles with natural gas engines and hy-
ble into the spare fuel canister.
brids
– If the spare fuel canister is made of
Every 6 months it is necessary to run on pet-
Fig. 186 Fuel tank flap with tank cap attached. metal, the filling nozzle must be in con-
rol until the control lamp  switches off, and tact with the canister during filling. This
then the tank must be refilled. This is neces- helps prevent an electrostatic charge
The fuel tank flap is on the rear right of the
sary to ensure that the system works proper- building up.
vehicle.
ly, as well as the fuel quality required for driv-
– Never spill fuel in the vehicle or in the
The tank flap is unlocked when the car is un- ing with petrol.
luggage compartment. Fuel vapour is
locked using the central locking remote con- explosive. Risk of fatal accident!
trol ››› page 96. WARNING

● Open the fuel tank flap by pressing on the Fuel is highly flammable and can cause se-
rious burns and other injuries.
retainer zone.
● When refuelling, turn off the engine and
● Unscrew the cap by turning it to the left.
turn off the ignition for safety reasons.
270
Checking and refilling levels

CAUTION Refuelling natural gas ● If you wish to finish refuelling in advance,


press the button on the pump to stop the flow.
● If any fuel is spilt onto the vehicle, it
should be removed immediately. It could If the ambient temperature is very high, the
otherwise damage the paintwork. natural gas pump’s overheating protection
● Never run the tank completely dry. The disconnects it automatically.
catalytic converter can be damaged.
Closing the fuel tank cap
For the sake of the environment ● Check that the mouth retainer 2 of the gas
Do not overfill the fuel tank, it may cause filler is not trapped with the filler. If this hap-
the fuel to overflow if it becomes warm. pens, replace it in the filler mouth.
● Insert the plug in the filler mouth.
Note Fig. 187 Tank cap open: gas filler mouth 1 , ● Close the tank flap. Make sure you hear it
filler mouth retainer 2 .
There is no emergency mechanism for the
click into place.
manual release of the fuel tank flap. If nec- Before refuelling, the engine and the ignition,
essary, request assistance from special- WARNING
mobile telephone and heating must be
ised personnel. switched off separately ››› . Natural gas is a highly explosive, easily
flammable substance. Incorrect handling
Read the instructions on how to use the natu- of the natural gas can cause accidents se-
Note ral gas pump carefully. rious burns and other injuries.
● If the pump nozzle is worn, damaged, or if
● Before refuelling with natural gas, en-
it is very small, it is possible that it will not Refuelling gage the filling mouth correctly. If you can
be able to open the protective device. Be-
The natural gas filler mouth is behind the fuel smell gas, stop refuelling immediately.
fore trying to insert the pump nozzle by
turning it, try a different pump or request
tank cap, next to the petrol filler mouth ● Read and take note ››› in Natural gas
specialist help. ››› Fig. 187. on page 274.
● If you fill the tank from a reserve fuel can- ● Remove the plug from the gas filler mouth
ister, the protective device will not open. 1 . WARNING
One way to resolve this is to pour the fuel in
● Connect the pump filling nozzle to the gas The vehicle is not suitable for liquefied nat-
slowly.
filler mouth. ural gas (LNG) or liquefied petrol gas (LPG),
so LNG or LPG should not be used under
● The fuel tank will be full when the pump
any circumstances. Liquid gas can cause »
compressor automatically cuts the supply.

271
Practical tips

an explosion of the natural gas tanks and sor (fast refuel) at natural gas service sta- 1 Petrol with ethanol (“E” stands for Etha-
cause severe injuries! . tions. nol). The number indicates the percent-
age of ethanol in the petrol. “E5” means,
for example, an ethanol ratio of 5% max.
WARNING
2 Diesel according to the EN590 standard.
If the vehicle underbody touches the Fuel types The number indicates the maximum per-
ground or in the event of a rear collision,
centage of Biodiesel in the fuel. “B7”
there could be damage to the natural gas
tanks. If damaged, natural gas tanks are
Identification of fuels1) means a maximum of 7% Biodiesel.
full of fuel and can explode, causing seri- 3 Synthetic diesel according to the
ous or fatal injuries. EN15940 standard.
● Even if you don't notice the smell of gas, 4 Natural gas: “CNG” means Compressed
take the vehicle to a specialised workshop Natural Gas.
immediately and have the natural gas sys-
tem checked. Do not refuel natural gas
again until the natural gas system has been
inspected.
Type of petrol
3 Valid for: vehicles with petrol engines

Note The correct grade of petrol is listed inside the


● The filling nozzles of natural gas pumps fuel tank flap.
can differ in the way they are operated. Ask
The vehicle is equipped with a catalytic con-
a qualified employee at the petrol station Fig. 188 Identification of fuels according to
verter and must only be run on unleaded
to do the refuelling if you do not know how. European Union (EU) Directive 2014/94/
petrol. The petrol must comply with the
● Noises heard when refuelling are normal
Fuels are identified by different symbols on standard EN 228 and be sulphur-free. Fuels
and do not indicate damage in the system. with a 10% ethanol ratio can be refuelled
the pump and on your vehicle's tank flap. The
● The vehicle natural gas system is pre- (E10)2). The types of petrol are differentiated
identification serves to prevent confusion
pared both for refuelling with a small com- by using the octane numbers (RON) or via
when choosing the fuel.
pressor (slow refuel) and a large compres- the anti-knock index (AKI).

1) Depending on country
2)Follow the regulations of the country you are
driving in.
272
Checking and refilling levels

Super unleaded petrol 95 octane petrol or CAUTION ● In countries in which there is no sulphur-
normal 91 octane petrol at least free fuel, it is also allowed to use low sul-
● Fuels high percentage of ethanol, e.g.
We recommend refuelling with super 95 oc- phur content fuel.
E30 - E100 button must not be used. The
tane petrol (91 AKI). If not available, normal 91 fuel system would be damaged. Exception:
octane petrol (87 AKI) (with a slight power vehicles with Totalflex engine ››› page 273,
loss) may be used. Ethanol fuel. Ethanol fuel
● A single refuelling with leaded fuel or
3 Valid for: vehicles with Totalflex engines
Super unleaded petrol, 95 octanes at other metal additives entails a permanent
least deterioration of the effectiveness of the You can recognise vehicles with Totalflex en-
You should use super 95 octane petrol (91 catalytic converter. gines1) by label on the fuel tank lid with the
AKI) at least. ● Only use fuel additives that have been marking “Petrol/ethanol”.
approved by SEAT. The products that con-
If super is not available, if necessary, use nor- Vehicles with Totalflex engine can run with
tain substances to increase the octane rat-
mal 91 octane petrol (87 AKI). In this case only unleaded petrol (95 octane / 91 AKI) accord-
ing or decrease knocking may contain met-
use moderate engine speeds and a light al additives that damage the engine and
ing to ANP No. 57 and with fuels with any high
throttle. Refuel with super as soon as possi- catalytic converter. This type of products percentage of ethanol. The vehicle is refuel-
ble. must not be used. led in the same way as petrol refuelling.
● Do not use fuels shown in the pump as Also consider that ››› page 272, Type of pet-
Unleaded super plus 98 octane petrol or containing metals. LRP (lead replacement rol
super 95 octane petrol at least petrol) fuels contain high concentrations of
We recommend refuelling with super plus 98 metal additives. Risk of engine damage! Note
octane petrol (93 AKI). If not available: super ● High engine speed and full throttle can SEAT recommends filling the tank exclu-
95 octane petrol (91 AKI) (with a slight power damage the engine when using petrol with sively with petrol every 10,000 km to de-
loss). an octane rating lower than the correct crease impurities that using E100 ethanol
grade for the engine. fuel might have left in the engine.
If super is not available, if necessary, use nor-
mal 91 octane petrol (87 AKI). In this case only
use moderate engine speeds and a light Note
throttle. Refuel with super as soon as possi- ● Fuel with an octane rating higher than the
ble. one required by the engine can be used.

1) This motor is only available in some markets.


273
Practical tips

Natural gas Updated information relating to natural gas WARNING


quality is displayed on the instrument panel
3 Valid for: vehicles with natural gas engines Damaged, corroded or rusted tanks can re-
››› page 72.
sult in serious injury or even death.
Natural gas can be compressed or in liquid
Regular checks of the natural gas system ● Have the natural gas deposits checked at
form, addition to others.
least every 4 years (visual check).
The natural gas tanks may be damaged or
● Natural gas tanks have a limited service
Use of compressed natural gas (CNG) corroded by external factors. The walls of the
life. Have the natural gas tanks replaced
Vehicles with a natural gas engine must only gas tanks are weakened by deformations,
when required. You can obtain further infor-
be working with CNG (Compressed Natural damage or corrosion. The vehicle owner must
mation about this at SEAT dealers or speci-
Gas CNG ), or with a mixture of biomethane have a specialised workshop check (visual alised workshops.
if it complies with Regulation EN 16723-2. check) the gas system at least once every
4 years. Natural gas tanks must be replaced
Fuels such as liquefied natural gas (LNG), liq- at a specialised workshop.
uefied petroleum gas (LPG) or hithane (mix-
ture of hydrogen and methane) should not be
Engine management and
WARNING
used to fill the tank.
Failure to act when you can smell gas in the
emissions control system
vehicle or when refuelling can cause seri-
Natural gas quality and consumption Introduction
ous injuries.
Natural gas is divided into the groups H and L ● Stop the vehicle immediately.
depending on its quality. WARNING
● Switch the ignition off.
Gas type H has a superior heating power and ● Open the doors to appropriately venti-
● Due to the high temperatures reached by
inferior nitrogen and carbon dioxide content late the vehicle.
the exhaust gas scrubbing system, you
than type L. The higher the heating power of should not park your vehicle near a surface
● Extinguish cigarettes immediately.
the natural gas, the lower the consumption that can catch fire easily. Fire hazard!
will be. ● Move away from the vehicle or switch off ● Do not apply wax underneath the vehicle
objects that may cause sparks or a fire. around the area of the exhaust system: Fire
The engine management automatically
● If you continue to smell gas, do not con- hazard!
adapts to the natural gas used according to
tinue driving!
its quality. Therefore, different quality gases
● Seek specialist assistance. Have the fault
can be mixed in the tank, without the need for
repaired.
comprehensive draining before applying a
different quality gas. ● If necessary, warn the emergency serv-
ices.

274
Checking and refilling levels

Control lamps Catalytic converter For the sake of the environment


Even when the emission control system is
To maintain the useful life of the catalytic
 It lights up
converter
working perfectly, there may be a smell of
sulphur from the gases on occasions. This
Fault in the emission control system.
● Always use unleaded petrol. depends on the sulphur content of the fuel
Reduce speed and drive carefully to the nearest spe-
cialised workshop to have the engine checked. ● Never run the fuel tank dry. used. This can quite often be avoided by
changing to another brand of fuel.
● When changing or adding engine oil, do not
 Flashes exceed the necessary amount ››› page 281,
Topping up the engine oil.
Combustion failures that can damage the catalytic Particulate filter
converter. ● Never tow the vehicle to start it, use jump
Reduce speed and drive carefully to the nearest spe- leads if necessary ››› page 49.
cialised workshop to have the engine checked.
The particulate filter eliminates most of the
If you should notice misfiring, uneven running soot from the exhaust gas system. Under nor-
or loss of power when the car is moving, have mal driving conditions the filter cleans itself. If
 It lights up the filter does not clean itself (e.g. if short
the vehicle inspected by a specialised work-
Particulate filter blocked ››› page 275. shop. In general, the emissions warning lamp journeys are made continuously), it becomes
 will light up when any of these symptoms blocked with soot and the following indica-
occur. If this happens, any unburnt fuel can tion is displayed to the driver:  Particu-
 It lights up
late filter: cleaned while the vehi-
enter the exhaust system and escape into the
Fault in the petrol engine management. atmosphere. The catalytic converter can also cle is moving. See Manual. The partic-
Have the engine checked as soon as possible by a ulate filter needs cleaning (regeneration).
specialised workshop.
be damaged by overheating.

When the ignition is switched on, the  (Electronic CAUTION Regeneration of the particulate filter
Power Control) lights up and should go off once the Requirements for the regeneration journey:
engine has started. Never run the fuel tank completely dry be-
cause an irregular fuel supply can cause the engine is at operating temperature.
ignition faults. This allows unburnt fuel to
Note enter the exhaust system, which could
● Drive at a speed of between 50-120 km/h

While the indicator lamps ,  or  are cause overheating and damage the cata- (31-75 mph). This increases the temperature
on, there might be faults in the engine, fuel lytic converter. and burns the soot in the filter ››› .
consumption may go up and the engine ● Consider the legal speed limits as well as
might lose power. the recommended gears.
● End the regeneration journey once the con-
trol warning lamp has gone out. »
275
Practical tips

If the warning lamp stays on after 30 minutes


Engine compartment ● Never spill liquids used for vehicle opera-
of running in regeneration mode, have a spe- tion on the engine compartment, as these
cialised workshop repair the fault may catch fire (e.g. the antifreeze in cool-
Working in the engine compart- ant).
WARNING ment ● Avoid causing short-circuits in the elec-
Always adjust your speed to suit the weath- trical system, particularly at the points
Always be aware of the danger of injury and
er conditions, roads, braking distance and where the jump leads are attached
scalding as well as the risk of accident or fire
traffic if the particulate filter is in its regen- ››› page 49. The battery could explode.
when working in the engine compartment
eration phase. Route recommendations ● If working inside the engine compart-
should never make you disregard each (e.g. when checking and refilling fluids).
ment, remember that, even when the igni-
country's specific traffic regulations. Always observe the warnings listed below tion is switched off, the radiator fan may
and follow all general safety precautions. start up automatically, and therefore there
CAUTION is a risk of injury.
The vehicle's engine compartment is a po-
● Never cover the engine with additional in-
● When the exhaust system detects that tentially hazardous area ››› .
the particulate filter is close to saturation, sulating materials such as a blanket. Risk of
fire!
the self-cleaning function of this system WARNING
recommends optimal driving for this func- ● Do not unscrew the cap on the coolant
When work is done in the engine compart-
tion. expansion tank when the engine is hot. The
ment, injuries, burns, accidents and even
● Due to the high temperatures caused by cooling system is under pressure.
fires can occur.
the regeneration of the particulate filter, it ● Protect face, hands and arms by cover-
● Switch the engine off, remove the key
is possible that the radiator fan will acti- ing the cap with a large, thick rag to protect
from the ignition and apply the electronic
vate after stopping the engine, even it its against escaping coolant and steam.
parking brake. If the vehicle has a manual
operating temperature has not been ● Always make sure you have not left any
gearbox, place the lever in neutral; if it has
reached. objects, such as cleaning cloths or tools, in
an automatic gearbox, place the selector
● Noise, smells and high idle speeds can lever in position P. Wait for the engine to the engine compartment.
occur during regeneration. cool down. ● If you have to work underneath the vehi-
● Always use the correct engine oil and the ● Never open the bonnet if you see steam cle, you must use suitable stands addition-
correct fuel to make sure the useful life of or drips of coolant being released from the ally to support the vehicle, there is a risk of
the particulate filter is not affected. Also engine compartment. Wait until no steam accident!. A hydraulic jack is insufficient for
avoid making short trips all the time. or coolant can be seen before opening the securing the vehicle and there is a risk of
bonnet. injury.
● Keep children away from the engine ● If any work has to be performed when the
compartment. engine is started or with the engine running,

276
Checking and refilling levels

there is an additional, potentially fatal, or other fluids in the area where it was
safety risk from the rotating parts, such as parked, have your vehicle inspected at the
the drive belts, alternator, radiator fan, etc., workshop.
and from the high-voltage ignition system. ● Service fluids leaks are harmful to the en-
You should also observe the following: vironment. For this reason you should make
– Never touch the electrical wiring of the regular checks on the ground underneath
ignition system. your vehicle. If you find spots of oil or other
– Ensure that jewellery, loose clothing fluids, have your vehicle inspected in a
and long hair do not get trapped in ro- specialised workshop.
tating engine parts. Danger of death.
Before starting any work remove jewel- Fig. 190 Lever under the bonnet.
lery, tie back and cover hair, and wear Opening and closing the bonnet
tight-fitting clothes. Opening the bonnet
– Never accelerate with a gear engaged The bonnet is released from inside the vehi-
without taking the necessary precau- cle.
tions. The vehicle could move, even if
the handbrake is applied. Danger of Before opening the bonnet, make sure that
death. the windscreen wiper arms are in place
● Observe the following additional warn- against the windscreen.
ings if work on the fuel system or the elec- ● Open the door and pull the lever under the
trical system is necessary:
dashboard ››› Fig. 189 1 .
– Always disconnect the battery from the
● To lift the bonnet, press towards the left on
on-board network.
the lever located under the bonnet, in the
– Do not smoke. Fig. 189 Release lever in the driver's footwell centre ››› Fig. 190 2 . The arrester hooks are
– Never work near naked flames. area.
released.
– Always keep an approved fire extin- ● The bonnet can be opened. Release the
guisher immediately available. bonnet stay and secure it in the fixture de-
signed for this in the bonnet.
For the sake of the environment
Closing the bonnet
● Inspect the ground underneath your vehi-
cle regularly so that any leaks are detec- ● Slightly lift the bonnet. »
ted at an early stage. If you find spots of oil

277
Practical tips

● Release the bonnet stay and replace it in its WARNING the windscreen wipers are in place against
support. the windscreen.
Make sure that the bonnet is properly
● At a height of approximately 20 cm let it fall
closed. If it opens when driving, it can
so it locks. cause an accident.

If the bonnet does not close, do not press


downwards. Open it again and let it fall as CAUTION
mentioned above. To avoid damage to the bonnet and to the
windscreen wiper arms, only open it when

Checking levels

Fig. 191 Diagram for the location of the various el-


ements.

From time to time, the levels of the different 1 Coolant expansion tank ››› page 282 5 Battery ››› page 285
fluids in the vehicle must be checked. Never 2 Engine oil level dipstick ››› page 280 6 Windscreen washer reservoir
fill with incorrect fluids, otherwise serious ››› page 285
3 Engine oil filler cap ››› page 281
damage to the engine may be caused.
4 Brake fluid reservoir ››› page 284
278
Checking and refilling levels

Note Key to the ››› Fig. 192: – Petrol and CNG engines: VW 504 00,
A Information about the engine oil stand- ACEA C3 or API SN standard.
The layout of parts may vary depending on
the engine. ard.
SEAT recommends changing the oil at a spe-
B Information about engine oil viscosity. cialised workshop. SEAT recommends an Of-
ficial SEAT Service.
The engine comes with a special, multi-grade
Engine oil oil that can be used all year round. SEAT recommends the use of engine oils ap-
proved according to the appropriate VW
Because the use of high-quality oil is essen-
standard. Use of engine oils that do not meet
General notes tial for the correct operation of the engine
these quality requirements can cause engine
and its long useful life, when topping up or
damage.
changing oil, use only those oils that comply
with VW standards. SEAT recommends the use of Original SEAT
Spare Part engine oils.
For vehicles with an engine oil label
Engine oil additives
If the engine oil has to be topped up, use one
of the oils shown on the label ››› Fig. 192. The No type of additive should be mixed with the
label with the prescribed standard is located engine oil. The deterioration caused by these
at the front of the engine compartment additives is not covered by the warranty.
››› Fig. 193 1 . If you use the recommended
engine oil, you can top up the oil as often as CAUTION
Fig. 192 In the engine compartment: engine oil necessary. Take the following into account if you have
label
refilled with an engine oil different to those
For vehicles without an engine oil label specified in the aforementioned standards,
or by your SEAT technical service centre:
Contact a specialised workshop or SEAT offi-
cial service for information about the corre- ● There is no way of completely avoiding
sponding standard. the danger of causing damage to the en-
gine and particulate filter.
If the engine oil level is too low ● You can continue driving with the vehicle
if the refill was no more than 0.5 l of engine
If the recommended engine oil is not availa-
oil. Go to a specialised workshop as soon
ble, in the event of an emergency you can
as possible and request an oil change. Oth-
Fig. 193 In the engine compartment: area change the oil once with a maximum of 0.5 L erwise, there is a danger of engine dam-
where the engine oil label is located of the next oil until the next oil change: age. »
279
Practical tips

● If you have topped up more than 0.5 l of Warning lamp Checking the engine oil level
engine oil, drive with the engine at low load
levels and within the medium RPM range as  It lights up red
a maximum. Do not drive at more than 80
km/h and do not travel more than 300 km  Do not carry on driving!
(approximately). Go to a specialised work- Engine oil pressure too low.
shop as soon as possible and request an oil Switch off the engine. Check the engine oil level.
change. Otherwise, there is a danger of en- If this warning lamp  starts to flash, and is accom-
gine damage. panied by three audible warnings, switch off the en-
● You are responsible for the risk of possi- gine and check the oil level. If necessary, add more
ble damage to the vehicle (engine, exhaust oil ››› page 281.
system). If in doubt, do not start the engine
If the warning lamp  flashes although the oil level
and request assistance from the technical is correct, stop driving. Do not even run the engine at Fig. 194 Engine oil dipstick.
service centre. idle speed! Obtain technical assistance.
● Do not start the engine if you have top- The engine oil dipstick indicates the level of
ped up with a fluid other than engine oil.  It lights up yellow the oil.
Request assistance from the technical
service centre. Danger of engine damage! Check the engine oil level as soon as possible.
Replace oil as soon as you have the opportunity to Checking oil level
do so ››› page 281. – Park the vehicle in a horizontal position.
Note
– Briefly run the engine at idle speed until the
Before a long trip, we recommend finding  It flashes yellow
an engine oil that conforms to the corre-
operating temperature is reached and then
sponding VW specifications and recom- Fault in the oil level sensor. stop.
mend keeping it in the vehicle. This way, the Have the check done by a specialised workshop. Un-
– Wait for about two minutes.
correct engine oil will always be available til then it is advisable to check the oil level every time
you refuel. – Pull out the dipstick. Wipe the dipstick with
for a top-up if needed.
a clean cloth and insert it again, pushing it
WARNING in as far as it will go.
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Con- – Then pull it out once more and check the oil
trol and warning lamps on page 87. level ››› Fig. 194. Top up with engine oil if
necessary.

The oil must leave a mark between zones A


and C . It can never go above zone A .
280
Checking and refilling levels

● Zone A : do not add oil. Topping up the engine oil The position of the oil filler opening is shown
● Zone B : you can add oil but keep the level in the corresponding engine compartment il-
in that zone. lustration ››› page 278.
● Zone C : add oil until zone B . Engine oil specification ››› page 279.

Depending on how you drive and the condi- WARNING


tions in which the vehicle is used, oil con-
Oil is highly inflammable! Ensure that no oil
sumption can be up to 0.5 l/1000 km. Oil
comes into contact with hot engine compo-
consumption is likely to be higher for the first
nents when topping up.
5,000 km. For this reason the engine oil level
must be checked at regular intervals, prefera-
bly when filling the tank and before a journey. CAUTION
Fig. 195 In the engine compartment: Engine oil If the oil level is above area ››› Fig. 194 A ,
WARNING filler cap. do not start the engine. This could result in
Any work carried out in the engine com- damage to the engine and catalytic con-
Before opening the bonnet, read and observe verter. Contact a specialised workshop.
partment or on the engine must be carried
out cautiously.
the warnings ››› in Working in the engine
compartment on page 276.
● When working in the engine compart- For the sake of the environment
ment, always observe the safety warnings The oil level must never be above zone
Topping up engine oil
››› page 276. ››› Fig. 194 A . Otherwise oil can be drawn in
● Unscrew cap from engine oil filler opening through the crankcase breather and leak
CAUTION ››› Fig. 195. into the atmosphere via the exhaust sys-
● Carefully add oil in small quantities (no tem.
If the oil level is above area A , do not start
more than 0.5 l).
the engine. This could result in damage to
the engine and catalytic converter. Con- ● To avoid adding too much oil, whenever you Note
tact a Technical Service. add a certain amount, wait about 2 minutes Before a long trip, we recommend finding
and recheck the oil level ››› page 280. an engine oil that conforms to the corre-
● If necessary, add some more oil. sponding VW specifications and recom-
mend keeping it in the vehicle. This way, the
● When the oil level reaches at least zone
correct engine oil will always be available
››› Fig. 194B , unscrew the engine oil filler
for a top-up if needed.
cap carefully ››› .

281
Practical tips

Engine oil change For the sake of the environment increased, but only up to 60 %; otherwise an-
tifreeze protection will diminish and this will
● We recommend that you change the en-
We recommend that you have the engine oil worsen cooling.
gine oil and the filter at a technical service
changed by a Technical Service.
centre. When the coolant is topped up, use a mixture
● Never pour oil down drains or into the of distilled water and at least 40 % of the
WARNING
ground. additive G12evo for optimal protection
Only change the engine oil yourself if you against corrosion. Mixing G12evo with G13
● Use a suitable container when draining
have the specialist knowledge required! (TL-VW 774 J), G12 plus-plus (TL-VW 774 G),
the used oil. It must be large enough to hold
● Before opening the bonnet, read and ob- all the engine oil.
G12 plus (TL-VW 774 F), G12 (red) or G11
serve the warnings ››› page 276. (green blue) engine coolants decreases pro-
● Wait for the engine to cool down. Hot oil tection again corrosion and should be avoi-
may cause burn injuries. ded.
● Wear eye protection to avoid injuries, Cooling system
WARNING
such as acid burns, caused by splashes of
oil. Coolant specifications If there is not enough anti-freeze in the
● When removing the oil drain plug with coolant system, the engine may fail lead-
your fingers, keep your arm horizontal to The engine cooling system is supplied from ing to serious damage.
help prevent oil from running down your the factory with a specially treated mixture of ● Ensure that the percentage of additive is
arm. water and at least 40 % of the additive correct for the lowest expected ambient
● Wash your skin thoroughly if it comes into G12evo (TL-VW 774 J), purple. This mixture temperature in the zone in which the vehi-
contact with engine oil. gives the necessary frost protection down to cle is to be used.
-25°C (-13°F) and protects the light alloy ● When the outside temperature is very
● Engine oil is poisonous! Used oil must be
parts of the engine cooling system against low, the coolant could freeze and the vehi-
stored in a safe place out of the reach of
children. corrosion. It also prevents scaling and con- cle would be immobilised.
siderably raises the boiling point of the cool-
ant. CAUTION
CAUTION
To protect the cooling system, the percent- The original additives should never be
No additives should be used with engine oil.
age of additive must always be at least 40 %, mixed with coolants which are not ap-
This could result in engine damage. Any
even in warm climates where anti-freeze pro- proved by SEAT.
damage caused by the use of such addi-
tection is not required. ● If the fluid in the expansion tank is not
tives would not be covered by the factory
warranty. If for weather reasons further protection is purple but is, for example, brown, this indi-
necessary, the proportion of additive may be cates that the G12evo additive has been

282
Checking and refilling levels

mixed with an inadequate coolant. The – Cover the coolant expansion tank cap with
coolant must be changed as soon as possi- a cloth and carefully unscrew it to the left
ble if this is the case! ››› .
– Top up the coolant only if there is still cool-
For the sake of the environment ant in the expansion tank, otherwise you
could damage the engine. If there is no
Coolants and additives can contaminate
the environment. If any fluids are spilled,
coolant in the expansion tank, do not con-
they should be collected and correctly dis- tinue driving. You should obtain professional
posed of, with respect to the environment. assistance ››› .
– If there is still some coolant in the expansion
Fig. 197 Engine compartment: coolant expan-
sion tank cap. tank, top up to the upper mark.
Refilling coolant – Top up with coolant until the level becomes
The coolant tank is located in the engine stable.
compartment ››› page 278.
– Screw the cap back on correctly.
Top up coolant when the level is below the 
(minimum) mark. If there is a coolant leak, take the vehicle spe-
cialised workshop to have the cooling system
Checking coolant level examined.
– Park the vehicle in a horizontal position.
WARNING
– Switch the ignition off.
● The cooling system is under pressure. Do
– Read off the coolant level on coolant ex- not unscrew the cap on the coolant expan-
pansion tank. When the engine is cold, the sion tank when the engine is hot: risk of
Fig. 196 In the engine compartment: marking burns!
on coolant expansion tank. coolant level should be between the marks
››› Fig. 196. When the engine is hot, it may ● Store the antifreeze in its original con-
be slightly above the upper mark. tainer and keep it out of reach of children.
● If working inside the engine compart-
Topping up coolant ment, remember that, even when the igni-
– Wait for the engine to cool down. tion is switched off, the radiator fan may
start up automatically, and therefore there
is a risk of injury. »

283
Practical tips

CAUTION However, if the brake fluid level goes down CLASS 4 standards, or USA Standards
noticeably in a short time, or drops below the FMVSS 116 DOT 4.
If you run out of coolant in the expansion
 mark, there may be a leak in the brake ● The replacement brake fluid must be
tank, park the car in a safe place and do
system. Seek specialist assistance. A warning
not continue driving. Obtain technical as- new.
light on the instrument panel display monitors
sistance. ● Brake fluid should be stored in the closed
the brake fluid level ››› page 86.
original container in a safe place out of
reach of children. Risk of poisoning!
Changing brake fluid
Brake fluid We recommend that you have the brake fluid
CAUTION
changed by a Technical Service.
Brake fluid should not come into contact
Check and refill the brake fluid
WARNING with the vehicle paintwork, as it is abrasive.

If the brake fluid level is low or unsuita-


ble/old brake fluid is used, the brake sys- For the sake of the environment
tem may fail or braking power may be re- Brake fluid is an environmental pollutant.
duced. Collect any spilt service fluids and allow a
● Check the brake system and the brake professional to dispose of them.
fluid level regularly!
● When the brake fluid is used and brakes
are subjected to extreme braking forces,
bubbles of vapour form in the brake sys-
tem. These bubbles can significantly re-
Fig. 198 Engine compartment: brake fluid res- duce braking power, notably increasing
ervoir cap. braking distance, and could result in the to-
tal failure of the brake system.
The brake fluid reservoir is located in the en- ● Be sure to always use the correct brake
gine compartment ››› page 278. fluid. Only use brake fluid that expressly
meets the VW 501 14 standard.
Checking the brake fluid level ● You can buy VW 501 14 standard brake
The brake fluid level must be between the  fluid in a SEAT dealership or a SEAT Official
and  markings. Service. If none is available, use only high-
quality brake fluid that meets DIN ISO 4925

284
Checking and refilling levels

Windscreen washer reservoir Plain water is not enough to clean the wind- CAUTION
screen and headlights. We recommend that
Never mix an unsuitable antifreeze or other
you always add a product to the windscreen
Checking the level of the window washer fluid.
similar additives with the windscreen wash-
er water. A greasy layer may be formed on
washer tank and refilling it
the windscreen which will impair visibility.
Recommended windscreen wipers
● Use clean water with a window cleaner
● For the hottest seasons we recommend recommended by SEAT.
summer G 052 184 A1 for clear glass. Propor-
● If necessary, add a suitable antifreeze to
tions of the mixture in the washer fluid tank:
the water in the reservoir.
1:100 (1 part concentrate per 100 parts wa-
ter).
CAUTION
● All year round, G 052 164 A2 for clear glass.
Approximate proportion of the winter mixture, ● Do not mix cleaning products recommen-
up to -18°C (0°F): 1:2 (1 part concentrate per 2 ded by SEAT with other products. This
parts water); otherwise, a 1:4 proportion of could lead to flocculation and may block
mixture in the washer fluid tank. the windscreen washer jets.
Fig. 199 In the engine compartment: blue cap
● When topping up service fluids, make ab-
of the windscreen washer tank. The capacity of the window washer tank can solutely certain that you fill the fluids into
be found in ››› page 316. the correct reservoirs. Using the wrong flu-
The window washer tank is in the engine
ids could cause serious malfunctions and
compartment ››› page 278.
CAUTION engine damage!
Check the water level in the windscreen If the water from the windscreen washer ● Lack of window washer fluid causes the
washer reservoir regularly and top up as re- does not contain enough anti-freeze, it may view through the windscreen to be ob-
quired. freeze on the windscreen and rear window, scured.
The window washer tank contains liquid de- reducing forward and rear visibility.
tergent for the windscreen and rear window. ● In winter, ensure the windscreen washer
contains enough anti-freeze.
● Open the bonnet  ››› page 276.
● In cold conditions, you should not use the
12-volt battery
● The window washer tank is marked with the windscreen wiper system unless you have
 symbol on the cap. warmed the windscreen with the ventila- General information
● Check there is enough windscreen water in tion system. The antifreeze could freeze on
the windscreen and reduce visibility. The battery is located in the engine compart-
the reservoir.
ment and is almost maintenance-free. It is »
285
Practical tips

checked as part of the Inspection Service. are lost. These functions will require resetting ● Fires, sparks, open flames and smoking
Nevertheless, check the terminals are clean after the battery is reconnected. are prohibited. When handling cables and
and have the correct tightening torque, espe- electrical equipment, avoid causing sparks
When disconnecting the battery from the ve-
cially in summer and winter. and electrostatic charge. Never short the
hicle on-board network, disconnect first the
battery terminals. High-energy sparks can
All work on batteries requires specialist negative cable and then the positive cable.
cause injury.
knowledge. Please refer to a SEAT Official
Deactivate the anti-theft alarm before you ● A highly explosive mixture of gases is re-
Service or a workshop specialising in batter-
disconnect the battery. Otherwise the alarm leased when the battery is under charge.
ies: risk of burns or exploding battery!
will be triggered. The batteries should be charged in a well-
The battery must not be opened. Never try ventilated room only.
to change the fluid level of the battery. Oth- Winter conditions ● Keep children away from acid and bat-
erwise explosive gas is released from the bat- teries.
During the winter, the starting power may be
tery that could cause an explosion.
reduced, and if necessary, the battery should ● Before working on the electrical system,
Battery warning indications be charged ››› you must switch off the engine, the ignition
and all electrical devices. The negative ca-
 Wear eye protection. WARNING ble on the battery must be disconnected.
When a light bulb is changed, you need on-
 Battery acid is extremely corrosive. Wear pro- Always be aware of the danger of injury
ly switch off the light.
tective gloves and eye protection. Rinse any and chemical burns as well as the risk of
splashes of electrolyte with plenty of water. accident or fire when working on the bat- ● Deactivate the anti-theft alarm by un-
tery and the electrical system: locking the vehicle before you disconnect
 Fires, sparks, open flames and smoking are
● Wear eye protection. Protect your eyes,
the battery! The alarm will otherwise be
prohibited.
triggered.
skin and clothing from acid and particles
 The battery should only be charged in a well- containing lead. ● When disconnecting the battery from the
ventilated zone. Risk of explosion! vehicle on-board network, disconnect first
● Battery acid is extremely corrosive. Wear
the negative cable and then the positive
 Keep children away from acid and batteries! protective gloves and eye protection. Do
cable.
not tilt the batteries. This could spill acid
 Always follow the instruction manual. through the vents. ● Switch off all electrical devices before
reconnecting the battery. Reconnect first
● Neutralise any electrolyte splashes on
Disconnecting the battery the positive cable and then the negative
the skin, eyes or clothing with a soapy solu-
cable. Never reverse the polarity of the
The battery should only be disconnected in tion, and rinse off with plenty of water. If
connections. This could cause an electrical
exceptional cases. When the battery is dis- acid is swallowed by mistake, consult a
fire.
connected, some of the vehicle's functions doctor immediately.

286
Checking and refilling levels

● Never charge a frozen battery, or one If the control lamp  lights up while driving, ● Check the colour display in the "magic eye"
which has thawed. This could result in ex- the alternator is no longer charging the bat- on the top of the battery.
plosions and chemical burns. Always re- tery. You should immediately drive to the ● If there are air bubbles in the window, tap
place a battery which has frozen. A flat nearest specialised workshop. the window gently until they disperse.
battery can also freeze at temperatures
You should avoid using electrical equipment
close to 0°C (+32°F). The position of the battery is shown in the
that is not absolutely necessary because this
● Ensure that the vent hose is always con- corresponding engine compartment diagram
will drain the battery.
nected to the battery. ››› page 278.
● Never use a defective battery. This could The “magic eye” indicator, located on the top
cause an explosion. Replace a damaged of the battery changes colour, depending on
Checking the battery electrolyte
battery immediately. the charge state and electrolyte level of the
level
battery.
CAUTION
There are two different colours:
● Do not expose the battery to direct sun-
Yellow or colourless: The battery's electrolyte
light over a long period of time, as the in-
level is too low. Go to a specialised work-
tense ultraviolet radiation can damage the
shop to have the battery checked and
battery housing.
replaced if necessary.
● If the vehicle is left standing in cold con-
ditions for a long period, protect the bat- Black: The battery’s electrolyte level is cor-
tery from “freezing”. If it freezes it will be rect.
damaged.

Fig. 200 Sight glass on the top of the 12 volt Charging or changing the battery
Warning lamp battery (schematic representation).
If you often drive short distances or if the ve-
The electrolyte level should be checked reg- hicle is not driven for long periods, the battery
 It lights up red ularly in high-mileage vehicles, in hot coun- should be checked by a specialised work-
Alternator fault. tries and in older batteries. shop between the scheduled services.

● Open the bonnet and then lift the cover If the battery has discharged and you have
The control lamp lights up when the ignition is problems starting the vehicle, the battery
switched on. It should go out when the engine that protects the front part of the battery
››› in Working in the engine compart- might be damaged. If this happens, we rec-
has started running.
ment on page 276. ommend you have the vehicle battery »
287
Practical tips

checked by a Technical Service where it will


be re-charged or replaced.
● Before starting any work on the batteries, Wheels
you must read and observe the warnings
››› in General information on page 286.
Charging the battery Wheels and tyres
The vehicle battery should be charged by a For the sake of the environment
specialised workshop only, as batteries using General notes
 Batteries contain toxic substances such
special technology have been installed and
as sulphuric acid and lead. They must be – When driving with new tyres, be especially
they must be charged in a controlled environ- disposed of appropriately and must not be
ment. careful during the first 500 km (300 miles).
disposed of with ordinary household waste.
– If you have to drive over a kerb or similar
Replacing a vehicle battery obstacle, drive very slowly and as near as
The battery has been developed to suit the possible at a right angle to the obstacle.
conditions of its location and has special – Check from time to time if the tyres are
safety features. If the battery must be re- damaged (punctures, cuts, cracks or
placed, consult a technical service for infor- dents). Remove any foreign objects em-
mation on electromagnetic compatibility, the bedded in the treads.
size and maintenance, performance and
safety requirements of the new battery in – Damaged wheels and tyres must be re-
your vehicle before you purchase one. SEAT placed immediately.
recommends you have the battery replaced – Keep grease, oil and fuel off the tyres.
by a technical service.
– Replace any missing valve caps as soon as
Start-Stop systems (››› page 194) are equip- possible.
ped with a special battery. Therefore, it must
only be replaced with a battery of the same – Mark the wheels before taking them off so
specifications. that they rotate in the same direction when
put back.
WARNING – When removed, the wheels or tyres should
● Always use only maintenance free bat- be stored in a cool, dry and preferably dark
teries that do not run flat alone and whose place.
properties, specifications and size corre-
spond to the standard battery. The specifi-
cations are indicated on the battery case.

288
Wheels

Low profile tyres Foreign objects inserted in the tyre P max. 150 km/h (93 mph)
Low profile tyres have a wider tread, a larger ● Do not remove foreign bodies if they have Q max. 160 km/h (99 mph)
wheel diameter and a lower sidewall height. penetrated through the tyre wall! R max. 170 km/h (106 mph)
Therefore, its driving behaviour is more agile. ● If the vehicle comes with a tyre mobility S max. 180 km/h (112 mph)
Low profile tyres may deteriorate more quick- system, where necessary seal the damaged
T max. 190 km/h (118 mph)
ly than standard tyres, for instance due to tyre as shown in section ››› page 40. Use a
strong knocks, potholes, manhole covers and specialised workshop for repair or replace- U max. 200 km/h (124 mph)
kerbs. Correct tyre pressure is very important ment. SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT H max. 210 km/h (130 mph)
››› page 291. dealership for this.
V max. 240 km/h (149 mph)
To avoid damage to tyres and wheels, drive The sealant at the lower part of the tyre tread
Some manufacturers use the letters “ZR” for
with special care when driving on roads in wraps around the foreign body and provision-
tyres with a maximum authorised speed
poor condition. ally seals the tyre.
above 240 km/h (149 mph).
Visually check your wheels every 3000 km.
Tyres with directional tread pattern WARNING
If the tyres or rims have received a heavy im-
An arrow on the tyre sidewall indicates the di- ● New tyres do not have maximum grip dur-
pact or have been damaged, have a special-
rection of rotation on single drive tyres. Al- ing the first 500 km. Drive particularly
ised workshop check whether or not it is nec-
ways note the direction of rotation indicated carefully to avoid possible accidents.
essary to change the tyre.
when mounting the wheel. This makes sure
● Never drive with damaged tyres. This
Low profile tyres may deteriorate more quick- that optimal use is made of tyre properties in
may cause an accident.
ly than standard tyres. terms of aquaplaning, grip, excessive noise
● If you notice unusual vibrations or if the
and wear.
vehicle pulls to one side when driving, stop
Concealed damage
the vehicle immediately and check the
Damage to tyres and rims is often not readily Subsequent fitting of accessories
tyres.
visible. If you notice unusual vibration or the If you wish to change or fit wheels, rims or ● Never use old tyres or those with an un-
car pulling to one side, this may indicate wheel trims, we recommend that you consult known history of use.
that one of the tyres is damaged. Reduce with a SEAT Official Service centre for advice
speed immediately if there is any reason to regarding current techniques.
suspect that damage may have occurred. In-
spect the tyres for damage. If no external Speed symbols New wheels and tyres
damage is visible, drive slowly and carefully
The speed rating indicates the maximum It is best to have all wheels and tyres serviced
to the nearest specialised workshop and
have the car inspected.
speed permitted for the tyres. by a specialised workshop. There they have »

289
Practical tips

the required knowledge, the special tools and Manufacturing date hibited use can cause accidents or can
the corresponding spare parts. The manufacturing date is also indicated on damage your vehicle.
● Even winter tyres lose their grip on ice. If you the tyre sidewall (or on the inside face of the ● If decorative hubcaps are subsequently

have installed new tyres, drive the first 500 wheel): fitted, make sure that they allow enough air
km carefully and at a moderate speed. in to cool the braking system. Risk of acci-
DOT ... 2218 ...
dent!
● All four wheels must be fitted with tyres of
it means, for example, that the tyre was man-
the same type, size (rolling circumference) ufactured in the 22nd week of 2018.
and, if possible, tread pattern. For the sake of the environment
● When changing tyres, do not change just WARNING Old tyres must be disposed of according to
one; change at least two on the same axle. the laws in the country concerned.
● Use only combinations of tyres and rims,
● If you want to equip your vehicle with a as well as suitable wheel nuts, approved by
combination tyres and rims that are different SEAT. Otherwise the vehicle may be dam- Note
to those fitted in the factory, inform your spe- aged, causing an accident. ● A SEAT Service Centre should be consul-
cialised workshop before purchasing them ● For technical reasons it is not possible to ted to find out whether wheels or tyres of
››› use wheels of other vehicles; in some cases different sizes to those originally fitted by
not even wheels from the same vehicle SEAT can be fitted, and to find out about
The sizes of the rims and tyres approved for model should be used. the combinations allowed between the
your vehicle are listed in the vehicle docu- front axle (axle 1) and the rear axle (axle 2).
● Always ensure that the tyres you have
mentation (e.g. EC Certificate of Conformity ● Never mount used tyres if you are not
chosen have adequate clearance. When
or COC document1)). The vehicle documen- selecting replacement tyres, do not rely sure of their “previous history”.
tation varies depending on the country of res- entirely on the nominal tyre size marked on
idence. the tyre, since the nominal tyre size can dif-
If the type of spare wheel is different form the fer significantly depending on the manu-
normal wheels — e.g. in the case of winter facturer. Lack of clearance can damage
the tyres or the vehicle and, as a result, en-
tyres or particularly wide tyres — the spare
danger road safety. Risk of accident!
wheel should only be used temporarily in the
event of a puncture, and the vehicle should ● Only use tyres that are over 6 years old in
be driven with care. Refit the normal road an emergency, and drive with due care.
wheel as soon as possible. ● The fitting of tyres with run-flat proper-
ties is not permitted on your vehicle! Pro-

1) COC = certificate of conformity.


290
Wheels

Tyre life ● Avoid fast cornering and hard acceleration. pressure of 4.2 bar as indicated on the tyre
● Inspect the tyres for irregular wear from pressure label ››› Fig. 201.
time to time.
Driving style
Tyre pressure Fast cornering, heavy acceleration and hard
The tyre inflation pressures are listed on a braking (squealing tyres) all increase tyre
sticker on the rear of the front left door frame wear.
››› Fig. 201.
Wheel balance
Insufficient or excessive pressure greatly re-
duces the useful life of the tyres and adverse- The wheels on new vehicles are balanced.
ly affects vehicle performance and ride. Cor- However, certain circumstances may lead to
rect inflation pressures are very important, imbalance (run-out), which is detected as vi-
especially at high speeds. brations in the steering wheel.

Depending on the vehicle, tyre pressure can Unbalanced wheels should be rebalanced,
be adjusted to medium load to improve driv- as they otherwise cause excessive wear on
ing comfort (tyre pressure  ››› Fig. 201). steering, suspension and tyres. A wheel must
When driving with comfort tyre pressure fuel also be rebalanced when a new tyre is fitted
consumption may increase slightly. or if a tyre is repaired.
Fig. 201 Location of the tyre pressure sticker.
The tyre pressure must be adjusted accord- Incorrect wheel alignment
Correct inflation pressures and sensible driv- ing to the load the vehicle is carrying. If the
ing habits will increase the useful life of your Incorrect running gear alignment causes ex-
vehicle is going to carry the maximum load,
tyres. cessive tyre wear, impairing the safety of the
the tyre pressure should be increased to the
vehicle. If you notice excessive tyre wear, you
● Check tyre pressure at least once a month,
maximum value indicated on the sticker
should check wheel alignment at a SEAT Of-
and also prior to any long trip. ››› Fig. 201.
ficial Service.
● The tyre pressure should only be checked Do not forget the spare wheel when checking
when the tyres are cold. Do not reduce the the tyre pressures: Keep this spare wheel in- WARNING
pressure of warm tyres. flated to the highest pressure required for the
Unsuitable handling of the wheels and
road wheels.
● Adjust tyre pressure to the load being car- tyres may lead to sudden tyre pressure los-
ried by the vehicle ››› Fig. 201. In the case of a minimised temporary spare ses, to tread separation or even to a blow-
● In vehicles with a tyre pressure indicator, wheel (125/70 R16 or 125/70 R18), inflate to a out. »
save the modified tyre pressure ››› page 295.
291
Practical tips

● The driver is responsible for ensuring that Tread wear indicators or triangles on the sidewall of the tyre mark
all of the vehicle tyres are correctly infla- the position of the wear indicators.
ted to the right pressure. The recommen- The minimum permitted profile depth1) have
ded tyre pressure is indicated on the label been reached when the tyres have worn
››› Fig. 201. down to the wear indicators. Replace the
● Check tyre pressures regularly and en- tyres with new ones ››› .
sure they are maintained at the pressures
indicated. Tyre pressure that is too low Changing wheels around
could cause overheating, resulting in tread
detachment or even burst tyres. To ensure that the wear is equal on all tyres
● When the tyres are cold, tyre pressure
the wheels should be changed round from
should be that indicated on the label
time to time according to the system
››› Fig. 201. ››› Fig. 203. The useful life of all the tyres will
Fig. 202 Tyre profile: tread wear indicators.
then be about the same time.
● Regularly check the cold inflation pres-
sure of the tyres. If necessary, change the
WARNING
tyre pressure of the vehicle tyres while they
are cold. The tyres must be replaced at the latest
● Regularly check your tyres for damage when the tread is worn down to the tread
and wear. wear indicators. Failure to follow this in-
struction could result in an accident.
● Never exceed the maximum permitted
● Particularly in difficult driving conditions
speed or loads specified for the type of
tyre fitted on your vehicle. such as wet or icy roads. It is important that
the tyre tread be as deep as possible and
be approximately the same on the tyres of
For the sake of the environment both the front and the rear axles.
Fig. 203 Interchanging tyres.
Under-inflated tyres will increase fuel con- ● The scant driving safety due to insuffi-
sumption. Wear indicators around 1.6 mm high can be cient tread depth is particularly evident in
found on the base of the original tyre treads, vehicle handling, when there is a risk of
“aquaplaning” in deep puddles of water
ordered at regular intervals and running
across the tread ››› Fig. 202. The letters "TWI"

1) Follow the regulations of the country you are

driving in.
292
Wheels

and when driving through corners, and tightening torque is too high, the wheel nuts pound, tread pattern) gives less grip on ice
braking is also adversely affected. and threads can be damaged. and snow. This applies particularly to vehicles
equipped with wide section tyres or with
● The speed has to be adapted according-
high speed tyres (code letters H, V or Y on
ly, otherwise there is a risk of losing control CAUTION
over the vehicle.
the sidewall).
See ››› page 46to find out the recommen-
Only use winter tyres of the correct type ap-
ded tightening torque for wheel nuts for
steel and alloy rims.
proved for your vehicle. The sizes of these
Wheel nuts tyres are specified in the vehicle's documents
(e.g. EC Certificate of Conformity or COC1)).
The wheel nuts are matched to the rims. The vehicle documentation varies depending
When installing different wheels (for instance
Winter tyres on the country of residence.
alloy wheels or wheels with winter tyres) it is Winter tyres lose a great deal of their proper-
– Winter tyres must be fitted on all four
important to use the correct wheel nuts with ties when the tread is worn down to a depth
wheels.
the right length and correctly shaped bolt of 4 mm.
heads. This ensures that wheels are fitted se- – Only use winter tyres that are approved for
curely and that the brake system functions your vehicle. The performance of winter tyres is also se-
correctly. verely impaired by ageing, even if the tread is
– Please note that the maximum permissible still much deeper than 4 mm.
The wheel nuts must be clean and turn easily. speed for winter tyres may be lower than
for summer tyres. A code letter indicating the speed limit is
A special adapter is required to remove the stamped on all winter tyres ››› page 289.
anti-theft wheel bolts ››› page 44. – Also note that winter tyres are no longer ef-
fective when the tread is worn down. Vehicles capable of exceeding these speeds
WARNING must have an appropriate sticker attached
– After fitting the wheels you must always so that it is visible to the driver. Suitable stick-
Wheel nuts should never be greased or check the tyre pressures. When doing so, ers are available from the SEAT Official Serv-
oiled. take into account the correct tyre pressures ice and specialised workshop. Please note
● Use only wheel nuts which belong to the listed on the rear of the front left door frame the regulations to this effect in your country.
wheel. ››› page 291.
● If the prescribed torque of the wheel nuts Using winter tyres with V-rating
In winter road conditions winter tyres will con-
is too low, they could loosen whilst the ve-
siderably improve vehicle handling. The de- Please note that the generally applicable
hicle is in motion. Risk of accident! If the
sign of summer tyres (width, rubber com- 240 km/h (149 mph) speed for winter tyres »

1) COC = certificate of conformity.


293
Practical tips

with the letter V is subject to technical re- Snow chains Remove any central wheel trims and the rim
strictions; the maximum permissible speed ring before fitting snow chains.
for your vehicle may be significantly lower. Snow chains should only be used on the
The maximum speed limit for these tyres de- front wheels. WARNING
pends directly on the maximum axle weights The use of unsuitable or incorrectly fitted
for your car and on the listed weight rating of ● Check that they are correctly seated after
chains could lead to serious accidents and
the tyres being used. driving for a few yards; correct the position if
damage.
necessary, in accordance with the manufac-
It is best to contact a SEAT Official Service to turer's fitting instructions. ● Always the appropriate snow chains.
check the maximum speed which is permissi- ● Observe the fitting instructions provided
● Keep your speed below 50 km/h (30 mph).
ble for the V-rated tyres fitted on your car on by the snow chain manufacturer.
the basis of this information. ● If there is a danger of being trapped de-
● Never exceed the maximum permitted
spite having mounted the chains, it is best to
speeds when driving with snow chains.
WARNING disable the driving wheels (ASR) in the ESC
Exceeding the maximum speed permitted
››› page 239, Connecting and disconnect-
ing the ESC and ASR. CAUTION
for the winter tyres fitted on your car can
cause tyre failure, resulting in a loss of con- ● Remove the snow chains to drive on
Snow chains will improve braking ability as
trol of the vehicle – risk of accident. roads without snow. Otherwise they will im-
well as traction in winter conditions. pair vehicle handling, damage the tyres
For technical reasons snow chains may only and wear out very quickly.
For the sake of the environment
be used with the following wheel rim/tyre ● Wheel rims may be damaged or scratch-
When winter is over, change back to sum- combination. ed if the chains come into direct contact
mer tyres at an appropriate moment. In with them. SEAT recommends the use of
temperatures above +7°C (+45°F), perform- Tyres Wheel rim Chains covered snow chains.
ance will be improved if summer tyres are
used. Fuel consumption, wear and noises Max. link 13.5
195/60 R16 6Jx16 ET45
while driving will all be reduced. mm

205/60 R16 6Jx16 ET45


Note
205/55 R17 6.5Jx17 ET48 Max. link 9 mm
All-weather tyres can also be used instead
of winter tyres. Please note that only winter 215/45 R18 7Jx18 ET47
tyres with the symbol  may be fitted in
Other dimensions do not allow chains
some countries where winter tyres are
mandatory.

294
Wheels

Tyre pressure monitor sys- Wheel tread change hicle status > Tyres; OR:  > Exteri-
The wheel diameter changes when: or settings > Tyres ››› page 92 .
tem
● Tyre pressure is changed manually. When driving, the system self-calibrates the
tyre pressure provided by the driver and the
Control lamp ● Tyre pressure is insufficient.
wheels fitted. After a long journey with varied
● The tyre structure is damaged. speeds the programmed values are collected
 It lights up
● The vehicle is unbalanced because of a and monitored.
The tyre pressure of a wheel is much lower than the load. With the wheels under very heavy loads, the
value set by the driver ››› in Tyre pressure moni- ● The wheels on an axle are subject to a tyre pressure must be increased to the total
tor indicator on page 295.
heavier load (e.g. with a heavy load). recommended tyre pressure before calibra-
Or: Fault in the tyre pressure gauge. ● The vehicle is fitted with snow chains. tion ››› Fig. 201.

● The temporary spare wheel is fitted.


Several control and warning lamps light up WARNING
for a few seconds when the ignition is switch- ● The wheel on one axle is changed.
When the tyres are inflated at different
ed on while the function is verified. They will pressures or at a pressure that is too low
switch off after a few seconds. There may be a delay in the reaction of the
then a tyre may be damaged resulting in a
tyre pressure monitoring indicator  or it may
loss of control of the vehicle and a serious
WARNING not indicate anything under certain circum-
or fatal accident.
stances (e.g. sporty driving, snow-covered or
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Con- unpaved roads, or when driving with snow ● If the lamp  lights up, reduce speed im-
trol and warning lamps on page 87. mediately and avoid any sudden turning or
chains).
braking manoeuvre. Stop when possible,
and check the tyre pressure and status.
Calibrate the tyre pressure monitoring in-
● The tyre monitoring system can only op-
Tyre pressure monitor indicator dicator
erate correctly if all of the tyres are infla-
After changing the tyre pressure or replacing ted to the correct pressure when cold.
The tyre pressure monitor indicator compares
one or more wheels, the tyre pressure moni-
wheel revolutions and, with this information, ● If a tyre has not been punctured and it
toring indicator must be recalibrated. Do the
the tread of each wheel using the ABS sen- does not have to be changed immediately,
same, for example, when the front and rear drive to the nearest specialised workshop
sors.
wheels are swapped. at a moderate speed and have the tyre
The tyre pressure monitor indicator warns of checked and inflated to the correct pres-
● Switch the ignition on.
any change in the tread diameter of a wheel sure. »
. ● Save the new inflation pressure in the info-
tainment system using the button  > Ve-
295
Practical tips

Note Spare wheel Removing the temporary spare wheel

● Driving for the first time with new tyres at ● Lift and hold up the floor panel to remove
a high speed can cause them to slightly ex- Location and use of the temporary the temporary spare wheel ››› page 130.
pand, which could then produce an air ● Turn the thumb wheel anti-clockwise.
spare wheel
pressure warning.
● Take out the temporary spare wheel.
● Do not only rely on the tyre monitoring
system. Regularly check your tyres to en-
Getting the spare wheel out of vehicles
sure that the tyre pressure is correct and
with BEATS Audio 6 speakers (with sub-
that the tyres are not damaged due to
woofer)
puncture, cuts, tears and impacts/dents.
Remove objects from the tyres only when To remove the spare wheel, you must first re-
they have not pierced the tyres. move the subwoofer.
● The tyre pressure monitoring indicator
● Vehicles without a variable floor in the lug-
does not function when there is a fault in
gage compartment: pull the floor of the lug-
the ESC or ABS ››› page 237.
gage compartment (carpet) upwards to get it
● If the battery is disconnected, the yellow
out.
warning lamp  lights up after turning the
ignition on. This should turn off after a brief ● Vehicles with a variable luggage compart-
Fig. 204 In the luggage compartment: remove
journey. the subwoofer. ment floor: lift and secure the floor luggage
compartment as explained in ››› page 130.
The temporary spare wheel is stored under ● Disconnect the subwoofer ››› Fig. 204 1
the floor panel in the luggage compartment speaker cable.
and is attached by a thumbnut. ● Turn the securing wheel in an anti-clock-
The temporary spare wheel has been de- wise direction ››› Fig. 204 2 .
signed to be used for short periods of time. ● Remove the subwoofer speaker and the
Have the tyres checked and replaced as spare wheel.
soon as possible at a SEAT Official Service or
● When re-mounting the spare tyre, place the
at a specialised workshop.
subwoofer on the base of the wheel rim with
The spare wheel must not be switched for a care. When doing so, the tip of the “FRONT”
spare wheel from another vehicle. arrow on the subwoofer should point forward.
● Reconnect the speaker cable and firmly ro-
tate the securing wheel clockwise so that the
296
Wheels

subwoofer system and wheel are firmly in ble. Failure to do so may cause an acci-
place. dent. The tyre pressure is listed on the back
of the left front door frame ››› Fig. 201.
Removing the 16” temporary spare wheel ● Do not drive at over 80 km/h (50 mph)
(without subwoofer) when the temporary spare wheel is fitted
● Remove the luggage compartment varia- on the vehicle: risk of accident!
ble floor to access the wheel and the tools ● Never travel more than 200 km using a
››› page 130. temporary spare wheel.
● Loosen the strap that secures the box by ● Avoid heavy acceleration, hard braking
pressing on the buckle. and fast cornering: risk of accident!
● Remove the toolbox. ● Never use more than one temporary
spare wheel at the same time, risk of acci-
● Turn the securing wheel anti-clockwise and
dent.
remove it.
● No other type of tyre (normal summer or
● Press the thread and turn it 90° clockwise
winter tyre) may be fitted on the compact
or anti-clockwise and remove it. temporary spare wheel rim.
● Pull on the front part of the spare wheel to ● If you are driving using the spare wheel,
remove it. the ACC system could automatically
switch off during the journey. Switch off the
Chains system when starting off.
For technical reasons, snow chains must not
be used on the temporary spare wheel.
If you have a puncture on one of the front
wheels when using snow chains, fit the tem-
porary spare wheel in place of one of the rear
wheels. Fit the snow chains on the rear wheel
that you have removed and replace the
punctured front wheel with this wheel.

WARNING
● After fitting the temporary spare wheel,
check the tyre pressures as soon as possi-
297
Maintenance

Maintenance Service works ● Make sure that any repairs are carried
out by a SEAT authorised service or speci-
In the Digital Maintenance Plan, your SEAT
authorised service or specialised workshop alised workshop.
SEAT Maintenance Pro- documents the following information:
CAUTION
gramme ● When each one of the services was carried
out. SEAT cannot be held liable for any damage
to the vehicle due to insufficient work or of
Service intervals ● Whether a specific repair has been sugges-
lack of availability of spare parts.
ted, e.g. changing the brake pads in the near
future.
Service work and the Digital Main- Note
● If you have expressed a special request for
tenance Plan Regular services on the vehicle not only
the maintenance. Your Service Advisor will
write the work order. maintain its value, but also its correct oper-
Log of services performed (“Digital Main- ation and road safety. For this reason, con-
tenance Plan”) ● The components or fluids that were
duct the services in accordance with SEAT
changed. guidelines.
The SEAT dealership or a specialised work-
shop records Service receipts in a central ● The date of the next service.
system. Thanks to this comprehensive docu-
The Long Life Mobility Warranty is valid until
mentation of the service history, it is possible Set Service or Flexible Service In-
the next inspection. This information is docu-
to reproduce the services performed any
time. SEAT recommends requesting a Service
mented in all checks performed. tervals
receipt after every service carried out con- The type and the volume of the service may
Services are classified as oil change service
taining all the services carried out on the sys- vary from one vehicle to another. A special-
and inspection. The service interval display
tem. ised workshop will be able to provide specific
on the instrument panel display serves as a
information on the jobs for your vehicle.
Whenever there is a new service the receipt is reminder of the next service.
replaced with a current one.
WARNING Depending on the features, the engine and
The Digital Maintenance Plan is not avail- the conditions of use of the car, either the
If the services are insufficient or not per-
able in some markets. In this case, your Fixed service or the Flexible service will be
formed and if the service intervals are not
SEAT dealer will inform you about the cur- observed, the vehicle may be immobilised applied for an oil change service..
rent documentation of the work. in traffic cause an accident and severe in-
juries.

298
SEAT Maintenance Programme

How to know which type of service needs you have to carry out this service, take into Information about the terms of use
to his vehicle account the individual conditions of use and
● Check the tables below: personal driving style. A major component of The service intervals and groups are usually
the flexible service the use of LongLife oil in- based on normal conditions of use.
stead of conventional engine oil.
Oil change servicea) If, on the other hand, the vehicle is under ad-
Bear in mind the information about the speci- verse conditions of use, some of the work
Type of fications of the engine oil according to the
PR No. Service interval must be carried out before the next service
service VW standard ››› page 279. period or even between service intervals.
Every 5000 km or after If you do not want to the flexible service Conditions of use adverse include:
QI1
1 yearb)
you can select the fixed service However,
a fixed service may affect service costs ● The use of fuel with a high sulphur content.
Every 7500 km or after
QI2
1 yearb) The Service Advisor will gladly advise you. ● Frequent short trips.
Fixed
Every 10000 km or after ● Letting the engine idle for a long period of
QI3 Service interval display
1 yearb) time, as in the case of taxis.
At SEAT, the dates of the services are indica- ● Using the vehicle in areas with thick dust.
Every 15000 km or after
QI4 ted by the service intervals display:
1 yearb) ● Frequent driving with a trailer (depending
● on the instrument panel ››› page 82 on equipment).
According to the service in-
QI6 Flexible ● in the infotainment system: menu  > Set-
terval display ● Using the vehicle mostly in situations with a
tings > Service; OR  > Vehicle status > lot of traffic and stops (e.g. in a city).
a) The data are based on normal conditions of use.
Service ››› page 88.
b) ● Using the vehicle mostly in winter.
Whatever happens first.
The service interval display gives information
This applies especially for the following
Inspection Servicea) for service dates that involve an engine oil
parts (depending on equipment):
change or an inspection. When the time for
According to the service interval display the corresponding service comes, additional ● Dust and pollen filter
a) The data are based on normal conditions of use. work required, such as the change of brake
● Air Care allergen filter
fluid and the spark plugs, can be carried out.
● Air filter
Particular characteristics of the Flexible
Service ● Toothed chain
● Particulate filter
Regarding the Flexible Service, the oil
change service only has to be performed ● Engine oil »
when the vehicle needs it. To calculate when
299
Maintenance

The Service Advisor of your specialised ● Your SEAT authorised service placing complete sets, such as: light engine,
workshop will gladly inform you about the ● Your specialised workshop gearboxes, heads, control units, electrical
need of performing service work between components, etc.
normal service intervals, always considering Due to technical reasons (continuous devel-
These parts are, approved parts, and are the
the conditions of use of your vehicle. opment of components) the sets of services
same as the factory parts, which are also ap-
may vary. Your SEAT authorised service or
proved spare parts.
WARNING specialised workshop is always receiving up-
If the services are insufficient or not per- dates in time.
formed and if the service intervals are not
observed, the vehicle may be immobilised
Original accessories
in traffic and cause accidents and severe
injuries.
Additional service offers We recommend you only use SEAT Original
Accessories and SEAT approved accessories
● Have the services conducted at author-
Approved spare parts for your vehicle. The reliability, safety and
ised SEAT services or specialised work-
suitability of these accessories have been in-
shops.
Original SEAT Spare Parts have been con- spected specifically for this type of vehicle.
ceived for their vehicles and approved by SEAT cannot be held liable for the safety and
CAUTION SEAT S.A., with a special emphasis on safety. suitability of parts from other manufacturers.
SEAT cannot be held liable for any damage These parts correspond exactly to the manu-
to the vehicle due to insufficient work or of facturer's requirements in terms of design,
lack of availability of spare parts. accuracy of the measurements and materi- SEAT Service Mobility
als. The original SEAT Spare Parts have been
conceived exclusively for your vehicle. For this Since the moment you purchase your SEAT
reason, we always recommend the use of vehicle you will be able to enjoy the benefits
Service sets
Original SEAT Spare Parts. SEAT S.A. cannot and coverage of the SEAT Mobility Service.
Sets of services include all the maintenance be held liable for the safety and suitability of
For the first two years after the purchase,
works needed to ensure the safety and the parts from other manufacturers.
your new SEAT vehicle is automatically cov-
smooth running of the vehicle (depending on ered by the SEAT Mobility Service without ad-
the conditions of use and the features of ditional costs.
the vehicle, such as the engine, gearbox, or Approved spare parts
If you wish to enjoy this service after this peri-
operating fluids). Maintenance services are
Approved spare parts, following the manu- od, you can extend SEAT Mobility as long as
divided into inspection and review services.
facturer's requirements, are an additional you carry out the recommended Inspection
Consult the details of the jobs required for
your vehicle at: service to you, offering the possibility of re-
300
Vehicle maintenance

and Maintenance Services at a SEAT Author-


ised Service.
Vehicle maintenance Washing the vehicle

The longer you take to clean the tanks, e.g.


If your SEAT vehicle is immobilised due to a
fault or an accident, our assistance services
Maintenance and cleaning remains of insects, bird excrements, tree resin
or anti frost salt adhered to your vehicle, the
will help you keep moving.
Basic observations more damage it can cause to the surface.
Take into account that the SEAT Mobility High temperatures, for instance strong sun-
Service differs depending on the country in Regular and careful care helps to maintain light, further intensify the damage.
which the vehicle was purchased. For further the value of your vehicle. In addition, it may Before washing the car, soften the dirt using
information ask your SEAT dealership or the become a prerequisite to demand the war- plenty of water.
SEAT website in your country. ranty in the event of corrosion damage and
deficiencies in the paint coat of the body- To remove encrusted dirt such as insects, bird
work. droppings or tree resin, use a lot of water and
a microfibre cloth.
Warranty Specialised workshops have the necessary
care products. Please follow the instructions Have the underside of the vehicle washed af-
for application on the packaging. ter the end of the anti frost salts in winter.
Fault-free operation warranty

SEAT Authorised Services ensure the perfect WARNING High pressure cleaning equipment
condition of new vehicles. Check the pur- ● Cleaning products and other materials When washing the vehicle with a high-pres-
chase agreement or complementary addi- used for car care can be damaging to your sure cleaner, always follow the operating in-
tional documentation provided by your Tech- health if misused. structions for the equipment. This applies
nical Service to see the conditions and the ● Always keep care products in a safe particularly to the operating pressure and the
terms of the warranty. Consult further infor- place, out of the reach of children. Danger distance between the spraying water. Do not
mation in this regard in your SEAT Official of poisoning! aim the jet directly to the side window gas-
Service. kets, doors, covers or the panoramic sunroof;
the same applies to tyres, rubber hoses,
For the sake of the environment
soundproofing material, sensors or camera
● When purchasing car care products, lenses. Keep a distance of at least 40 cm.
chose products that are compatible with
the environment. Do not remove snow and ice with a high-
● The waste from car-care products should
pressure cleaner. »
not be disposed of with ordinary household
waste.

301
Maintenance

Do not use a nozzle that sprays the water out Apply the product with a microfibre cloth. To exterior mirrors should only be folded elec-
in a direct stream or one that has a rotating avoid damaging the surface of the paint, do tronically!
jet for forcing off dirt. not apply too much pressure.
● Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight.
The water temperature must not exceed Rinse with plenty of water. Then clean it with Risk of damaging the paint job!
60°C. a neutral cleaning product and a soft microfi- ● Do not use sponges, abrasive household
bre cloth. sponges or similar to clean insect remains.
Automatic car washes Risk of damaging the surface!
Rinse the vehicle again with plenty of water
Spray the vehicle before starting the car and then leave it to dry. Remove traces of ● Vehicle parts with matte paint:
wash. water with a leather cloth. – Do not use polish or hard wax. Risk of
damaging the surface!
Make sure that the windows and the panor-
WARNING – Never select washing programs that in-
amic sunroof are closed and the windscreen
wipers are deactivated. Bear in mind the in- ● Only wash the vehicle with the ignition clude the use of wax. This could dam-
structions of the car wash tunnel operator, switched off or according to the specifica- age the appearance of matte paint.
especially if your vehicle has detachable tions of the car wash tunnel operator. Risk – Do not put stickers or magnets on parts
parts. of accident! with matte paint, as removing them
● When cleaning the underbody or the in- may damage the paint.
Use of car washes without brushes if possible.
side of the wheel arches, protect yourself
from sharp or pointy metal parts. Risk of For the sake of the environment
Washing by hand cut!
Clean your vehicle from top to bottom with a The car should only be washed in special
● After cleaning the brakes could act more
wash bays. These places are prepared to
soft sponge or with a brush. Only use clean- slowly due to moisture or, in winter, the ice
prevent oily water from getting into the
ing products that do not contain solvents. on the brake discs and pads. Risk of acci-
public drains.
dent! In this case the brakes should be
Washing vehicles with a matte paint by dried by pressing the brake pedal several
hand times.

To prevent damage to the vehicle when


Cleaning and maintenance instruc-
washing it, first remove the thicker dust and CAUTION tions
dirt. To remove traces of insects, grease and ● Before washing the vehicle in an auto-
fingerprints, it is best to use a special cleaner The cleaning and maintenance of individual
matic car wash, please make sure to re-
for matte paint. components of the vehicle can be checked in
tract the exterior mirrors to prevent them
from being damaged. The electric folding
the following tables. The contents should be
understood merely as a recommendation. Go
to your specialised workshop if you have
302
Vehicle maintenance

special questions or parts that are not listed. Wheels


Problem Solution
Take he general considerations into account
Problem Solution
››› in Take special care with... on Corrosion
Have your specialised work-
page 306. Antifreeze salt Water shop take care of this

Brake abrasion Acid-free special cleaning The water does


dust product not create drop- Maintain with hard wax (at
Cleaning the exterior lets on the clean least 2 times a year)
paint
End exhausts
Windscreen wipers Treat with suitable wax and ap-
Problem Solution No shine de- ply paint preservative after-
Problem Solution spite sober main- wards if the wax used does not
Antifreeze salt Water, if a steel cleaning prod-
Dirt Soft cloth with wipers uct is required tenance/paint contain preservative ingredi-
ents
Headlights / Tail lights Covers / Trims Tanks, e.g. insect
Immediately soften with water
remains, bird
Problem Solution Problem Solution droppings, tree
and remove with a microfibre
cloth
sap, road salt
Dirt Soft sponge with neutral soap Dirt Neutral soap solutiona), if a
solutiona) steel cleaning product is re- Fat-based dirt,
quired Delete immediately with a neu-
e.g. cosmetic
a) Neutral soap solution: two tablespoons maximum in tral soap solutiona) and a soft
products or
1 litre of water a) Neutral soap solution: two tablespoons maximum in cloth
sunscreen
1 litre of water
Sensors / Camera lenses a) Neutral soap solution: two tablespoons maximum in
Paint
Problem Solution 1 litre of water
Problem Solution
Sensors: soft cloth with a sol- Carbon fibre parts
vent-free cleaning product Check the paint's colour code
Dirt Camera lenses: soft cloth with Paint flaws in an authorised service and re-
Problem Solution
an alcohol-free cleaning prod- store with a touch-up pencil Dirt Clean the same way as pain-
uct
Spilled fuel Immediately rinse with water
ted parts ››› page 301 »
Hand brush/Anti frost spray
Snow/ice Apply rust remover and then
with no solvents
Environmental rust apply hard wax. Go you your
tank specialised workshop if you
have any queries

303
Maintenance

Decoration slides Displays/instrument panel


Problem Solution
Problem Solution Problem Solution
Grease-based Apply a neutral soap solutiona).
Dirt Soft sponge with neutral soap Dirt Soft cloth with a liquid crystal dirt, e.g. oil, make- Absorb the dissolved grease
solutiona) display cleaner up, etc. and paint particles drying with
an absorbent cloth, in case you
a) Neutral soap solution: two tablespoons maximum in must treat it with water after-
Control panels
1 litre of water wards
Problem Solution Special dirt, e.g. Special stain remove: dry with
Dirt Soft brush, then soft cloth with pens, nail polish, an absorbent cloth, if applica-
Interior cleaning neutral soap solutiona) dispersion paint, ble, apply neutral soap solution
shoe cream etc. afterwardsa)
a) Neutral soap solution: two tablespoons maximum in
Windows a) Neutral soap solution: two tablespoons maximum in
1 litre of water
Problem Solution 1 litre of water
Seat belts
Dirt Apply windscreen cleaner and Natural leather
then dry with a cloth Problem Solution
Problem Solution
Dirt Neutral soap solutiona), al-
Covers / Trims Recent dirt Cotton cloth with neutral soap
lowed to dry before retracting
solutiona)
Problem Solution a) Neutral soap solution: two tablespoons maximum in
Water-based dirt, Recent stains: absorbent cloth
Dirt Neutral soap solutiona) 1 litre of water
e.g. coffee, tea, Dry stains: stain remover suita-
a) Neutral soap solution: two tablespoons maximum in Fabrics, artificial, Alcantara leather blood etc. ble for leather
1 litre of water Grease-based Recent stains: absorbent cloth
Problem Solution
dirt, e.g. oil, make- and suitable stain remover for
Plastic parts up, etc. leather
Particles of dirt Vacuum cleaner
stuck to surfaces Dry stains: grease solvent
Problem Solution
spray
Dirt Damp cloth Water-based dirt, Absorbent cloth and neutral
e.g. coffee, tea, soap solutiona) Special dirt, e.g. Stain remover suitable for
Encrusted dirt Neutral soap solutiona), if pos- blood etc. pens, nail polish, leather
sible solvent-free plastic clean- dispersion paint,
er shoe cream etc.

a) Neutral soap solution: two tablespoons maximum in

1 litre of water
304
Vehicle maintenance

Problem Solution Camera lenses ● The ambient rust deposits must not be re-
● Do not use hot or warm water to remove ice moved through friction. Risk of damaging the
Care Apply preservative cream regu- or snow from the camera lenses. Risk of paint job!
larly to protect from sunlight.
cracking the lens! ● Remove cosmetic products and sunlight
Use a colour preservative if re-
quired ● To clean the camera lens, never use abra- immediately. Risk of damaging the paint job!
sive cleaning products or products with alco-
a) Neutral soap solution: two tablespoons maximum in
hol. Risk of scratches and cracks! Displays/instrument panel
1 litre of water ● The screens, the instrument panel and the
Carbon fibre parts Windows trim around it must not be cleaned dry. Risk of
● Remove snow and ice from windows and scratches!
Problem Solution exterior mirrors with a plastic scraper only. To ● Make sure that the instrument panel is
Dirt Clean like plastic parts avoid scratches, the scraper should only be switched off and cooled down before clean-
pushed in one direction and not moved to ing.
and fro. ● Make sure that no liquid leaks between the
● Never remove snow or ice from windows instrument panel and the trim. Risk of dam-
Take special care with...
and rearview mirrors with warm or hot water. age!
Risk of cracks on the windows!
Headlights/tail lights
● To prevent damage to the heating of the Control panels
● Do not clean the headlights/tail lights with
rear window, do not put stickers over the ● Make sure that no liquid leaks into the con-
a dry cloth or sponge.
heating elements. trol panels. Risk of damage!
● Do not use cleaning products that contain
alcohol. Risk of cracks! Covers/trims Seat belts
● Do not use cleaning products or chrome ● Do not remove the seat belts to clean them.
Wheels
based cleaning agents. ● Seat belts and their components must nev-
● Do not use for paint wax or other abrasive
er be cleaned with chemical products, nor
products. Paint should they be allowed to come into contact
● If the protective coating on the paint of the ● The vehicle must be free from dirt and dust with corrosive liquids, solvents or sharp ob-
rim has been damaged due to stone impacts, before applying wax or care products. Risk of jects. Risk of damaging the fabric!
scratches, etc., the damage should be re- scratches! ● If you find any damage to the belt webbing,
paired immediately. ● Do not apply wax or care products if the belt fittings, the belt retractor or the buckle,
vehicle is exposed to direct sunlight. Risk of ask your specialised workshop to replace the
damaging the paint job! belt in question. »
305
Maintenance

Fabrics/artificial leather/Alcantara leath-


er
longed period in the bright sun, it is best to
cover the leather.
Accessories and modifi-
● Do not treat artificial leather/Alcantara cations to the vehicle
leather with leather cleaning products, sol- WARNING
vents, wax polish, shoe cream, stain removers
or similar products.
Do not use water-repellent coatings on the
windscreen. In bad visibility conditions
Accessories, spare parts and
● If the stain is very hard to remove, take the such as humid weather, darkness or when repair work
vehicle to a specialised workshop to have it the sun is in its lowest point, visibility may
be impacted. Risk of accident! Such coat-
removed there. This will prevent damage. Introduction
ings can also cause the windscreen wiper
● Do not use steam cleaners, brushes, hard blades to make noise.
sponges, etc. to clean. Always ask your dealer or specialist retailer
for advice before purchasing accessories
● Do not turn on seat heating to dry the
Note and replacement parts.
seats.
● Remains of insects can be removed much Your vehicle is designed to offer a high stand-
● Sharp objects on clothing, such as zips, riv-
more easily with previously treated paint. ard of active and passive safety. For this rea-
ets or belts can damage the surface.
● Regular car care treatments can prevent son, we recommend that you ask a SEAT Offi-
● Open Velcro, e.g. on clothes can damage deposits of ambient rust. cial Service for advice before fitting accesso-
the seat upholstery. Make sure that Velcro ries or replacement parts. Your SEAT Official
fasteners are closed. Service has the latest information from the
manufacturer and can recommend accesso-
Natural leather Remove the vehicle from traffic
ries and replacement parts which are suita-
● Never use solvents, wax polish, shoe cream, ble for your requirements. They can also an-
If you want to leave your vehicle stationary
spot removers or similar products on leather. swer any questions you might have regarding
for a long period of time, contact a qualified
● Sharp objects on clothing, such as zips, riv- workshop. They will gladly inform you about official regulations.
ets or belts can damage the surface. the necessary measures, such as anti-corro- We recommend only using SEAT accesso-
● Do not use steam cleaners, brushes, hard sion protection, Service and storage. ries and genuine SEAT parts®. SEAT has
sponges, etc. to clean. tested these parts and accessories for suita-
Also take into account instructions regarding
● Do not turn on seat heating to dry the the vehicle's battery ››› page 285. bility, reliability and safety. SEAT Official
seats. Services have the necessary experience and
facilities to ensure that the parts are installed
● Avoid exposing leather to direct sunlight for
correctly and professionally.
long periods, otherwise it may tend to lose
some of its colour. If the car is left for a pro-

306
Accessories and modifications to the vehicle

Any retro-fitted equipment which has a di- For this reason we recommend asking official Mobile radio transmitters
rect effect on the vehicle and/or the way it is SEAT service centres to do any necessary Commercial mobile telephones or radio
driven, such as a cruise control system or work using genuine SEAT parts®. equipment might interfere with the electron-
electronically-controlled suspension, must ics of your vehicle and cause malfunctions.
be approved for use in your vehicle and bear WARNING This may be due to:
the e mark (the European Union's authorisa- Incorrectly performed modifications or
tion symbol). other work on your vehicle can lead to mal- ● No external aerial.

If any additional electrical devices are fit- functions and cause accidents. ● External aerial incorrectly installed.
ted which do not serve to control the vehicle ● Transmitting power more than 10 W.
itself (for instance a refrigerator box, laptop
or ventilator fan, etc.), they must bear the  Radio telephones and office equip- You must, therefore, do not operate portable
sign (manufacturer conformity declaration in mobile telephones or radio equipment inside
ment the vehicle without a properly installed exter-
the European Union).
nal aerial ››› .
Radio transmitters (fixed installation)
WARNING Please note also that the maximum range of
Any retrofit installations of radio transmitters
Accessories, for example telephone hold- in the vehicle require prior approval. SEAT the equipment can only be achieved with an
ers or cup holders, should never be fitted external aerial.
generally authorises in-vehicle installations
on the covers, or within the working range
of approved types of radio transmitters provi-
of the airbags. Otherwise, there is a danger Business equipment
ded that:
of injury if the airbag is triggered in an acci-
dent. Retrofit installation of business or private
● The antenna is installed correctly.
equipment in the vehicle is permitted, provi-
● The aerial is installed on the exterior of the ded the equipment cannot interfere with the
vehicle (and shielded cables are used to- driver's immediate control of the vehicle and
Technical modifications gether with non-reflective aerial trimming). that any such equipment carries the  mark.
● The effective transmitting power does not Any retrofit equipment that could influence
Unauthorised modifications to the electronic the driver's control of the vehicle must have a
exceed 10 Watts at the aerial base.
components, software, wiring or data transfer type approval for your vehicle and must carry
in the vehicle may cause malfunctioning. A SEAT Official Service and specialised work- the e mark.
You will appreciate that your SEAT dealership shop will be able to inform you about options
cannot be held liable for any damage for installing and operating radio transmitters WARNING
caused by modifications and/or work per- with a higher transmitting power.
Mobile telephones or radio equipment
formed incorrectly. which is operated inside the vehicle without »
307
Maintenance

a properly installed external aerial can


create excessive magnetic fields that
could cause a health hazard.

Note
● The posterior fitting of electric and elec-
tronic equipment in this vehicle affects its
licence and could lead to the withdrawal of
the vehicle registration document under
certain circumstances.
● Please use the mobile telephone/radio
operating instructions.

308
Information for the user

Information for the user These data will provide a better understand-
ing of the circumstances of the accident.
vehicle's ODB (“On-Board-Diagnose”) inter-
face while the vehicle is switched on.
Data from the driving assist systems are also SEAT will not have access to EDR data unless
Information for the user recorded. This includes data such as whether the owner (or, in “Leasing” cases, the lessee
the systems were inactive or active and if or hirer) gives their consent. There may be ex-
such action had an impact on the vehicle’s ceptions to this, depending on legal or con-
Information stored by the dynamic behaviour, changing its path in the tractual provisions.
control units aforementioned situations, accelerating or
Due to legal requirements in safety-related
decelerating the vehicle.
products, SEAT may use the EDR data for
Storage of accident data (Event Depending on vehicle equipment, this in- field research and in order to improve vehicle
Data Recorder) cludes data from systems such as: system quality. Any data used for the purpo-
ses of research will be treated anonymously
Your vehicle has an event data recorder ● Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
(in other words, no reference will be made to
(EDR). ● Emergency brake assistance system (Front the vehicle, their owner or the lessee/hirer).
Assist).
The EDR’s function is to record data in the
event of a mild or serious accident. These da- ● Park Pilot system
ta are used to support the analysis of how dif-
The EDR data are only recorded in specific Other important information
ferent vehicle systems behaved.
accident situations. No data are recorded in
The EDR records, over a reduced time range normal driving conditions. Environmental compatibility
(normally 10 seconds or less), dynamic driv-
No audio or video data inside or around the
ing data and data from the restraint systems, Environmental protection is a top priority in
vehicle are recorded. Under no circumstan-
such as: the design, choice of materials and manufac-
ces are personal data such as name, age, or
ture of your new SEAT.
● How different vehicle systems worked. gender recorded. Nevertheless, third parties
● Whether the driver and the occupants were (such as criminal proceedings authorities)
Constructive measures to encourage re-
may relate the contents of the EDR data to
wearing their seat belts. cycling
other data sources and create a personal
● How hard the acceleration or brake pedal ● Joints and connections designed for easy
reference in the context of an accident inves-
was pressed. tigation. dismantling.
● Vehicle speed. ● Modular construction to facilitate disman-
In order to read the EDR data it is necessary
● GPS position. to access (if legally permitted to do so) the tling.
● Increased use of single-grade materials. »
309
Information for the user

● Plastic parts and elastomers are marked in ● Use of systems for the recovery of residual
accordance with ISO 1043, ISO 11469 and heat (thermal recovery, enthalpy wheels,
www.seat.com/generalinfo 
ISO 1629. etc.).
United Kingdom
● The use of water-soluble paints.
Choice of materials Your vehicle has different radioelectrical devi-
ces. The manufacturers of these devices de-
● Use of recycled materials.
clare that they comply with the UK Radio
● Use of compatible plastics in the same part Recycling of electrical or electron- Equipment Regulations 2017 (SI 2017/1206) if
if its components are not easily separated. ic devices required by law.
● Use of recycled materials and/or materials
All electrical or electronic devices (EED) that The full text of the declaration of conformity is
originating from renewable sources.
are not permanently fitted in the vehicle must available online at the following Internet ad-
● Reduction of volatile components, including dress:
be marked with the following symbol:
odour, in plastic materials.
● Use of CFC-free coolants.  www.seat.com/generalinfo

Ban on heavy metals, with the exceptions This symbol indicates that EED must not be
Ukraine
dictated by law (Annex II of ELV Directive discarded as home waste but through selec-
2000/53/EC): cadmium, lead, mercury, tive waste collection. Your vehicle has different radioelectrical devi-
hexavalent chromium. ces. The manufacturers of these devices de-
clare that they comply with Ukraine Decree
355/2017 (TR Radio Equipment) where legal-
Manufacturing methods
Radioelectrical equipment ly required.
● Reduction of the quantity of thinner in the
protective wax for cavities. The full text of the declaration of conformity is
Simplified declaration of conformi- available online at the following Internet ad-
● Use of plastic film as protection during vehi-
ty dress:
cle transport.
● Use of solvent-free adhesives. Your vehicle has different radioelectrical devi- www.seat.com/generalinfo 
● Use of CFC-free coolants in cooling sys- ces. The manufacturers of these devices de-
clare that they comply with Directive
tems.
2014/53/EU when legally required.
● Recycling and energy recovery from resi- Addresses of the manufacturers
dues (RDF). The full text of the EU compliance declaration
is available online at the following address: The address of the manufacturers of compo-
● Improvement in the quality of waste water.
nents that, due to their size or nature, cannot
310
Information for the user

include a sticker are listed below, as long as it Antenna amplifiers KATHREIN Automotive GmbH
is legally required: ASK Industries S.p.A Römerring 1
Via dell'Industria n.12/14/16 31137 Hildesheim, Germany
Central control unit (BCM) 60037 Monte San Vito (AN), Italy Phone: +498031184-0
Phone: +3907174521 Website: www.kathrein.com
Robert Bosch GmbH/Braunschweig
Theodor-Heuss-Strasse 12 Website: www.askgroup.it
38122 - Braunschweig, Germany Connectivity Box
Phone: 0049 53188890 Hirschmann Car Communication GmbH Molex CVS Dabendorf GmbH
Stuttgarter Strasse 45-51 Märkische Strasse 72
72654 Neckartenzlingen, Germany 15806 Zossen OT Dabendorf, Germany
Keyless Access system
Phone: +49 7127 140 Phone:+49 3377 3160
HELLA GmbH & Co. KGaA/Hamm Website: www.te.com Website: www.molex.com
Roemerstr. 66
59075 - Hamm, Germany KATHREIN Automotive GmbH
Phone: 0049 23817980 Römerring 1 Basic infotainment system
31137 Hildesheim, Germany Panasonic Automotive Systems Czech
Roof antenna Phone: +498031184-0 U Panasonicu 266
Website: www.kathrein.com 530 06, Pardubice, Czech Republic
ASK Industries S.p.A
Via dell'Industria n.12/14/16 Molex CVS Hildesheim GmbH
60037 Monte San Vito (AN), Italy Optional infotainment system
Daimlerring 31
Phone: +3907174521 31135 Hildesheim, Germany LG Electronics Mlawa SP
Website: www.askgroup.it Phone: +49 3377 3160 LG Electronics 7
Website: www.molex.com 06 500, Mlawa
Mitsumi Electronics Europe GmbH
Siemensstrasse 32 Remote control key
Navigation antenna
63225 Langen, Germany
Phone: +49 (0) 6103913-0 Hirschmann Car Communication GmbH Digades GmbH Digitales Und Ana/Zittau
Website: www.minebeamitsumi.co.jp Stuttgarter Strasse 45-51 Äußere Weberstr. 20
72654 Neckartenzlingen, Germany 02763 - Zittau, Germany
Molex CVS Hildesheim GmbH Phone: +49 7127 140 Phone: 0049 358357750 »
Daimlerring 31 Website: www.te.com
31135 Hildesheim, Germany
Phone: +49 3377 3160
Website: www.molex.com

311
Information for the user

Instrument panel Panasonic Automotive Systems Czech, Rear radar sensors


Analogue SE38x/SE316 s.r.o. Hella GmbH & Co. KGaA
Visteon Electronics Germany GmbH U Panasonicu 266 Rixbecker Straße 75
Visteonstr. 4-10 530 06, Pardubice, Czech Republic 59552 Lippstadt (Germany)
50170 Kerpen, Germany
Front radar sensors Online Connectivity Unit
Analogue all other models MRR for SE38X
Continental Automotive Spain, S.A. LG ELECTRONICS INC.
Robert Bosch GmbH 10, Magokjungang 10-ro,
Crta. de Rubí a Ullastrell, nº 12-30 Markwiesenstrasse, 46
08191 Rubí (Barcelona - Spain) Gangseo-gu, Seoul, Republic of Korea
72770 Reutlingen (Kusterdingen) Germany
FPK (digital) MRR for Tarraco, Ateca, Ibiza, Arona
Continental Automotive GmbH Automotive Distance Control Systems
VDO-Strasse 1, GmbH
64832 Babenhausen, Germany Peter-Dornier-Strasse, 10
Panasonic Automotive Systems Europe 88131, Lindau, Germany
GmbH
Robert Bosch Str. 27-29
63225 Langen, Germany

Frequency bands, station power

Radioelectrical equipmenta) Frequency band Max. station power Valid for models
433.05-434.78 MHz 10 mW (ERP)

433.05-434.79 MHz 10 mW
Radiofrequency remote control (vehicle) All SEAT models
868.0-868.6 MHz 25 mW

434.42 MHz 32 µW

Radio frequency remote control (auxiliary 868.7-869.2 MHz (869.0 MHz) 25 mW Leon, Ateca and Tarraco
heater) 868.0-868.6 MHz (868.3 MHz) 3.1 mW Alhambra
312
Information for the user

Radioelectrical equipmenta) Frequency band Max. station power Valid for models
868.0-868.6 MHz (868.3 MHz) 23.5 mW Alhambra
Transmitted-Receiver (independent heating)
868.7-869.2 MHz (869.0 MHz) 23.5 mW Leon, Ateca and Tarraco

2402-2480 MHz 6 dBm


Bluetooth All SEAT models
2400-2483.5 MHz 10 dBm

GSM 900: 880-915 MHz 33 dBm

GSM 1800: 1710-1785 MHz 30 dBm Leon, Alhambra and Tarraco

WCDMA FDD I: 1920-1980 MHz 24 dBm

WCDMA FDD lll: 1710-1785 MHz 21 dBm

WCDMA FDD VIII: 880-915MHz 21 dBm


Connection to the external antenna of the car
LTE FDD1: 1920-1980 MHz 23 dBm

LTE FDD3: 1710-1785 MHz 23 dBm Tarraco and Leon

LTE FDD7: 2500-2570 MHz 23 dBm

LTE FDD8: 880-915 MHz 23 dBm

LTE FFD20: 832-862 MHz 23 dBm

Wireless hotspot 2400-2483.5 MHz 10 dBm Leon, Ateca and Tarraco

Keyless Access 434.42 MHz 32 µW Ibiza, Arona, Leon, Ateca and Tarraco

28.2 dBm Leon and Alhambra


Radar sensors for front assist systems 76 GHz-77 GHz
35.0 dBm Ibiza, Arona, Ateca and Tarraco

Radar sensors for rear assist systems 24050-24250 MHz 20 dBm Ibiza, Arona, Leon, Ateca and Tarraco

Wireless charging 110-120 kHz 5W Ibiza, Arona, Leon, Ateca and Tarraco »

313
Information for the user

Radioelectrical equipmenta) Frequency band Max. station power Valid for models
Ibiza, Arona, Ateca, Tarraco and
Instrument panel 125 kHz 40 dBµA/m
Alhambra

EGSM900: 880-915 MHz 33 dBm

DCS1800: 1710-1785 MHz 31 dBm

UMTS FDD 1: 1920-1980 MHz 24 dBm

UMTS FDD 3: 1710-1785 MHz 24 dBm

UMTS FDD 8: 880-915 MHz 24 dBm

Online Connectivity Unit E-UTRA FDD 1: 1920-1980 MHz 23.5 dBm Ibiza, Arona, Leon, Ateca and Tarraco

E-UTRA FDD 3: 1710-1785 MHz 23.0 dBm

E-UTRA FDD 7: 2500-2570 MHz 23.5 dBm

E-UTRA FDD 8: 880-915 MHz 23.0 dBm

E-UTRA FDD 20: 832-862 MHz 23.5 dBm

E-UTRA FDD 28: 703-748 MHz 23.0 dBm


a) The commissioning or authorisation of radioelectrical technology may be restricted in some European countries, forbidden or only allowed with additional requirements.

Additional information for coun- available online at the following Internet ad- conditions: (1) this equipment or device may
dress: not cause harmful interference, and (2) this
tries outside the European Union
equipment or device must accept any inter-
Mexico https://www.seat.mx/servicio/mi-seat/manual- ference, including interference that may
del-propietario.html cause undesired operation.
Your vehicle has different radioelectrical devi-
ces. The manufacturers of these devices de- Certificate: RLVHERS17-0286. RS4 Hella United Kingdom
clare that they comply with Directive KGaA Hueck & Co. short-range radar
RLVCOAR15-0008 when legally required. The IFT:RLVHERS17-0286. The operation of this This vehicle has various radio equipment de-
full text of the declaration of conformity is equipment is subject to the following two vices installed.

314
Information for the user

The following acts as importer of the radio Importer:


equipment devices for the United Kingdom Porsche Ukraine LLC
market within the meaning of The Radio Pavla Tychyny ave. 1V, Office “B”, 4th floor
Equipment Regulations 2017: 02152 Kyiv, Ukraine.
Volkswagen Group United Kingdom Ltd.
Yeomans Drive, Blakelands
Milton Keynes, MK 14 5AN
United Kingdom

Türkiye
Telsiz Ekipmanları Yönetmeliği
(2014/53/AB)
Aracınızda çeşitli telsiz ekipmanları bulun-
maktadır.
Telsiz Ekipmanlari Yönetmeliği (2014/53/AB)
açısından Türkiye pazarı için radyo ekipmanı
ithalatçısı (bu bilgi sadece resmi temsilcimiz
olan Doğuş Otomotiv Servis ve Ticaret A.Ş.’nin
ithal ettiği ürünler için geçerlidir):

Doğuş Otomotiv Servis ve Ticaret A.Ş.


Şekerpınar Mahallesi, Anadolu Caddesi,
No: 22 ve 45
41420 Çayırova/Kocaeli

Ukraine
Імпортер:
ТОВ «Порше Україна»
просп. Павла Тичини, 1В, офіс „В“, 4-й
поверх
02152 Київ, Україна.

315
Technical data

Technical data Vehicle identification data vidual vehicle, as well as on the driving style,
road conditions, traffic conditions, environ-
Vehicle ID number mental conditions, load or number of passen-
Indications about the The vehicle ID number can be found in the
gers.
following places:
technical data
● One the vehicle's data label. Filling capacities
Important information ● In front, under the windscreen.
Tank level
● To the right in the engine compartment.
Introduction Petrol engines 40 l, 7 l reserve
Type plate approx. 13.8 kg
The values indicated in the technical data Natural gas en-
The type plate is located on the vehicle’s right Additional petrol tank: 9 l, of
ginea)
may differ depending on optional equipment hand door frame. Vehicles for certain export which approx 7.6 l is a reserve
or version of the model, as well as in the case countries do not have a type plate. a) The capacity depends on the efficacy and charac-
of special vehicles and equipment for certain
teristics of the natural gas pumps. The capacity indi-
countries. cated is based on a minimum loading pressure of 200
bar.
The information in the official vehicle docu- Fuel consumption
mentation takes precedence at all times. Capacity of the windscreen washer fluid con-
Approved consumption values are derived tainer
Abbreviations used in the Technical Speci- from measurements performed or supervised
Windscreen washer
fications section by certified EU laboratories, according to the approx. 3 litres
fluid container
legislation in force at the time (for more infor-
kW Kilowatt, engine power measurement.
mation, see the Publications Office of the Eu-
Pferdestärke (horsepower), formerly ropean Union on the EUR-Lex website: © Eu-
PS
used to denote engine power. ropean Union, http://eur-lex.europa.eu/) and Weights
apply to the specified vehicle characteristics.
rpm, 1/min Revolutions per minute - engine speed. Load on the roof
The values relating to fuel consumption and
Nm Newton metres, unit of engine torque. The maximum authorised roof load for your
CO2 emissions can be found in the documen-
tation provided to the purchaser of the vehi- vehicle is 75 kg.
Cetane number, indication of the die-
CZ
sel combustion power. cle at the time of purchase.
Research octane number, indication of Fuel consumption and CO2 emissions de-
RON
the knock resistance of petrol. pend on the equipment/features of each indi-
316
Indications about the technical data

Empty weight, total weight, axle loads


The empty weight of the vehicle with driver
(75 kg) was calculated according to the (EU)
1230/2012 standard. Optional equipment can
increase the empty weight, which means that
the possible useful load decreases propor-
tionally.

Trailer weight
The maximum permitted drawbar load on the
ball head of the towing bracket is 55 kg.

WARNING
The values indicated for the maximum per-
mitted weights must not be exceeded.
There is a risk of accident and damage!

317
Technical data

Engine specifications

Petrol engines 1.0 TSI Start-Stop


Power output in kW (PS) at 1/min 70 (95)/5,000-5,500 81 (110)/5,500

Maximum torque (Nm at 1/min) 175/1,600-3,500 200/2,000-3,000

No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) 3/999 3/999

Fuel Super 95 / Normal 91 (with a slight power loss) ROZ

Gearbox manual manual DSG

Top speed (km/h) 182 (V) 190 (V) 190 (VI)

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 11.4 10.3 10.1

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,700a) 1,720a) 1,740a)


a) Varies depending on the features.

Petrol engines 1.5 TSI Start-Stop 1.6 MPI


Power output in kW (PS) at 1/min 110 (150)/5,000-6,000 81 (110)/5,800

Maximum torque (Nm at 1/min) 250/1,500-3,500 152/3,800-4,000

No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) 4/1,498 4/1,598

Fuel Super 95 / Normal 91 (with a slight power loss) ROZ

Gearbox DSG manual automatic

Top speed (km/h) 210 (V) 181 (IV) 181 (IV)

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 8.4 11 11.5

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,760a) 1,680a) 1,720a)


a) Varies depending on the features.

318
Indications about the technical data

Natural gas / petrol engine 1.0 TGI Start-Stop


Power output in kW (PS) at 1/min 66 (90)/4,000-5,500

Maximum torque (Nm at 1/min) 160/1,800-3,800

No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) 3/999

CNG
Fuel
Super 95 / Normal 91 (with a slight power loss) ROZ

Gearbox manual (VI)

Top speed (km/h) 178 (IV)

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 13.2

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1710

319
Technical data

Dimensions.

Fig. 205 Dimensions and angles.

320
Indications about the technical data

››› Fig. 205 ARONA


A Front projection (mm) 809

B Rear projection (mm) 779

C Wheelbase (mm) 2,566

D Length (mm) 4,154

E Fronta) track (mm) 1,513

F Backa) track (mm) 1,495

G Width (mm) 1,780

H Height at kerb weight (mm) 1,537b)

I Ground clearance between the axles (mm) 173

J Front projection angle limited by the bumper maximum 18.1°

K Rear projection angle limited by the bumper maximum 28.1°

Turning radius (m) 10.6


a) This data will change depending on the type of wheel rim.
b) Dimension to the roof bars.

321
Index

Index Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Antifreeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Apple CarPlay
Airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Disconnecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Numbers and Symbols activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 establish connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
12-volt battery control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
assisted start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 deactivation of the front airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
disconnect and connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83, 285 front airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Applications (apps) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 how it works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Aspects to think about before starting the ve-
winter operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 Air conditioning hicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Climatronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 ASR
A manual air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 see Traction control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
ABS usage instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Assistance systems
see Anti-lock brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Air recirculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
ACC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Air vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 assisted parting system (Park Assist) . . . . . . 240
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136, 306 Alternator cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Activating SEAT CONNECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 driver alert system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Active cylinder management (ACT) Android Auto™ driving assist (Travel Assist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
status indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Disconnecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 emergency braking (Front Assist) . . . . . . . . . . 216
Adapting the playback volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 establish connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 front camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Adaptive Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 front radar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
control and warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 general notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
noises . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Anti-lock brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 lane departure warning (Side Assist) . . . . . . 229
operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Anti-puncture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40, 41 parking aid Plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
special driving situations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 rear cross traffic alert (RCTA) . . . . . . . . . 229, 232
status display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 check after 10 minutes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 rear parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Adjust components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 road sign detection system messages . . . . . . 75
front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 inflating the tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 safety advice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
headrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 sealing the tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Anti-puncture set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 system limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Anti-theft alarm system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Tyre pressure monitor indicator . . . . . . . . . . . 295
time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259, 260 Tyre pressure monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Adjusting the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Anti-trap function Assisted start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
323
Index

Audible warning Blown bulbs Change a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58


control and warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 change a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 interior light and reading light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 luggage compartment lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
unbuckled seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 number plate light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Auto Lock (central locking) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276, 278 tail light bulb in the bodywork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Automatic car wash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302 opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 tail light bulb in the rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Automatic dipped beam headlight control . . . 112 Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 Change the wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 subsequent work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
downhill assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 brake servo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 wheel nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
driving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 braking assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Changing parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
emergency release of the selector lever. . . 202 new brake pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Checking levels
ignition key extraction lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 Braking assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
kick-down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Braking system Check lists
operating fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 requirements for Android Auto™ . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
selector lever lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 requirements for Apple CarPlay . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
selector lever positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 C requirements for MirrorLink® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
steering wheel with shift paddles . . . . . . . . . . 199 Camera Childproof locks
tiptronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197, 199 cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Capacities Child seats
Average fuel consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 natural gas tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 group classification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
window washer water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 ISOFIX system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
B Care safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Background lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 see Cleaning the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 securing with the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Backrest of the rear seat Catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Top Tether system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 34, 35
folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Central locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Cleaning the vehicle
raise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 anti-theft alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 high pressure cleaning equipment . . . . . . . . . 301
Bag hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 central locking switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 special care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 emergency lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 vehicle exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
Before starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 vehicle interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Belt tightening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 remote control key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 wash the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
Bicycle carrier selective unlocking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Climatronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
installing on the tow bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Clocks
max. load rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 set the time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79

324
Index

Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 rear cross traffic alert (RCTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Display of road signs on the instrument panel
bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79, 270 activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Clutch (lamp) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Disposal
Coming Home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Start-Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Connectivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 steering column lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Distance control
WLAN access point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Travel Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 see Adaptive Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Connectivity Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 Tyre pressure monitor system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 Door cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Contact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 Controls and displays Door handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Control and warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 Door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Controls on the steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Convenience close function child lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Downhill assistance function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
alternator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 Convenience open function Downhill assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
anti-lock brake system ABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Drawers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
ASR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237, 239 Cooling system Drink holder
audible warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 check the coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 bottle holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
braking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 refilling coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 Driver
cruise control (GRA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 Copyright . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 see Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
EDL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Driver alert system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Driving
electronic parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 driving on flooded roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
emissions control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Cruise control system economical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 parking on inclines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
engine management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 park on upward slopes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Current documentation attached . . . . . . . . . . . 143 safe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
ESC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237, 239 trips abroad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118, 208
fuel reserve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 D with trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261, 263, 267
gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 Dangers of not using the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Driving Assist (Travel Assist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 Data label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
lane departure warning (Side Assist) . . . . . . 230 Data transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 status display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Deactivating SEAT CONNECT services . . . . . . 159 troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Deactivation of cylinders Driving data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
press on the brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216, 219 see Active cylinder management (ACT) . . . . 69 Driving data indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Deactivation of the front airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Driving mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
325
Index

Driving on flooded roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 fire extinguishers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Engine and ignition


Driving profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 first aid kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 automatic ignition disconnection . . . . . . . . . . 190
DSG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 emergency start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Duplicate keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 jump leads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 My Beat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Dust and pollen filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 replace a blown fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 preheat the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Dynamic headlight range control . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 vehicle tool kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
warning triangle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 starting the engine with Press & Drive . . . . . . 191
E Emergency braking assist system . . . . . . . . . . . 210 switching off the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
e-Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276, 278
E10 operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
see Ethanol (fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 status display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Eco-driving notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 system limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282, 283
EDL temporarily deactivating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
see Electronic differential lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Emergency braking warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Electric Emergency call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Emergency call service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 window washer tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Electrical accessories Emergency locking of the front passenger Engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
see Power socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 check the level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Emergency opening control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Electrolyte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 driver's door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 G12evo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 G12 plus-plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Emergency operation G13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Electronic differential lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 front passenger door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Electronic engine torque management gear selector lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 temperature indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
(XDS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Emissions control system warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Electronic immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106, 193 catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Engine failure
Electronic parking brake control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Engine management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Electronic self-locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Engine control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . 237 assisted start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Engine oil
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 noises . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279, 282
anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 preheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 checking the oil level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 running in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
changing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 Start-Stop system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
emergency vehicle towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 inspection service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
326
Index

maintenance frequencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 Extinguisher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Fuel tank cap


refill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 F Fuel tank flap
Engine oil pressure Fabrics: clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Factors that have a negative influence on Full-LED headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Engine specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Full Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Enlarge Fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
the luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Filling capacities settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Environment fuel tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
ecological driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 window washer tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
environmental compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 Filling the tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 colour coded . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 First aid kit fuse box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55, 56, 57
Environmental tip housing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 preparations for replacing fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Fog lights with cornering light function . . . . . . . 115 recognise blown fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136, 306 Frequency bands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 replace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
telephone interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Front airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
ESC Front Assist G
electronic stability control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . 237 see Emergency braking assist system . . . . . 216 Gear-change recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
multi-collision brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Front drink holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Gearbox DSG
Sport mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 Front passenger front airbag see Automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Ethanol (fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Gear change
Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 Fuel engage the gears (manual change) . . . . . . . 196
Exhaust gases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 ethanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Exterior lighting fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Gear indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
change a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 Glove compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Exterior mirrors natural gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
driving with a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 petrol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 H
folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Handbrake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
fold manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 saving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Hangers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Fuel consumption Hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 inertia disconnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Head-on collisions and the laws of physics . . . 18
Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7, 8 why does consumption increase? . . . . . . . . . 275 Head-protection airbags
External antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
external audio sources control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
adapting the playback volume . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
327
Index

Headlights
change a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
overview and controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147, 148
J
Jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
trips abroad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Radio mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
position points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Headrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125, 126 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Jump leads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Heating and fresh air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 share a WLAN connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Jump start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Hill driving assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 sound settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 system settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
telephone interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
I vehicle information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
K
vehicle settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Keyless Access
Identification of fuels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Keyless Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Identifying letters on engine (LDM)
WLAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Keyless Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Infotainment system Press & Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Identity accreditation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
see Infotainment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279, 298 starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Ignition key extraction lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Inspection service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 unlocking and locking the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 99
Ignition lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66, 67 Keyless Access lock and ignition system:
Inertia mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
control and warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 see Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Information profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
digital (SEAT Digital Cockpit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Keyless Entry
Infotainment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88, 143
display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 see Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
adapt menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
menu structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Keyless Exit
Android Auto™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
service intervals display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 see Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Apple CarPlay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
status display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69, 71 Keys
before first use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
use with the multifunction steering wheel . . . 84 assign a key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
connecting and disconnecting . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Instrument panel display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68, 69 changing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
customise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Instrument panel lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
customised menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Interior door handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 spare key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
drop-down menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Interior mirror synchronise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
executing functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
anti-dazzle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 unlock and lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98, 106
function buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Interior monitoring and the anti-tow system vehicle key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
initial configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Key switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Internet access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Interior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Kick-down
Media mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Interlock button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
MirrorLink® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
ISOFIX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 driving profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
ISOFIX system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
328
Index

L fog light with cornering light function . . . . . . . 115


headlight range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
storing the rear shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
variable luggage compartment floor . . . . . .
129
130
Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
instrument lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Luggage compartment floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
control and warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
interior light and front reading lights . . . . . . . . 62 Luggage compartment shelf
how it works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Lane assist Plus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
leaving home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Lumbar support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Lane Assist system
luggage compartment lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
see Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
main beam assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 M
Lane departure warning (Side Assist)
main beam headlight lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Main beam assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
main beam headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Main beam headlight lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
driving situations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
motorway light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Maintenance
how it works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
number plate light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 see Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
indication on the exterior mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
reading lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Maintenance frequencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Leather: clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
side lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Malfunction
Leaving a parking space with the parking as-
switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
sist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
switching on and off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 assisted parting system (Park Assist) . . . . . . 240
Leaving Home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
turn signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Legal provisions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Loading the luggage compartment emergency brake assistance system (Front
Levels control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Assist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
general advice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Lift the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108, 128 towing device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Light Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
positioning the load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Light range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
positioning the luggage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
audible warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260 Media Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
AUTO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Load on the roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 MirrorLink®
change a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Disconnecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
coming home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Lock and unlock establish connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
control and warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
in the locking cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
control lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
with Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
controlling the lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
with the central locking switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
cornering light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108, 128 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
daylight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
emergency unlocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
dipped beam headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
luggage compartment lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
fog light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113

329
Index

Mirrors managing the map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96


adjusting the exterior mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177, 180 bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
anti-dazzle interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 navigation announcements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 by remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
see also Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 offroad mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Mobile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Other options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 in the locking cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Mobile phones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 route details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Multi-collision brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 saved data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177, 182 tank cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270, 271
Multifunction display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 saved destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169, 188 save destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 with the central locking switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
favourites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 split screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Operating fault
play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
select source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 use contact details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Operation in winter
use streaming services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 use the map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
My Beat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 use the map to enter the destination . . . . . . 180 salt on the roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Noise snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
N brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Natural gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 ESC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Original accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 refuelling natural gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 Original SEAT Spare Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
fuel tank cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289, 293 Overview (left hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
LNG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 Number of seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Overview (right hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271, 274 Ownership accreditation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 O
Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Octane (petrol) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 P
decrease the navigation map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67, 68 Painting the vehicle
detailed view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 partial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
edit route . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Park Assist
enter an address for a guide destination . . . 179 Oil change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 see the assisted parking system (Park As-
favourite destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 One-touch signalling function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 sist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
frequent destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 Online services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 with the assisted parking system (Park As-
function: entering destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 sist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
increase the navigation map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 tank cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270, 271 Parking aid
last destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 automatic activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
learn usage pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 braking during the manoeuvre . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251, 253
330
Index

parking aid plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Places with risk of explosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Rear cross traffic alert (RCTA) . . . . . . . . . . 229, 232
rear parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 Places with special regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
see the assisted parking system (Park As- Power socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Rear fog light
sist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Power sockets control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
sensors and camera: clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
setting the indications and audio sig- Power steering Rear mounting
nals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251, 253 see Electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . 203 towing device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
surroundings warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Preheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 Rear parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
towing device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 Preheating system Rear seat
trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 folding down and raising the backrest . . . . . 127
visual indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250, 253 Preheat the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 Rear Traffic Alert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
Parking aid system Press & Drive Rear View Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247, 249, 252 start button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 Rear window wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Parking aid system (Park Assist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 Refuelling
angle parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
automatic brake operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 R fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
automatic interruption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Radar sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 gas tank indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
conditions for leaving a parking space . . . . 246 Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 natural gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
leaving a parking space (only when paral- equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 opening the fuel tank flap. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
lel parked) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 frequency bands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Releasing the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 preset buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Remote control key
parallel parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 unlock and lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
parking conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 Traffic information (TP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Repair work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
stop early . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 tune station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Requirements for Apple CarPlay . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Parking distance warning system Radio-operated remote control Reverse assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247, 249, 252 see Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Parking (automatic transmission) . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Radio mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
ParkPilot Radio screen: clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247, 249, 252 Radio telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 usage instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Rain sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Reverse assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Pedals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 15 function control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Reverse (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Petrol Raise the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Revolution counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67, 68, 79
additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 RCTA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Road signs
particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 see Rear cross traffic alert (RCTA) . . . . . . . . . 229 shown on the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
331
Index

Road signs detection system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Save fuel Selective unlocking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98


how it works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 inertia mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Selector lever lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
limited operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Selector lever (automatic gearbox)
shown on the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 emergency unlocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
speed warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 adjusting de seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Selling the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
windscreen damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Service
Roof carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Digital Maintenance plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
fix the crossbars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 protective function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 flexible service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
Roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 purpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 22 inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
Roof rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 oil change service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
Rotation direction unfastened . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 proof of Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
Running in control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 service sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
new brake pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 SEAT CONNECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 service works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
new engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 set service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
new tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 terms of use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
legal provisions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Service interval display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
S SEAT Digital Cockpit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
S-PIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 information profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Service Menu
Safe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 navigation map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 identifying letters on engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 SEAT Drive Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 restart the oil service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Safe security system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Seat heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 restart Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Safety SEAT Ident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 service intervals display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Seats time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 adjusting the headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Service notification: consult . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 backrest of the rear seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Set of vehicle keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Safety equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 fitting the headrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Shift paddles (automatic transmission) . . . . . . 199
Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Side airbags
head-protection airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 incorrect positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 manual adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
side airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 number of seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Sound settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
using child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 removing the headrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Sound system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
using seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 SEAT Service Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300 Spanner symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Seat's Mobility Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300 Spare parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
332
Index

Spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296 ECO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 other object holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135


Special characteristics Eco-driving notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 storage bag in the seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Android Auto™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Emergency brake assistance system (Front Storage compartment accessories
Apple CarPlay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Assist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 see Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
MirrorLink® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 gear-change recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Storage of accident data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51, 53 identifying letters on engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Storing objects
tow start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 loading the trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Speed limiter outside temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 positioning the load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
indication on display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 road signs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 positioning the luggage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 SEAT Drive Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 roof carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Speed symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 selector lever positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70, 197 roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132, 133
Speed warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Sport Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Stabilisation of the towing vehicle and trailer speed warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Sun blind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
combination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Sun protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Start-Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Travel Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 Switch
Start-Stop system tyre control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
disconnect and connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 warning and information messages . . . . . . . . 73 Switching off
driver indications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 Steering telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
how it works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 telephone interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 System settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
stopping and starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . 194 steering assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
the engine does not turn off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Steering assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 T
the engine starts by itself . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Steering wheel Tail lights
Starter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 adjust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 change a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Starting up the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Tail lights on the bodywork
Start the engine by towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 multifunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 remove the tail light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 shift paddles (automatic transmission) . . . . 199 Tail lights on the rear lid
Status display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Storage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 remove the bulb holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
ACT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 drawers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
active cylinder management status (ACT) . 69 glove compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 fuel consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 glove compartment light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 load on the roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
compass indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 on-board documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 vehicle dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
doors, bonnet and rear lid open . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 on the front passenger side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
333
Index

vertical load on the tow hitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 retrofitting a towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 safety check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 safety lug . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
Technical modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Towing bracket device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Telephone description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 stabilisation of the towing vehicle and trail-
contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 operation and conservation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 er combination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
disconnecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Towing device tail lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258, 259
favourites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 fitting a bicycle carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 technical requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
pairing a mobile phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 fitting later . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 towable loads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Phone book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 towing cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258, 259
send messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 Towing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51, 53 trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
speed dial buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52, 53 vertical load on the tow hitch . . . . . . . . 256, 260
to call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 front towline anchorage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Trailer mode
Telephone interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52, 53 see Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
places with risk of explosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 rear towline anchorage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Transportation of children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Temperature indicator special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51, 53 Travel Assist
exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 tow bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 see Driving Assist (Travel Assist) . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Time towing cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Trips abroad
adjust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72, 79 towing prohibited . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Tiptronic (automatic transmission) . . . . . . 197, 199 with towing device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 petrol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
To change the battery Traction control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Turning off the lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
of the vehicle key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Trademarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Turning on the lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
To park the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 Traffic information (TP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Turning the ignition on and off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Top Tether . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 34, 35 Traffic programme Turn signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Top Tether System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 34, 35 see TP (traffic information) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Tyre Mobility System
Torque Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256, 263 see Anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
wheel nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 adjusting the headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 Tyre pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Touch screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147, 148 anti-theft alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259, 260 Tyre pressure loss indicator
Touch zones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 connecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259, 267 Tyre pressure monitor indicator . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Towable loads exterior mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 Tyre pressure monitor system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
loading the trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260 hitching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Tyre profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Tow cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258, 259 LED tail lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258, 259 Tyre repair kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Tow hook loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260 see also Anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
fitting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Tyre repairs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
place in the reserve position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251, 253
power socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
334
Index

Tyres unlocking and locking with Keyless Access . 99 Wheel nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44, 293
accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 vehicle ID number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 anti-theft device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Vehicle battery caps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
directional tread pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 electrolyte level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
foreign objects inserted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Vehicle care Wheels
new tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 wiper blade service position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43, 46
speed symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Vehicle conservation products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
tread wear indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 Vehicle dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
tyre pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 Vehicle information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 new wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
useful life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 Vehicle location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
with directional tread pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Vehicle maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
Tyre tread depth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 Vehicle seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 wheel central trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Tyre wear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 Vehicle settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 wheel nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Vehicle tool kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Wheel spanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
U Vehicle wallet compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Wheel trim
Unlock and lock Vertical load on the tow hitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
by remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 loading the trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260 Wi-Fi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 voice control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Window controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
with Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Android Auto™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Windows
with the central locking switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Siri™ (Apple CarPlay™) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 automatic opening/closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 Volume automatic operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
USB port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 set for external audio sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 convenience closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
convenience opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
V W Window washer
Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Warning symbols window washer lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Variable luggage compartment floor . . . . . . . . 130 see Control and warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Window washer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Vehicle Warning triangle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39, 117 Window washer water
data label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
identification data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 Washing the vehicle filling quantities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
identification number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 conserving the exterior of the vehicle . . . . . . 301 refill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
lending or selling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 high pressure cleaning equipment . . . . . . . . . 301 Windscreen heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
parking on inclines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Windscreen washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
parking on upward slopes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 Windscreen wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
raise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Wheel balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Wheel central trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 lift the blade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
335
Index

rain sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121


reposition the blade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
service position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Winter conditions
trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Winter tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Wiper and rear window wiper blades
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
service position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Wiper blades
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
Wireless Charger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Wireless charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
WLAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164

X
XDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238

336
Vehicle identification data Confirmation of receipt of documentation
and vehicle keys
Model:
The following items were delivered
YES NO
with the vehicle:
Vehicle Registration:
On-board documentation
Vehicle identification
number: First key

Date of vehicle registration Second key


or vehicle delivery:
Correct working order of all keys was
checked
SEAT Official Service:
Location:

SEAT S.A. is permanently concerned about continuous development of its types and models. For this reason we ask you to understand,
that at any given time, changes regarding shape, equipment and technique may take place on the car delivered. For this reason no
Date: right at all may derive based on the data, drawings and descriptions in this current handbook.
All texts, illustrations and standards in this handbook are based on the status of information at the time of printing. Except for error or
omission, the information included in the current handbook is valid as of the date of closing print.
Signature of owner: Re-printing, copying or translating, whether total or partial is not allowed unless SEAT allows it in written form.
SEAT reserves all rights in accordance with the “Copyright” Act.
Service advisor:
All rights on changes are reserved.

Telephone:
❀ This paper has been manufactured using bleached non-chlorine cellulose.
© SEAT S.A. - Reprint: 15.11.21
Inglés 6F9012720BQ (11.21)

6F9012720BQ

SEAT Arona Inglés (11.21)


Owner’s manual
Arona

You might also like